PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8-Bit LCD Flash Microcontroller with USB and XLP Technology
eXtreme Low-Power Features
• Multiple Power Management Options for Extreme
Power Reduction:
- VBAT allows for lowest power consumption on
back-up battery (with or without RTCC)
- Deep Sleep allows near total power-down with the
ability to wake-up on external triggers
- Sleep and Idle modes selectively shut down
peripherals and/or core for substantial power
reduction and fast wake-up
• Alternate Clock modes Allow On-the-Fly Switching to
a Lower Clock Speed for Selective Power Reduction
• Extreme Low-Power Current Consumption for
Deep Sleep:
- WDT: 650 nA @ 2V typical
- RTCC: 650 nA @ 32 kHz, 2V typical
- Deep Sleep current, 80 nA typical
Universal Serial Bus Features
• USB V2.0 Compliant
• Low Speed (1.5 Mb/s) and Full Speed (12 Mb/s)
• Supports Control, Interrupt, Isochronous and Bulk
Transfers
• Supports up to 32 Endpoints (16 bidirectional)
• USB module can use Any RAM Location on the
Device as USB Endpoint Buffers
• On-Chip USB Transceiver
Peripheral Features
• LCD Display Controller:
- Up to 60 segments by 8 commons
- Internal charge pump and low-power, internal
resistor biasing
- Operation in Sleep mode
• Up to Four External Interrupt Sources
• Peripheral Pin Select Lite (PPS-Lite):
- Allows independent I/O mapping of many
peripherals
• Four 16-Bit and Four 8-Bit Timers/Counters with
Prescaler
• Seven Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) modules
• Three Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP)
modules:
- One, two or four PWM outputs
- Selectable polarity
- Programmable dead time
- Auto-shutdown and auto-restart
- Pulse steering control
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
• Hardware Real-Time Clock/Calendar (RTCC):
- Runs in Deep Sleep and VBAT modes
• Two Master Synchronous Serial Ports (MSSP)
modules Featuring:
- 3-Wire/4-Wire SPI (all 4 modes)
- SPI Direct Memory Access (DMA) channel
w/1024 byte count
- Two I2C modules Support Multi-Master/Slave
mode and 7-Bit/10-Bit Addressing
• Four Enhanced Addressable USART modules:
- Support RS-485, RS-232 and LIN/J2602
- On-chip hardware encoder/decoder for IrDA®
- Auto-wake-up on Auto-Baud Detect
• Digital Signal Modulator Provides On-Chip OOK,
FSK and PSK Modulation for a Digital Signal Stream
• High-Current Sink/Source 18 mA/18 mA on all Digital I/O
• Configurable Open-Drain Outputs on ECCP/CCP/
USART/MSSP
• Extended Microcontroller mode Using 12, 16 or
20-Bit Addressing mode
Analog Features
• 10/12-Bit, 24-Channel Analog-to-Digital (A/D)
Converter:
- Conversion rate of 500 ksps (10-bit),
200 kbps (12-bit)
- Conversion available during Sleep and Idle
• Three Rail-to-Rail Enhanced Analog Comparators
with Programmable Input/Output Configuration
• On-Chip Programmable Voltage Reference
• Charge Time Measurement Unit (CTMU):
- Used for capacitive touch sensing, up to
24 channels
- Time measurement down to 1 ns resolution
- CTMU temperature sensing
High-Performance CPU
• High-Precision PLL for USB
• Two External Clock modes, Up to 64 MHz
(16 MIPS®)
• Internal 31 kHz Oscillator
• High-Precision Internal Oscillator with Clock
Recovery from SOSC to Achieve 0.15% Precision,
31 kHz to 8 MHz or 64 MHz w/PLL,
±0.15% Typical, ±1.5% Max.
• Secondary Oscillator using Timer1 @ 32 kHz
• C Compiler Optimized Instruction Set Architecture
• Two Address Generation Units for Separate Read
and Write Addressing of Data Memory
DS30000575C-page 1
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Special Microcontroller Features
• Power-on Reset (POR), Power-up Timer (PWRT)
and Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• Brown-out Reset (BOR) with Operation Below VBOR,
with Regulator Enabled
• High/Low-Voltage Detect (HLVD)
• Flexible Watchdog Timer (WDT) with its Own
RC Oscillator for Reliable Operation
• Standard and Ultra Low-Power Watchdog Timers
(WDT) for Reliable Operation in Standard and Deep
Sleep modes
• Operating Voltage Range of 2.0V to 3.6V
• Two On-Chip Voltage Regulators (1.8V and 1.2V) for
Regular and Extreme Low-Power Operation
• 20,000 Erase/Write Cycle Endurance Flash Program
Memory, Typical
• Flash Data Retention: 10 Years Minimum
• Self-Programmable under Software Control
• Two Configurable Reference Clock Outputs
(REFO1 and REFO2)
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Operation:
- Detects clock failure and switches to on-chip,
low-power RC oscillator
TABLE 1:
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY TYPES
Flash
Program
(bytes)
Data SRAM
(bytes)
Timers
8-Bit/16-Bit
USART w/IrDA®
SPI w/ DMA
Comparators
CCP/ECCP
I2C
10/12-Bit A/D (ch)
CTMU
LCD (pixels)
USB
Deep Sleep w/VBAT
PPS (Lite)
Remappable Peripherals
Pins
Memory
PIC18F97J94
100
128K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
480
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F87J94
80
128K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
352
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F67J94
64
128K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
16
Y
224
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F96J94
100
64K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
480
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F86J94
80
64K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
352
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F66J94
64
64K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
16
Y
224
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F95J94
100
32K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
480
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F85J94
80
32K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
24
Y
352
Y
Y
Lite
PIC18F65J94
64
32K
4K
4
4
2
3
Y
2
16
Y
224
Y
Y
Lite
Device
For other small form-factor package availability and marking information, visit http://www.microchip.com/packaging or
contact your local sales office.
DS30000575C-page 2
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
PIN DIAGRAMS
64-PIN TQFP, QFN DIAGRAM FOR PIC18F6XJ94
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
LCDBIAS3/RP30/CS/RE2
COM0/RP33/REFO1/RE3
COM1/RP32/RE4
COM2/RP37/RE5
COM3/RP34/RE6
LCDBIAS0/RP31/RE7
SEG0/RP20/PSP0/RD0
VDD
VSS
SEG1/RP21/PSP1/RD1
SEG2/RP22/PSP2/RD2
SEG3/RP23/PSP3/RD3
SEG4/RP24/PSP4/RD4
SEG5/SDA2/RP25/PSP5/RD5
SEG6/SCL2/RP26/PSP6/RD6
SEG7/RP27/REFO2/PSP7/RD7
FIGURE 1:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
PIC18F6XJ94
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
VLCAP1/RP8/CTED13/INT0/RB0
VLCAP2/RP9/RB1
SEG9/RP14/CTED1/RB2
SEG10/RP7/CTED2/RB3
SEG11/RP12/CTED3/RB4
SEG8/RP13/CTED4/RB5
CTED5/PGC/RB6
VSS
OSC2/CLKO/RP6/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RP10/RA7
VDD
CTED6/PGD/RB7
SEG12/RP16/CTED10/RC5
SEG16/SDA1/RP17/CTED9/RC4
SEG17/SCL1/RP15/CTED8/RC3
SEG13/AN9/RP11/CTED7/RC2
VUSB3V3
VBAT
AVDD
AVSS
VREF+/AN3/RP3/RA3
SEG21/VREF-/AN2/RP2/RA2
SEG18/AN1/RP1/RA1
SEG19/AN0/AN1-/RP0/RA0
VSS
VDD
SEG15/AN4/LVDIN/C1INA/C2INA/C3INA/RP5/RA5
SEG14/AN6/RP4/RA4
SOSCI/RC1
SOSCO/SCLKI/PWRLCLK/RC0
SEG27/RP18/UOE/CTED11/RC6
SEG22/RP19/CTED12/RC7
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR/RE1
LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD/RE0
COM4/SEG28/AN8/RP46/RG0
COM5/SEG29/AN19/RP39/RG1
COM6/SEG30/AN18/C3INA/RP42/RG2
COM7/SEG31/AN17/C3INB/RP43/RG3
MCLR
SEG26/AN16/C3INC/RP44/RTCC/RG4
VSS
VCAP
SEG25/AN5/RP38/RF7
SEG24/AN11/C1INA/RP40/RF6
SEG23/CVREF/AN10/C1INB/RP35/RF5
D+/RF4
D-/RF3
SEG20/AN7/CTMUI/C2INB/RP36/RF2
Note 1: Pinouts are subject to change.
2: See Table 2 for the pin allocation table.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 3
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
80-PIN TQFP DIAGRAM FOR PIC18F8XJ94
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
A17/SEG46/AN22/RH1
A16/SEG47/AN23/RH0
AD10/LCDBIAS3/RP30/CS/RE2
AD11/COM0/RP33/REFO1/RE3
AD12/COM1/RP32/RE4
AD13/COM2/RP37/RE5
AD14/COM3/RP34/RE6
AD15/LCDBIAS0/RP31/RE7
AD0/SEG0/RP20/PSP0/RD0
VDD
VSS
AD1/SEG1/RP21/PSP1/RD1
AD2/SEG2/RP22/PSP2/RD2
AD3/SEG3/RP23/PSP3/RD3
AD4/SEG4/RP24/PSP4/RD4
AD5/SEG5/SDA2/RP25/PSP5/RD5
AD6/SEG6/SCL2/RP26/PSP6/RD6
AD7/SEG7/RP27/REFO2/PSP7/RD7
ALE/SEG32/RJ0
OE/SEG33/RJ1
FIGURE 2:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
PIC18F8XJ94
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
WRL/SEG34/RJ2
WRH/SEG35/RJ3
VLCAP1/RP8/CTED13/INT0/RB0
VLCAP2/RP9/RB1
SEG9/RP14/CTED1/RB2
SEG10/RP7/CTED2/RB3
SEG11/RP12/CTED3/RB4
SEG8/RP13/CTED4/RB5
CTED5/PGC/RB6
VSS
OSC2/CLKO/RP6/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RP10/RA7
VDD
CTED6/PGD/RB7
SEG12/RP16/CTED10/RC5
SEG16/SDA1/RP17/CTED9/RC4
SEG17/SCL1/RP15/CTED8/RC3
SEG13/AN9/RP11/CTED7/RC2
UB/SEG36/RJ7
LB/SEG37/RJ6
SEG41/AN13/C2IND/RH5
SEG40/AN12/C2INC/RH4
VUSB3V3
VBAT
AVDD
AVSS
VREF+/AN3/RP3/RA3
SEG21/VREF-/AN2/RP2/RA2
SEG18/AN1/RP1/RA1
SEG19/AN0/AN1-/RP0/RA0
Vss
VDD
SEG15/AN4/LVDIN/C1INA/C2INA/C3INA/RP5/RA5
SEG14/AN6/RP4/RA4
SOSCI/RC1
SOSCO/SCLKI/PWRLCLK/RC0
SEG27/RP18/UOE/CTED11/RC6
SEG22/RP19/CTED12/RC7
BA0/SEG39/RJ4
CE/SEG38/RJ5
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
A18/SEG45/AN21/RH2
A19/SEG44/AN20/RH3
AD9/LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR/RE1
AD8/LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD/RE0
COM4/SEG28/AN8/RP46/RG0
COM5/SEG29/AN19/RP39/RG1
COM6/SEG30/AN18/C3INA/RP42/RG2
COM7/SEG31/AN17/C3INB/RP43/RG3
MCLR
SEG26/AN16/C3INC/RP44/RTCC/RG4
VSS
VCAP
SEG25/AN5/RP38/RF7
SEG24/AN11/C1INA/RP40/RF6
SEG23/CVREF/AN10/C1INB/RP35/RF5
D+/RF4
D-/RF3
SEG20/AN7/C2INB/RP36/RF2
SEG43/AN15/RH7
SEG42/AN14/C1INC/RH6
Note 1: Pinouts are subject to change.
2: See Table 3 for the pin allocation table.
DS30000575C-page 4
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
100-PIN TQFP DIAGRAM FOR PIC18F9XJ94
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
PIC18F9XJ94
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
WRL/SEG34/RJ2
WRH/SEG35/RJ3
VLCAP1/RP8/CTED13/INT0/RB0
VLCAP2/RP9/RB1
DDIO1/SEG61/RK5
SEG9/RP14/CTED1/RB2
SEG10/RP7/CTED2/RB3
SEG11/RP12/CTED3/RB4
SEG8/RP13/CTED4/RB5
DDIO0/SEG60/RK4
CTED5/PGC/RB6
VSS
SEG59/RK3
OSC2/CLKO/RP6/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RP10/RA7
SEG58/RK2
VDD
CTED6/PGD/RB7
SEG12/RP16/CTED10/RC5
SEG16/SDA1/RP17/CTED9/RC4
SEG57/RK1
SEG17/SCL1/RP15/CTED8/RC3
SEG13/AN9/RP11/CTED7/RC2
UB/SEG36/RJ7
LB/SEG37/RJ6
SEG41/AN13/C2IND/RH5
SEG40/AN12/C2INC/RH4
VUSB3V3
VBAT
SEG53/RL5
AVDD
AVSS
VREF+/AN3/RP3/RA3
SEG21/VREF-/AN2/RP2/RA2
VSS
SEG18/AN1/RP1/RA1
SEG19/AN0/AN1-/RP0/RA0
SEG54/RL6
VSS
VDD
SEG55/RL7
SEG15/AN4/LVDIN/C1INA/C2INA/C3INA/RP5/RA5
SEG14/AN6/RP4/RA4
SOSCI/RC1
SOSCO/SCLKI/PWRLCLK/RC0
SEG56/RK0
SEG27/RP18/UOE/CTED11/RC6
SEG22/RP19/CTED12/RC7
BA0/SEG39/RJ4
CE/SEG38/RJ5
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
A18/SEG45/AN21/RH2
A19/SEG44/AN20/RH3
AD9/LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR/RE1
AD8/LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD/RE0
VDD
COM4/SEG28/AN8/RP46/RG0
COM5/SEG29/AN19/RP39/RG1
COM6/SEG30/AN18/C3INA/RP42/RG2
COM7/SEG31/AN17/C3INB/RP43/RG3
SEG49/RL1
MCLR
SEG26/AN16/C3INC/RP44/RTCC/RG4
SEG50/RL2
VSS
VCAP
SEG51/RL3
SEG25/AN5/RP38/RF7
SEG24/AN11/C1INA/RP40/RF6
SEG23/CVREF/AN10/C1INB/RP35/RF5
D+/RF4
SEG52/RL4
D-/RF3
SEG20/AN7/CTMUI/C2INB/RP36/RF2
SEG43/AN15/RH7
SEG42/AN14/C1INC/RH6
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
A17/SEG46/AN22/RH1
A16/SEG47/AN23/RH0
AD10/LCDBIAS3/RP30/CS/RE2
AD11/COM0/RP33/REFO1/RE3
RG7
AD12/COM1/RP32/RE4
AD13/COM2/RP37/RE5
AD14/COM3/RP34/RE6
AD15/LCDBIAS0/RP31/RE7
SEG48/RL0
AD0/SEG0/RP20/PSP0/RD0
RG6
VDD
VSS
AD1/SEG1/RP21/PSP1/RD1
SEG63/RK7
AD2/SEG2/RP22/PSP2/RD2
AD3/SEG3/RP23/PSP3/RD3
AD4/SEG4/RP24/PSP4/RD4
AD5/SEG5/SDA2/RP25/PSP5/RD5
SEG62/RK6
AD6/SEG6/SCL2/RP26/PSP6/RD6
AD7/SEG7/RP27/REFO2/PSP7/RD7
ALE/SEG32/RJ0
OE/SEG33/RJ1
FIGURE 3:
Note 1: Pinouts are subject to change.
2: See Table 4 for the pin allocation table.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 5
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
PIN ALLOCATION TABLES
USB
LCD
MSSP
PSP
Interrupt
REFO
PPS-Lite(1)
Pull-up
Basic
AN0/
AN1-
—
—
—
—
SEG19
—
—
—
—
RP0
—
—
ADC
CTMU
24
HLVD
RA0
Comparator
64-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F6XJ94)
64-Pin TQFP/QFN
I/O
TABLE 2:
RA1
23
AN1
—
—
—
—
SEG18
—
—
—
—
RP1
—
—
RA2
22
AN2/
VREF-
—
—
—
—
SEG21
—
—
—
—
RP2
—
—
RA3
21
AN3/
VREF+
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP3
—
—
RA4
28
AN6
—
—
—
—
SEG14
—
—
—
—
RP4
—
—
RA5
27
AN4
C1INA/
C2INA/
C3INA
LVDIN
—
—
SEG15
—
—
—
—
RP5
—
—
RA6
40
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP6
—
OSC2/
CLKO
RA7
39
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP10
—
OSC1/
CLKI
RB0
48
—
—
—
CTED13
—
VLCAP1
—
—
INT0
—
RP8
—
—
RB1
47
—
—
—
—
—
VLCAP2
—
—
—
—
RP9
—
—
RB2
46
—
—
—
CTED1
—
SEG9
—
—
—
—
RP14
—
—
RB3
45
—
—
—
CTED2
—
SEG10
—
—
—
—
RP7
—
—
RB4
44
—
—
—
CTED3
—
SEG11
—
—
—
—
RP12
—
—
RB5
43
—
—
—
CTED4
—
SEG8
—
—
—
—
RP13
—
—
RB6
42
—
—
—
CTED5
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGC
RB7
37
—
—
—
CTED6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGD
RC0
30
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SOSCO/
SCKI/
PWRCLK
RC1
29
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SOSCI
RC2
33
AN9
—
—
CTED7
—
SEG13
—
—
—
—
RP11
—
—
RC3
34
—
—
—
CTED8
—
SEG17
SCL1
—
—
—
RP15
—
—
RC4
35
—
—
—
CTED9
—
SEG16
SDA1
—
—
—
RP17
—
—
RC5
36
—
—
—
CTED10
—
SEG12
—
—
—
—
RP16
—
—
RC6
31
—
—
—
CTED11
UOE
SEG27
—
—
—
—
RP18
—
—
RC7
32
—
—
—
CTED12
—
SEG22
—
—
—
—
RP19
—
—
RD0
58
—
—
—
—
—
SEG0
—
PSP0
—
—
RP20
Y
—
RD1
55
—
—
—
—
—
SEG1
—
PSP1
—
—
RP21
Y
—
RD2
54
—
—
—
—
—
SEG2
—
PSP2
—
—
RP22
Y
—
RD3
53
—
—
—
—
—
SEG3
—
PSP3
—
—
RP23
Y
—
RD4
52
—
—
—
—
—
SEG4
—
PSP4
—
—
RP24
Y
—
RD5
51
—
—
—
—
—
SEG5
SDA2
PSP5
—
—
RP25
Y
—
RD6
50
—
—
—
—
—
SEG6
SCL2
PSP6
—
—
RP26
Y
—
RD7
49
—
—
—
—
—
SEG7
—
PSP7
—
REFO2
RP27
Y
—
RE0
2
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS1
—
RD
—
—
RP28
Y
—
RE1
1
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS2
—
WR
—
—
RP29
Y
—
RE2
64
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS3
—
CS
—
—
RP30
Y
—
RE3
63
—
—
—
—
—
COM0
—
—
—
REFO1
RP33
Y
—
RE4
62
—
—
—
—
—
COM1
—
—
—
—
RP32
Y
—
RE5
61
—
—
—
—
—
COM2
—
—
—
—
RP37
Y
—
DS30000575C-page 6
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Basic
Pull-up
PPS-Lite(1)
REFO
Interrupt
PSP
MSSP
LCD
USB
CTMU
HLVD
Comparator
I/O
ADC
64-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F6XJ94) (CONTINUED)
64-Pin TQFP/QFN
TABLE 2:
RE6
60
—
—
—
—
—
COM3
—
—
—
—
RP34
Y
—
RE7
59
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS0
—
—
—
—
RP31
Y
—
RF2
16
AN7
C2INB
—
CTMUI
—
SEG20
—
—
—
—
RP36
Y
—
RF3
15
—
—
—
—
D-
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RF4
14
—
—
—
—
D+
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RF5
13
AN10
C1INB/
CVREF
—
—
—
SEG23
—
—
—
—
RP35
Y
—
RF6
12
AN11
C1INA
—
—
—
SEG24
—
—
—
—
RP40
Y
—
RF7
11
AN5
—
—
—
—
SEG25
—
—
—
—
RP38
Y
—
RG0
3
AN8
—
—
—
—
COM4/
SEG28
—
—
—
—
RP46
Y
—
RG1
4
AN19
—
—
—
—
COM5/
SEG29
—
—
—
—
RP39
Y
—
RG2
5
AN18
C3INA
—
—
—
COM6/
SEG30
—
—
—
—
RP42
Y
—
RG3
6
AN17
C3INB
—
—
—
COM7/
SEG31
—
—
—
—
RP43
Y
—
RG4
8
AN16
C3INC
—
—
—
SEG26
—
—
—
—
RP44
Y
—
RG5/
MCLR
7
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
MCLR
AVDD
19
AVDD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
AVSS
20
AVSS
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
18
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
VCAP/
VDDCORE
10
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VCAP/
VDD
26,
38,
57
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
VSS
9,
25,
41,
56
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
VUSB3V3
17
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VUSB3V3
Note
The peripheral inputs and outputs that support PPS have no default pins.
1:
VDDCORE
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 7
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
80-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F8XJ94)
HLVD
CTMU
USB
LCD
MSSP
PSP
Interrupt
REFO
EMB
PPS-Lite(1)
Pull-up
Basic
AN0/
AN1-
—
—
—
—
SEG19
—
—
—
—
—
RP0
—
—
29
AN1
—
—
—
—
SEG18
—
—
—
—
—
RP1
—
—
28
AN2/
VREF-
—
—
—
—
SEG21
—
—
—
—
—
RP2
—
—
27
AN3/
VREF+
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP3
—
—
RA0
30
RA1
RA2
RA3
ADC
Comparator
80-Pin TQFP
I/O
TABLE 3:
RA4
34
AN6
—
—
—
—
SEG14
—
—
—
—
—
RP4
—
—
RA5
33
AN4
C1INA/
C2INA/
C3INA
LVDIN
—
—
SEG15
—
—
—
—
—
RP5
—
—
RA6
50
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP6
—
OSC2/
CLKO
RA7
49
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP10
—
OSC1/
CLKI
—
RB0
58
—
—
—
CTED13
—
VLCAP1
—
—
INT0
—
—
RP8
—
RB1
57
—
—
—
—
—
VLCAP2
—
—
—
—
—
RP9
—
—
RB2
56
—
—
—
CTED1
—
SEG9
—
—
—
—
—
RP14
—
—
RB3
55
—
—
—
CTED2
—
SEG10
—
—
—
—
—
RP7
—
—
RB4
54
—
—
—
CTED3
—
SEG11
—
—
—
—
—
RP12
—
—
RB5
53
—
—
—
CTED4
—
SEG8
—
—
—
—
—
RP13
—
—
RB6
52
—
—
—
CTED5
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGC
RB7
47
—
—
—
CTED6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGD
RC0
36
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SOSCO/
SCKI/
PWRCLK
SOSCI
RC1
35
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RC2
43
AN9
—
—
CTED7
—
SEG13
—
—
—
—
—
RP11
—
—
RC3
44
—
—
—
CTED8
—
SEG17
SCL1
—
—
—
—
RP15
—
—
—
—
RC4
45
—
—
—
CTED9
—
SEG16
SDA1
—
—
—
—
RP17
RC5
46
—
—
—
CTED10
—
SEG12
—
—
—
—
—
RP16
RC6
37
—
—
—
CTED11
UOE
SEG27
—
—
—
—
—
RP18
—
—
RC7
38
—
—
—
CTED12
—
SEG22
—
—
—
—
—
RP19
—
—
RD0
72
—
—
—
—
—
SEG0
—
PSP0
—
—
AD0
RP20
Y
—
RD1
69
—
—
—
—
—
SEG1
—
PSP1
—
—
AD1
RP21
Y
—
—
—
—
—
—
SEG2
—
PSP2
—
—
RD2
68
RD3
67
SEG3
PSP3
AD2
RP22
Y
—
AD3
RP23
Y
—
RD4
66
—
—
—
—
—
SEG4
—
PSP4
—
—
AD4
RP24
Y
—
RD5
65
—
—
—
—
—
SEG5
SDA2
PSP5
—
—
AD5
RP25
Y
—
RD6
64
—
—
—
—
—
SEG6
SCL2
PSP6
—
—
AD6
RP26
Y
—
RD7
63
—
—
—
—
—
SEG7
—
PSP7
—
REFO2
AD7
RP27
Y
—
RE0
4
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS1
—
RD
—
—
AD8
RP28
Y
—
RE1
3
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS2
—
WR
—
—
AD9
RP29
Y
—
RE2
78
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS3
—
CS
—
—
AD10
RP30
Y
—
RE3
77
—
—
—
—
—
COM0
—
—
—
REFO1
AD11
RP33
Y
—
RE4
76
—
—
—
—
—
COM1
—
—
—
—
AD12
RP32
Y
—
RE5
75
—
—
—
—
—
COM2
—
—
—
—
AD13
RP37
Y
—
RE6
74
—
—
—
—
—
COM3
—
—
—
—
AD14
RP34
Y
—
RE7
73
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS0
—
—
—
—
AD15
RP31
Y
—
RF2
18
AN7
C2INB
SEG20
—
—
—
—
—
RP36
Y
—
DS30000575C-page 8
CTMUI
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Comparator
HLVD
CTMU
USB
LCD
MSSP
PSP
Interrupt
REFO
EMB
PPS-Lite(1)
Pull-up
Basic
RF3
17
—
—
—
—
D-
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RF4
16
—
—
—
—
D+
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RF5
15
AN10
C1INB/
CVREF
—
—
—
SEG23
—
—
—
—
—
RP35
Y
—
I/O
ADC
80-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F8XJ94) (CONTINUED)
80-Pin TQFP
TABLE 3:
RF6
14
AN11
C1INA
—
—
—
SEG24
—
—
—
—
—
RP40
Y
—
RF7
13
AN5
—
—
—
—
SEG25
—
—
—
—
—
RP38
Y
—
RG0
5
AN8
—
—
—
—
COM4/
SEG28
—
—
—
—
—
RP46
Y
—
RG1
6
AN19
—
—
—
—
COM5/
SEG29
—
—
—
—
—
RP39
Y
—
RG2
7
AN18
C3INA
—
—
—
COM6/
SEG30
—
—
—
—
—
RP42
Y
—
RG3
8
AN17
C3INB
—
—
—
COM7/
SEG31
—
—
—
—
—
RP43
Y
—
RG4
10
AN16
C3INC
—
—
—
SEG26
—
—
—
—
—
RP44
Y
—
RG5/
MCLR
9
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
MCLR
RH0
79
AN23
—
—
—
—
SEG47
—
—
—
—
A16
—
Y
—
RH1
80
AN22
—
—
—
—
SEG46
—
—
—
—
A17
—
Y
—
RH2
1
AN21
—
—
—
—
SEG45
—
—
—
—
A18
—
Y
—
RH3
2
AN20
—
—
—
—
SEG44
—
—
—
—
A19
—
Y
—
RH4
22
AN12
C2INC
—
—
—
SEG40
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH5
21
AN13
C2IND
—
—
—
SEG41
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH6
20
AN14
C1INC
—
—
—
SEG42
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH7
19
AN15
—
—
—
—
SEG43
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RJ0
62
—
—
—
—
—
SEG32
—
—
—
—
ALE
—
Y
—
RJ1
61
—
—
—
—
—
SEG33
—
—
—
—
OE
—
Y
—
RJ2
60
—
—
—
—
—
SEG34
—
—
—
—
WRL
—
Y
—
RJ3
59
—
—
—
—
—
SEG35
—
—
—
—
WRH
—
Y
—
RJ4
39
—
—
—
—
—
SEG39
—
—
—
—
BA0
—
Y
—
RJ5
40
—
—
—
—
—
SEG38
—
—
—
—
CE
—
Y
—
RJ6
41
—
—
—
—
—
SEG37
—
—
—
—
LB
—
Y
—
RJ7
42
—
—
—
—
—
SEG36
—
—
—
—
UB
—
Y
—
AVDD
25
AVDD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
AVSS
26
AVSS
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
24
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
VCAP/
VDDCORE
12
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VCAP/
VDD
32, 48,
71
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
VSS
11, 31,
51, 70
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
23
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VUSB3V3
VUSB3V3
Note
1:
VDDCORE
The peripheral inputs and outputs that support PPS have no default pins.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 9
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
100-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F9XJ94)
HLVD
CTMU
USB
LCD
MSSP
PSP
Interrupt
REFO
EMB
PPS-Lite(1)
Pull-up
Basic
AN0/
AN1-
—
—
—
—
SEG19
—
—
—
—
—
RP0
—
—
36
AN1
—
—
—
—
SEG18
—
—
—
—
—
RP1
—
—
34
AN2/
VREF-
—
—
—
—
SEG21
—
—
—
—
—
RP2
—
—
33
AN3/
VREF+
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP3
—
—
RA0
37
RA1
RA2
RA3
ADC
Comparator
100-Pin TQFP
I/O
TABLE 4:
RA4
43
AN6
—
—
—
—
SEG14
—
—
—
—
—
RP4
—
—
RA5
42
AN4
C1INA/
C2INA/
C3INA
LVDIN
—
—
SEG15
—
—
—
—
—
RP5
—
—
RA6
62
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP6
—
OSC2/
CLKO
RA7
61
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RP10
—
OSC1/
CLKI
RB0
73
—
—
—
CTED13
—
VLCAP1
—
—
INT0
—
—
RP8
—
—
RB1
72
—
—
—
—
—
VLCAP2
—
—
—
—
—
RP9
—
—
RB2
70
—
—
—
CTED1
—
SEG9
—
—
—
—
—
RP14
—
—
RB3
69
—
—
—
CTED2
—
SEG10
—
—
—
—
—
RP7
—
—
RB4
68
—
—
—
CTED3
—
SEG11
—
—
—
—
—
RP12
—
—
RB5
67
—
—
—
CTED4
—
SEG8
—
—
—
—
—
RP13
—
—
RB6
65
—
—
—
CTED5
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGC
RB7
58
—
—
—
CTED6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PGD
RC0
45
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SOSCO/
SCKI/
PWRCLK
RC1
44
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SOSCI
RC2
53
AN9
—
—
CTED7
—
SEG13
—
—
—
—
—
RP11
—
—
RC3
54
—
—
—
CTED8
—
SEG17
SCL1
—
—
—
—
RP15
—
—
RC4
56
—
—
—
CTED9
—
SEG16
SDA1
—
—
—
—
RP17
—
—
RC5
57
—
—
—
CTED10
—
SEG12
—
—
—
—
—
RP16
—
—
RC6
47
—
—
—
CTED11
UOE
SEG27
—
—
—
—
—
RP18
—
—
RC7
48
—
—
—
CTED12
—
SEG22
—
—
—
—
—
RP19
—
—
RD0
90
—
—
—
—
—
SEG0
—
PSP0
—
—
AD0
RP20
Y
—
RD1
86
—
—
—
—
—
SEG1
—
PSP1
—
—
AD1
RP21
Y
—
RD2
84
—
—
—
—
—
SEG2
—
PSP2
—
—
AD2
RP22
Y
—
RD3
83
—
—
—
—
—
SEG3
—
PSP3
—
—
AD3
RP23
Y
—
RD4
82
—
—
—
—
—
SEG4
—
PSP4
—
—
AD4
RP24
Y
—
RD5
81
—
—
—
—
—
SEG5
SDA2
PSP5
—
—
AD5
RP25
Y
—
RD6
79
—
—
—
—
—
SEG6
SCL2
PSP6
—
—
AD6
RP26
Y
—
RD7
78
—
—
—
—
—
SEG7
—
PSP7
—
REFO2
AD7
RP27
Y
—
RE0
4
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS1
—
RD-bar
—
—
AD8
RP28
Y
—
RE1
3
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS2
—
WRbar
—
—
AD9
RP29
Y
—
—
RE2
98
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS3
—
CS-bar
—
—
AD10
RP30
Y
RE3
97
—
—
—
—
—
COM0
—
—
—
REFO1
AD11
RP33
Y
—
RE4
95
—
—
—
—
—
COM1
—
—
—
—
AD12
RP32
Y
—
RE5
94
—
—
—
—
—
COM2
—
—
—
—
AD13
RP37
Y
—
RE6
93
—
—
—
—
—
COM3
—
—
—
—
AD14
RP34
Y
—
RE7
92
—
—
—
—
—
LCDBIAS0
—
—
—
—
AD15
RP31
Y
—
DS30000575C-page 10
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
PPS-Lite(1)
—
SEG20
—
—
—
—
—
RP36
Y
—
—
D-
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
Basic
EMB
CTMUI
—
Pull-up
LCD
—
—
REFO
USB
C2INB
—
Interrupt
CTMU
AN7
PSP
HLVD
23
22
MSSP
Comparator
RF2
RF3
I/O
ADC
100-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F9XJ94) (CONTINUED)
100-Pin TQFP
TABLE 4:
RF4
20
—
—
—
—
D+
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RF5
19
AN10
C1INB/
CVREF
—
—
—
SEG23
—
—
—
—
—
RP35
Y
—
RF6
18
AN11
C1INA
—
—
—
SEG24
—
—
—
—
—
RP40
Y
—
RF7
17
AN5
—
—
—
—
SEG25
—
—
—
—
—
RP38
Y
—
RG0
6
AN8
—
—
—
—
COM4/
SEG28
—
—
—
—
—
RP46
Y
—
RG1
7
AN19
—
—
—
—
COM5/
SEG29
—
—
—
—
—
RP39
Y
—
RG2
8
AN18
C3INA
—
—
—
COM6/
SEG30
—
—
—
—
—
RP42
Y
—
RG3
9
AN17
C3INB
—
—
—
COM7/
SEG31
—
—
—
—
—
RP43
Y
—
RG4
12
AN16
C3INC
—
—
—
SEG26
—
—
—
—
—
RP44
Y
—
RG5/
MCLR
11
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
MCLR
RG6
89
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RG7
96
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH0
99
AN23
—
—
—
—
SEG47
—
—
—
—
A16
—
Y
—
RH1
100
AN22
—
—
—
—
SEG46
—
—
—
—
A17
—
Y
—
RH2
1
AN21
—
—
—
—
SEG45
—
—
—
—
A18
—
Y
—
RH3
2
AN20
—
—
—
—
SEG44
—
—
—
—
A19
—
Y
—
RH4
27
AN12
C2INC
—
—
—
SEG40
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH5
26
AN13
C2IND
—
—
—
SEG41
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH6
25
AN14
C1INC
—
—
—
SEG42
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RH7
24
AN15
—
—
—
—
SEG43
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RJ0
77
—
—
—
—
—
SEG32
—
—
—
—
ALE
—
Y
—
RJ1
76
—
—
—
—
—
SEG33
—
—
—
—
OE
—
Y
—
RJ2
75
—
—
—
—
—
SEG34
—
—
—
—
WRL
—
Y
—
RJ3
74
—
—
—
—
—
SEG35
—
—
—
—
WRH
—
Y
—
RJ4
49
—
—
—
—
—
SEG39
—
—
—
—
BA0
—
Y
—
RJ5
50
—
—
—
—
—
SEG38
—
—
—
—
CE
—
Y
—
RJ6
51
—
—
—
—
—
SEG37
—
—
—
—
LB
—
Y
—
RJ7
52
—
—
—
—
—
SEG36
—
—
—
—
UB
—
Y
—
RK0
46
—
—
—
—
—
SEG56
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK1
55
—
—
—
—
—
SEG57
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK2
60
—
—
—
—
—
SEG58
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK3
63
—
—
—
—
—
SEG59
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK4
66
—
—
—
—
—
SEG60
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK5
71
—
—
—
—
—
SEG61
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK6
80
—
—
—
—
—
SEG62
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RK7
85
—
—
—
—
—
SEG63
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL0
91
—
—
—
—
—
SEG48
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL1
10
—
—
—
—
—
SEG49
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL2
13
—
—
—
—
—
SEG50
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL3
16
—
—
—
—
—
SEG51
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL4
21
—
—
—
—
—
SEG52
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL5
30
—
—
—
—
—
SEG53
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 11
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Basic
Pull-up
PPS-Lite(1)
EMB
REFO
Interrupt
PSP
MSSP
LCD
USB
CTMU
HLVD
Comparator
I/O
ADC
100-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE (PIC18F9XJ94) (CONTINUED)
100-Pin TQFP
TABLE 4:
RL6
38
—
—
—
—
—
SEG54
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
RL7
41
—
—
—
—
—
SEG55
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
—
—
AVDD
31
AVDD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
AVSS
32
AVSS
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
29
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VBAT
VCAP/
VDDCORE
15
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VCAP/
VDDCORE
VDD
5, 40,
59, 88
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
VSS
14, 35,
39, 64,
87
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
VUSB3V3
28
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VUSB3V3
Note
The peripheral inputs and outputs that support PPS have no default pins.
1:
DS30000575C-page 12
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview ........................................................................................................................................................................ 15
2.0 Guidelines for Getting Started with PIC18FJ Microcontrollers ................................................................................................... 36
3.0 Oscillator Configurations ............................................................................................................................................................ 41
4.0 Power-Managed Modes ............................................................................................................................................................. 69
5.0 Reset .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 89
6.0 Memory Organization ............................................................................................................................................................... 117
7.0 Flash Program Memory............................................................................................................................................................ 146
8.0 External Memory Bus ............................................................................................................................................................... 156
9.0 8 x 8 Hardware Multiplier.......................................................................................................................................................... 167
10.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................. 169
11.0 I/O Ports ................................................................................................................................................................................... 197
12.0 Data Signal Modulator.............................................................................................................................................................. 234
13.0 Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) Controller.................................................................................................................................... 244
14.0 Timer0 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 280
15.0 Timer1/3/5 Modules.................................................................................................................................................................. 283
16.0 Timer2/4/6/8 Modules............................................................................................................................................................... 293
17.0 Real-Time Clock and Calendar (RTCC) ................................................................................................................................... 295
18.0 Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP) Module................................................................................................................ 315
19.0 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Modules ................................................................................................................................. 336
20.0 Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Module .................................................................................................................... 347
21.0 Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (EUSART) ............................................................... 406
22.0 12-Bit A/D Converter with Threshold Scan............................................................................................................................... 429
23.0 Comparator Module.................................................................................................................................................................. 484
24.0 Comparator Voltage Reference Module ................................................................................................................................... 492
25.0 High/Low-Voltage Detect (HLVD) ............................................................................................................................................. 495
26.0 Charge Time Measurement Unit (CTMU)................................................................................................................................. 500
27.0 Universal Serial Bus (USB) ...................................................................................................................................................... 517
28.0 Special Features of the CPU .................................................................................................................................................... 544
29.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 565
30.0 Electrical Specifications............................................................................................................................................................ 615
31.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 648
32.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Charts ....................................................................................................................... 652
33.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 653
Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 667
The Microchip Website....................................................................................................................................................................... 668
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 668
Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 668
Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 669
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 13
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at docerrors@microchip.com or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Website at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
• Microchip’s Worldwide Website; http://www.microchip.com
• Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our website at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
DS30000575C-page 14
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
This document contains device-specific information for
the following devices:
•
•
•
•
•
PIC18F97J94
PIC18F87J94
PIC18F67J94
PIC18F96J94
PIC18F86J94
•
•
•
•
PIC18F66J94
PIC18F95J94
PIC18F85J94
PIC18F65J94
This family introduces a new line of low-voltage LCD
microcontrollers with Universal Serial Bus (USB). It
combines all the main traditional advantage of all
PIC18 microcontrollers, namely, high computational
performance and a rich feature set at an extremely
competitive price point. These features make the
PIC18F9XJ94 family a logical choice for many highperformance applications, where cost is a primary
consideration.
1.1
1.1.1
Core Features
TECHNOLOGY
All of the devices in the PIC18F9XJ94 family incorporate
a range of features that can significantly reduce power
consumption during operation. Key items include:
• Alternate Run Modes: By clocking the controller
from the Timer1 source or the Internal RC oscillator, power consumption during code execution
can be reduced.
• Multiple Idle Modes: The controller can also run
with its CPU core disabled but the peripherals still
active. In these states, power consumption can be
reduced even further.
• On-the-Fly Mode Switching: The power-managed
modes are invoked by user code during operation,
allowing the user to incorporate power-saving ideas
into their application’s software design.
• XLP: An extra low-power Sleep, BOR, RTCC and
Watchdog Timer.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
1.1.2
OSCILLATOR OPTIONS AND
FEATURES
All of the devices in the PIC18F9XJ94 family offer different oscillator options, allowing users a range of choices
in developing application hardware. These include:
• Two Crystal modes (HS, MS)
• One External Clock mode (EC)
• A Phase Lock Loop (PLL) frequency multiplier,
which allows clock speeds of up to 64 MHz.
• A fast Internal Oscillator (FRC) block that provides
an 8 MHz clock (±0.15% accuracy) with Active
Clock Tuning (ACT) from USB or SOSC source.
- Offers multiple divider options from 8 MHz to
500 kHz
- Frees the two oscillator pins for use as
additional general purpose I/O
• A separate Low-Power Internal RC Oscillator
(LPRC) (31 kHz nominal) for low-power, timinginsensitive applications.
The internal oscillator block provides a stable reference
source that gives the family additional features for
robust operation:
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM): This option
constantly monitors the main clock source against a
reference signal provided by the internal oscillator.
If a clock failure occurs, the controller is switched to
the internal oscillator, allowing for continued lowspeed operation or a safe application shutdown.
• Two-Speed Start-up (IESO): This option allows
the internal oscillator to serve as the clock source
from Power-on Reset, or wake-up from Sleep
mode, until the primary clock source is available.
DS30000575C-page 15
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
1.1.3
MEMORY OPTIONS
The PIC18F9XJ94 family provides ample room for
application code, from 32 Kbytes to 128 Kbytes of code
space. The Flash cells for program memory are rated
to last up to 20,000 erase/write cycles. Data retention
without refresh is conservatively estimated to be
greater than 10 years.
The Flash program memory is readable and writable.
During normal operation, the PIC18F9XJ94 family also
provides plenty of room for dynamic application data
with up to 3,578 bytes of data RAM.
1.1.4
UNIVERSAL SERIAL BUS (USB)
Devices in the PIC18F9XJ94 family incorporate a fullyfeatured USB communications module with a built-in
transceiver that is compliant with the USB Specification
Revision 2.0. The module supports both low-speed and
full-speed communication for all supported data transfer types.
1.1.5
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS
Should 128 Kbytes of memory be inadequate for an
application, the 80-pin and 100-pin members of the
PIC18F9XJ94 family have an External Memory Bus
(EMB), enabling the controller’s internal Program
Counter to address a memory space of up to 2 Mbytes.
This is a level of data access that few 8-bit devices can
claim and enables:
• Using combinations of on-chip and external
memory of up to 2 Mbytes
• Using external Flash memory for reprogrammable
application code or large data tables
• Using external RAM devices for storing large
amounts of variable data
DS30000575C-page 16
1.1.6
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET
The PIC18F9XJ94 family implements the optional
extension to the PIC18 instruction set, adding eight
new instructions and an Indexed Addressing mode.
Enabled as a device configuration option, the extension
has been specifically designed to optimize re-entrant
application code originally developed in high-level
languages, such as ‘C’.
1.1.7
EASY MIGRATION
All devices share the same rich set of peripherals. This
provides a smooth migration path within the device
family as applications evolve and grow.
The consistent pinout scheme, used throughout the
entire family, also aids in migrating to the next larger
device. This is true when moving between the 64-pin
members, between the 80-pin members, between the
100-pin members or even jumping from 64-pin to 80pin to 100-pin devices.
The PIC18F9XJ94 family is also largely pin compatible
with other PIC18 families, such as the PIC18F87J90,
PIC18F87J11 and the PIC18F87J50. This allows a new
dimension to the evolution of applications, allowing
developers to select different price points within
Microchip’s PIC18 portfolio, while maintaining a similar
feature set.
1.2
LCD Controller
The on-chip LCD driver includes many features that
make the integration of displays in low-power applications easier. These include an integrated voltage regulator with charge pump and an integrated internal
resistor ladder that allows contrast control in software
and display operation above device VDD.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
1.3
Other Special Features
• Communications: The PIC18F9XJ94 family
incorporates a range of serial communication
peripherals, including USB, four Enhanced
Addressable USARTs with IrDA, and two Master
Synchronous Serial Port MSSP modules capable
of both SPI and I2C (Master and Slave) modes of
operation.
• CCP Modules: PIC18F9XJ94 family devices
incorporate up to seven Capture/Compare/PWM
(CCP) modules. Up to six different time bases can
be used to perform several different operations at
once.
• ECCP Modules: The PIC18F9XJ94 family has
three Enhanced CCP (ECCP) modules to
maximize flexibility in control applications:
- Up to eight different time bases for
performing several different operations at
once
- Up to four PWM outputs for each module –
for a total of 12 PWMs
- Other beneficial features, such as polarity
selection, programmable dead time, autoshutdown and restart, and Half-Bridge and
Full-Bridge Output modes
• 12-Bit A/D Converter: The PIC18F9XJ94 family
has a software selectable, 10/12-bit
Analog-to-Digital (A/D) Converter. It incorporates
programmable acquisition time, allowing for a
channel to be selected and a conversion to be
initiated without waiting for a sampling period, and
thus, reducing code overhead.
• Charge Time Measurement Unit (CTMU): The
CTMU is a flexible analog module that provides
accurate differential time measurement between
pulse sources, as well as asynchronous pulse
generation.
• Together with other on-chip analog modules, the
CTMU can precisely measure time, measure
capacitance or relative changes in capacitance, or
generate output pulses that are independent of
the system clock.
• LP Watchdog Timer (WDT): This enhanced
version incorporates a 22-bit prescaler, allowing
an extended time-out range that is stable across
operating voltage and temperature. See
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications” for
time-out periods.
• Real-Time Clock and Calendar Module
(RTCC): The RTCC module is intended for applications requiring that accurate time be maintained
for extended periods of time, with minimum to no
intervention from the CPU.
• The module is a 100-year clock and calendar with
automatic leap year detection. The range of the
clock is from 00:00:00 (midnight) on January 1,
2000 to 23:59:59 on December 31, 2099.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
1.4
Details on Individual Family
Members
Devices in the PIC18F9XJ94 family are available in 64pin, 80-pin and 100-pin packages. Block diagrams for
the two groups are shown in Figure 1-1, Figure 1-2 and
Figure 1-3.
The devices are differentiated from each other in these
ways:
• Flash Program Memory:
- PIC18FX5J94 – 32 Kbytes
- PIC18FX6J94 – 64 Kbytes
- PIC18FX7J94 – 128 Kbytes
• Data RAM:
- All devices – 4 Kbytes
• I/O Ports:
- PIC18F6XJ9X (64-pin devices) – seven
bidirectional ports
- PIC18F8XJ9X (80-pin devices) – nine
bidirectional ports
- PIC18F9XJ9X (100-pin devices) – eleven
bidirectional ports
• A/D Channels:
- PIC18F6XJXX (64-pin devices) – 16 channels
- PIC18F8XJXX (80-pin devices) – 24 channels
- PIC18F9XJXX (100-pin devices) – 24 channels
All other features for devices in this family are identical.
These are summarized in Table 1-1, Table 1-2 and
Table 1-3.
The pinouts for all devices are listed in Table 1-4.
DS30000575C-page 17
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-1:
DEVICE FEATURES FOR THE 64-PIN DEVICES
Features
PIC18F65J94
PIC18F66J94
Operating Frequency
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
PIC18F67J94
DC – 64 MHz
32K
64K
128K
16,384
32,768
65,536
Data Memory (Bytes)
4K
4K
4K
Interrupt Sources
42
48
I/O Ports
Ports A, B, C, D, E, F, G
Parallel Communications
Parallel Slave Port (PSP)
Timers
8
Comparators
3
LCD
224 pixels
CTMU
Yes
RTCC
Yes
Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM Modules
Serial Communications
3 ECCPs and 7 CCPs
Two MSSPs, Four Enhanced USARTs (EUSART) and USB
10/12-Bit Analog-to-Digital Module
Resets (and Delays)
Instruction Set
16 Input Channels
POR, BOR, CM RESET Instruction, Stack Full, Stack Underflow, MCLR,
WDT (PWRT, OST)
75 Instructions, 83 with Extended Instruction Set Enabled
Packages
TABLE 1-2:
64-Pin QFN, 64-Pin TQFP
DEVICE FEATURES FOR THE 80-PIN DEVICES
Features
PIC18F85J94
Operating Frequency
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
PIC18F86J94
DC – 64 MHz
32 K
64K
16,384
32,768
4K
4K
Interrupt Sources
42
Parallel Communications
Timers
Comparators
LCD
4K
Ports A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, J
Parallel Slave Port (PSP)
8
3
352 pixels
Yes
RTCC
Yes
Serial Communications
12-Bit Analog-to-Digital Module
Resets (and Delays)
Instruction Set
Packages
DS30000575C-page 18
65,536
48
CTMU
Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM Modules
128K
(Up to 2 Mbytes with Extended Memory)
Data Memory (Bytes)
I/O Ports
PIC18F87J94
3 ECCPs and 7 CCPs
Two MSSPs, Four Enhanced USARTs (EUSART) and USB
24 Input Channels
POR, BOR, CM RESET Instruction, Stack Full, Stack Underflow, MCLR,
WDT (PWRT, OST)
75 Instructions, 83 with Extended Instruction Set Enabled
80-Pin TQFP
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-3:
DEVICE FEATURES FOR THE 100-PIN DEVICES
Features
PIC18F95J94
Operating Frequency
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
PIC18F96J94
DC – 64 MHz
32 K
64K
32,768
Data Memory (Bytes)
4K
4K
Interrupt Sources
42
Parallel Communications
4K
Ports A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, J, K, L
Parallel Slave Port (PSP)
8
Comparators
3
CTMU
RTCC
Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM Modules
Serial Communications
12-Bit Analog-to-Digital Module
Resets (and Delays)
Instruction Set
Packages
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
65,536
48
Timers
LCD
128K
(Up to 2 Mbytes with Extended Memory)
16,384
I/O Ports
PIC18F97J94
480 pixels
Yes
Yes
3 ECCPs and 7 CCPs
Two MSSPs, Four Enhanced USARTs (EUSART) and USB
24 Input Channels
POR, BOR, CM RESET Instruction, Stack Full, Stack Underflow, MCLR,
WDT (PWRT, OST)
75 Instructions, 83 with Extended Instruction Set Enabled
100-Pin TQFP
DS30000575C-page 19
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 1-1:
64-PIN DEVICE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
Table Pointer
20
Address Latch
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
12
Data Address
31-Level Stack
4
BSR
Address Latch
STKPTR
Program Memory
RB(1)
12
PORTC
RC(1)
inc/dec
logic
Table Latch
Instruction Bus
PORTB
4
Access
Bank
12
FSR0
FSR1
FSR2
Data Latch
8
RA(1,2)
Data Memory
(4 Kbytes)
PCLATU PCLATH
21
PORTA
Data Latch
8
8
inc/dec logic
Address
Decode
ROM Latch
PORTD
RD(1)
IR
OSC2/CLKO
OSC1/CLKI
Timing
Generation
PRODH PRODL
W
8
8
8
8
Power-on
Reset
Precision
Band Gap
Reference
8
BITOP
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
PORTE
RE(1)
8 x 8 Multiply
3
Power-up
Timer
INTRC
Oscillator
8 MHz
Oscillator
8
State Machine
Control Signals
Instruction
Decode and
Control
PORTF
8
RF(1)
ALU
Watchdog
Timer
8
BOR and
HLVD
Voltage
Regulator
PORTG
RG(1)
VDDCORE/VCAP
VDD, VSS
MCLR
Timer0
Timer1
Timer
2/4/6/8
Timer
3/5
CCP
4/5/6/7/8/9/10
ECCP
1/2/3
EUSART1
EUSART2
Note 1:
2:
CTMU
RTCC
A/D
10/12-Bit
MSSP1/2
LCD
224 Pixels
USB
Comparator
1/2/3
EUSART3
EUSART4
See Table 1-4 for I/O port pin descriptions.
RA6 and RA7 are only available as digital I/O in select oscillator modes. For more information, see Section 3.0 “Oscillator
Configurations”.
DS30000575C-page 20
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 1-2:
80-PIN DEVICE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
Table Pointer
8
8
inc/dec logic
20
Address Latch
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
31-Level Stack
4
BSR
System Bus Interface
STKPTR
FSR0
FSR1
FSR2
Table Latch
RD(1)
Address
Decode
Instruction Bus
PORTE
RE(1)
IR
AD, A
(Multiplexed with PORTD,
PORTE and PORTH)
Instruction
Decode and
Control
Timing
Generation
Power-up
Timer
INTRC
Oscillator
8 MHz
Oscillator
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Watchdog
Timer
Voltage
Regulator
BOR and
HLVD
VDD, VSS
RF(1)
PRODH PRODL
3
PORTG
8 x 8 Multiply
RG(1)
8
BITOP
W
8
8
8
8
Power-on
Reset
Precision
Band Gap
Reference
PORTF
8
State Machine
Control Signals
PORTH
RH(1)
8
ALU
PORTJ
8
RJ(1)
MCLR
Timer0
Timer1
Timer
2/4/6/8
Timer
3/5
CTMU
A/D
12-Bit
CCP
4/5/6/7/8/9/10
ECCP
1/2/3
EUSART1
EUSART2
RTCC
MSSP1/2
2:
12
PORTD
ROM Latch
Note 1:
RC(1)
inc/dec
logic
8
VDDCORE/VCAP
PORTC
4
Access
Bank
12
Data Latch
OSC2/CLKO
OSC1/CLKI
PORTB
RB(1)
12
Data Address
Address Latch
Program Memory
RA(1,2)
Data Memory
(4 Kbytes)
PCLATU PCLATH
21
PORTA
Data Latch
USB
LCD
352 Pixels
Comparator
1/2/3
EUSART4 EUSART3
USB
EMB
See Table 1-4 for I/O port pin descriptions.
RA6 and RA7 are only available as digital I/O in select oscillator modes. See Section 3.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for
more information.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 21
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 1-3:
100-PIN DEVICE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
Table Pointer
8
8
inc/dec logic
20
PORTB
12
Data Address
31-Level Stack
4
BSR
Address Latch
STKPTR
12
RB(1)
4
Access
Bank
FSR0
FSR1
FSR2
Data Latch
8
RA(1,2)
Address Latch
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
Program Memory
PORTA
Data Memory
(4 Kbytes)
PCLATU PCLATH
21
System Bus Interface
Data Latch
USB
PORTC
RC(1)
12
PORTD
inc/dec
logic
Table Latch
RD(1)
Address
Decode
ROM Latch
Instruction Bus
PORTE
RE(1)
IR
AD, A
(Multiplexed with PORTD,
PORTE and PORTH)
Instruction
Decode and
Control
OSC2/CLKO
OSC1/CLKI
Timing
Generation
Power-up
Timer
INTRC
Oscillator
8 MHz
Oscillator
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Watchdog
Timer
Voltage
Regulator
BOR and
HLVD
VDD, VSS
PORTF
RF(1)
PRODH PRODL
3
PORTG
8 x 8 Multiply
8
BITOP
W
RG,
RG(1)
8
8
8
PORTH
8
Power-on
Reset
Precision
Band Gap
Reference
VDDCORE/VCAP
8
State Machine
Control Signals
8
RH(1)
ALU
8
PORTJ
RJ(1)
PORTK
MCLR
RK(1)
Timer0
Timer1
CCP
4/5/6/7/8/9/10
Note 1:
2:
ECCP
1/2/3
Timer
2/4/6/8
Timer
3/5
CTMU
EUSART1
EUSART2
RTCC
A/D
12-Bit
MSSP1/2
LCD
480 Pixels
PORTL
Comparator
1/2/3
EUSART4 EUSART3
USB
RL(1)
EMB
See Table 1-4 for I/O port pin descriptions.
RA6 and RA7 are only available as digital I/O in select oscillator modes. See Section 3.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for
more information.
DS30000575C-page 22
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin Name
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
MCLR
11
9
7
OSC1/CLKI/RP10/RA7
61
49 39
I
OSC1
CLKI
I
I
RP10
RA7
I/O
I/O
OSC2/CLKO/RP6/RA6
62
50 40
OSC2
O
CLKO
O
RP6
RA6
I/O
I/O
Legend:
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Buffer
Type
ST
Description
Master Clear (input) or programming voltage (input).
This pin is an active-low Reset to the device.
Oscillator crystal or external clock input.
Oscillator crystal input.
External clock source input. Always associated with pin
function, OSC1. (See related OSC1/CLKI,OSC2/CLKO pins.)
ST/DIG Remappable Peripheral Pin 10 input/output.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
ST
CMOS
Oscillator crystal or clock output.
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in
Crystal Oscillator mode.
DIG
In certain oscillator modes, OSC2 pin outputs CLKO,
which has 1/4 the frequency of OSC1 and denotes the
instruction cycle rate.
ST/DIG Remappable Peripheral Pin 6 input/output.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
—
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 23
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
SEG19/AN0/AN1-/RP0/RA0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
37
36
34
33
43
SEG15
AN4
LVDIN
C1INA
C2INA
C3INA
RP5
RA5
Legend:
42
O
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG18 output for LCD.
Analog Input 1.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 1 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG21 output for LCD.
A/D reference voltage (low) input.
Analog Input 2.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 2 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
A/D reference voltage (high) input.
Analog Input 3.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 3 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG14 output for LCD.
Analog Input 6.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 4 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG15 output for LCD.
Analog Input 4.
High/Low-Voltage Detect (HLVD) input.
Comparator 1 Input A.
Comparator 2 Input A.
Comparator 3 Input A.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 5 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
34 28
SEG14
AN6
RP4
RA4
SEG15/AN4/LVDIN/C1INA/
C2INA/C3INA/RP5/RA5
SEG19 output for LCD.
Analog Input 0.
A/D negative input channel.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 0 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
27 21
VREF+
AN3
RP3
RA3
SEG14/AN6/RP4/RA4
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
28 22
SEG21
VREFAN2
RP2
RA2
VREF+/AN3/RP3/RA3
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
29 23
SEG18
AN1
RP1
RA1
SEG21/VREF-/AN2/RP2/RA2
33 27
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 24
Description
30 24
SEG19
AN0
AN1RP0
RA0
SEG18/AN1/RP1/RA1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
VLCAP1/RP8/CTED13/INT0/RB0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
73
72
70
69
68
67
65
58
PGD
CTED6
RB7
Legend:
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG9 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 14 input/output.
CTMU Edge 1 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG10 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 7 input/output.
CTMU Edge 2 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG11 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 12 input/output.
CTMU Edge 3 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG8 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 13 input/output.
CTMU Edge 4 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
I
I/O
ST/DIG In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming clock pin.
ST
CTMU Edge Input.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
I
I/O
ST/DIG In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming data pin.
ST
CTMU Edge 6 input.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
52 42
PGC
CTED5
RB6
PGD/CTED6/RB7
Analog LCD Drive Charge Pump Capacitor Input 2.
ST/DIG Remappable Peripheral Pin 9 input/output.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
53 43
SEG8
RP13
CTED4
RB5
PGC/CTED5/RB6
I
I/O
I/O
54 44
SEG11
RP12
CTED3
RB4
SEG8/RP13/CTED4/RB5
47 37
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
LCD Drive Charge Pump Capacitor Input 1.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 8 input/output.
CTMU Edge 13 input.
External Interrupt 0.
General purpose I/O pin.
55 45
SEG10
RP7
CTED2
RB3
SEG11/RP12/CTED3/RB4
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST
ST/DIG
56 46
SEG9
RP14
CTED1
RB2
SEG10/RP7/CTED2/RB3
I
I/O
I
I
I/O
57 47
VLCAP2
RP9
RB1
SEG9/RP14/CTED1/RB2
Description
58 48
VLCAP1
RP8
CTED13
INT0
RB0
VLCAP2/RP9/RB1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 25
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
SOSCO/SCLKI/PWRLCLK/RC0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
45
Buffer
Type
Description
36 30
SOSCO
SCLKI
PWRLCLK
O
I
I
—
ST
ST
RC0
I/O
ST
I
I/O
Analog
ST
Timer1 oscillator input.
General purpose Input pin.
O
I
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG13 output for LCD.
Analog Input 9.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 11 input/output.
CTMU Edge 7 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
I2C
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG17 output for LCD.
I2C clock input/output.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 15 input/output.
CTMU Edge 8 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
I2C
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG16 output for LCD.
I2C data input/output.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 17 input/output.
CTMU Edge 9 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG12 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 16 input/output.
CTMU Edge 10 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG27 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 18 input/output.
External USB transceiver NOE output.
CTMU Edge 11 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
I
I/O
Analog
ST/DIG
ST
ST/DIG
SEG22 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 19 input/output.
CTMU Edge 12 input.
General purpose I/O pin.
SOSCI/RC1
44
35 29
SOSCI
RC1
SEG13/AN9/RP11/CTED7/RC2
53
43 33
SEG13
AN9
RP11
CTED7
RC2
SEG17/SCL1/RP15/CTED8/RC3
54
44 34
SEG17
SCL1
RP15
CTED8
RC3
SEG16/SDA1/RP17/CTED9/RC4
56
45 35
SEG16
SDA1
RP17
CTED9
RC4
SEG12/RP16/CTED10/RC5
57
46 36
SEG12
RP16
CTED10
RC5
SEG27/RP18/UOE/CTED11/RC6
47
37 31
SEG27
RP18
UOE/
CTED11
RC6
SEG22/RP19/CTED12/RC7
SEG22
RP19
CTED12
RC7
Legend:
48
38 32
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 26
SOSC oscillator output.
Digital SOSC input.
SOSC input at 50 Hz or 60 Hz only
(RTCCLKSEL = 11 or 10).
General purpose Input pin.
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
AD0/SEG0/RP20/PSP0/RD0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
90
86
84
83
82
81
79
78
AD7
SEG7
RP27
REFO2
PSP7
RD7
Legend:
External Memory Address/Data 1.
SEG1 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 21 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 2.
SEG2 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 22 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 3.
SEG3 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 3 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 4.
SEG4 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 24 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
I2C
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 5.
SEG5 output for LCD.
I2C data input/output.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 25 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
I2C
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 6.
SEG6 output for LCD.
I2C clock input/output.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 26 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 7.
SEG7 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 27 input/output.
Reference output clock.
Parallel Slave Port data
General purpose I/O pin.
64 50
AD6
SEG6
SCL2
RP26
PSP6
RD6
AD7/SEG7/RP27/REFO2/
PSP7/RD7
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
65 51
AD5
SEG5
SDA2
RP25
PSP5
RD5
AD6/SEG6/SCL2/RP26/PSP6/RD6
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
66 52
AD4
SEG4
RP24
PSP4
RD4
AD5/SEG5/SDA2/RP25/PSP5/RD5
External Memory Address/Data 0.
SEG0 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 20 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port data.
General purpose I/O pin.
67 53
AD3
SEG3
RP23
PSP3
RD3
AD4/SEG4/RP24/PSP4/RD4
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
68 54
AD2
SEG2
RP22
PSP2
RD2
AD3/SEG3/RP23/PSP3/RD3
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
I/O
69 55
AD1
SEG1
RP21
PSP1
RD1
AD2/SEG2/RP22/PSP2/RD2
63 49
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Description
72 58
AD0
SEG0
RP20
PSP0
RD0
AD1/SEG1/RP21/PSP1/RD1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 27
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
AD8/LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD/RE0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
4
4
3
3
98
97
95
94
93
AD15
LCDBIAS0
RP31
RE7
Legend:
92
External Memory Address/Data 9.
BIAS2 input for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 29 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port write strobe.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
I
I/O
I
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
TTL
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 10.
BIAS3 input for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 30 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port chip select.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 11.
COM0 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 33 input/output.
Reference output clock.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 12.
COM1 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 32 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 13.
COM2 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 37 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
O
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 14.
COM3 output for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 34 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
I/O
I
I/O
I/O
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
External Memory Address/Data 15.
BIAS0 input for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 31 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
74 60
AD14
COM3
RP34
RE6
AD15/LCDBIAS0/RP31/RE7
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
TTL
ST/DIG
75 61
AD13
COM2
RP37
RE5
AD14/COM3/RP34/RE6
I/O
I
I/O
I
I/O
76 62
AD12
COM1
RP32
RE4
AD13/COM2/RP37/RE5
External Memory Address/Data 8.
BIAS1 input for LCD.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 28 input/output.
Parallel Slave Port read strobe.
General purpose I/O pin.
77 63
AD11
COM0
RP33
REFO1
RE3
AD12/COM1/RP32/RE4
TTL/DIG
Analog
ST/DIG
TTL
ST/DIG
78 64
AD10
LCDBIAS3
RP30
CS
RE2
AD11/COM0/RP33/REFO1/RE3
I/O
I
I/O
I
I/O
1
AD9
LCDBIAS2
RP29
WR
RE1
AD10/LCDBIAS3/RP30/CS/RE2
73 59
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 28
Description
2
AD8
LCDBIAS1
RP28
RD
RE0
AD9/LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR/RE1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
SEG20/AN7/CTMUI/C2INB/RP36/
RF2
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
23
22
20
19
18
17
SEG25
AN5
RP38
RF7
Legend:
I/O
I
—
ST
USB bus minus line input/output.
General purpose input pin.
I/O
I
—
ST
USB bus plus line input/output.
General purpose input pin.
O
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG23 output for LCD.
Comparator reference voltage output.
Analog Input 10.
Comparator 1 Input B.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 35 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG24 output for LCD.
Analog Input 11.
Comparator 1 Input A.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 40 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
SEG25 output for LCD.
Analog Input 5.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 38 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
14 12
SEG24
AN11
C1INA
RP40
RF6
SEG25/AN5/RP38/RF7
SEG20 output for LCD.
Analog Input 7.
CTMU pulse generator charger for the C2INB comparator input.
Comparator 2 Input B.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 36 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
15 13
SEG23
CVREF
AN10
C1INB
RP35
RF5
SEG24/AN11/C1INA/RP40/RF6
Analog
Analog
—
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
16 14
D+
RF4
SEG23/CVREF/AN10/C1INB/
RP35/RF5
O
I
O
I
I/O
I/O
17 15
DRF3
D+/RF4
Description
18 16
SEG20
AN7
CTMUI
C2INB
RP36
RF2
D-/RF3
Buffer
Type
13 11
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 29
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
COM4/SEG28/AN8/RP46/RG0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
6
5
O
O
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
COM4 output for LCD.
SEG28 output for LCD.
Analog Input 8.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 46 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
COM5 output for LCD.
SEG29 output for LCD.
Analog Input 19.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 39 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
COM6 output for LCD.
SEG30 output for LCD.
Analog Input 18.
Comparator 3 Input A.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 42 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I
I
I/O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
ST/DIG
COM7 output for LCD.
SEG31 output for LCD.
Analog Input 17.
Comparator 3 Input B.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 43 input/output.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
O
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
—
ST/DIG
SEG26 output for LCD.
Analog Input 16.
Comparator 3 Input C.
Remappable Peripheral Pin 44 input/output.
RTCC output.
General purpose I/O pin.
89
I/O
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
96
I/O
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
7
6
4
COM5
SEG29
AN19
RP39
RG1
COM6/SEG30/AN18/C3INA/RP42/
RG2
8
7
5
COM6
SEG30
AN18
C3INA
RP42
RG2
COM7/SEG31/AN17/C3INB/RP43/
RG3
9
8
6
COM7
SEG31
AN17
C3INB
RP43
RG3
SEG26/AN16/C3INC/RP44/RTCC/
RG4
12
SEG26
AN16
C3INC
RP44
RTCC
RG4
RG6
RG7
Legend:
10
8
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 30
Description
3
COM4
SEG28
AN8
RP46
RG0
COM5/SEG29/AN19/RP39/RG1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
A16/SEG47/AN23/RH0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
99
1
2
27
26
25
24
SEG43
AN15
RH7
Legend:
External Memory Address 17.
SEG46 output for LCD.
Analog Input 22.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I
I/O
DIG
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
External Memory Address 18.
SEG45 output for LCD.
Analog Input 21.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I
I/O
DIG
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
External Memory Address 19.
SEG44 output for LCD.
Analog Input 20.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
SEG40 output for LCD.
Analog Input12.
Comparator 2 Input C.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
SEG41 output for LCD.
Analog Input 13.
Comparator 2 Input D.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I
I/O
Analog
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
SEG42 output for LCD.
Analog Input 14.
Comparator 1 Input C.
General purpose I/O pin.
O
I
I/O
Analog SEG43 output for LCD.
Analog Analog Input 15.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
20
SEG42
AN14
C1INC
RH6
SEG43/AN15/RH7
DIG
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
21
SEG41
AN13
C2IND
RH5
SEG42/AN14/C1INC/RH6
O
O
I
I/O
22
SEG40
AN12
C2INC
RH4
SEG41/AN13/C2IND/RH5
External Memory Address 16.
SEG47 output for LCD.
Analog Input 23.
General purpose I/O pin.
2
A19
SEG44
AN20
RH3
SEG40/AN12/C2INC/RH4
DIG
Analog
Analog
ST/DIG
1
A18
SEG45
AN21
RH2
A19/SEG44/AN20/RH3
O
O
I
I/O
100 80
A17
SEG46
AN22
RH1
A18/SEG45/AN21/RH2
Description
79
A16
SEG47
AN23
RH0
A17/SEG46/AN22/RH1
Buffer
Type
19
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 31
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
ALE/SEG32/RJ0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
77
76
75
74
49
50
51
UB
SEG36
RJ7
Legend:
52
DIG
External memory write low control.
Analog SEG34 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I/O
DIG
External memory write high control.
Analog SEG35 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I/O
DIG
External Memory Byte Address 0 control
Analog SEG39 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I/O
DIG
External memory chip enable control.
Analog SEG38 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I/O
DIG
External memory low byte control.
Analog SEG37 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
O
I/O
DIG
External memory high byte control.
Analog SEG36 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
41
LB
SEG37
RJ6
UB/SEG36/RJ7
O
O
I/O
40
CE
SEG38
RJ5
LB/SEG37/RJ6
DIG
External memory output enable.
Analog SEG33 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
39
BA0
SEG39
RJ4
CE/SEG38/RJ5
O
O
I/O
59
WRH
SEG35
RJ3
BA0/SEG39/RJ4
DIG
External memory address latch enable.
Analog SEG32 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
60
WRL
SEG34
RJ2
WRH/SEG35/RJ3
O
O
I/O
61
OE
SEG33
RJ1
WRL/SEG34/RJ2
42
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 32
Description
62
ALE
SEG32
RJ0
OE/SEG33/RJ1
Buffer
Type
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
SEG56/RK0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
O
I/O
Analog SEG59 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG60 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG61 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG62 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG63 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
85
SEG63
RK7
Legend:
Analog SEG58 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
80
SEG62
RK6
SEG63/RK7
O
I/O
71
SEG61
RK5
SEG62/RK6
Analog SEG57 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
66
SEG60
RK4
SEG61/RK5
O
I/O
63
SEG59
RK3
SEG60/RK4
Analog SEG56 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
60
SEG58
RK2
SEG59/RK3
O
I/O
55
SEG57
RK1
SEG58/RK2
Description
46
SEG56
RK0
SEG57/RK1
Buffer
Type
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 33
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
SEG48/RL0
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
Description
91
SEG48
RL0
SEG49/RL1
O
I/O
Analog SEG48 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG49 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG50 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG51 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG52 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG53 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG54 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
O
I/O
Analog SEG55 output for LCD.
ST/DIG General purpose I/O pin.
10
SEG49
RL1
SEG50/RL2
13
SEG50
RL2
SEG51/RL3
16
SEG51
RL3
SEG52/RL4
21
SEG52
RL4
SEG53/RL5
30
SEG53
RL5
SEG54/RL6
38
SEG54
RL6
SEG55/RL7
41
SEG55
RL7
Legend:
Buffer
Type
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
DS30000575C-page 34
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 1-4:
PIC18FXXJ94 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
Pin Number
Pin
100 80 64 Type
Buffer
Type
Description
32 26
48 38
71 57
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
VDD
5
40
59
88
11 9
31 25
51 41
70 56
P
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
VSS
14
35
39
64
87
AVDD
31
25 19
P
—
Positive supply for analog modules.
AVSS
32
26 20
P
—
Ground reference for analog modules.
VDDCORE/VCAP
15
12 10
P
P
—
—
Core logic power or external filter capacitor connection.
External filter capacitor connection (regulator enabled/disabled).
VDDCORE
VCAP
VBAT
29
24 18
P
—
VUSB3V3
28
23 17
P
—
Legend:
TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
P = Power
I2C = I2C/SMBus
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
USB voltage input pin.
CMOS
Analog
O
OD
= CMOS compatible input or output
= Analog input
= Output
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
DS30000575C-page 35
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
• All VDD and VSS pins
(see Section 2.2 “Power Supply Pins”)
• All AVDD and AVSS pins, regardless of whether or
not the analog device features are used
(see Section 2.2 “Power Supply Pins”)
• MCLR pin
(see Section 2.3 “Master Clear (MCLR) Pin”)
R1
R2
Additionally, the following pins may be required:
• VREF+/VREF- pins are used when external voltage
reference for analog modules is implemented
Note:
The AVDD and AVSS pins must always be
connected, regardless of whether any of
the analog modules are being used.
(1)
MCLR
VCAP/VDDCORE
C1
C7
PIC18FXXJXX
C6(2)
VSS
VDD
VDD
VSS
C3(2)
C5(2)
These pins must also be connected if they are being
used in the end application:
• PGC/PGD pins used for In-Circuit Serial
Programming™ (ICSP™) and debugging purposes
(see Section 2.5 “ICSP Pins”)
• OSC1 and OSC2 pins when an external oscillator
source is used
(see Section 2.6 “External Oscillator Pins”)
VSS
VDD
VSS
The following pins must always be connected:
C2(2)
VDD
Getting started with the PIC18FXXJ94 of 8-bit
microcontrollers requires attention to a minimal set of
device pin connection before proceeding with
development.
RECOMMENDED
MINIMUM CONNECTIONS
VDD
Basic Connection Requirements
FIGURE 2-1:
AVSS
2.1
GUIDELINES FOR GETTING
STARTED WITH PIC18FJ
MICROCONTROLLERS
AVDD
2.0
C4(2)
Key (all values are recommendations):
C1 through C6: 0.1 F, 20V ceramic
C7: 10 F, 6.3V or greater, tantalum or ceramic
R1: 10 kΩ
R2: 100Ω to 470Ω
Note 1:
2:
See Section 2.4 “Core Voltage Regulator
(VCAP/VDDCORE)” for explanation of VCAP/
VDDCORE connections.
The example shown is for a PIC18F device
with five VDD/VSS and AVDD/AVSS pairs.
Other devices may have more or less pairs;
adjust the number of decoupling capacitors
appropriately.
The minimum mandatory connections are shown in
Figure 2-1.
DS30000575C-page 36
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
2.2
2.2.1
Power Supply Pins
DECOUPLING CAPACITORS
The use of decoupling capacitors on every pair of
power supply pins, such as VDD, VSS, AVDD and
AVSS, is required.
Consider the following criteria when using decoupling
capacitors:
• Value and type of capacitor: A 0.1 F (100 nF),
10-20V capacitor is recommended. The capacitor
should be a low-ESR device, with a resonance
frequency in the range of 200 MHz and higher.
Ceramic capacitors are recommended.
• Placement on the printed circuit board: The
decoupling capacitors should be placed as close
to the pins as possible. It is recommended to
place the capacitors on the same side of the
board as the device. If space is constricted, the
capacitor can be placed on another layer on the
PCB using a via; however, ensure that the trace
length from the pin to the capacitor is no greater
than 0.25 inch (6 mm).
• Handling high-frequency noise: If the board is
experiencing high-frequency noise (upward of
tens of MHz), add a second ceramic type capacitor in parallel to the above described decoupling
capacitor. The value of the second capacitor can
be in the range of 0.01 F to 0.001 F. Place this
second capacitor next to each primary decoupling
capacitor. In high-speed circuit designs, consider
implementing a decade pair of capacitances as
close to the power and ground pins as possible
(e.g., 0.1 F in parallel with 0.001 F).
• Maximizing performance: On the board layout
from the power supply circuit, run the power and
return traces to the decoupling capacitors first,
and then to the device pins. This ensures that the
decoupling capacitors are first in the power chain.
Equally important is to keep the trace length
between the capacitor and the power pins to a
minimum, thereby reducing PCB trace
inductance.
2.2.2
TANK CAPACITORS
On boards with power traces running longer than
six inches in length, it is suggested to use a tank capacitor for integrated circuits, including microcontrollers, to
supply a local power source. The value of the tank
capacitor should be determined based on the trace
resistance that connects the power supply source to
the device, and the maximum current drawn by the
device in the application. In other words, select the tank
capacitor so that it meets the acceptable voltage sag at
the device. Typical values range from 4.7 F to 47 F.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
2.3
Master Clear (MCLR) Pin
The MCLR pin provides two specific device
functions: Device Reset, and Device Programming
and Debugging. If programming and debugging are
not required in the end application, a direct
connection to VDD may be all that is required. The
addition of other components, to help increase the
application’s resistance to spurious Resets from
voltage sags, may be beneficial. A typical
configuration is shown in Figure 2-1. Other circuit
designs may be implemented, depending on the
application’s requirements.
During programming and debugging, the resistance
and capacitance that can be added to the pin must
be considered. Device programmers and debuggers
drive the MCLR pin. Consequently, specific voltage
levels (VIH and VIL) and fast signal transitions must
not be adversely affected. Therefore, specific values
of R1 and C1 will need to be adjusted based on the
application and PCB requirements. For example, it is
recommended that the capacitor, C1, be isolated
from the MCLR pin during programming and
debugging operations by using a jumper (Figure 2-2).
The jumper is replaced for normal run-time
operations.
Any components associated with the MCLR pin
should be placed within 0.25 inch (6 mm) of the pin.
FIGURE 2-2:
EXAMPLE OF MCLR PIN
CONNECTIONS
VDD
R1
R2
JP
MCLR
PIC18FXXJXX
C1
Note 1:
R1 10 k is recommended. A suggested
starting value is 10 k. Ensure that the
MCLR pin VIH and VIL specifications are met.
2:
R2 470 will limit any current flowing into
MCLR from the external capacitor, C, in the
event of MCLR pin breakdown, due to
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical
Overstress (EOS). Ensure that the MCLR pin
VIH and VIL specifications are met.
DS30000575C-page 37
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
2.4
Core Voltage Regulator (VCAP/
VDDCORE)
FIGURE 2-3:
A low-ESR (< 5Ω) capacitor is required on the VCAP pin
to stabilize the output voltage of the on-chip voltage
regulator. The VCAP pin must not be connected to VDD
and must use a capacitor of 10 μF connected to
ground. The type can be ceramic or tantalum. Suitable
examples of capacitors are shown in Table 2-1.
Capacitors with equivalent specification can be used.
FREQUENCY vs. ESR
PERFORMANCE FOR
SUGGESTED VCAP
10
ESR ()
1
Designers may use Figure 2-3 to evaluate ESR
equivalence of candidate devices.
0.1
0.01
It is recommended that the trace length not exceed
0.25 inch (6 mm). Refer to Section 30.0 “Electrical
Specifications” for additional information.
0.001
0.01
Note:
0.1
1
10
100
Frequency (MHz)
1000 10,000
Typical data measurement at 25°C, 0V DC bias.
.
TABLE 2-1:
SUITABLE CAPACITOR EQUIVALENTS
Make
Part #
Nominal
Capacitance
Base Tolerance
Rated Voltage
Temp. Range
TDK
C3216X7R1C106K
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 125ºC
TDK
C3216X5R1C106K
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 85ºC
Panasonic
ECJ-3YX1C106K
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 125ºC
Panasonic
ECJ-4YB1C106K
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 85ºC
Murata
GRM32DR71C106KA01L
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 125ºC
Murata
GRM31CR61C106KC31L
10 µF
±10%
16V
-55 to 85ºC
DS30000575C-page 38
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
CONSIDERATIONS FOR CERAMIC
CAPACITORS
In recent years, large value, low-voltage, surface-mount
ceramic capacitors have become very cost effective in
sizes up to a few tens of microfarad. The low-ESR, small
physical size and other properties make ceramic
capacitors very attractive in many types of applications.
Ceramic capacitors are suitable for use with the
VDDCORE voltage regulator of this microcontroller.
However, some care is needed in selecting the capacitor to ensure that it maintains sufficient capacitance
over the intended operating range of the application.
Typical low-cost, 10 µF ceramic capacitors are available
in X5R, X7R and Y5V dielectric ratings (other types are
also available, but are less common). The initial tolerance specifications for these types of capacitors are
often specified as ±10% to ±20% (X5R and X7R), or 20%/+80% (Y5V). However, the effective capacitance
that these capacitors provide in an application circuit will
also vary based on additional factors, such as the
applied DC bias voltage and the temperature. The total
in-circuit tolerance is, therefore, much wider than the
initial tolerance specification.
The X5R and X7R capacitors typically exhibit satisfactory temperature stability (ex: ±15% over a wide
temperature range, but consult the manufacturer’s data
sheets for exact specifications). However, Y5V capacitors typically have extreme temperature tolerance
specifications of +22%/-82%. Due to the extreme
temperature tolerance, a 10 µF nominal rated Y5V type
capacitor may not deliver enough total capacitance to
meet minimum VDDCORE voltage regulator stability and
transient response requirements. Therefore, Y5V
capacitors are not recommended for use with the
VDDCORE regulator if the application must operate over
a wide temperature range.
In addition to temperature tolerance, the effective
capacitance of large value ceramic capacitors can vary
substantially, based on the amount of DC voltage
applied to the capacitor. This effect can be very significant, but is often overlooked or is not always
documented.
A typical DC bias voltage vs. capacitance graph for
X7R type and Y5V type capacitors is shown in
Figure 2-4.
FIGURE 2-4:
Capacitance Change (%)
2.4.1
DC BIAS VOLTAGE vs.
CAPACITANCE
CHARACTERISTICS
10
0
-10
16V Capacitor
-20
-30
-40
10V Capacitor
-50
-60
-70
6.3V Capacitor
-80
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
DC Bias Voltage (VDC)
When selecting a ceramic capacitor to be used with the
VDDCORE voltage regulator, it is suggested to select a
high-voltage rating, so that the operating voltage is a
small percentage of the maximum rated capacitor voltage. For example, choose a ceramic capacitor rated at
16V for the 2.5V VDDCORE voltage. Suggested
capacitors are shown in Table 2-1.
2.5
ICSP Pins
The PGC and PGD pins are used for In-Circuit Serial
Programming™ (ICSP™) and debugging purposes. It
is recommended to keep the trace length between the
ICSP connector and the ICSP pins on the device as
short as possible. If the ICSP connector is expected to
experience an ESD event, a series resistor is recommended, with the value in the range of a few tens of
ohms, not to exceed 100Ω.
Pull-up resistors, series diodes, and capacitors on the
PGC and PGD pins are not recommended as they will
interfere with the programmer/debugger communications to the device. If such discrete components are an
application requirement, they should be removed from
the circuit during programming and debugging. Alternatively, refer to the AC/DC characteristics and timing
requirements information in the respective device
Flash programming specification for information on
capacitive loading limits, and pin input voltage high
(VIH) and input low (VIL) requirements.
For device emulation, ensure that the “Communication
Channel Select” (i.e., PGCx/PGDx pins), programmed
into the device, matches the physical connections for
the ICSP to the Microchip debugger/emulator tool.
For more information on available Microchip
development tools connection requirements, refer to
Section 31.0 “Development Support”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 39
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
2.6
External Oscillator Pins
FIGURE 2-5:
Many microcontrollers have options for at least two
oscillators: a high-frequency primary oscillator and a
low-frequency
secondary
oscillator
(refer to
Section 3.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for details).
The oscillator circuit should be placed on the same
side of the board as the device. Place the oscillator
circuit close to the respective oscillator pins with no
more than 0.5 inch (12 mm) between the circuit
components and the pins. The load capacitors should
be placed next to the oscillator itself, on the same side
of the board.
Use a grounded copper pour around the oscillator circuit to isolate it from surrounding circuits. The
grounded copper pour should be routed directly to the
MCU ground. Do not run any signal traces or power
traces inside the ground pour. Also, if using a two-sided
board, avoid any traces on the other side of the board
where the crystal is placed.
Single-Sided and In-Line Layouts:
Copper Pour
(tied to ground)
For additional information and design guidance on
oscillator circuits, refer to these Microchip Application
Notes, available at the corporate website
(www.microchip.com):
• AN826, “Crystal Oscillator Basics and Crystal
Selection for rfPIC™ and PICmicro® Devices”
• AN849, “Basic PICmicro® Oscillator Design”
• AN943, “Practical PICmicro® Oscillator Analysis
and Design”
• AN949, “Making Your Oscillator Work”
2.7
Unused I/Os
Primary Oscillator
Crystal
DEVICE PINS
Primary
Oscillator
OSC1
C1
`
OSC2
GND
C2
`
T1OSO
T1OS I
Timer1 Oscillator
Crystal
Layout suggestions are shown in Figure 2-5. In-line
packages may be handled with a single-sided layout
that completely encompasses the oscillator pins. With
fine-pitch packages, it is not always possible to completely surround the pins and components. A suitable
solution is to tie the broken guard sections to a mirrored
ground layer. In all cases, the guard trace(s) must be
returned to ground.
In planning the application’s routing and I/O assignments, ensure that adjacent port pins, and other
signals in close proximity to the oscillator, are benign
(i.e., free of high frequencies, short rise and fall times,
and other similar noise).
SUGGESTED PLACEMENT
OF THE OSCILLATOR
CIRCUIT
`
T1 Oscillator: C1
T1 Oscillator: C2
Fine-Pitch (Dual-Sided) Layouts:
Top Layer Copper Pour
(tied to ground)
Bottom Layer
Copper Pour
(tied to ground)
OSC2
C2
Oscillator
Crystal
GND
C1
OSC1
DEVICE PINS
Unused I/O pins should be configured as outputs and
driven to a logic low state. Alternatively, connect a 1 kΩ
to 10 kΩ resistor to VSS on unused pins and drive the
output to logic low.
DS30000575C-page 40
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.0
OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATIONS
• Software-controllable switching between various
clock sources
• Software-controllable postscaler for selective
clocking of CPU for system power savings
• A Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) that detects
clock failure and permits safe application recovery
or shutdown
• A separate and independently configurable
system clock output for synchronizing external
hardware
This section describes the PIC18F oscillator system
and its operation. The PIC18F oscillator system has the
following modules and features:
• A total of four external and internal oscillator
options as clock sources, providing up to
11 different clock modes
• An on-chip USB PLL block to provide a stable
48 MHz clock for the USB module, as well as a
range of frequency options for the system clock
FIGURE 3-1:
A simplified diagram of the oscillator system is shown
in Figure 3-1.
PIC18F GENERAL SYSTEM CLOCK DIAGRAM
PIC18F97J94 Family
48 MHz USB Clock
Primary Oscillator
MS, HS, EC
OSC2
REFOxCON2
USB PLL
MSPLL, HSPLL,
ECPLL, FRCPLL
PLL &
DIV
OSC1
Reference Clock
Generator
8 MHz
8 MHz
(nominal)
FRC
Oscillator
Reference
from USB
D+/D-
PLLDIV
FRC
Active Clock
Tuning
Control
FRCDIV
Peripherals
OSCCON3
FRCDIV 16
LPRC
Oscillator
31 kHz (nominal)
REFO
CPDIV
Postscaler
4 MHz
FRC
500 kHz
LPRC
Secondary Oscillator
SOSC
SOSCO
SOSCI
SOSCEN
Enable
Oscillator
Clock Control Logic
Fail-Safe
Clock
Monitor
WDT, PWRT
Clock Source Option
for Other Modules
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 41
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.1
CPU Clocking Scheme
The system clock source can be provided by one of
four sources:
• Primary Oscillator (POSC) on the OSC1 and
OSC2 pins
• Secondary Oscillator (SOSC) on the SOSCI and
SOSCO pins
• Fast Internal RC (FRC) Oscillator
• Low-Power Internal RC (LPRC) Oscillator
FIGURE 3-2:
The Primary Oscillator and FRC sources have the option
of using the internal USB PLL block, which generates
both the USB module clock and a separate system clock
from the 96 MHz PLL. Refer to Section 3.8.1 “Oscillator Modes and USB Operation” for additional
information.
The internal FRC provides an 8 MHz clock source. It
can optionally be reduced by the programmable clock
divider to provide a range of system clock frequencies.
The selected clock source generates the processor
and peripheral clock sources. The processor clock
source is divided by four to produce the internal instruction cycle clock, FCY. In this document, the instruction
cycle clock is also denoted by FOSC/4. The internal
instruction cycle clock, FOSC/4, can be provided on the
OSC2 I/O pin for some operating modes of the Primary
Oscillator. The timing diagram in Figure 3-2 shows the
relationship between the processor clock source and
instruction execution.
CLOCK OR INSTRUCTION CYCLE TIMING
TCY
FOSC
FCY
PC
PC
Fetch INST (PC)
Execute INST (PC – 2)
DS30000575C-page 42
PC + 2
Fetch INST (PC + 2)
Execute INST (PC)
PC + 4
Fetch INST (PC + 4)
Execute INST (PC + 2)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.2
Oscillator Configuration
The oscillator source (and operating mode) that is used
at a device Power-on Reset (POR) event is selected
using Configuration bit settings. The Oscillator Configuration bit settings are in the Configuration registers
located in the program memory (refer to Section 28.1
“Configuration Bits” for more information). The
Primary Oscillator Configuration bits, POSCMD
(CONFIG3L), and Oscillator Configuration bits,
TABLE 3-1:
FOSC (CONFIG2L), select the oscillator
source that is used at a POR. The FRC Oscillator with
Postscaler (FRCDIV) is the default (unprogrammed)
selection. The Secondary Oscillator, or one of the internal oscillators, may be chosen by programming these bit
locations.
The Configuration bits allow users to choose between
11 different clock modes, as shown in Table 3-1.
CONFIGURATION BIT VALUES FOR CLOCK SELECTION
Oscillator Mode
Oscillator Source
POSCMD
FOSC
Fast RC Oscillator with
Postscaler (FRCDIV)
Internal
11
111
1, 2
Fast RC Oscillator divided by 16
(FRC500kHz)
Internal
11
110
1
Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC)
Notes
Internal
11
101
1
Secondary
11
100
1
Primary Oscillator (HS) with PLL
Module (HSPLL)
Primary
10
011
Primary Oscillator (MS) with PLL
Module (MSPLL)
Primary
01
011
Primary Oscillator (EC) with PLL
Module (ECPLL)
Primary
00
011
Primary Oscillator (HS)
Primary
10
010
Primary Oscillator (MS)
Primary
01
010
Primary Oscillator (EC)
Primary
00
010
Fast RC Oscillator with PLL Module
(FRCPLL)
Internal
11
001
1
Fast RC Oscillator (FRC)
Internal
11
000
1
Secondary (Timer1) Oscillator
(SOSC)
Note 1:
2:
OSC2 pin function is determined by the CLKOEN Configuration bit.
Default oscillator mode for an unprogrammed (erased) device.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 43
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.2.1
CLOCK SWITCHING MODE
CONFIGURATION BITS
The FSCMx Configuration bits (CONFIG3L) are
used to jointly configure device clock switching and the
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM). Clock switching is
enabled only when FSCM1 is programmed (‘0’). The
FSCM is enabled only when FSCM are both
programmed (‘00’).
3.2.2
OSC1 AND OSC2 PIN FUNCTIONS
IN NON-CRYSTAL MODES
When the Primary Oscillator on OSC1 and OSC2 is not
configured as the clock source (POSCMD = 11),
the OSC1 pin is automatically reconfigured as a
digital I/O. In this configuration, as well as when the
Primary Oscillator is configured for EC mode
(POSCMD = 00), the OSC2 pin can also be
configured as a digital I/O by programming the
CLKOEN Configuration bit (CONFIG2L).
When CLKOEN is unprogrammed (‘1’), a FOSC/4 clock
output is available on OSC2 for testing or synchronization purposes. With CLKOEN programmed (‘0’), the
OSC2 pin becomes a general purpose I/O pin. In both
of these configurations, the feedback device between
OSC1 and OSC2 is turned off to save current.
3.3
Control Registers
The operation of the oscillator is controlled by six
Special Function Registers (SFRs):
•
•
•
•
•
•
OSCCON
OSCCON2
OSCCON3
OSCCON4
ACTCON
OSCTUNE
3.3.1
OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
(OSCCON)
The OSCCON register (Register 3-1) is the main control register for the oscillator. It controls clock source
switching and allows the monitoring of clock sources.
The COSCx (OSCCON) Status bits are read-only
bits that indicate the current oscillator source the
device is operating from. The COSCx bits default to the
Internal Fast RC Oscillator with Postscaler (FRCDIV),
configured for 4 MHz, on a Power-on Reset (POR) and
DS30000575C-page 44
Master Clear Reset (MCLR). A clock switch will
automatically be performed to the new oscillator source
selected by the FOSCx Configuration bits (CONFIG2L). The COSCx bits will change to indicate
the new oscillator source at the end of a clock switch
operation.
The NOSCx Status bits select the clock source for the
next clock switch operation. On POR and MCLRs,
these bits automatically select the oscillator source
defined by the FOSCx Configuration bits. These bits
can be modified by software.
Setting the CLKLOCK bit (OSCCON2) prevents
clock switching if the FSCM1 Configuration bit is set. If
the FSCM1 bit is clear, the CLKLOCK bit state is
ignored and clock switching can occur.
The IOLOCK bit (OSCCON2) is used to unlock the
Peripheral Pin Select (PPS) feature; it has no function
in the system clock’s operation.
The LOCK Status bit (OSCCON2) is read-only and
indicates the status of the PLL circuit. It is set when the
PLL achieves a frequency lock and is reset when a
valid clock switching sequence is initiated. It reads as
‘0’ whenever the PLL is not used as part of the current
clock source.
The CF Status bit (OSCCON2) is a readable/clearable Status bit that indicates a clock failure; it is reset
whenever a valid clock switch occurs.
The POSCEN bit (OSCCON2) is used to control
the operation of the Primary Oscillator in Sleep mode.
Setting this bit bypasses the normal automatic
shutdown of the oscillator whenever Sleep mode is
invoked.
The Secondary Oscillator can be turned on by a variety
of options:
•
•
•
•
•
•
SOSCGO – OSCCON2
SOSCSEL – CONFIG2L
FOSC – CONFIG2L
DSWDTOSC – CONFIG8H
RTCEN – RTCCON1
SOSCEN – T1CON, T3CON or
T5CON
The ACTCON register (Register 3-10) controls the
Active Clock Tuning features.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-1:
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R-x
R-x
R-x
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
IDLEN
COSC2
COSC1
COSC0
—
NOSC2
NOSC1
NOSC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
IDLEN: Idle Enable bit
1 = SLEEP instruction invokes Idle mode
0 = SLEEP instruction invokes Sleep mode
bit 6-4
COSC: Current Oscillator Selection bits (read-only)
000 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC)
001 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC), divided by N, with PLL module
010 = Primary Oscillator (MS, HS, EC)
011 = Primary Oscillator (MS, HS, EC) with PLL module
100 = Secondary Oscillator (SOSC)
101 = Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC)
110 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) divided by 16 (500 kHz)
111 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) divided by N
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
NOSC: New Oscillator Selection bits
000 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC)
001 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC), divided by N, with PLL module
010 = Primary Oscillator (MS, HS, EC)
011 = Primary Oscillator (MS, HS, EC) with PLL module
100 = Secondary Oscillator (SOSC)
101 = Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC)
110 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) divided by 16 (500 kHz)
111 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) divided by N
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 45
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-2:
OSCCON2: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
U-0
R/C-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
CLKLOCK(2)
IOLOCK(1)
LOCK
—
CF
POSCEN
SOSCGO
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
C = Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CLKLOCK: Clock Lock Enabled bit(2)
1 = Clock and PLL selection are locked and may not be modified
0 = Clock and PLL selection are not locked, configurations may be modified
bit 6
IOLOCK: I/O Lock Enable bit(1)
1 = I/O lock is active (If IOL1WAY (CONFIG5H = 1), the bit cannot be cleared, once it is set, except
on a device Reset.)
0 = I/O lock is not active
bit 5
LOCK: PLL Lock Status bit (read-only)
1 = Indicates that PLL module is in lock or PLL start-up timer is satisfied
0 = Indicates that PLL module is out of lock, PLL start-up timer is in progress or PLL is disabled
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
CF: Clock Fail Detect bit (readable/clearable by application)
1 = FSCM has detected a clock failure
0 = FSCM has not detected A clock failure
bit 2
POSCEN: Primary Oscillator (POSC) Enable bit
1 = Enables Primary Oscillator in Sleep mode
0 = Disables Primary Oscillator in Sleep mode
bit 1
SOSCGO: 32 kHz Secondary (LP) Oscillator Enable bit
1 = Enables Secondary Oscillator independent of other SOSC enable requests; provides a way to keep
the SOSC running even when not actively used by the system
0 = Disables Secondary Oscillator; the SOSC will be enabled if directly requested by the system. Reset
on POR or BOR only.
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1:
2:
The IOLOCK bit cannot be cleared once it has been set, provided that the IOL1WAY (CONFIG5H) = 1.
If the user wants to change the clock source, ensure that the FSCM bits (CONFIG3L) are set
appropriately.
DS30000575C-page 46
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.3.2
OSCCON3 – CLOCK DIVIDER
REGISTER (IRCF BITS)
This option is described in more detail in Section 3.10.2
“FRC Postscaler Mode (FRCDIV)” and Section 3.10.3
“FRC Oscillator with PLL Mode (FRCPLL)”.
The IRCFx bits (OSCCON3) select the postscaler
option for the FRC Oscillator output, allowing users to
choose a lower clock frequency than the nominal 8 MHz.
REGISTER 3-3:
U-0
OSCCON3: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER 3
U-0
—
—
U-0
—
U-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
(1)
—
IRCF2
R/W-0
R/W-1
(1)
IRCF1
IRCF0(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
IRCF: Reference Clock Divider bits(1)
000 = FRC divide-by-1
001 = FRC divide-by-2 (default)
010 = FRC divide-by-4
011 = FRC divide-by-8
100 = FRC divide-by-16
101 = FRC divide-by-32
110 = FRC divide-by-64
111 = FRC divide-by-256
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
The default FRC divide-by setting on an 8-bit device corresponds to 1 MIPS operation.
REGISTER 3-4:
OSCCON4: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER 4
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
CPDIV1
CPDIV0
PLLEN
—
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
CPDIV: USB System Clock Select bits (postscaler select from 64 MHz clock branch)
00 = Input clock/1
01 = Input clock/2
10 = Input clock/4
11 = Input clock/8
bit 5
PLLEN: PLL Enable bit
1 = PLL is enabled even though it is not requested by the CPU; provides ability to “warm-up” the PLL
and keep it running to avoid the PLL start-up time. This setting will force the PLL and associated
clock source to stay active in Sleep.
0 = PLL is disabled; PLL will be automatically turned on when SRC1 is selected, or when REFO1 or
REFO2 is enabled and using the PLL clock as its source. In either case, the PLL will require a
start-up time.
bit 4-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 47
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.3.3
OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
(OSCTUNE)
The FRC Oscillator Tuning register (Register 3-5)
allows the user to fine-tune the FRC Oscillator. Refer to
the data sheet of the specific device for further
information regarding the FRC Oscillator tuning.
REGISTER 3-5:
The tuning response of the FRC Oscillator may not be
monotonic or linear; the next closest frequency may be
offset by a number of steps. It is recommended that
users try multiple values of OSCTUNE to find the
closest value to the desired frequency.
OSCTUNE: FRC OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
TUN5
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at all Resets
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-0
TUN: FRC Oscillator Tuning bits
011111 = Maximum frequency deviation
011110 =
.
.
.
000001 =
000000 = Center frequency; oscillator is running at factory calibrated frequency
111111 =
.
.
.
100001 =
100000 = Minimum frequency deviation
DS30000575C-page 48
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.4
Reference Clock Output Control
Module
The PIC18F97J94 family has two Reference Clock
Output (REFO) modules. Each of the Reference Clock
Output modules provides the user with the ability to
send out a programmed output clock onto the
REFO1or REFO2 pins.
3.4.1
REFERENCE CLOCK SOURCE
3.4.3
OPERATION IN SLEEP MODE
If any clock source, other than the peripheral clock, is
used as a base reference (i.e., ROSEL 0001),
the user has the option to configure the behavior of the
oscillator in Sleep mode. The RSLP Configuration bit
determines if the oscillator will continue to run in Sleep.
If RSLP = 0, the oscillator will be shut down in Sleep
(assuming no other consumers are requesting it). If
RSLP = 1, the oscillator will continue to run in Sleep.
The module provides the ability to select one of the
following clock sources:
The Reference Clock Output is synchronized with the
Sleep signal to avoid any glitches on its output.
•
•
•
•
3.4.3.1
Primary Crystal Oscillator (POSC)
Secondary Crystal Oscillator (SOSC)
32.768 kHz Internal Oscillator (INTOSC)
Fast Internal Oscillator (FRC)
It includes a programmable clock divider with ratios
ranging from 1:1 to 1:65534.
When the clock source is a crystal or internal oscillator,
the RSLP bit can be set to continue REFO operation
while the device is in Sleep Mode.
3.4.2
CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION
The Reference Clock Output is enabled only once
(ON = 1). Note that the source of the clock and the
divider values should be chosen prior to the bit being
set to avoid glitches on the REFO output.
Once the ON bit is set, its value is synchronized to the
Reference Clock Output domain to enable the output.
This ensures that no glitches will be seen on the output.
Similarly, when the ON bit is cleared, the output and the
associated output enable signals will be synchronized
and disabled on the falling edge of the Reference Clock
Output. Note that with large divider values, this will
cause the REFO to be enabled for some period after
ON is cleared.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Module Enable Signal
The REFOx module may be enabled or disabled using
the REFOxMD register bit, which holds the REFOx
module in Reset, or the ON register bit, which does not.
3.4.3.2
Registers and Bits
This module provides the following device registers
and/or bits:
• REFOxCON – Reference Clock Output Control
Register
• REFOxCON1 – Reference Clock Output Control 1
Register
• REFOxCON2 – Reference Clock Output Control 2
Register
• REFOxCON3 – Reference Clock Output Control 3
Register
In addition, the REFOxCON1 module needs to be
enabled by clearing the REFOxMD disable bit
(PMD3).
3.4.3.3
Interrupts
This module does not generate any interrupts.
Note:
Throughout this section, references to
register and bit names that may be associated with specific Reference Clock Output
modules are referred to generically by the
use of ‘x’ in place of the specific module
number. Thus, “REFOxCON” might refer to
the control register for either REFO1 or
REFO2.
DS30000575C-page 49
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-6:
R/W-0
REFOxCON: REFERENCE CLOCK OUTPUT CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
ON
—
R/W-0
SIDL
R/W-0
OE
R/W-0
(1)
RSLP
U-0
HC/R/W-0
HS/HC/R-0
—
DIVSW_EN
ACTIVE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
HC = Hardware Clearable bit
HS = Hardware Settable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at all Resets
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ON: Reference Clock Output Enable bit
1 = Reference clock module is enabled
0 = Reference clock module is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
SIDL: Peripheral Stop in Idle Mode bit
1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode
0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode
bit 4
OE: Reference Clock Output Enable bit
1 = Reference clock is driven out on REFOx pin
0 = Reference clock is NOT driven out on REFOx pin
bit 3
RSLP: Reference Clock Output Run in Sleep bit(1)
1 = Reference Clock Output continues to run in Sleep
0 = Reference Clock Output is disabled in Sleep
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1
DIVSW_EN: Clock RODIV Switch Enabled Status bit
1 = Clock Divider Switching currently in progress
0 = Clock Divider Switching has completed
bit 0
ACTIVE: Reference Clock Output Request Status bit
1 = Reference clock request is active (user should not update the ROSEL and RODIV register fields)
0 = Reference clock request is not active (user may update the ROSEL and RODIV register fields)
Note 1:
This bit has no effect when ROSEL = 0000/0001, as the system clock and peripheral clock are
always disabled in Sleep mode on PIC18 devices.
DS30000575C-page 50
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-7:
REFOxCON1: REFERENCE CLOCK OUTPUT CONTROL REGISTER 1
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
—
—
—
—
ROSEL3
ROSEL2
ROSEL1
ROSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at all Resets
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
(Reserved for additional ROSEL bits.)
bit 3-0
ROSEL: Reference Clock Output Source Select bits(1)
Select one of the various clock sources to be used as the reference clock.
0111-1111 = Reserved
0110 = PLL (4/6/8x or 96 MHz)
0101 = SOSC
0100 = LPRC
0011 = FRC
0010 = POSC
0001 = Peripheral clock (reference clock reflects any peripheral clock switching)
0000 = System clock (reference clock reflects any device clock switching)
When PLLDIV (CONFIG2H) = 1111, ROSEL should not be set to ‘0110’.
Note 1:
The ROSEL register field should not be written while the ACTIVE (REFOxCON) bit is ‘1’; undefined
behavior will result.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 51
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-8:
REFOxCON2: REFERENCE CLOCK OUTPUT CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W -0(1)
R/W -0(1)
RODIV7
RODIV6
RODIV5
RODIV4
RODIV3
RODIV2
RODIV1
RODIV0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at all Resets
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
RODIV: Reference Clock Output Divider bits(1)
Reserved for expansion of RODIV.
The RODIV register field should not be written while the ACTIVE (REFOxCON) bit is ‘1’; Undefined
behavior will result.
REGISTER 3-9:
REFOxCON3: REFERENCE CLOCK OUTPUT CONTROL REGISTER 3
U-0
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0(1)
—
RODIV14
RODIV13
RODIV12
RODIV11
RODIV10
RODIV9
RODIV8
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at all Resets
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-0
RODIV: Reference Clock Output Divider bits(1)
Used in conjunction with RODIV to specify clock divider frequency.
111111111111111 = REFO clock is base clock frequency divided by 65,534 (32,767 * 2)
111111111111110 = REFO clock is base clock frequency divided by 65,532 (32,766 * 2)
•
•
•
000000000000011 = REFO clock is base clock frequency divided by 6 (3 * 2)
000000000000010 = REFO clock is base clock frequency divided by 4 (2 * 2)
000000000000001 = REFO clock is base clock frequency divided by 2 (1 * 2)
000000000000000 = REFO clock is the same frequency as the base clock (no divider)
Note 1:
The RODIV register field should not be written while the ACTIVE (REFOxCON) bit is ‘1’; undefined
behavior will result.
DS30000575C-page 52
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.5
Primary Oscillator (POSC)
input or an external crystal. Further details of the
Primary Oscillator operating modes are described in
subsequent sections. The Primary Oscillator has up to
6 operating modes, summarized in Table 3-2.
The Primary Oscillator is available on the OSC1 and
OSC2 pins of the PIC18F family. In general, the Primary Oscillator can be configured for an external clock
TABLE 3-2:
PRIMARY OSCILLATOR OPERATING MODES
Oscillator Mode
EC
Description
OSC2 Pin Function
External clock input (0-64 MHz)
FOSC/4
ECPLL
External clock input (4-48 MHz), PLL enabled
FOSC/4, Note 2
HS
10 MHz-32 MHz crystal
Note 1
HSPLL
10 MHz-32 MHz crystal, PLL enabled
Note 2
MS
3.5 MHz-10 MHz crystal
Note 1
MSPLL
3.5 MHz-8 MHz crystal, PLL enabled
Note 1
Note 1: External crystal is connected to OSC1 and OSC2 in these modes.
2: Available only in devices with special PLL blocks (such as the 96 MHz PLL); the basic 4x PLL block
generates clock frequencies beyond the device’s operating range.
The POSCMDx and FOSCx Configuration bits (CONFIG3L and CONFIG2L, respectively) select
the operating mode of the Primary Oscillator. The
POSCMD bits select the particular submode to
be used (MS, HS or EC), while the FOSC bits
determine if the oscillator will be used by itself or with
FIGURE 3-3:
the internal PLL. The PIC18F operates from the
Primary Oscillator whenever the COSCx bits
(OSCCON) are set to ‘010’ or ‘011’.
Refer to the “Electrical Characteristics” section in
the specific device data sheet for further information
regarding frequency range for each crystal mode.
CRYSTAL OR CERAMIC RESONATOR OPERATION
(MS OR HS OSCILLATOR MODE)
To Internal Logic
OSC1
C1(3)
XTAL
RF(2)
Sleep
OSC2
RS(1)
C2
(3)
PIC18F
Note 1: A series resistor, Rs, may be required for AT strip cut crystals.
2: The internal feedback resistor, RF, is typically in the range of 2 to 10 M
3: See Section 3.6.5 “Determining the Best Values for Oscillator Components”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 53
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.5.1
3.6
SELECTING A PRIMARY
OSCILLATOR MODE
Crystal Oscillators and Ceramic
Resonators
The main difference between the MS and HS modes is
the gain of the internal inverter of the oscillator circuit,
which allows the different frequency ranges. The MS
mode is a medium power, medium frequency mode.
HS mode provides the highest oscillator frequencies
with a crystal. OSC2 provides crystal feedback in both
HS and MS Oscillator modes.
In MS and HS modes, a crystal or ceramic resonator is
connected to the OSC1 and OSC2 pins to establish
oscillation (Figure 3-3). The PIC18F oscillator design
requires the use of a parallel cut crystal. Using a series
cut crystal may give a frequency out of the crystal
manufacturer’s specifications.
The EC and HS modes that use the PLL circuit provide
the highest device operating frequencies. The oscillator circuit will consume the most current in these modes
because the PLL is enabled to multiply the frequency of
the oscillator.
3.6.1
In general, users should select the oscillator option with
the lowest possible gain that still meets their specifications. This will result in lower dynamic currents (IDD).
The frequency range of each oscillator mode is the
recommended frequency cutoff, but the selection of a
different gain mode is acceptable as long as a thorough
validation is performed (voltage, temperature and
component variations, such as resistor, capacitor and
internal oscillator circuitry).
The oscillator feedback circuit is disabled in all EC
modes. The OSC1 pin is a high-impedance input and
can be driven by a CMOS driver.
If the Primary Oscillator is configured for an external
clock input, the OSC2 pin is not required to support the
oscillator function. For these modes, the OSC2 pin can
be used as an additional device I/O pin or a clock output pin. When the OSC2 pin is used as a clock output
pin, the output frequency is FOSC/4.
FIGURE 3-4:
OSCILLATOR/RESONATOR STARTUP
As the device voltage increases from VSS, the oscillator
will start its oscillations. The time required for the oscillator to start oscillating depends on many factors,
including:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Crystal/resonator frequency
Capacitor values used
Series resistor, if used, and its value and type
Device VDD rise time
System temperature
Oscillator mode selection of device (selects the
gain of the internal oscillator inverter)
• Crystal quality
• Oscillator circuit layout
• System noise
The course of a typical crystal or resonator start-up is
shown in Figure 3-4. Notice that the time to achieve
stable oscillation is not instantaneous.
EXAMPLE OSCILLATOR/RESONATOR START-UP CHARACTERISTICS
Maximum VDD of System
Device VDD
VIH
Voltage
VIL
0V
Crystal Start-up Time
Time
DS30000575C-page 54
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.6.2
PRIMARY OSCILLATOR START-UP
FROM SLEEP MODE
The most difficult time for the oscillator to start-up is
when waking up from Sleep mode. This is because the
load capacitors have both partially charged to some
quiescent value and phase differential at wake-up is
minimal. Thus, more time is required to achieve stable
oscillation. Also remember that low voltage, high temperatures and the lower frequency clock modes also
impose limitations on loop gain, which in turn, affects
start-up.
Each of the following factors increases the start-up
time:
• Low-frequency design (with a Low Gain Clock
mode)
• Quiet environment (such as a battery-operated
device)
• Operating in a shielded box (away from the noisy
RF area)
• Low voltage
• High temperature
• Wake-up from Sleep mode
Circuit noise, on the other hand, may actually help to
“kick start” the oscillator and help to lower the oscillator
start-up time.
3.6.3
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
In order to ensure that a crystal oscillator (or ceramic
resonator) has started and stabilized, an Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) is provided. The OST is a simple,
10-bit counter that counts 1024 TOSC cycles before
releasing the oscillator clock to the rest of the system.
This time-out period is designated as TOST. The amplitude of the oscillator signal must reach the VIL and VIH
thresholds for the oscillator pins before the OST can
begin to count cycles.
The TOST interval is required every time the oscillator
has to restart (i.e., on POR, BOR and wake-up from
Sleep mode). The Oscillator Start-up Timer is applied to
the MS and HS modes for the Primary Oscillator, as well
as the Secondary Oscillator, SOSC (see Section 3.9
“Secondary Oscillator (SOSC)”).
3.6.4
TUNING THE OSCILLATOR
CIRCUIT
Since Microchip devices have wide operating ranges
(frequency, voltage and temperature, depending on the
part and version ordered), and external components
(crystals, capacitors, etc.) of varying quality and manufacture, validation of operation needs to be performed to
ensure that the component selection will comply with the
requirements of the application. There are many factors
that go into the selection and arrangement of these
external components. Depending on the application,
these may include any of the following:
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Amplifier gain
Desired frequency
Resonant frequency(s) of the crystal
Temperature of operation
Supply voltage range
Start-up time
Stability
Crystal life
Power consumption
Simplification of the circuit
Use of standard components
Component count
3.6.5
DETERMINING THE BEST VALUES
FOR OSCILLATOR COMPONENTS
The best method for selecting components is to apply
a little knowledge, and a lot of trial measurement and
testing. Crystals are usually selected by their parallel
resonant frequency only; however, other parameters
may be important to your design, such as temperature
or frequency tolerance. Microchip Application Note
AN588, “PICmicro® Microcontroller Oscillator Design
Guide” (DS00000588) is an excellent reference to learn
more about crystal operation and ordering information.
The PIC18F internal oscillator circuit is a parallel
oscillator circuit which requires that a parallel resonant
crystal be selected. The load capacitance is usually
specified in the 22 pF to 33 pF range. The crystal will
oscillate closest to the desired frequency, with a load
capacitance in this range. It may be necessary to alter
these values, as described later, in order to achieve
other benefits.
The clock mode is primarily chosen based on the
desired frequency of the crystal oscillator. The main difference between the MS and HS Oscillator modes is
the gain of the internal inverter of the oscillator circuit,
which allows the different frequency ranges. In general,
use the oscillator option with the lowest possible gain
that still meets specifications. This will result in lower
dynamic currents (IDD). The frequency range of each
oscillator mode is the recommended frequency cutoff,
but the selection of a different gain mode is acceptable
as long as a thorough validation is performed (voltage,
temperature and component variations, such as resistor, capacitor and internal oscillator circuitry). C1 and
C2 should also be initially selected based on the load
capacitance, as suggested by the crystal manufacturer,
and the tables supplied in the device data sheet. The
values given in the device data sheet can only be used
as a starting point, since the crystal manufacturer, supply voltage, and other factors already mentioned, may
cause your circuit to differ from the one used in the
factory characterization process.
Ideally, the capacitance is chosen so that it will oscillate
at the highest temperature and the lowest VDD that the
circuit will be expected to perform under. High tempera-
DS30000575C-page 55
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
ture and low VDD both have a limiting effect on the loop
gain, such that if the circuit functions at these extremes,
the designer can be more assured of proper operation
at other temperatures and supply voltage combinations. The output sine wave should not be clipped in the
highest gain environment (highest VDD and lowest temperature) and the sine output amplitude should be large
enough in the lowest gain environment (lowest VDD
and highest temperature) to cover the logic input
requirements of the clock, as listed in the device data
sheet. OSC1 may have specified VIL and VIH levels
(refer to the specific product data sheet for more information).
A method for improving start-up is to use a value of C2
greater than C1. This causes a greater phase shift across
the crystal at power-up, which speeds oscillator start-up.
Besides loading the crystal for proper frequency
response, these capacitors can have the effect of lowering loop gain if their value is increased. C2 can be
selected to affect the overall gain of the circuit. A higher
C2 can lower the gain if the crystal is being overdriven
(also see discussion on Rs). Capacitance values that are
too high can store and dump too much current through
the crystal, so C1 and C2 should not become excessively
large. Unfortunately, measuring the wattage through a
crystal is difficult, but if you do not stray too far from the
suggested values, you should not have to be concerned
with this.
A series resistor, Rs, is added to the circuit if after all
other external components are selected to satisfaction,
and the crystal is still being overdriven. This can be
determined by looking at the OSC2 pin, which is the
driven pin, with an oscilloscope. Connecting the probe
to the OSC1 pin will load the pin too much and negatively affect performance. Remember that a scope
probe adds its own capacitance to the circuit, so this
may have to be accounted for in your design (i.e., if the
circuit worked best with a C2 of 22 pF and the scope
probe was 10 pF, a 33 pF capacitor may actually be
called for). The output signal should not be clipping or
flattened. Overdriving the crystal can also lead to the
circuit jumping to a higher harmonic level, or even,
crystal damage.
The OSC2 signal should be a clean sine wave that
easily spans the input minimum and maximum of the
clock input pin. An easy way to set this is to again test
the circuit at the minimum temperature and maximum
VDD that the design will be expected to perform in; then,
look at the output. This should be the maximum amplitude of the clock output. If there is clipping, or the sine
wave is distorted near VDD and VSS, increasing load
capacitors may cause too much current to flow through
the crystal, or push the value too far from the manufacturer’s load specification. To adjust the crystal current,
add a trimmer potentiometer between the crystal
DS30000575C-page 56
inverter output pin and C2, and adjust it until the sine
wave is clean. The crystal will experience the highest
drive currents at the low temperature and high VDD
extremes.
The trimmer potentiometer should be adjusted at these
limits to prevent overdriving. A series resistor, Rs, of
the closest standard value can now be inserted in place
of the trimmer. If Rs is too high, perhaps more than
20 k, the input will be too isolated from the output,
making the clock more susceptible to noise. If you find
a value this high is needed to prevent overdriving the
crystal, try increasing C2 to compensate or changing
the oscillator operating mode. Try to get a combination
where Rs is around 10 k or less, and load
capacitance is not too far from the manufacturer’s
specification.
3.7
External Clock Input
In EC mode, the OSC1 pin is in a high-impedance state
and can be driven by CMOS drivers. The OSC2 pin can
be configured as either an I/O or the clock output
(FOSC 4) by selecting the CLKOEN bit (CONFIG2L).
With CLKOEN set (Figure 3-5), the clock output is available for testing or synchronization purposes. With
CLKOEN clear (Figure 3-6), the OSC2 pin becomes a
general purpose I/O pin. The feedback device between
OSC1 and OSC2 is turned off to save current.
FIGURE 3-5:
EXTERNAL CLOCK INPUT
OPERATION (CLKOEN = 1)
Clock from
External System
OSC1
PIC18F
FOSC/2
FIGURE 3-6:
Clock from
External
System
OSC2 (FOSC/4 output)
EXTERNAL CLOCK INPUT
OPERATION (CLKOEN = 0)
OSC1
PIC18F
I/O
I/O RA6 (General Purpose I/O)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.8
Phase Lock Loop (PLL) Branch
The PLL module contains two separate PLL
submodules: PLLM and PLL96MHZ. The PLLM submodule is configurable as a 4x, 6x or 8x PLL. The
PLL96MHZ submodule runs at 96 MHz and requires an
input clock between 4 MHz and 48 MHz (a multiple of
4 MHz). These are selected through the PLLDIV
bits.
FIGURE 3-7:
BASIC OSCILLATOR BLOCK DIAGRAM
FRCDIV
FRC Oscillator (FRC)
Divide
by N
OSCMUX
PLL Module
(PLLM, PLL96MHZ)
Primary Oscillator (POSC)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 57
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.8.1
OSCILLATOR MODES AND USB
OPERATION
Because of the timing requirements imposed by USB,
an internal clock of 48 MHz is required at all times while
the USB module is enabled and not in a suspended
operating state. A method is provided to internally
generate both the USB and system clocks from a single
oscillator source. PIC18F97J94 family devices use the
same clock structure as most other PIC18 devices, but
include a two-branch PLL system to generate the two
clock signals.
The USB PLL block is shown in Figure 3-8. In this system, the input from the Primary Oscillator is divided
down by a PLL prescaler to generate a 4 MHz output.
FIGURE 3-8:
This is used to drive an on-chip 96 MHz PLL frequency
multiplier to drive the two clock branches. One branch
uses a fixed, divide-by-2 frequency divider to generate
the 48 MHz USB clock. The other branch uses a fixed,
divide-by-1.5 frequency divider and configurable PLL
prescaler/divider to generate a range of system clock
frequencies. The CPDIVx bits select the system clock
speed; available clock options are listed in Table 3-3.
The USB PLL prescaler does not automatically sense
the incoming oscillator frequency. The user must manually configure the PLL divider to generate the required
4 MHz output, using the PLLDIV Configuration
bits. This limits the choices for Primary Oscillator
frequency to a total of 8 possibilities, shown in Table 3-4.
96 MHz PLL BLOCK
USB Clock
48 MHz Clock
for USB Module
÷2
96 MHz PLL
System Clock
Input from
FRC
4 MHz or
8 MHz
PLLDIV
÷12
÷8
÷6
÷5
÷4
÷3
÷2
÷1
0111
0110
0101
0100
0011
0010
0001
0000
Postsclaer
Input from
POSC
PLL Prescaler
FOSC
÷8
÷4
÷2
÷1
11
10
01
00
÷ 1.5
PLL Output for
System Clock
CPDIV
Graphics Clock
÷2
Graphics Clock
Option 2
48 MHz Branch
4 MHz Branch
96 MHz Branch
G1CLKSEL
0
DS30000575C-page 58
Postsclaer
96 MHz
PLL
÷64
÷63
...
÷17.50
÷17.00
...
÷1.25
127
126
...
65
64
...
1
Clock Output for
Display Interface
(DISPCLK)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 3-3:
SYSTEM CLOCK OPTIONS
DURING USB OPERATION
MCU Clock Division
(CPDIV)
System Clock
Frequency
(Instruction Rate in
MIPS®)
None (00)
64 MHz (16)
2 (01)
32 MHz (8)
4 (10)
16 MHz (4)
8 (11)
(1)
8 MHz (2)
Note 1: These options are not compatible with
USB operation. They may be used whenever the PLL branch is selected and the
USB module is disabled.
TABLE 3-4:
VALID PRIMARY OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATIONS FOR USB
OPERATIONS
Input
Oscillator
Frequency
Clock Mode
PLL Division
(PLLDIV)
48 MHz
ECPLL
12 (111)
32 MHz
ECPLL
8 (110)
24 MHz
HSPLL, ECPLL
6 (101)
20 MHz
HSPLL, ECPLL
5 (100)
16 MHz
HSPLL, ECPLL
4 (011)
3.8.2
CONSIDERATIONS FOR USING
THE PLL BLOCK
All PLL blocks use the LOCK bit (OSCCON2) as a
read-only Status bit to indicate the lock status of the
PLL. It is automatically set after the typical time delay
for the PLL to achieve lock, designated as TLOCK. It is
cleared at a POR and on clock switches when the PLL
is selected as a clock source. It remains clear when any
clock source not using the PLL is selected.
If the PLL does not stabilize properly during start-up,
the LOCK bit may not reflect the actual status of the
PLL lock, nor does it detect when the PLL loses lock
during normal operation. Refer to the ”Electrical Characteristics” section in the specific device data sheet
for further information on the PLL lock interval.
Using any PLL block with the FRC Oscillator provides
a stable system clock for microcontroller operations.
USB operation is only possible with FRC Oscillators
that are implemented with ±1/4% frequency accuracy.
Serial communications using USART are only possible
when FRC Oscillators are implemented with ±2% frequency accuracy. The PIC18F97J94 family is able to
meet the required oscillator accuracy for both USB and
USART providing stable communication by use of its
active clock tuning feature. Refer to Section 3.13.3
“Active Clock Tuning (ACT) Module” for more
information.
12 MHz
HSPLL, ECPLL
3 (010)
8 MHz
ECPLL, MSPLL,
FRCPLL(1)
2 (001)
If an application is being migrated between PIC18F
platforms with different PLL blocks, the differences in
PLL and clock options may require the reconfiguration
of peripherals that use the system clock. This is particularly true with serial communication peripherals, such
as the USARTs.
4 MHz
ECPLL, MSPLL,
FRCPLL(1)
1 (000)
3.9
Note 1: FRCPLL with ±0.25% accuracy can be
used for USB operation.
Note:
Because of USB clocking accuracy
requirements (±0.25%), not all PIC18F
devices support the use of the FRCPLL
system clock configuration for USB operation. Refer to the specific device data
sheet for details on the FRC Oscillator
module.
Secondary Oscillator (SOSC)
In most PIC18F devices, the low-power Secondary
Oscillator (SOSC) is implemented to run with a
32.768 kHz crystal. The oscillator is located on the
SOSCO and SOSCI device pins, and serves as a secondary crystal clock source for low-power operation. It
is used to drive Timer1, Real-Time Clock and Calendar
(RTCC) and other modules requiring a clock signal
while in low-power operation.
3.9.1
ENABLING THE SECONDARY
OSCILLATOR
The operation of the SOSC is selected by the FOSCx
Configuration bits or by selection of the NOSCx bits
(OSCCON). The SOSC can also be enabled by
setting the SOSCEN bit in Timer1, Timer3 or Timer5.
The SOSC has a long start-up time; therefore, to avoid
delays for peripheral start-up, the SOSC can be
manually started using one of the SOSCEN bits.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 59
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.9.2
3.9.2.1
SECONDARY OSCILLATOR
OPERATION
Continuous Operation
The SOSC is always running when any of the SOSCEN
bits are set. Leaving the oscillator running at all times
allows a fast switch to the 32 kHz system clock for
lower power operation. Returning to the faster main
oscillator still requires an oscillator start-up time if it is a
crystal-type source. This start-up time can be avoided
on PLL clock sources by setting the PLLEN bit (OSCCON4) in advance of switching the clock source.
In addition, the oscillator will need to remain running at
all times for Real-Time Clock (RTC) application using
Timer1 or the RTCC module. Refer to Section 14.
“Timers” and Section 29. “Real-Time Clock and
Calendar (RTCC)” in the “PIC18F Family Reference
Manual” for further details.
3.9.2.2
Intermittent Operation
When all SOSCEN bits are cleared, the oscillator will
only operate when it is selected as the current device
clock source (COSC = 100). It will be disabled
automatically if it is the current device clock source and
the device enters Sleep mode.
3.9.3
3.9.3.1
OPERATING MODES
Digital Mode
The SOSCO pin can also be configured to operate as a
digital clock input. The SOSCO pin is configured as a
digital input by setting SOSCSEL (CONFIG2L) = 10.
When running in this mode, the SOSCO/SCLKI pin will
operate as a digital input to the oscillator section, while
the SOSCI pin will function as a port pin. The crystal
driving circuit is disabled. The Oscillator Configuration
Fuse bits (FOSC) and New Oscillator Selection
bits (NOSC) have no effect.
3.9.4
SOSC CRYSTAL SELECTION
A typical 50K ESR and 12.5 pF CL (capacitive loading)
rated crystal is recommended for reliable operation of
the SOSC. The duty cycle of the SOSC output can be
measured on the REFO pin, and is recommended to be
within +/-15% from a 50% duty cycle.
3.10
Internal Fast RC Oscillator (FRC)
The FRC Oscillator is a fast (8 MHz nominal), internal
RC Oscillator. This oscillator is intended to be a precise
internal RC Oscillator accurate enough to provide the
clock frequency necessary to maintain baud rate tolerance for serial data transmissions, without the use of
an external crystal or ceramic resonator. The PIC18F
device operates from the FRC Oscillator whenever the
COSCx bits are ‘111’, ‘110’, ‘001’ or ‘000’.
DS30000575C-page 60
3.10.1
ENABLING THE FRC OSCILLATOR
Since it serves as the system clock during device initialization, the FRC Oscillator is always enabled at a POR.
After the device is configured and PWRT expires, FRC
remains active only if it is selected as the device clock
source.
3.10.2
FRC POSTSCALER MODE (FRCDIV)
Users are not limited to the nominal 8 MHz FRC output
if they wish to use the Fast Internal Oscillator as a clock
source. An additional FRC mode, FRCDIV, implements
a selectable postscaler that allows the choice of a lower
clock frequency, from 7 different options, plus the direct
8 MHz output. The postscaler is configured using the
IRCF bits (OSCCON3). Assuming a
nominal 8 MHz output, available lower frequency
options range from 4 MHz (divide-by-2) to 31 kHz
(divide-by-256). The range of frequencies allows users
the ability to save power at any time in an application
by simply changing the IRCFx bits.
The FRCDIV mode is selected whenever the COSCx
bits are ‘111’.
3.10.3
FRC OSCILLATOR WITH PLL MODE
(FRCPLL)
The FRCPLL mode is selected whenever the COSCx
bits are ‘001’. In addition, this mode only functions when
the direct or divide-by-2 FRC postscaler options are
selected (IRCF = 000 or 001).
When using the 4x or 8x PLL option, the output of the
FRC postscaler may also be combined with the PLL to
produce a nominal system clock of 16 MHz, 32 MHz or
64 MHz. Although somewhat less precise in frequency
than using the Primary Oscillator with a crystal or resonator, it allows high-speed operation of the device
without the use of external oscillator components.
For devices with the basic 4x PLL block, the output of the
FRC postscaler block may also be combined with the
PLL to produce a nominal system clock of either 16 MHz
or 32 MHz. Although somewhat less precise in frequency than using the Primary Oscillator with a crystal or
resonator, it still allows high-speed operation of the
device without the use of external oscillator components.
When using the 96 MHz PLL block, the output of the
FRC postscaler block may also be combined with the
PLL to produce a nominal system clock of either
4 MHz, 8 MHz, 16 MHz or 32 MHz. It also produces a
48 MHz USB clock; however, this USB clock must be
generated with the FRC Oscillator meeting the
frequency accuracy requirement of USB for proper
operation. Refer to the specific device data sheet for
details on the FRC Oscillator electrical characteristics.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
In cases where the frequency accuracy is not met for
USB operation, the FRCPLL mode should not be used
when USB is active.
Note:
3.11
Using FRC postscaler values, other than
‘000‘or ‘001‘, will cause the clock input to
the PLL to be below the operating
frequency input range and may cause
undesirable operation.
Internal Low-Power RC Oscillator
(LPRC)
The LPRC Oscillator is separate from the FRC and oscillates at a nominal frequency of 31 kHz. LPRC is the
clock source for the Power-up Timer (PWRT), Watchdog
Timer (WDT) and FSCM circuits. It may also be used to
provide a low-frequency clock source option for the
device, in those applications where power consumption
is critical and timing accuracy is not required.
3.11.1
ENABLING THE LPRC OSCILLATOR
Since it serves the Power-up Timer (PWRT) clock
source, the LPRC Oscillator is enabled at POR events
whenever the on-board voltage regulator is disabled.
After the PWRT expires, the LPRC Oscillator will
remain on if any one of the following is true:
• The FSCM is enabled.
• The WDT is enabled.
• The LPRC Oscillator is selected as the system
clock (COSC = 101).
If none of the above is true, the LPRC will shut off after
the PWRT expires.
3.12
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM)
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device
to continue to operate, even in the event of an oscillator
failure. The FSCM function is enabled by programming
the FSCMx (Clock Switch and Monitor) bits in CONFIG3L. FSCM is only enabled when the
FSCM bits (CONFIG3L) = 00. When FSCM
is enabled, the internal LPRC Oscillator will run at all
times (except during Sleep mode).
In the event of an oscillator failure, the FSCM will generate a clock failure trap and will switch the system clock
to the FRC Oscillator. The user will then have the option
to either attempt to restart the oscillator or execute a
controlled shutdown. FSCM will monitor the system
clock source regardless of its source or oscillator mode.
This includes the Primary Oscillator for all oscillator
modes and the Secondary Oscillator, SOSC, when
configured as the system clock.
The FSCM module takes the following actions when
switching to the FRC Oscillator:
1.
2.
The COSCx bits are loaded with ‘000’.
The CF Status bit is set to indicate the clock
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
failure.
Note:
3.12.1
For more information about the oscillator failure trap, refer to Section 10.0
“Interrupts”.
FSCM DELAY
On a POR, BOR or wake from Sleep mode event, a
nominal delay (TFSCM) may be inserted before the
FSCM begins to monitor the system clock source. The
purpose of the FSCM delay is to provide time for the
oscillator and/or PLL to stabilize when the PWRT is not
utilized. The FSCM delay will be generated after the
internal System Reset signal, SYSRST, has been
released. Refer to Section 28.4 “Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor” for FSCM delay timing information.
The TFSCM interval is applied whenever the FSCM is
enabled and the EC, HS or SOSC Oscillator modes are
selected as the system clock.
Note:
3.12.2
Refer to the “Electrical Characteristics”
section of the specific device data sheet
for TFSCM specification values.
FSCM AND SLOW OSCILLATOR
START-UP
If the chosen device oscillator has a slow start-up time
coming out of POR, BOR or Sleep mode, it is possible
that the FSCM delay will expire before the oscillator
has started. In this case, the FSCM will initiate a clock
failure trap. As this happens, the COSCx bits are
loaded with the FRC Oscillator selection. This will
effectively shut off the original oscillator that was trying
to start. The user can detect this situation and initiate a
clock switch back to the desired oscillator in the Trap
Service Routine (TSR).
3.12.3
FSCM AND WDT
The FSCM and the WDT both use the LPRC Oscillator
as their time base. In the event of a clock failure, the
WDT is unaffected and continues to run on the LPRC.
3.13
Clock Switching Operation
With few limitations, applications are free to switch
between any of the four clock sources (Primary, SOSC,
FRC and LPRC) under software control and at any
time. To limit the possible side effects that could result
from this flexibility, PIC18F devices have a safeguard
lock built into the switch process.
Note:
Primary Oscillator mode has three different
submodes (MS, HS and EC), which are
determined by the POSCMDx Configuration bits. While an application can switch to
and from Primary Oscillator mode, in software, it cannot switch between the different
primary submodes without reprogramming
the device.
DS30000575C-page 61
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.13.1
ENABLING CLOCK SWITCHING
To enable clock switching, the FCKSM1 Configuration
bit must be programmed to ‘0’. If the FCKSM1 Configuration bit is unprogrammed (‘1’), the clock switching
function and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor function are
disabled; this is the default setting.
The NOSCx control bits (OSCCON) do not control
the clock selection when clock switching is disabled. However, the COSCx bits (OSCCON) will reflect the
clock source selected by the FOSC Configuration bits.
3.13.2
OSCILLATOR SWITCHING
SEQUENCE
2.
3.
3.
4.
5.
At a minimum, performing a clock switch requires this
basic sequence:
1.
2.
If desired, read the COSCx bits (OSCCON)
to determine the current oscillator source.
Clear the CLKLOCK bit (OSCCON2) to
enable writes to the NOSCx bits (OSCCON).
Write the appropriate value to the NOSCx control
bits (OSCCON) for the new oscillator
source.
initiated.
The new oscillator is turned on by the hardware
if it is not currently running. If a crystal oscillator
must be turned on, the hardware will wait until
the OST expires. If the new source is using the
PLL, then the hardware waits until a PLL lock is
detected (LOCK = 1).
The hardware waits for the new clock source to
stabilize and then performs the clock switch.
The NOSCx bit values are transferred to the
COSCx Status bits.
The old clock source is turned off at this time,
with the exception of LPRC (if WDT or FSCM is
enabled) or SOSC (if it is enabled by one of the
timer sources).
The timing of the transition between clock sources is
shown in Figure 3-9.
Note 1: The processor will continue to execute
code throughout the clock switching
sequence. Timing-sensitive code should
not be executed during this time.
Once the basic sequence is completed, the system
clock hardware responds automatically as follows:
1.
The clock switching hardware compares the
COSC Status bits with the new value of the
NOSC control bits. If they are the same, then the
clock switch is a redundant operation. If they are
different, then a valid clock switch has been
FIGURE 3-9:
2: Direct clock switches between any
Primary Oscillator mode with PLL and
FRCPLL mode are not permitted. This
applies to clock switches in either direction. In these instances, the application
must switch to FRC mode as a transition
clock source between the two PLL
modes.
CLOCK TRANSITION TIMING DIAGRAM
New Source
Enabled
New Source
Stable
Old Source
Disabled
Old Clock Source
New Clock Source
System Clock
NOSC = COSC
(old oscillator enabled)
NOSC ≠ COSC
(oscillator source in process of transition)
NOSC = COSC
(new oscillator
source enabled)
Both Oscillators Active
Note: The system clock can be any selected source (Primary, Secondary, FRC or LPRC).
DS30000575C-page 62
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
A recommended code sequence for a clock switch
includes the following:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Disable interrupts during the OSCCON register
unlock and write sequence.
Clear the CLKLOCK bit (OSCCON2) to
enable writes to the NOSCx bits (OSCCON).
Write new oscillator source to NOSCx control bits.
Continue to execute code that is not clocksensitive (optional).
Invoke an appropriate amount of software delay
(cycle counting) to allow the selected oscillator
and/or PLL to start and stabilize.
Check to see if COSC contains the new oscillator
values that were requested in Step 3.
3.13.2.1
Clock Switching Considerations
When incorporating clock switching into an application,
users should keep certain things in mind when designing
their code.
• If the new clock source is a crystal oscillator, the
clock switch time will be dominated by the
oscillator start-up time.
• If the new clock source does not start, or is not
present, the clock switching hardware will wait
indefinitely for the new clock source. The user can
detect this situation because the COSCx bits will
not change to reflect the new desired oscillator
settings.
• Switching to a low-frequency clock source, such
as the Secondary Oscillator, will result in very
slow device operation.
Note:
3.13.3
The application should not attempt to
switch to a clock with a frequency lower
than 100 kHz when the FSCM is enabled.
Clock switching in these instances may
generate a false oscillator fail trap and
result in a switch to the Internal Fast RC
Oscillator.
ACTIVE CLOCK TUNING (ACT)
MODULE
The Active Clock Tuning (ACT) module continuously
adjusts the 8 MHz internal oscillator, using an
available external reference, to achieve ± 0.20%
accuracy. This eliminates the need for a high-speed,
high-accuracy external crystal when the system has
an available lower speed, lower power, high-accuracy
clock source available. Systems implementing a RealTime Clock Calendar (RTCC) or a full-speed USB
application can take full advantage of the ACT module.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
3.13.3.1
Active Clock Tuning Operation
The ACT module defaults to the disabled state after
any Reset. When the ACT module is disabled, the user
can write to the TUN bits in the OSCTUNE
register to manually adjust the 8 MHz internal oscillator.
The module is enabled by setting the ACTEN bit of the
ACTCON register. When enabled, the ACT module
takes control of the OSCTUNE register. The ACT
module uses the selected ACT reference clock to tune
the 8 MHz internal oscillator to an accuracy of 8 MHz ±
0.2%. The tuning automatically adjusts the OSCTUNE
register every reference clock cycle.
3.13.3.2
Active Clock Tuning Source
Selection
The ACT reference clock is selected with the ACTSRC
bit of the ACTCON register. The reference clock
sources are provided by the:
• USB module in full-speed operation (ACT_clk)
• Secondary clock at 32.768 kHz (SOSC_clk)
3.13.3.3
ACT Lock Status
The ACTLOCK bit will be set to ‘1’, when the 8 MHz
internal oscillator is successfully tuned.
The bit will be cleared by the following conditions:
• Out of Lock condition
• Device Reset
• Module is disabled
3.13.3.4
ACT Out-of-Range Status
If the ACT module requires an OSCTUNE value
outside the range to achieve ± 0.20% accuracy, then
the ACT Out-of-Range (ACTORS) Status bit will be set
to ‘1’.
An out-of-range status can occur:
• When the 8 MHZ internal oscillator is tuned to its
lowest frequency and the next ACT_clk event
requests a lower frequency.
• When the 8 MHZ internal oscillator is tuned to its
highest frequency and the next ACT_clk event
requests a higher frequency.
When the ACT out-of-range event occurs, the 8 MHz
internal oscillator will continue to use the last written
OSCTUNE value. When the OSCTUNE value moves
back within the tunable range and ACTLOCK is
established, the ACTORS bit is cleared to ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 63
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Note 1: When the ACT module is enabled, the
OSCTUNE register is only updated by
the module. Writes to the OSCTUNE
register by the user are inhibited, but
reading the register is permitted.
2: After disabling the ACT module, the user
should wait three instructions before writing to the OSCTUNE register.
FIGURE 3-10:
ACTIVE CLOCK TUNING BLOCK DIAGRAM
ACTEN
ACTSRC
FSUSB_clk
1
SOSC_clk
0
ACT_clk
Enable
Active
Clock
Tuning
Module
8 MHz
Internal OSC
ACT data
7
ACTUD
ACTEN
DS30000575C-page 64
sfr data
7
OSCTUNE
Write
OSCTUNE
ACTEN
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 3-10:
ACTCON: ACTIVE CLOCK TUNING (ACT) CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ACTEN
—
ACTSIDL
ACTSRC(1)
R-0
R/W-0
ACTLOCK ACTLOCKPOL
R-0
R/W-0
ACTORS
ACTORSPOL
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ACTEN: Active Clock Tuning Selection bit
1 = ACT module is enabled, updates to OSCTUNE are exclusive to the ACT module
0 = ACT module is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Reads as ‘0’
bit 5
ACTSIDL: Active Clock Tuning Stop in Idle bit
1 = Active clock tuning stops during Idle mode
0 = Active clock tuning continues during Idle mode
bit 4
ACTSRC: Active Clock Tuning Source Selection bit
1 = The FRC oscillator is tuned to approximately match the USB host clock tolerance
0 = The FRC oscillator is tuned to approximately match the 32.768 kHz SOSC tolerance
bit 3
ACTLOCK: Active Clock Tuning Lock Status bit
1 = Locked; internal oscillator is within ± 0.20%
0 = Not locked; internal oscillator tuning has not stabilized within ± 0.20%
bit 2
ACTLOCKPOL: Active Clock Tuning Lock Interrupt Polarity bit
1 = ACT lock interrupt is generated when ACTLOCK is ‘0’
0 = ACT lock interrupt is generated when ACTLOCK is ‘1’
bit 1
ACTORS: Active Clock Tuning Out-of-Range Status bit
1 = Out-of-range; oscillator frequency is outside of the OSCTUNE range
0 = In-range; oscillator frequency is within the OSCTUNE range
bit 0
ACTORSPOL: Active Clock Tuning Out of Range Interrupt Polarity bit
1 = ACT out of range interrupt is generated when ACTORS is ‘0’
0 = ACT out of range interrupt is generated when ACTORS is ‘1’
Note 1:
The ACTSRC bit should only be changed when ACTEN = 0.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 65
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.13.4
ABANDONING A CLOCK SWITCH
In the event the clock switch does not complete, it can
be abandoned by setting the NOSCx bits to their previous values. This abandons the clock switch process,
stops and resets the OST (if applicable), and stops the
PLL (if applicable).
A clock switch procedure can be aborted at any time. A
clock switch that is already in progress can also be
aborted by performing a second clock switch.
3.13.5
ENTERING SLEEP MODE DURING
A CLOCK SWITCH
If the device enters Sleep mode during a clock switch
operation, the operation is abandoned. The processor
keeps the old clock selection and the NOSCx bits
return to their previous values (the same as COSC).
The SLEEP instruction is then executed normally.
3.14
Two-Speed Start-Up
Two-Speed Start-up is an automatic clock switching
feature that is independent of the manually controlled
clock switching previously described. It helps to minimize the latency period, from oscillator start-up to code
execution, by allowing the microcontroller to use the
FRC Oscillator as a clock source until the primary clock
source is available. This feature is controlled by the
IESO Configuration bit (CONFIG2L) and operates
independently of the state of the FSCM Configuration
bits.
Two-Speed Start-up is particularly useful when an
external oscillator is selected by the FOSCx Configuration bits, and a crystal-based oscillator (either a
Primary or Secondary Oscillator) may have a longer
start-up time. As an internal RC Oscillator, the FRC
clock source is available almost immediately following
a POR or device wake-up.
With Two-Speed Start-up, the device starts executing
code on POR in its default oscillator configuration (FRC).
It continues to operate in this mode until the external
oscillator source, specified by the FOSCx Configuration
bits, becomes stable; at which time, it automatically
switches to that source.
Two-Speed Start-up is used on wake-up from the powersaving Sleep mode. The device uses the FRC clock
source until the selected primary clock is ready. It is not
used in Idle mode, as the device will be clocked by the currently selected clock source until the primary clock source
becomes available.
DS30000575C-page 66
3.14.1
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS FOR
USING TWO-SPEED START-UP
While using the FRC Oscillator in Two-Speed Start-up,
the device still obeys the normal command sequences
for entering power-saving modes, including SLEEP
and IDLE instructions. In practice, this means that user
code can change the NOSC bit settings or issue
#SLEEP instructions before the OST times out. This
would allow an application to briefly wake-up, perform
routine “housekeeping” tasks and return to Sleep
before the device starts to operate from the external
oscillator.
User code can also check which clock source is currently providing the device clocking by checking the
status of the COSC bits against the NOSC
bits. If these two sets of bits match, the clock switch has
been completed successfully and the device is running
from the intended clock source; the Primary Oscillator
is providing the clock. Otherwise, FRC is providing the
clock during wake-up from Reset or Sleep mode.
3.15
3.15.1
Reference Clock Output Module
(REFO1 and REFO2)
APPLICATIONS
The PIC18F97J94 family has two Reference Clock
Output modules. Each of the Reference Clock Output
modules provides the user with the ability to send out
a programmed output clock onto the REFO1or REFO2
pins.
3.15.2
REFERENCE CLOCK SOURCE
The module provides the ability to select one of the
following clock sources:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Primary Crystal Oscillator (POSC)
Secondary Crystal Oscillator (SOSC)
32.768 kHz Internal Oscillator (INTOSC)
Fast Internal Oscillator (FRC)
Raw System Clock (sys_clk)
Peripheral Clock (p1_clk)
It includes a programmable clock divider with ratios
ranging from 1:1 to 1:65534.
When the clock source is a crystal or internal oscillator,
the RSLP bit (REFOxCON can be set to continue
REFOx operation while the device is in Sleep Mode.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
3.15.3
CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION
The Reference Clock Output is enabled only once
(ON = 1). Note that the source of the clock and the
divider values should be chosen prior to the bit being
set to avoid glitches on the REFO output.
Once the ON bit is set, its value is synchronized to the
reference clock domain to enable the output. This
ensures that no glitches will be seen on the output. Similarly, when the ON bit is cleared, the output and the
associated output enable signals will be synchronized,
and disabled on the falling edge of the reference clock.
Note that with large divider values, this will cause the
REFO to be enabled for some period after ON is
cleared.
3.15.4
OPERATION IN SLEEP MODE
If any clock source, other than the peripheral clock, is
used as a base reference (i.e., ROSEL 0001),
the user has the option to configure the behavior of the
oscillator in Sleep mode. The RSLP Configuration bit
determines if the oscillator will continue to run in
Sleep. If RSLP = 0, the oscillator will be shut down in
Sleep (assuming no other consumers are requesting
it). If RSLP = 1, the oscillator will continue to run in
Sleep.
3.15.5
MODULE ENABLE SIGNAL
The REFOx module may be enabled or disabled using
the REFOxMD register bit (PMD3, bit 1 or 0). The
module also needs to be turned on using the ON bit
(REFO1CON).
3.15.5.1
Registers and Bits
This module provides the following device registers
and/or bits:
• REFOxCON – Reference Clock Output Control
Register
• REFOxCON1 – Reference Clock Output Control 1
Register
• REFOxCON2 – Reference Clock Output Control 2
Register
• REFOxCON3 – Reference Clock Output Control 3
Register
The Reference Clock Output is synchronized with the
Sleep signal to avoid any glitches on its output.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 67
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.0
POWER-MANAGED MODES
All PIC18F97J94 Family devices offer a number of
built-in strategies for reducing power consumption.
These strategies can be particularly useful in applications, which are both power-constrained (such as
battery operation), yet require periods of full-power
operation for timing-sensitive routines (such as serial
communications).
Aside from their low-power architecture, these devices
include an expanded range of dedicated hardware
features that allow the microcontroller to reduce power
consumption to even lower levels when long-term
hibernation is required, and still be able to resume
operation on short notice.
The device has four power-saving features:
•
•
•
•
Instruction-Based Power-Saving Modes
Hardware-Based Power Reduction Features
Microcontroller Clock Manipulation
Selective Peripheral Control
4.1
Overview of Power-Saving Modes
In addition to full-power operation, otherwise known as
Run mode, PIC18F97J94 Family devices offer three
instruction-based, power-saving modes and one hardware-based mode. In descending order of power
consumption, they are:
•
•
•
•
Idle
Sleep (including retention Sleep)
Deep Sleep (with and without retention)
VBAT (with and without RTCC)
By powering down all four modes, different functional
areas of the microcontroller allow progressive reductions of operating and Idle power consumption. In addition, three of the modes can be tailored for more power
reduction at a trade-off of some operating features.
Table 4-1 lists all of the operating modes (including Run
mode, for comparison) in order of increasing power
savings and summarizes how the microcontroller exits
the different modes.
Combinations of these methods can be used to selectively tailor an application’s power consumption, while
still maintaining critical or timing-sensitive application
features. However, it is more convenient to discuss the
strategies separately.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 69
SUMMARY OF OPERATING MODES FOR PIC18F97J94 FAMILY DEVICES WITH VBAT POWER-SAVING FEATURES
Exit Conditions
Active Systems
INT0 Only
All
POR
MCLR
RTCC Alarm
(DS)WDT(3)
VDD Restore
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
Next Instruction
Instruction
N
N(4)
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
Next Instruction
Instruction +
RETEN bit
N
(4)
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
Retention
Deep Sleep
Instruction +
DSEN bit +
RETEN bit
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
Next Instruction
Deep Sleep
Instruction +
DSEN bit
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N/A
Reset Vector
Reset Vector
Core
Run (default)
Idle
RTCC(1)
Y
N
Entry
Data RAM
Retention
N/A
Instruction
Mode
Peripherals
All
Resets
DSGPRx(2)
Interrupts
Code Execution
Resumes
Sleep modes:
Sleep
Retention
Sleep
N
Deep Sleep modes:
VBAT:
with RTCC
Hardware
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
w/o RTCC
Hardware +
by disabling the
RTCC PMD bit
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
If RTCC is otherwise enabled in firmware.
Data retention in the DSGPR0, DSGPR1, DSGPR2 and DSGPR3 registers.
Deep Sleep WDT in Deep Sleep modes; WDT in all other modes.
Some select peripherals may continue to operate in this mode, using either the LPRC or an external clock source.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
DS30000575C-page 70
TABLE 4-1:
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.2
Instruction-Based Power-Saving
Modes
PIC18F97J94 Family devices have three instructionbased power-saving modes; two of these have additional features that allow for additional tailoring of power
consumption. All three modes are entered through the
execution of the SLEEP instruction. In descending order
of power consumption, they are:
• Idle Mode: The CPU is disabled, but the system
clock source continues to operate. Peripherals
continue to operate, but can optionally be
disabled.
• Sleep Modes: The CPU, system clock source and
any peripherals that operate on the system clock
source are disabled.
• Deep Sleep Modes: The CPU system clock
source, and all the peripherals except RTCC and
DSWDT are disabled. This is the lowest power
mode for the device. The power to RAM and
Flash is also disabled. Deep Sleep modes
represent the lowest power modes available
without removing power from the application.
Idle and Sleep modes are entered directly with the
SLEEP statement. Having IDLEN (OSCCON) set
prior to the SLEEP statement will put the device into Idle
mode. For Deep Sleep mode, it is necessary to set the
DSEN bit (DSCONH). To prevent inadvertent entry
into Deep Sleep mode, and possible loss of data, the
DSEN bit must be written to twice. The write need not
be consecutive instructions; however, it is a better
practice to write both, one after the other. It is also
recommended to clear the DSCON1 register before
setting the DSEN bit (Example 4-1).
Note:
SLEEP_MODE and IDLE_MODE are constants defined in the Assembler Include
file for the selected device.
EXAMPLE 4-1:
clrf
clrf
bsf
bsf
sleep
SLEEP ASSEMBLY
SYNTAX
DSCON1
DSCON1
DSCON1,7
DSCON1,7
or
movlw
movwf
movwf
sleep
0x80
DSCON1
DSCON1
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
The instruction-based power-saving modes are exited
as a result of several different hardware triggers. When
the device exits one of these three operating modes, it
is said to ‘wake-up’. The characteristics of the powersaving modes are described in the subsequent sections.
4.2.1
INTERRUPTS COINCIDENT WITH
POWER SAVE INSTRUCTIONS
Any interrupt that coincides with the execution of a
SLEEP instruction will be held off until entry into Sleep,
Idle or Deep Sleep mode is completed. The device will
then wake-up from the power-managed mode.
Interrupts that occur during the Deep Sleep unlock
sequence will interrupt the mandatory unlock sequence
and cause a failure to enter Deep Sleep. For this
reason, it is recommended to disable all interrupts
during the Deep Sleep unlock sequence.
4.2.2
RETENTION REGULATOR
A second on-chip voltage regulator is used for power
management in Sleep and Deep Sleep modes. This
regulator, also known as the retention regulator, supplies core logic and other circuits with power at a lower
VCORE level, about 1.2V nominal. Running these
circuits at a lower voltage allows for an additional
incremental power saving over the normal minimum
VCORE level.
In Retention Sleep modes, using the regulator maintains the entire data RAM and its contents, instead of
just a few protected registers. This allows the device to
exit a power-saving mode and resume code execution
as its previous state.
The retention regulator is controlled by the Configuration
bit, RETEN (CONFIG7L), and the SRETEN bit
(RCON4). The RETEN bit makes the retention
regulator available for software control. By default
(RETEN = 1), the regulator is disabled and the SRETEN
bit has no effect. Programming RETEN (= 0) allows the
SRETEN bit to control the regulator’s operation, leaving
its use in power-saving modes at the user’s discretion.
Setting the SRETEN bit prior to executing the SLEEP
instruction puts the device into Retention Sleep mode.
If the DSEN bit was also unlocked and set prior to the
instruction, the device will enter Retention Deep Sleep
mode.
The retention regulator is not available outside of
Sleep, Deep Sleep or VBAT modes. Enabling it while
the device is operating in Run or Idle modes does not
allow the device to operate at a lower level of VCORE.
DS30000575C-page 71
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.2.3
IDLE MODE
When the device enters Idle mode, the following events
occur:
• The CPU will stop executing instructions.
• The WDT is automatically cleared.
• The system clock source will remain active and
the peripheral modules, by default, will continue to
operate normally from the system clock source.
Peripherals can optionally be shut down in Idle
mode using their ‘Stop in Idle’ control bit. (See
peripheral descriptions for further details.)
• If the WDT or FSCM is enabled, the LPRC will
also remain active.
The processor will wake-up from Idle mode on the
following events:
• On any interrupt that is individually enabled.
• On any source of device Reset.
• On a WDT time-out.
Upon wake-up from Idle mode, the clock is reapplied to
the CPU and instruction execution begins immediately,
starting with the instruction following the SLEEP instruction, or the first instruction in the Interrupt Service
Routine (ISR).
4.2.3.1
Time Delays on Wake-up from Idle
Mode
Unlike a wake-up from Sleep mode, there are no additional time delays associated with wake-up from Idle
mode. The system clock is running during Idle mode,
therefore, no start-up times are required at wake-up.
4.2.3.2
Wake-up from Idle on Interrupt
Any source of interrupt that is individually enabled
using the corresponding control bit in the PIEx register,
will be able to wake-up the processor from Idle mode.
When the device wakes from Idle mode, one of two
options may occur:
• If the GIE bit is set, the processor will wake and
the Program Counter will begin execution at the
interrupt vector.
• If the GIE bit is not set, the processor will wake
and the Program Counter will continue execution
following the SLEEP instruction.
The PD Status bit (RCON) is set upon wake-up.
DS30000575C-page 72
4.2.3.3
Wake-up from Idle on Reset
Any Reset, other than a Power-on Reset (POR), will
wake-up the CPU from Idle mode on any device Reset,
except a POR.
4.2.3.4
Wake-up from Idle on WDT Time-out
If the WDT is enabled, then the processor will wake-up
from Idle mode on a WDT time-out and continue code
execution with the instruction following the SLEEP
instruction that initiated Idle mode. Note that the WDT
time-out does not reset the device in this case. The TO
bit (RCON) will be set.
4.2.4
SLEEP MODES
Most 08KA101 family devices that incorporate powersaving features and VBAT, offer two distinct Sleep
modes: Sleep mode and Retention Sleep mode. The
characteristics of both Sleep modes are:
• The system clock source is shut down. If an onchip oscillator is used, it is turned off.
• The device current consumption will be optimum,
provided no I/O pin is sourcing the current.
• The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) does not
operate during Sleep mode since the system
clock source is disabled.
• The LPRC clock will continue to run in Sleep
mode if the WDT is enabled.
• If Brown-out Reset (BOR) is enabled, the Brownout Reset (BOR) circuit remains operational
during Sleep mode.
• The WDT, if enabled, is automatically cleared
prior to entering Sleep mode.
• Some peripherals may continue to operate in
Sleep mode. These peripherals include I/O pins
that detect a change in the input signal or
peripherals that use an external clock input. Any
peripheral that operates from the system clock
source will be disabled in Sleep mode.
The processor will exit, or ‘wake-up’ from Sleep on one
of the following events:
• On any interrupt source that is individually
enabled
• On any form of device Reset
• On a WDT time-out
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.2.4.1
Retention Sleep Mode
Retention Sleep mode allows for additional power savings over Sleep mode by maintaining key systems from
the lower power retention regulator. When the retention
regulator is used, the normal on-chip voltage regulator
(operating at 1.8V nominal) is turned off and will enable
a low-power (1.2V typical) regulator. By using a lower
voltage, a lower total power consumption is achieved.
Retention Sleep also offers the advantage of maintaining the contents of the data RAM. As a trade-off, the
wake-up time is longer than that for Sleep mode.
4.3.4
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP ON
WATCHDOG TIME-OUT
If the Watchdog Timer (WDT) is enabled and expires
while the device is in Sleep mode, the processor will
wake-up. The SWDTEN Status bit (RCON2) is set
to indicate that the device resumed operation due to
the WDT expiration. Note that this event does not reset
the device. Operation continues from the instruction following the SLEEP instruction that initiated Sleep mode.
4.3.5
CONTROL BIT SUMMARY FOR
SLEEP MODES
Retention Sleep mode is controlled by the SRETEN bit
(RCON4) and the RETEN Configuration bit, as
described in Section 4.2.2, Retention Regulator.
Table 4-2 shows the settings for the bits relevant to
Sleep modes.
4.3
TABLE 4-2:
Clock Source Considerations
When the device wakes up from either of the Sleep
modes, it will restart the same clock source that was
active when Sleep mode was entered. Wake-up delays
for the different oscillator modes are shown in Table 43 and Table 4-4, respectively.
If the system clock source is derived from a crystal oscillator and/or the PLL, the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
and/or PLL lock times must be applied before the system
clock source is made available to the device. As an
exception to this rule, no oscillator delays are necessary
if the system clock source is the Secondary Oscillator
and it was running while in Sleep mode.
4.3.1
SLOW OSCILLATOR START-UP
The OST and PLL lock times may not have expired
when the power-up delays have expired.
Mode
Sleep
Retention
Sleep
4.3.6
BIT SETTINGS FOR ALL
SLEEP MODES
DSEN
DSCONH
Retention Regulator
SRETEN
RETEN
CONFIG7L RCON4
State
x
1
x
Disabled
x
0
0
Disabled
x
0
1
Enabled
WAKE-UP DELAYS
The restart delay, associated with waking up from
Sleep and Retention Sleep modes, parallel each other
in terms of clock start-up times. They differ in the time
it takes to switch over from their respective regulators.
The delays for the different oscillator modes are shown
in Table 4-3 and Table 4-4, respectively.
To avoid this condition, one can enable Two-Speed
Start-up by the device that will run on FRC until the
clock source is stable. Once the clock source is stable,
the device will switch to the selected clock source.
4.3.2
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP ON
INTERRUPT
Any source of interrupt that is individually enabled, using
its corresponding control bit in the PIEx registers, can
wake-up the processor from Sleep mode. When the
device wakes from Sleep mode, one of two following
actions may occur:
• If the GIE bit is set, the processor will wake and
the Program Counter will begin execution at the
interrupt vector.
• If the GIE bit is not set, the processor will wake
and the Program Counter will continue execution
following the SLEEP instruction that initiated Sleep
mode.
4.3.3
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP ON RESET
All sources of device Reset will wake-up the processor
from Sleep mode.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 73
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 4-3:
DELAY TIMES FOR EXITING FROM SLEEP MODE
Clock Source
Exit Delay
Oscillator Delay
Notes
EC
TPM
—
ECPLL
TPM
TLOCK
1, 3
1, 2
1
MS, HS
TPM
TOST
MSPLL, HSPLL
TPM
TOST + TLOCK
SOSC
(Off during Sleep)
TPM
TOST
(On during Sleep)
TPM
—
TPM
TFRC
1, 4
(Off during Sleep)
TPM
TLPRC
1, 4
(On during Sleep)
TPM
—
TPM
TLOCK
FRC, FRCDIV
LPRC
FRCPLL
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1
1
1, 3
TPM = Start-up delay for program memory stabilization.
TOST = Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST); a delay of 1024 oscillator periods before the oscillator clock is
released to the system.
TLOCK = PLL lock time.
TFRC and TLPRC are RC Oscillator start-up times.
TABLE 4-4:
DELAY TIMES FOR EXITING FROM RETENTION SLEEP MODE
Clock Source
Exit Delay
Oscillator Delay
EC
TRETR + TPM
—
ECPLL
TRETR + TPM
TLOCK
1, 2, 4
MS, HS
TRETR + TPM
TOST
1, 2, 3
MSPLL, HSPLL
TRETR + TPM
TOST + TLOCK
SOSC
(Off during Sleep)
TRETR + TPM
TOST
(On during Sleep)
TRETR
FRC, FRCDIV
LPRC
4:
5:
—
1, 2
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2, 3
1, 2
TRETR + TPM
TFRC
1, 2, 5
(Off during Sleep)
TRETR + TPM
TLPRC
1, 2, 5
(On during Sleep)
TRETR + TPM
—
TRETR + TPM
TLOCK
FRCPLL
Note 1:
2:
3:
+ TPM
Notes
1, 2
1, 2, 4
TRETR = Retention regulator start-up delay.
TPM = Start-up delay for program memory stabilization; applicable only when IPEN (RCON) = 0.
TOST = Oscillator Start-up Timer; a delay of 1024 oscillator periods before the oscillator clock is released to
the system.
TLOCK = PLL lock time.
TFRC and TLPRC are RC Oscillator start-up times.
DS30000575C-page 74
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.4
Deep Sleep Modes
The Deep Sleep modes puts the device into its lowest
power consumption states without requiring the use of
external switches to remove power from the device.
There are two modes available: Deep Sleep mode and
Retention Deep Sleep mode.
During both Deep Sleep modes, the power to the
microcontroller core is removed to reduce leakage
current. Therefore, most peripherals and functions of
the microcontroller become unavailable during Deep
Sleep. However, a few specific peripherals and functions are powered directly from the VDD supply rail of
the microcontroller, and therefore, can continue to
function in Deep Sleep. In addition, four data memory
locations, DSGPR0, DSGPR1, DSGPR2 and
DSGPR3, are preserved for context information after
an exit from Deep Sleep.
Deep Sleep has a dedicated Deep Sleep Brown-out
Reset (DSBOR) and a Deep Sleep Watchdog Timer
Reset (DSWDT) for monitoring voltage and time-out
events in Deep Sleep mode. The DSBOR and DSWDT
are independent of the standard BOR and WDT used
with other power-managed modes (Run, Idle and
Sleep).
Entering Deep Sleep mode clears the Deep Sleep
Wake-up Source Registers (DSWAKEL and
DSWAKEH). If enabled, the Real-Time Clock and
Calendar (RTCC) continues to operate uninterrupted.
When a wake-up event occurs in Deep Sleep mode (by
Reset, RTCC alarm, External Interrupt (INT0) or
DSWDT), the device will exit Deep Sleep mode and rearm a Power-on Reset (POR). When the device is
released from Reset, code execution will resume at the
Reset vector.
4.4.1
RETENTION DEEP SLEEP MODE
In Retention Deep Sleep, the retention regulator is
enabled, which allows the data RAM to retain data
while all other systems are powered down. This also
allows the device to return to code execution where it
left off, instead of going through a POR-like Reset.
As a trade-off, Retention Deep Sleep mode has greater
power consumption than Deep Sleep. However, it
offers the lowest level of power consumption of the
power-saving modes that still allows a direct return to
code execution.
Retention Deep Sleep is controlled by the SRETEN bit
(RCON4) and the RETEN Configuration bit, as
described in Section 4.2.2 “Retention Regulator”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
4.4.2
ENTERING DEEP SLEEP MODES
Deep Sleep modes are entered by:
• Setting the DSEN bit (DSCONH)
• Executing the SLEEP instruction
To enter Retention Deep Sleep, the SRETEN bit must
also be set prior to setting the DSEN bit (Example 4-1).
In order to minimize the possibility of inadvertently
entering Deep Sleep, the DSEN bit must be set by two
separate write operations. To enter Deep Sleep, the
SLEEP instruction must be executed after setting the
DSEN bit (i.e., the next instruction). If DSEN is not set
when Sleep is executed, the device will enter a Sleep
mode instead.
4.4.3
DEEP SLEEP WAKE-UP SOURCES
The device can be awakened from Deep Sleep modes
by any of the following:
•
•
•
•
•
MCLR
POR
RTCC Alarm
INT0 Interrupt
DSWDT Event
After waking from Deep Sleep mode, the device performs a POR. When the device is released from Reset,
code execution will begin at the device’s Reset vector.
The software can determine if the wake-up was caused
from an exit from Deep Sleep mode by reading the
DPSLP bit (RCON4). If this bit is set, the POR was
caused by a Deep Sleep exit. The DPSLP bit must be
manually cleared by the software.
The software can determine the wake-up event source
by reading the DSWAKE registers. These registers are
cleared automatically when entering Deep Sleep
mode, so software should read these registers after
exiting Deep Sleep mode or before re-enabling this
mode.
4.4.4
CLOCK SELECTION ON WAKE-UP
FROM DEEP SLEEP MODE
For Deep Sleep mode, the processor will restart with
the default oscillator source, selected with the FOSCx
Configuration bits. On wake-up from Deep Sleep, a
POR is generated internally, hence, the system resets
to its POR state with the exception of the RCONx,
DSCONH/L and DSGPRx registers.
For Retention Deep Sleep, the processor restarts with
the same clock source that was selected before entering Retention Deep Sleep mode. Wake-up is similar to
that of Sleep and Retention Sleep modes.
DS30000575C-page 75
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.4.5
SAVING CONTEXT DATA WITH THE
DSGPRx REGISTERS
As exiting Deep Sleep mode causes a POR, most
Special Function Registers (SFRs) reset to their default
POR values. In addition, because the core power is not
supplied in Deep Sleep mode, information in data RAM
may be lost when exiting this mode. Applications which
require critical data to be saved prior to Deep Sleep may
use the Deep Sleep General Purpose registers,
DSGPR0, DSGPR1, DSGPR2 and DSGPR3. Unlike
other SFRs, the contents of these registers are preserved while the device is in Deep Sleep mode. After
exiting Deep Sleep, software can restore the data by
reading the registers and clearing the RELEASE bit
(DSCONL).
Any data stored in the DSGPRx registers must be written twice. Like other Deep Sleep control features, the
write operations do not need to be sequential. However,
back-to-back writes are a recommended programming
practice.
Since the contents of data RAM are maintained in
Retention Deep Sleep, the use of the DSGPRx registers
to store critical data is not necessary in this mode.
4.4.6
I/O PINS DURING DEEP SLEEP
During Deep Sleep, general purpose I/O pins retain
their previous states. Pins that are configured as inputs
(TRIS bit is set), prior to entry into Deep Sleep, remain
high-impedance during Deep Sleep.
Pins that are configured as outputs (TRIS bit is clear),
prior to entry into Deep Sleep, will remain as output pins
during Deep Sleep. While in this mode, they will drive the
output level determined by their corresponding LAT bit at
the time of entry into Deep Sleep.
Once the device wakes back up, all I/O pins will continue
to maintain their previous states, even after the device
has finished the POR sequence and is executing application code again. Pins configured as inputs during Deep
Sleep will remain high-impedance and pins configured as
outputs will continue to drive their previous value. After
waking up, the TRIS and LAT registers will be reset. If
firmware modifies the TRIS and LAT values for the I/O
pins, they will not immediately go to the newly configured
states. Once the firmware clears the RELEASE bit
(DSCONL), the I/O pins are “released”. This
causes the I/O pins to take the states configured by
their respective TRIS and LAT bit values.
If the Deep Sleep BOR (DSBOR) is enabled, and a
DSBOR event occurs during Deep Sleep (or VDD is
hard-cycled to VSS), the I/O pins will be immediately
released, similar to clearing the RELEASE bit. All
previous state information will be lost, including the
general purpose DSGPR0, DSGPR1, DSGPR2 and
DSGPR3 contents. DSGPRx register contents will be
maintained if the VBAT pin is powered.
DS30000575C-page 76
If a MCLR Reset event occurs during Deep Sleep, the
I/O pins will also be released automatically, but in this
case, the DSGPR0, DSGPR1, DSGPR2 and DSGPR3
contents will remain valid.
In case of MCLR Reset and all other Deep Sleep wakeup cases, application firmware needs to clear the
RELEASE bit (DSCONL) in order to reconfigure the I/
O pins.
4.4.7
DEEP SLEEP WATCHDOG TIMER
(DSWDT)
Deep Sleep has its dedicated WDT (DSWDT). It is
enabled through the DSWDTEN Configuration bit. The
DSWDT is equipped with a postscaler for time-outs of
2.1 ms to 25.7 days, configurable through the Configuration bits, DSWDTPS. Entering Deep Sleep mode
automatically clears the DSWDT.
The DSWDT also has a configurable reference clock
source for selecting the LPRC or SOSC. The reference
clock source is configured through the DSWDTOSC
Configuration bit.
Under certain circumstances, it is possible for the DSWDT
clock source to be off when entering Deep Sleep mode. In
this case, the clock source is turned on automatically (if
DSWDT is enabled), without the need for software intervention. However, this can cause a delay in the start of the
DSWDT counters. In order to avoid this delay, when using
SOSC as a clock source, the application can activate
SOSC prior to entering Deep Sleep mode.
4.4.8
DEEP SLEEP LOW-POWER
BROWN-OUT RESET
Devices with a Deep Sleep Power-Saving mode also
have a dedicated BOR for Deep Sleep modes (DSBOR).
It has a trip point range of 1.7V-2.3V nominal and is
enabled through the DSBOREN (CONFIG7L)
Configuration bit.
When the device enters a Deep Sleep mode and
receives a DSBOR event, the device will not wake-up
and will remain in the Deep Sleep mode. When a valid
wake-up event occurs and causes the device to exit
Deep Sleep mode, software can determine if a DSBOR
event occurred during Deep Sleep mode by reading the
BOR (DSWAKEL) Status bit.
4.4.9
RTCC AND DEEP SLEEP
The RTCC can operate uninterrupted during Deep
Sleep modes. It can wake-up the device from Deep
Sleep by configuring an alarm. The RTCC clock source
is configured with the RTCC Clock Select bits,
RTCCLKSEL. The available reference clock
sources are the LPRC and SOSC. If the LPRC is used,
the RTCC accuracy will directly depend on the LPRC
tolerance.
If the RTCC is not required, Deep Sleep mode with the
RTCC disabled, affords the lowest power consumption
of any of the instruction-based power-saving modes.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.4.10
CONTROL BIT SUMMARY FOR
SLEEP MODES
Table 4-5 shows the settings for the bits relevant to
Deep Sleep modes.
TABLE 4-5:
BIT SETTINGS FOR ALL DEEP SLEEP MODES
Instruction-Based
Mode
DSEN
(DSCONH)
Retention Deep Sleep
Deep Sleep
4.4.11
Retention Regulator
RETEN
(CONFIG7L)
SRETEN
(RCON4)
State
DSWDTEN
(CONFIG8H)
1
0
1
Enabled
0
1
1
x
Disabled
x
WAKE-UP DELAYS
Note:
The Reset delays associated with wake-up from Deep
Sleep and Retention Deep Sleep modes, in different
oscillator modes, are provided in Table 4-6 and
Table 4-7, respectively.
TABLE 4-6:
The PMSLP bit (RCON4) allows the
voltage regulator to be maintained during
Sleep modes.
DELAY TIMES FOR EXITING FROM DEEP SLEEP MODE
Clock Source
Exit Delay
Oscillator Delay
Notes
EC
TDSWU
—
ECPLL
TDSWU
TLOCK
1, 3
1, 2
MS, HS
TDSWU
TOST
MSPLL, HSPLL
TDSWU
TOST + TLOCK
SOSC
(Off during Sleep)
TDSWU
TOST
(On during Sleep)
TDSWU
—
TDSWU
TFRC
1, 4
(Off during Sleep)
TDSWU
TLPRC
1, 4
(On during Sleep)
TDSWU
—
TDSWU
TFRC + TLOCK
FRC, FRCDIV
LPRC
FRCPLL
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1
1
1, 3, 4
TDSWU = Deep Sleep wake-up delay.
TOST = Oscillator Start-up Timer; a delay of 1024 oscillator periods before the oscillator clock is released to
the system.
TLOCK = PLL lock time.
TFRC and TLPRC are RC Oscillator start-up times.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 77
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 4-7:
DELAY TIMES FOR EXITING RETENTION DEEP SLEEP MODE
Clock Source
Exit Delay
Oscillator Delay
EC
TRETR + TPM
—
ECPLL
TRETR + TPM
TLOCK
1, 2, 4, 6
MS, HS
TRETR + TPM
TOST
1, 2, 3, 6
MSPLL, HSPLL
TRETR + TPM
TOST + TLOCK
Off during Sleep
TRETR + TPM
TOST
On during Sleep
TRETR + TPM
—
SOSC
4:
5:
6:
1, 2, 3, 4, 6
1, 2, 3, 6
1, 2, 6
TFRC
1, 2, 5, 6
Off during Sleep
TRETR + TPM
TLPRC
1, 2, 5, 6
On during Sleep
TRETR + TPM
—
TRETR + TPM
TLOCK
TRETR
FRCPLL
Note 1:
2:
3:
1, 2, 6
+ TPM
FRC, FRCDIV
LPRC:
Notes
1, 2, 6
1, 2, 3, 6
TPM = Start-up delay for program memory stabilization; applicable only when IPEN (RCON) = 0.
TRETR = Retention regulator start-up delay.
TOST = Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST); a delay of 1024 oscillator periods before the oscillator clock is
released to the system.
TLOCK = PLL lock time.
TFRC and TLPRC = RC Oscillator start-up times.
TFLASH = Flash program memory ready delay. Setting the PMSLP bit will provide a faster wake-up.
DS30000575C-page 78
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.5
VBAT Mode
Entering VBAT mode requires that a power source, distinct from the main VDD power source, be available on
VBAT and that VDD be completely removed from the
VDD pin(s). Removing VDD can be either unintentional,
as in a power failure, or as part of a deliberate power
reduction strategy.
VBAT mode is a hardware-based power mode that
maintains only the most critical operations when a
power loss occurs on VDD. The mode does this by
powering these systems from a back-up power source
connected to the VBAT pin. In this mode, the RTCC can
run even when there is no power on VDD.
As with Deep Sleep modes, the contents of the Deep
Sleep General Purpose (DSGPRx) registers are maintained by the retention regulator. Since the power loss
on VDD may be unforeseen, it is recommended to load
any data to be saved in these registers in advance.
VBAT mode is entered whenever power is removed
from VDD. An on-chip power switch detects the power
loss from the VDD and connects the VBAT pin to the
retention regulator. This provides power at 1.2V to
maintain the retention regulator, as well as the RTCC,
with its clock source (if enabled) and the Deep Sleep
General Purpose (DSGPRx) registers (Figure 4-1).
FIGURE 4-1:
Any data stored in the DSGPRx registers must be written
twice. The write operations do not need to be sequential;
however, back-to-back writes are a recommended
programming practice.
VBAT POWER TOPOLOGY
PIC18F97J94 Family Microcontroller
Core
VBAT
Back-up
Battery
VDD
Power
Switch
Retention
Regulator
1.2V
DSGPRx
Registers
Peripherals
VSS
RTCC
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 79
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.5.1
WAKE-UP FROM VBAT MODES
When VDD is restored to a device in VBAT mode, it automatically wakes. Wake-up occurs with a POR, after
which the device starts executing code from the Reset
vector. All SFRs, except the Deep Sleep semaphores
and RTCC registers are reset to their POR values. If
the RTCC was not configured to run during VBAT mode,
it will remain disabled and RTCC will not run. Wake-up
timing is similar to that for a normal POR.
Wake-up from VBAT mode is identified by checking the
state of the VBAT bit (RCON3). If this bit is set when
the device is awake and starting to execute the code
from the Reset vector, it indicates that the exit was from
VBAT mode. To identify future VBAT wake-up events,
the bit must be cleared in software.
When a POR event occurs with no battery connected
to the VBAT pin, the VBPOR bit (RCON3) becomes
set. On the device, if there is no battery connected to
the VBAT pin, VBPOR will indicate that the battery needs
to be connected to the VBAT pin.
In addition, if the VBAT power source falls below the
level needed for Deep Sleep semaphore operation
while in VBAT mode (e.g., the battery has been
drained), the VBPOR bit will be set. VBPOR is also set
when the microcontroller is powered up the very first
time, even if power is supplied to VBAT.
DS30000575C-page 80
4.6
Saving Context Data with the
DSGPRx Registers
As exiting VBAT causes a POR, most Special Function
Registers reset to their default POR values. In addition,
because the core power is not supplied in VBAT mode,
information in data RAM will be lost when exiting this
mode. Applications which require critical data to be
saved, should be saved in DSGPR0, DSGPR1,
DSGPR2 and DSGPR3.
Any data stored to the DSGPRx registers must be
written twice. The write operations do not need to be
sequential. However, back-to-back writes are a
recommended programming practice.
After exiting VBAT mode, software can restore the data
by reading the registers.
4.6.1
I/O PINS DURING VBAT MODE
All I/O pins should be maintained at VSS level; no I/O
pins should be given VDD (refer to “Absolute
Maximum Ratings(†)” in Section 30.0 “Electrical
Specifications”) during VBAT mode. The only
exceptions are the SOSCI and SOSCO pins, which
maintain their states if the Secondary Oscillator is
being used as the RTCC clock source. It is the user’s
responsibility to restore the I/O pins to their proper
states, using the TRIS and LAT bits, once VDD has
been restored.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-1:
DSCONL: DEEP SLEEP CONTROL REGISTER LOW
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R-0
R/W-0, HSC
R/W-0, HS
—
—
—
—
—
r
DSBOR(1)
RELEASE(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
r = Reserved bit
HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
HS = Hardware Settable bit
bit 7-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
Reserved: Maintained as ‘0’
bit 1
DSBOR: Deep Sleep BOR Event Status bit(1)
1 = DSBOR was enabled and VDD dropped below the DSBOR threshold during Deep Sleep(2)
0 = DSBOR disabled while device is in Deep Sleep mode
bit 0
RELEASE: I/O Pin State Release bit(1)
Upon waking from Deep Sleep, the I/O pins maintain their previous states. Clearing this bit will release
the I/O pins and allow their respective TRIS and LAT bits to control their states.
Note 1:
2:
This is the value when VDD is initially applied.
Unlike all other events, a Deep Sleep BOR event will not cause a wake-up from Deep Sleep; this bit is
present only as a Status bit.
REGISTER 4-2:
DSCONH: DEEP SLEEP CONTROL REGISTER HIGH
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0, HS(2)
DSEN(1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
RTCCWDIS
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
HS = Hardware Settable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
DSEN: Deep Sleep Mode Enable bit(1)
1 = Deep Sleep mode is enabled and device will enter Deep Sleep mode when the SLEEP instruction
is executed
0 = Deep Sleep mode is not enabled
bit 6-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
RTCCWDIS: RTCC Wake-up Disable bit(2)
1 = Wake-up from RTCC is disabled
0 = Wake-up from RTCC is enabled
Note 1:
2:
In order to enter Deep Sleep, DSEN must be written to in two separate operations. The write operations
do not need to be consecutive. Before writing DSEN, the DSCON1 register should be cleared twice.
This is the value when VDD is initially applied.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 81
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
DSWAKEL: DEEP SLEEP WAKE-UP SOURCE REGISTER LOW(1)
REGISTER 4-3:
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
DSFLT
BOR
EXT
DSWDT
DSRTC
MCLR
ICD
DSPOR
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
DSFLT: Deep Sleep Fault Detect bit
1 = A Deep Sleep Fault was detected during Deep Sleep
0 = A Deep Sleep Fault was not detected during Deep Sleep
bit 6
BOR: BOR Deep-Sleep Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = DSBOR event will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = DSBOR event will not wake device from Deep Sleep
bit 5
EXT: External Interrupt Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = External interrupt will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = External interrupt will not wake device from Deep Sleep
bit 4
DSWDT: DSWDT Deep-Sleep Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = DSWDT roll-over event will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = DSWDT roll-over event will not wake device from Deep Sleep
bit 3
DSRTC: Real-Time Clock and Calendar Alarm bit
1 = The Real-Time Clock/Calendar triggered an alarm during Deep Sleep
0 = The Real-Time Clock /Calendar did not trigger an alarm during Deep Sleep
bit 2
MCLR: MCLR Deep-Sleep Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = The MCLR Reset will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = The MCLR Reset will not wake device from Deep Sleep
bit 1
ICD: In-Circuit Debugger Deep-Sleep Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = In-Circuit Debugger will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = In-Circuit Debugger will not wake device from Deep Sleep
bit 0
DSPOR: Power-on Reset Event bit
1 = The VDD supply POR circuit was active and a POR event was detected
0 = The VDD supply POR circuit was not active, or was active but did not detect a POR event
Note 1:
To be set in software, all bits in DSWAKE must be written to twice. The write operations do not need to be
consecutive.
REGISTER 4-4:
DSWAKEH: DEEP SLEEP WAKE-UP SOURCE REGISTER HIGH
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
INT0: Deep Sleep Wake-up Source Enable bit
1 = INT0 interrupt will wake device from Deep Sleep
0 = INT0 interrupt will not wake device from Deep Sleep
DS30000575C-page 82
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
4.7
Selective Peripheral Power
Control
Sleep and Idle modes allow users to substantially reduce
power consumption by slowing or stopping the CPU
clock. Even so, peripheral modules still remain clocked,
and thus, consume some amount of power. There may
be cases where the application needs what these modes
do not provide: the ability to allocate limited power
resources to the CPU while eliminating power consumption from the peripherals. The 08KA101 family addresses
this requirement by allowing peripheral modules to be
selectively enabled or disabled, reducing or eliminating
their power consumption.
4.7.1
DISABLING PERIPHERAL
MODULES
Most of the peripheral modules in the 08KA101 family
architecture can be selectively disabled, reducing, or
essentially eliminating, their power consumption during
all operating modes. Two different options are available
to users, each with a slightly different effect.
4.7.2
MODULE ENABLE BIT (XXXEN)
Many peripheral modules have a Module Enable bit,
generically named, “XXXEN”, usually located in Bit
Position 7 of their control registers (or Primary Control
registers for more complex modules). Here, “XXX”
represents the mnemonic form for the module of the
module name. For example, the enable bit for an
MSSPx module is “SSPEN”, and so on. The bit is provided for all serial and parallel communication modules
and the Real-Time Clock (RTC). Clearing this bit
disables the module’s operation; however, it continues
to receive clock signals and draw a minimal amount of
current.
Disabling modules not required for a particular application, in this manner, allows for the selective and
dynamic adjusting power consumption, under software
control, as the application is running.
4.7.3
PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE
BIT (XXMD)
All peripheral modules (except for I/O ports) also have
a second control bit that can disable their functionality.
These bits, known as the Peripheral Module Disable
(PMD) bits, are generically named, “XXMD” (using “XX”
as the mnemonic version of the module’s name), as
shown in Section 4.7.2 “Module Enable Bit
(XXXEN)”). These bits are located in the PMDx SFRs.
In contrast to the module enable bits, the XXMD bit
must be set (= 1) to disable the module.
While the PMD and module enable bits both disable a
peripheral’s functionality, the PMD bit completely shuts
down the peripheral, effectively powering down all
circuits and removing all clock sources. This has the
additional effect of making any of the module’s control
and buffer registers, mapped in the SFR space,
unavailable for operations. In other words, when the
PMD bit is used to disable a module, the peripheral
ceases to exist until the PMD bit is cleared. This differs
from using the module enable bit, which allows the
peripheral to be reconfigured and buffer registers
preloaded, even when the peripheral’s operations are
disabled.
The PMD bit is most useful in highly power-sensitive
applications, where even tiny savings in power
consumption can determine the ability of an application
to function. In these cases, the bits can be set before
the main body of the application to remove those
peripherals that will not be needed at all.
As with all earlier PIC® MCU devices, timers continue to
be under selective operation and are controlled by their
own TON bit, also located in Position 7. The A/D Converter also has a legacy enable bit, ADON, that has the
same function as the XXXEN bits. I/O ports and features
associated with them, such as input change notification
and input capture, do not have their own module enable
bits, since their operation is secondary to other modules.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 83
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-5:
PMD0: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE REGISTER 0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCP10MD
CCP9MD
CCP8MD
CCP7MD
CCP6MD
CCP5MD
CCP4MD
ECCP3MD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CCP10MD: CCP10 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP10 module is disabled. All CCP10 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP10 module is enable
bit 6
CCP9MD: CCP9 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP9 module is disabled. All CCP9 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP9 module is enabled
bit 5
CCP8MD: CCP8 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP8 module is disabled. All CCP8 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP8 module is enabled
bit 4
CCP7MD: CCP7 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP7 module is disabled. All CCP7 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP7 module is enabled
bit 3
CCP6MD: CCP6 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP6 module is disabled. All CCP6 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP6 module is enabled
bit 2
CCP5MD: CCP5 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP5 module is disabled. All CCP5 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP5 module is enabled
bit 1
CCP4MD: CCP4 Module Disable bit
1 = The CCP4 module is disabled. All CCP4 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The CCP4 module is enabled
bit 0
ECCP3MD: ECCP3 Module Disable bit
1 = The ECCP3 module is disabled. All ECCP3 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The ECCP3 module is enabled
DS30000575C-page 84
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-6:
PMD1: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ECCP2MD
ECCP1MD
UART4MD
UART3MD
UART2MD
UART1MD
SSP2MD
SSP1MD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ECCP2MD: ECCP2 Module Disable bit
1 = The ECCP2 module is disabled. All ECCP2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The ECCP2 module is enabled
bit 6
ECCP1MD: ECCP1 Module Disable bit
1 = The ECCP1 module is disabled. All ECCP1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The ECCP1 module is enabled
bit 5
UART4MD: USART4 Module Disable bit
1 = The USART4 module is disabled. All USART4 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The USART4 module is enabled
bit 4
UART3MD: USART3 Module Disable bit
1 = The USART3 module is disabled. All USART3 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The USART3 module is enabled
bit 3
UART2MD: USART2 Module Disable bit
1 = The USART2 module is disabled. All USART2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The USART2 module is enabled
bit 2
UART1MD: USART1 Module Disable bit
1 = The USART1 module is disabled. All USART1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The USART1 module is enabled
bit 1
SSP2MD: SSP2 Module Disable bit
1 = The SSP2 module is disabled. All SSP2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The SSP2 module is enabled
bit 0
SSP1MD: SSP1 Module Disable bit
1 = The SSP1 module is disabled. All SSP1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The SSP1 module is enabled
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 85
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-7:
PMD2: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR8MD
TMR6MD
TMR5MD
TMR4MD
TMR3MD
TMR2MD
TMR1MD
TMR0MD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
TMR8MD: Timer8 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer8 module is disabled. All Timer8 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer8 module is enabled
bit 6
TMR6MD: Timer6 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer6 module is disabled. All Timer6 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer6 module is enabled
bit 5
TMR5MD: Timer5 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer5 module is disabled. All Timer5 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer5 module is enabled
bit 4
TMR4MD: Timer4 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer4 module is disabled. All Timer4 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer4 module is enabled
bit 3
TMR3MD: Timer3 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer3 module is disabled. All Timer3 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer3 module is enabled
bit 2
TMR2MD: Timer2 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer2 module is disabled. All Timer2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer2 module is enabled
bit 1
TMR1MD: Timer1 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer1 module is disabled. All Timer1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer1 module is enabled
bit 0
TMR0MD: Timer0 Module Disable bit
1 = The Timer0 module is disabled. All Timer0 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The Timer0 module is enabled
DS30000575C-page 86
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-8:
PMD3: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE REGISTER 3
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
DSMMD
CTMUMD
ADCMD
RTCCMD
LCDMD
PSPMD
REFO1MD
REFO2MD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
x = Bit is unknown
DSMMD: Modulator Output Module Disable bit
1 = The Modulator Output module is disabled. All Modulator Output registers are held in Reset and
are not writable.
0 = The Modulator Output module is enabled
bit 6
CTMUMD: CTMU Module Disable bit
1 =The CTMU module is disabled. All CTMU registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 =The CTMU module is enabled
bit 5
ADCMD: ADC Module Disable bit
1 =The ADC module is disabled. All ADC registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 =The ADC module is enabled
bit 4
RTCCMD: RTCC Module Disable bit
1 = The RTCC module is disabled. All RTCC registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The RTCC module is enabled
bit 3
LCDMD: LCD Module Disable bit
1 = The LCD module is disabled. All LCD registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The LCD module is enabled
bit 2
PSPMD: PSP Module Disable bit
1 = The PSP module is disabled. All PSP registers are held in Reset and not are writable.
0 = The PSP module is enabled
bit 1
REFO1MD: REFO1 Module Disable bit
1 = The REFO1 module is disabled. All REFO1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The REFO1 module is enabled
bit 0
REFO2MD: REFO2 Module Disable bit
1 = The REFO2 module is disabled. All REFO2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable.
0 = The REFO2 module is enabled
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 87
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 4-9:
PMD4: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE REGISTER 4
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
CMP1MD
CMP2MD
CMP3MD
USBMD
IOCMD
LVDMD
—
EMBMD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CMP1MD: CMP1 Module Disable bit
1 = The CMP1 module is disabled; all CMP1 registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The CMP1 module is enabled
bit 6
CMP2MD: CMP2 Module Disable bit
1 = The CMP2 module is disabled; all CMP2 registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The CMP2 module is enabled
bit 5
CMP3MD: CMP3 Module Disable bit
1 = The CMP3 module is disabled; all CMP3 registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The CMP3 module is enabled
bit 4
USBMD: USB Module Disable bit
1 = The USB module is disabled; all USB registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The USB module is enabled
bit 3
IOCMD: Interrupt-on-Change Module Disable bit
1 = The IOC module is disabled; all IOC registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The IOC module is enabled
bit 2
LVDMD: Low Voltage Detect Module Disable bit
1 = The LVD module is disabled; all LVD registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The LVD module is enabled
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
EMBMD: EMB Module Disable bit
1 = The EMB module is disabled; all EMB registers are held in Reset and are not writable
0 = The EMB module is enabled
DS30000575C-page 88
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.0
RESET
The 08KA101 family devices differentiate between various kinds of Reset:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
Power-on Reset (POR)
MCLR Reset
Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset
Configuration Mismatch (CM)
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
RESET Instruction
Stack Underflow/Overflow Reset
This section discusses Resets generated by MCLR,
POR and BOR, and covers the operation of the various
start-up timers. For information on WDT Resets, see
Section 28.2 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)”. For Stack
Reset events, see Section 6.1.4.4 “Stack Full and
Underflow Resets”. For Deep Sleep mode, see
Section 4.4 “Deep Sleep Modes”.
FIGURE 5-1:
A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit
is shown in Figure 5-1.
5.1
RCON Registers
Device Reset events are tracked through the RCON,
RCON2, RCON3 and RCON4 registers (Register 5-1,
Register 5-2, Register 5-3 and Register 5-4). The register bits indicate that a specific Reset event has occurred.
Depending on the definition, Status bits may be set or
cleared by the event, and re-initialized by the application, after the event to the opposite state. Setting or
clearing Reset Status bits does not cause a Reset.
The state of these flag bits, taken together, can be read
to indicate the type of Reset that just occurred.
The RCON register also has a control bit for setting
interrupt priority (IPEN). Interrupt priority is discussed
in Section 10.0 “Interrupts”.
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
RESET
Instruction
Stack Full/Underflow Reset
Stack
Pointer
External Reset
MCLR
MCLRE
Idle
Sleep
WDT
Time-out
VDD Rise POR Pulse
Detect
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
BOREN
S
OST/PWRT
OST
1024 Cycles
10-Bit Ripple Counter
OSC1
32 s
INTOSC(1)
PWRT
R
Q
Internal Reset
1 ms
11-Bit Ripple Counter
Enable PWRT
Enable OST(2)
Note 1:
2:
This is the INTOSC source from the internal oscillator block and is separate from the RC Oscillator of the CLKI pin.
See Table 5-1 for time-out situations.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 89
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 5-1:
RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R-1
R-1
R/W-0(1)
R/W-0
IPEN
—
CM
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
HC = Hardware Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable Register bit
1 = Prioritized interrupts are enabled
0 = Prioritized interrupts are disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
CM: Configuration Mismatch Flag bit
1 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset has not occurred
0 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset occurred; must be set in software once the Reset occurs
bit 4
RI: RESET Instruction Flag bit
1 = The RESET instruction was not executed (set by firmware only)
0 = The RESET instruction was executed, causing a device Reset (must be set in software after a
Brown-out Reset occurs)
bit 3
TO: Watchdog Time-out Flag bit
1 = Set by power-up, CLRWDT instruction or SLEEP instruction
0 = A WDT time-out occurred
bit 2
PD: Power-down Detection Flag bit
1 = Set by power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction
0 = Set by execution of the SLEEP instruction
bit 1
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit(1)
1 = A Power-on Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
bit 0
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
1 = A Brown-out Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Brown-out Reset occurs)
Note 1:
Brown-out Reset is said to have occurred when BOR is ‘0’ and POR is ‘1’ (assuming that POR was set to
‘1’ by software immediately after a Power-on Reset).
DS30000575C-page 90
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 5-2:
R/W-0, HS
RCON2: RESET CONTROL REGISTER 2
U-0
(1)
EXTR
—
R/W-0
(2)
SWDTEN
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
—
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
HS = Hardware Settable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
EXTR: External Reset (MCLR) Pin bit(1)
1 = A Master Clear (pin) Reset has occurred
0 = A Master Clear (pin) Reset has not occurred
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
SWDTEN: Software Controlled Watchdog Timer Enable bit(2)
1 = Watchdog Timer is on
0 = Watchdog Timer is off
bit 4-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1:
2:
x = Bit is unknown
This bit is set in hardware; it can be cleared in software.
This bit has no effect unless the Configuration bits, WDTEN = 10.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 91
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 5-3:
U-0
RCON3: RESET CONTROL REGISTER 3
U-0
—
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/C-0
R/C-0
(1)
VDDBOR
VDDPOR
R/C-0
(1,2)
(1,3)
VBPOR
R/W-0
VBAT
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
C = Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
VDDBOR: VDD Brown-out Reset Flag bit(1)
1 = A VDD Brown-out Reset has occurred
0 = A VDD Brown-out Reset has not occurred
bit 2
VDDPOR: VDD Power-On Reset Flag bit(1,2)
1 = A VDD Power-up Reset has occurred
0 = A VDD Power-up Reset has not occurred
bit 1
VBPOR: VBPOR Flag bit(1,3)
1 = A VBAT POR has occurred
0 = A VBAT POR has not occurred
bit 0
VBAT: VBAT Flag bit(1)
1 = A POR exit has occurred while power was applied to VBAT pin
0 = A POR exit from VBAT has not occurred
Note 1:
2:
3:
This bit is set in hardware only; it can only be cleared in software.
Indicates a VDD POR. Setting the POR bit (RCON) indicates a VCORE POR.
This bit is set when the device is originally powered up, even if power is present on VBAT.
DS30000575C-page 92
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 5-4:
RCON4: RESET CONTROL REGISTER 4
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/C-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
SRETEN(1)
—
DPSLP(2)
—
PMSLP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
SRETEN: Retention Regulator Voltage Sleep Disable bit(1)
1 = If RETEN (CONFIG7L) = 0 and the regulator is enabled, the device goes into Retention mode
in Sleep
0 = The regulator is on when device’s Sleep mode is enabled and the Low-Power mode is controlled
by the PMSLP bit
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
DPSLP: Deep Sleep Wake-up Status bit (used in conjunction with the POR and BOR bits in RCON to
determine the Reset source)(2)
1 = The last exit from Reset was caused by a normal wake-up from Deep Sleep
0 = The last exit from Reset was not due to a wake-up from Deep Sleep
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
PMSLP: Program Memory Power During Sleep bit
1 = Program memory bias voltage remains powered during Sleep
0 = Program memory bias voltage is powered down during Sleep
Note 1:
2:
This bit is available only when RETEN (CONFIG7L) = 0.
This bit is set in hardware only; it can only be cleared in software.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 93
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.2
Power-on Reset (POR)
The PIC18F97J94 family has two types of Power-on
Resets:
• POR
• VBAT POR
POR is the legacy PIC18J series Power-on Reset which
monitors core power supply. The second, VBAT POR,
monitors voltage on the VBAT pin. These POR circuits
use the same technique to enable and monitor their
respective power source for adequate voltage levels to
ensure proper chip operation. There are two threshold
voltages associated with them. The first voltage is the
device threshold voltage, VPOR. The device threshold
voltage is the voltage at which the POR module
becomes operable. The second voltage associated with
a POR event is the POR circuit threshold voltage. Once
the correct threshold voltage is detected, a power-on
event occurs and the POR module hibernates to
minimize current consumption.
A power-on event generates an internal POR pulse
when a VDD rise is detected. The device supply voltage
characteristics must meet the specified starting voltage,
VPOR, and rise rate requirements, SVDD, to generate the
POR pulse. In particular, VDD must fall below VPOR
before a new POR is initiated. For more information on
the VPOR and VDD rise rate specifications, refer to
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”.
5.2.1
POR CIRCUIT
The POR circuit behaves differently than VBAT POR
once the POR state becomes active. The internal POR
pulse resets the POR timer and places the device in the
Reset state. The POR also selects the device clock
source identified by the Oscillator Configuration bits.
After the POR pulse is generated, the POR circuit
inserts a small delay, TCSD, to ensure that internal
device bias circuits are stable.
DS30000575C-page 94
After the expiration of TCSD, a delay, TPWRT, is always
inserted every time the device resumes operation after
any power-down. During this time, code execution is
disabled. The PWRT is used to extend the duration of
a power-up sequence to permit the on-chip band gap
and regulator to stabilize and to load the Configuration
Word settings. The on-chip regulator is always enabled
and its stabilization time is shorter than other concurrently running delays, and does not extend start-up
time.
The power-on event clears the BOR and POR Status
bits (RCON); it does not change for any other
Reset event. POR is not reset to ‘1’ by any hardware
event. To capture multiple events, the user manually
resets the bit to ‘1’ in software following any Power-on
Reset. Alternatively, the VDDPOR (RCON3) bit can
be used; it is set on a VDD POR event. It must be
cleared after any Power-on Reset to detect subsequent
VDD POR events.
After TPWRT expires, an additional start-up time for the
system clock (either TOST, TIOBST and TRC, depending
on the source) occurs while the clock source becomes
stable. Internal Reset is then released and the device
is no longer held in Reset (Table 5-2). Once all of the
delays have expired, the system clock is released and
code execution can begin. Refer to Section 30.0
“Electrical Specifications” for more information on
the values of the delay parameters.
Note:
When the device exits the Reset condition
(begins normal operation), the device
operating parameters (voltage, frequency,
temperature, etc.) must be within their
operating ranges; otherwise, the device
will not function correctly. The user must
ensure that the delay between the time
power is first applied, and the time,
INTERNAL RESET, becomes inactive, is
long enough to get all operating
parameters within specification.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 5-2:
POR MODULE TIMING SEQUENCE FOR RISING VDD
POR Circuit Threshold Voltage
VDD
VPOR
Internal Power-on Reset Pulse Occurs
and Begins POR Delay Time, TCSD
POR
TCSD
POR Circuit is Initialized at VPOR
System Clock is Started
After TPWRT Delay
Expires
PWRT
TPWRT
System Clock is Released
and Code Execution
Begins
SYSRST
(Note 1)
System Reset is Released
After Clock is Stable
Oscillator Delay
INTERNAL RESET
Time
Note 1: Timer and interval are determined by the initial start-up oscillator configuration; TOSC is for external
oscillator modes, TFRC is for the FRC Oscillator or TLPRC for the internal 31 kHz RC Oscillator.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 95
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.2.1.1
Using the POR Circuit
To take advantage of the POR circuit, tie the MCLR pin
directly to VDD. This will eliminate external RC components usually needed to create a POR delay. A
minimum rise time for VDD is required. Refer to the
“Electrical Characteristics” section of the specific
device data sheet for more information.
Depending on the application, a resistor may be
required between the MCLR pin and VDD. This resistor
can be used to decouple the MCLR pin from a noisy
power supply rail.
Figure 5-3 displays a possible POR circuit for a slow
power supply ramp up. The external POR circuit is only
required if the device would exit Reset before the
device VDD is in the valid operating range. The diode,
D, helps discharge the capacitor quickly when VDD
powers down.
FIGURE 5-3:
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
5.2.2
The device will remain in VBAT mode as long as no
power is present on VDD. The VBPOR is active when
the device is operating in VBAT mode and deriving
power from the VBAT pin. Similar to the POR, the circuit
monitors VBAT voltage and holds the device in Reset
until adequate voltage is present to power up the
device. After exiting the VBAT POR condition, the
VBPOR (RCON3) bit is set. All other registers will
be in a POR state, including Deep Sleep semaphores.
Minimum VBAT ramp time and rearm voltage requirements apply. Refer to Parameters D003 and D004 in
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications” for details.
The device does not execute code in VBAT mode. Also,
there is no Power-up Timer associated with VBPOR.
After VDD power is restored, the device exits VBAT
mode and the VBAT (RCON3) bit is set. All other
registers, except those associated with RTCC, its clock
source and the Deep Sleep semaphores (DSGPRx),
will be in a POR state. For more information about VBAT
mode, see Section 4.5 “Vbat Mode”.
5.3
VDD
VDD
D
R
R1
C
MCLR
PIC18FXXJXX
Note 1:
External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode, D, helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
2:
R < 40 k is recommended to make sure that
the voltage drop across R does not violate
the device’s electrical specification.
3:
R1 1 k will limit any current flowing into
MCLR from external capacitor, C, in the event
of MCLR/VPP pin breakdown, due to Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical
Overstress (EOS).
Master Clear Reset (MCLR)
Whenever the MCLR pin is driven low, the device asynchronously asserts SYSRST, provided the input pulse
on MCLR is longer than a certain minimum width, TMCL
(see Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”).
When the MCLR pin is released, SYSRST is also
released. The Reset vector fetch starts from the
SYSRST release. The processor continues to use the
existing clock source that was in use before the MCLR
Reset occurred. The EXTR Status bit (RCON2) is
set to indicate the MCLR Reset.
5.4
Watchdog Timer Reset (WDT)
Whenever a Watchdog Timer time-out occurs, the
device asynchronously asserts SYSRST. The clock
source remains unchanged. Note that a WDT time-out
during Sleep or Idle mode will wake-up the processor,
but NOT reset the processor. The TO bit (RCON) is
cleared when a WDT time-out occurs. Software must
set this bit to initialize the flag. For more information,
refer to Section 28.2 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)”.
Note:
DS30000575C-page 96
VBAT POWER-ON-RESET (VBPOR)
The WDT described here is not the same
one used in Deep Sleep mode. For more
information on Deep Sleep WDT, see
Section 28.2 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.5
Configuration Mismatch
Reset (CM)
5.6
The Configuration Mismatch (CM) Reset is designed to
detect, and attempt to recover from, random memory
corrupting events. These include Electrostatic
Discharge (ESD) events, which can cause widespread,
single bit changes throughout the device and result in
catastrophic failure.
In PIC18FXXJXX Flash devices, device Configuration
registers (located in the configuration memory space)
are continuously monitored during operation by comparing their values to complimentary shadow registers. If a
mismatch is detected between the two sets of registers,
a CM Reset automatically occurs. These events are
captured by the CM bit (RCON) being set to ‘0’.
This bit does not change for any other Reset event. A
CM Reset behaves similarly to a Master Clear Reset,
RESET instruction, WDT Time-out Reset or Stack Event
Reset. As with all hard and power Reset events, the
device’s Configuration Words are reloaded from the
Flash Configuration Words in program memory as the
device restarts.
TABLE 5-1:
Feature
Brown-out Reset (BOR) Features
The PIC97J94 family has four different types of BOR
circuits:
•
•
•
•
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
VDDCORE Brown-out Reset (VDDBOR)
VBAT Brown-out Reset (VBATBOR)
Deep Sleep Brown-out Reset (DSBOR)
All four BOR circuits monitor a voltage and put the
device in a Reset condition while the voltage is in a
specified region. SFRs will reset to the BOR state,
including the Deep Sleep semaphore holding registers,
DSGPR0 and DSGPR1. Upon BOR exit, the device
remains in Reset until the associated trip point voltage
is exceeded. Any I/O pins configured as outputs will be
tri-stated. BOR, VDDBOR and DSBOR exit into Run
mode; VBATBOR remains in VBAT mode.
These features differ by their power mode, monitored
voltage source, trip points, control and status. Refer to
Table 5-1 for the PIC18F97J94 BOR differences.
BOR FEATURE SUMMARY(1)
Mode
Source
Trip Points
BOR
Run, Idle, Sleep
VDDCORE
1.6V (typ)
Always Enabled
VDDBOR
Run, Idle, Sleep
VDD
VVDDBOR
BOREN (CONFIG1H)
VBAT
VBAT
VVBATBOR
VBTBOR (CONFIG7L)
Deep Sleep
VDD
VDSBOR
VBATBOR
DSBOR
Note 1:
Enable
DSBOREN (CONFIG7L)
Refer to Table for details.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 97
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.6.1
BROWN-OUT RESET (BOR)
Brown-out Reset is the legacy PIC18 “J” feature that
monitors the core voltage, VDDCORE. Since the regulator
on the PIC18F97J94 family is always enabled, this
feature is always active. Its trip point is non-configurable.
A Brown-out Reset will occur as the regulator output
voltage drops below, approximately 1.6V. After proper
operating voltage recovers, the Brown-out Reset condition is exited and execution begins after the Power-up
Timer has expired. The BOR (RCON) bit is also
cleared. This bit must be set after each Brown-out and
Power-on Reset event to detect subsequent Brown-out
Reset events.
Note:
5.6.2
Brown-out Reset (BOR) has been provided to support legacy devices that can
disable their internal regulator. The
PIC18F97J94 family’s regulator is always
enabled. Therefore, it’s recommended
that new designs use VDDBOR to detect
Brown-out conditions.
VDD BOR (VDDBOR)
VDDBOR is enabled by setting the BOREN (CONFIG1H) Configuration bit. The low-power BOR trip
level is configurable to either 1.8V or 2.0V, (typ)
depending on the BORV (CONFIG1H) Configuration bit setting. When in normal Run mode, Idle or normal Sleep modes, the BOR circuit that monitors VDD is
active and will cause the device to be held in BOR if
VDD drops below VBOR. Once VDD rises back above
VVDDBOR, the device will be held in Reset until the expiration of the Power-up Timer, with period, TPWRT. This
event is captured by the VDDBOR flag bit
(RCON3).
5.6.3
DETECTING VDD BOR
When the BOR module is enabled, the VDDBOR
(RCON3) bit is set on a Brown-out Reset event. This
makes it difficult to determine if a Brown-out Reset event
has occurred just by reading the state of VDDBOR
alone. A more reliable method is to simultaneously
check the state of both VDDPOR and VDDBOR. This
assumes that the VDDPOR bit is reset to ‘1’ in software
immediately after any Power-on Reset event. If
VDDBOR is ‘0’ while VDDPOR is ‘1’, it can be reliably
assumed that a Brown-out Reset event has occurred.
Legacy PIC18 software can use the respective POR
(RCON) and BOR (RCON) bits. This technique
monitors the regulator output voltage, VDDCORE. To take
advantage of the configuration features, it is
recommended to use VDDBOR instead of BOR.
DS30000575C-page 98
5.6.4
VBAT BROWN-OUT RESET
(VBATBOR)
The VBAT BOR can be enabled/disabled using the
VBTBOR bit in the Configuration register (CONFIG7L). If the VBTBOR enable bit is cleared, the
VBATBOR is always disabled and there will be no indication of a VBAT BOR. If the VBTBOR bit is set, the VBAT
POR will reset the device when the battery voltage
drops below VVBATBOR. After power is restored to the
VBAT pin, the device exits Reset and returns to VBAT
mode. The device remains in VBAT mode until power
returns to the VDD pin. For more information on using
the VBAT feature, refer to Section 4.5 “Vbat Mode”.
5.6.5
DEEP SLEEP BROWN-OUT RESET
(DSBOR)
The PIC18F97J94 has its dedicated BOR for Deep
Sleep mode (DSBOR). It is enabled through the
DSBOREN (CONFIG7L) Configuration bit. When
the device enters Deep Sleep mode and receives a
DSBOR event, the device will not wake-up and will
remain in Deep Sleep mode. When a valid wake-up
event occurs and causes the device to exit Deep Sleep
mode, software can determine if a DSBOR event
occurred during Deep Sleep mode by reading the
DSBOR (DSCONL) Status bit.
5.7
RESET Instruction
Whenever the RESET instruction is executed, the
device asserts SYSRST. This Reset state does not reinitialize the clock. The clock source that is in effect
prior to the RESET instruction remains in effect. Configuration settings are updated and the SYSRST is
released at the next instruction cycle. A noise filter in
the MCLR Reset path detects and ignores small
pulses. The RI bit (RCON) is cleared when a
RESET instruction is executed. Software must set this
bit to initialize the flag.
5.8
Stack Underflow/Overflow Reset
A Reset can be enabled on stack error conditions by
setting the STVREN (CONFIG1L) Configuration
bit. See Section 6.1.4.4 “Stack Full and Underflow
Resets”section for additional information.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
5.9
Device Reset Timers
PIC18F97J94 family devices incorporate three separate on-chip timers that help regulate the Power-on
Reset process. Their main function is to ensure that the
device clock is stable before code is executed. These
timers are:
• Power-up Timer (PWRT)
• Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• PLL Lock Time-out
5.9.1
POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT)
The Power-up Timer (PWRT) of the PIC18F97J94 family devices is a counter which uses the INTOSC source
as the clock input. While the PWRT is counting, the
device is held in Reset. The power-up time delay
depends on the INTOSC clock and varies slightly from
chip-to-chip due to temperature and process variation.
See the TPWRT specification for details. The PWRT is
always enabled and active after Brown-out and Poweron Reset events.
5.9.2
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
(OST)
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) provides a
1024 oscillator cycle (from OSC1 input) delay after the
PWRT delay is over. This ensures that the crystal
oscillator or resonator has started and stabilized.
5.9.3
PLL LOCK TIME-OUT
The PLL is enabled by programming FOSC = 011
(CONFIG2L. With the PLL enabled, the time-out
sequence, following a Power-on Reset, is slightly different from other oscillator modes. A separate timer is used
to provide a fixed time-out that is sufficient for the PLL to
lock to the main oscillator frequency. This PLL lock timeout (TRC) follows the oscillator start-up time-out.
5.9.4
RESET STATE OF REGISTERS
Most registers are unaffected by a Reset. Their status
is unknown on a Power-on Reset and unchanged by all
other Resets. The other registers are forced to a “Reset
state” depending on the type of Reset that occurred.
Most registers are not affected by a WDT wake-up,
since this is viewed as the resumption of normal operation. Status bits from the RCONx registers are set or
cleared differently in different Reset situations, as
indicated in Table 5-2. These bits are used in software
to determine the nature of the Reset.
Table 5-2 describes the Reset states for all of the
Special Function Registers. These are categorized by
Power-on and Brown-out Resets, Master Clear and
WDT Resets, and WDT wake-ups.
The OST time-out is invoked only for LP, MS, HS and
HSPLL modes, and only on Power-on Reset or on exit
from most power-managed modes.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 99
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
DPSLP
EXTR
RI
TO
PD
IDLE
CM
BOR
POR
VDDBOR
VDDPOR
VBPOR(4,6)
VBAT(4)
RCONx BIT OPERATION ON VARIOUS RESETS AND WAKE-UPS
PC
TABLE 5-2:
DSPOR:(4)
Loss of VDDBAT
000000
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
VBAT:(4)
Loss of VDD While VBAT is Established
000000
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
u
1
VDD POR:
Loss of VDD
000000
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
u
u
VDD BOR:
Brown-out of VDD
000000
u
u
0
0
1
0
0
u
u
1
u
u
u
POR:
Loss of VDDCORE
000000
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
u
u
u
u
BOR
Brown-out of VDDCORE
000000
u
u
0
0
1
0
0
1
u
u
u
u
u
Deep Sleep Exit
000000
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
u
u
u
u
Retention Deep Sleep Exit
000000
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
u
u
u
u
MCLR Reset
Operational Mode
000000
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
MCLR Reset in Idle Mode
000000
u
1
u
0(1)
0(2)
1(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
(1)
(2)
0(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Conditions
MCLR Reset in Sleep Mode
000000
u
1
u
RESET Instruction Reset
000000
u
u
1
Configuration Mismatch Reset
000000
u
u
WDT Reset
000000
u
u
WDT Reset in Idle Mode
PC + 2
u
WDT Reset in Sleep Mode
PC + 2
u
0
0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
1(2)
1(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
0
(2)
0
(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
(2)
1
(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Interrupt in Idle Mode
with GIE = 0
PC + 2
u
u
u
0(1)
Interrupt in Idle Mode
with GIE = 1
Vector
u
u
u
0(1)
1(2)
1(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Interrupt in Sleep Mode
With GIE = 0
PC + 2
u
u
u
0(1)
0(2)
0(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Interrupt in Sleep Mode
with GIE = 1
Vector
u
u
u
0(1)
0(2)
0(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
CLRWDT Instruction
PC + 2
u
u
u
0(3)
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
IDLE Instruction
PC + 2
u
u
u
0
1
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
SLEEP Instruction
PC + 2
u
u
u
0
0
0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
User Instruction Writes ‘1’
PC + 2
u
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
User Instruction Writes ‘0’
PC + 2
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
The SLEEP instruction clears the WDTO bit.
The CLRWDT clears the WDTO bit only when the WDT window feature is disabled or the WDT is in the safe window.
This bit is also set, flagging the loss of state retention even though the true POR condition has not occurred.
This bit is set in hardware only; it can only be cleared in software.
Indicates a VDD POR. Setting the POR bit (RCON) indicates a VCORE POR.
This bit is set when the device is originally powered up, even if power is present on VBAT.
DS30000575C-page 100
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
TOSU
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---0 uuuu(1)
TOSH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(1)
TOSL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(1)
STKPTR
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 0000
uu-0 0000
uu-u uuuu(1)
PCLATU
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
PCLATH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PCL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
PC + 2(2)
TBLPTRU
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TBLPTRH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TBLPTRL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TABLAT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PRODH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PRODL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
INTCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu(3)
INTCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu(3)
INTCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1100 0000
1100 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
INDF0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
FSR0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
N/A
FSR0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
WREG
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
INDF1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
FSR1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
N/A
FSR1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
BSR
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
INDF2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 101
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
POSTINC2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
N/A
N/A
N/A
FSR2H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
FSR2L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
STATUS
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---x xxxx
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
TMR0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T0CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RESERVED
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- ----
---- ----
---- ----
OSCCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0qqq -qqq
uuuu -uuu
uuuu -uuu
IPR5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-111 -111
-uuu -uuu
-uuu -uuu
IOCF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
qqqq qqqq
(4)
RCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-11 11qq
0-qq qquu
u-qq qquu
TMR1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T1CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PR2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
T2CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
SSP1BUF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
SSP1ADD
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP1STAT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP1CON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP1CON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CMSTAT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- -xxx
---- -uuu
---- -uuu
ADCBUF0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADCON1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0--- -000
u--- -uuu
u--- -uuu
ADCON1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 -000
uuuu -uuu
uuuu -uuu
CVRCONH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
CVRCONL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 ---0
uuuu ---u
uuuu ---u
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 102
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
ECCP1AS
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ECCP1DEL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCP1CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PIR5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 -0000
-000 -000
-uuu -uuu(3)
PIE5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 -000
-000 -000
-uuu -uuu
IPR4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIR4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
PIE4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TMR3H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR3L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T3CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T3GCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0x00
0000 00x0
uuuu uuuu
SPBRG1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
T1GCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0x00
0000 0x00
uuuu uuuu
IPR6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
HLVDCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PSPCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 ----
0000 ----
uuuu ----
PIR6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
IPR3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIR3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
PIE3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
IPR2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIR2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
PIE2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
IPR1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIR1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
PIE1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 103
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
PSTR1CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 0001
00-0 0001
uu-u uuuu
OSCTUNE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TRISJ
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISG(5)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
11-1 1111
11-1 1111
uu-u uuuu
TRISF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISD
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISC
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISB
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISA
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
LATJ
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATG(5)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xx-x xxxx
uu-u uuuu
uu-u uuuu
LATF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATD
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATC
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATB
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATA
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTJ
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTG(5)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xx-x x-xx
xx-x x-xx
uu-u u-uu
PORTF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTD
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTC
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTB
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTA
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
EECON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xx-0 x000
uu-0 u000
uu-u uuuu
EECON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- ----
---- ----
---- ----
RCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-0- 0---
q-u- 0---
0-u- 1---
RCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 q000
---u 0000
---u 0000
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 104
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
RCON4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 -0-0
00-u -0-u
00-u -0-u
UFRML
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
UFRMH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- -xxx
---- -xxx
---- -uuu
UIR
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
UEIR
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
USTAT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0--0 0000
0--0 0000
u--u uuuu
UCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-0x0 000-
-0x0 000-
-uuu uuu-
UADDR
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
TRISVP
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
LATVP
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
PORTVP
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TXADDRL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXADDRH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
RXADDRL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RXADDRH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
DMABCL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
DMABCH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
TXBUF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP1CON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP1MSK
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
BAUDCON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0100 0000
0100 0000
uuuu uuuu
OSCCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
000- 000-
00q- 000-
uuu- uuu-
OSCCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- -001
---- -uuu
---- -uuu
OSCCON4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
000- ----
uuu- ----
uuu- ----
OSCCON5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0000
u-uu uuuu
u-uu uuuu
WPUB
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIE6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 -000
0000 -000
uuuu -uuu
DMACON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RTCCON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0000
u-uu uuuu
u-uu uuuu
RTCCAL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
RTCVALH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
RTCVALL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ALRMCFG
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 105
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
ALRMRPT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ALRMVALH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ALRMVALL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
RTCCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
IOCP
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
IOCN
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PADCFG1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CM1CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0001 1111
0001 1111
uuuu uuuu
ECCP2AS
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ECCP2DEL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CCPR2H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR2L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ECCP2CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ECCP3AS
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ECCP3DEL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CCPR3H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR3L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ECCP3CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CCPR8H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR8L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP8CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR9H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR9L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP9CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR10H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR10L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP10CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TMR6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PR6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
T6CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
TMR8
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PR8
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
T8CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 106
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
SSP2CON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CM2CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0001 1111
0001 1111
uuuu uuuu
CM3CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0001 1111
0001 1111
uuuu uuuu
CCPTMRS0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CCPTMRS1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 -000
00-0 -000
uuuu uuuu
CCPTMRS2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 -000
---0 -000
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
BAUDCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
01x0 0000
01x0 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRGH1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
BAUDCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
01x0 0000
01x0 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRGH3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRG3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
DSCONL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- -000
---- -000
--- -uuu
DSCONH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-0- ---0
u-u- ---u
u-u- ---u
DSWAKEL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0001
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
DSWAKEH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- ---0
---- ---u
---- ---q
DSGPR0(6)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
DSGPR1(6)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
DSGPR2(6)
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
DSGPR3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
SPBRGH2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRG2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PSTR2CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 0001
00-0 0001
uu-u uuuu
PSTR3CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 0001
00-0 0001
uu-u uuuu
SSP2STAT
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP2CON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 107
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
SSP2CON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSP2MSK
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TMR5H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR5L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T5CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T5GCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0x00
0000 00x0
uuuu uuuu
CCPR4H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR4L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP4CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR5H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR5L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP5CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR6H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR6L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP6CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR7H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCPR7L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
CCP7CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TMR4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PR4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T4CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
SSP2BUF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
SSP2ADD
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ANCFG
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- -000
---- -000
---- -uuu
DMACON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
BAUDCON4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
01x0 0000
01x0 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRGH4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SPBRG4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CTMUCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0000
0-00 0000
u-uu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 108
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
CTMUCON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CTMUCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 00--
0000 00--
uuuu uu--
CTMUCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PMD0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PMD1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PMD2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PMD3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PMD4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 00--
0000 00--
uuuu uu--
MDCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0010 0--0
0010 0--0
uuuu u--u
MDSRC
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0--- xxxx
0--- uuuu
u--- uuuu
MDCARH
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0xx- xxxx
0uu- uuuu
uuu- uuuu
MDCARL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0xx- xxxx
0uu- uuuu
uuu- uuuu
ODCON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ODCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TRISK
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
LATK
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTK
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TRISL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
LATL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
MEMCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 --00
0-00 --00
u-uu --uu
REFO1CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0-00
u-uu u-uu
u-uu u-uu
REFO1CON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
REFO1CON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
REFO1CON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
REFO2CON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0-00
u-uu u-uu
u-uu u-uu
REFO2CON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
REFO2CON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
REFO2CON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
LCDPS
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDREG
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDCON
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
u-uu uuuu
LCDREF
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0-00 0000
u-uu uuuu
u-uu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 109
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
LCDREFL
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 -000
uuuu -uuu
uuuu -uuu
LCDSE7
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDSE0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA63
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA62
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA61
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA60
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA59
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA58
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA57
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA56
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA55
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA54
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA53
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA52
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA51
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA50
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA49
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA48
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA47
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA46
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA45
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA44
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA43
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA42
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA41
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA40
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 110
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
LCDDATA39
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA38
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA37
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA36
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA35
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA34
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA33
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA32
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA31
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA30
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA29
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA28
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA27
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA26
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA25
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA24
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA23
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA22
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA21
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA20
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA19
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA18
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA17
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA16
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA15
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA14
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA13
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA12
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA11
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA10
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA9
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA8
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA7
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 111
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
LCDDATA6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LCDDATA0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADCON2H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 00--
0000 00--
uuuu uu--
ADCON2L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCON3H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCON3L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCON5H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
000- --00
000- --00
uuu- --uu
ADCON5L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
ADCHS0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCHS0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCSS1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCSS1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCSS0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCSS0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCHIT1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- --00
---- --00
---- --uu
ADCHIT1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCHIT0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCHIT0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCTMUEN1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCTMUEN1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCTMUEN0H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCTMUEN0L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF25H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF25L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF24H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF24L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF23H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF23L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 112
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
ADCBUF22H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF22L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF21H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF21L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF20H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF20L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF19H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF19L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF18H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF18L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF17H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF17L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF16H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF16L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF15H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF15L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF14H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF14L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF13H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF13L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF12H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF12L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF11H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF11L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF10H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF10L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF9H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF9L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF8H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF8L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF7H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF7L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF6H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 113
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
ADCBUF6L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF5H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF5L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF4H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF4L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF3H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF3L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF2H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF2L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF1H
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF1L
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
ANCON1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
ANCON2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
ANCON3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR52_53
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR50_51
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR48_49
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR46_47
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR44_45
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR42_43
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR40_41
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR38_39
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR36_37
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR34_35
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR32_33
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR30_31
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR28_29
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR26_27
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR24_25
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR22_23
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR20_21
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR18_19
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR16_17
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 114
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
RPINR14_15
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR12_13
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR10_11
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR8_9
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR6_7
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR4_5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR2_3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPINR0_1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
RPOR46
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
RPOR44_45
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR42_43
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR40_41
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR38_39
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR36_37
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR34_35
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR32_33
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR30_31
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR28_29
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR26_27
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR24_25
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR22_23
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR20_21
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR18_19
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR16_17
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR14_15
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR12_13
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR10_11
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR8_9
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR6_7
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR4_5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR2_3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RPOR0_1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
UCFG
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
00-0 -000
00-0 -000
uu-u -uuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 115
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 5-3:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Register
Applicable Devices
MCLR Resets,
Power-on Reset,
WDT Reset,
Wake-up via
Brown-out
RESET Instruction, WDT or Interrupt
Reset
Stack Resets
UIE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
UEIE
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
0--0 0000
0--0 0000
u--u uuuu
UEP0
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP1
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP2
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP3
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP4
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP5
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP6
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP7
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP8
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP9
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP10
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP11
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP12
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP13
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP14
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
UEP15
64-pin
80-pin
100-pin
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged; x = unknown; - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’; q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate that conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
4: See Table 5-2 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 7,6 are unimplemented on 64 and 80-pin devices.
6: If the VBAT is always powered, the DSGPx register values will remain unchanged after the first POR.
DS30000575C-page 116
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
PIC18FXXJ94 devices have these types of memory:
• Program Memory
• Data RAM
FIGURE 6-1:
As Harvard architecture devices, the data and program
memories use separate buses. This enables
concurrent access of the two memory spaces.
Additional detailed information on the operation of the
Flash program memory is provided in Section 7.0
“Flash Program Memory”.
MEMORY MAPS FOR PIC18F97J94 FAMILY DEVICES
PC
CALL, CALLW, RCALL,
RETURN, RETFIE, RETLW,
ADDULNK, SUBULNK
21
Stack Level 1
Stack Level 31
PIC18FX6J94
On-Chip
Memory
PIC18FX7J94
On-Chip
Memory
Config Words
007FFFh
Config Words
00FFFFh
Config Words
Note:
000000h
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Read as ‘0’
Read as ‘0’
Read as ‘0’
01FFFFh
User Memory Space
PIC18FX5J94
On-Chip
Memory
1FFFFFh
Sizes of memory areas are not to scale. Sizes of program memory areas are enhanced to show detail.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 117
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.1
Program Memory Organization
PIC18 microcontrollers implement a 21-bit Program
Counter that is capable of addressing a 2-Mbyte
program memory space. Accessing a location between
the upper boundary of the physically implemented
memory and the 2-Mbyte address will return all ‘0’s (a
NOP instruction).
The entire PIC18FXXJ94 offers a range of on-chip
Flash program memory sizes, from 32 Kbytes (up to
16,384 single-word instructions) to 128 Kbytes (65,536
single-word instructions).
• PIC18F65J94, PIC18F85J94 and PIC18F95J94 –
32 Kbytes of Flash memory, storing up to
16,384 single-word instructions
• PIC18F66J94, PIC18F86J94 and PIC18F96J94 –
64 Kbytes of Flash memory, storing up to
32,768 single-word instructions
• PIC18F67J94, PIC18F87J94 and PIC18F97J94 –
128 Kbytes of Flash memory, storing up to
65,536 single-word instructions
The program memory maps for individual family
members are shown in Figure 6-1.
6.1.1
HARD MEMORY VECTORS
All PIC18 devices have a total of three hard-coded
return vectors in their program memory space. The
Reset vector address is the default value to which the
Program Counter returns on all device Resets; it is
located at 0000h.
TABLE 6-1:
FLASH CONFIGURATION
WORD FOR PIC18FXXJ94
FAMILY DEVICES
Program
Memory
(Kbytes)
Configuration
Word Addresses
PIC18F65J94
PIC18F85J94
PIC18F95J94
32
7FF0h to 7FFFh
PIC18F66J94
PIC18F86J94
PIC18F96J94
64
FFF0h to FFFFh
PIC18F67J94
PIC18F87J94
PIC18F97J94
128
1FFF0h to 1FFFFh
Device
FIGURE 6-2:
HARD VECTOR FOR
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
DEVICES
Reset Vector
0000h
High-Priority Interrupt Vector
0008h
Low-Priority Interrupt Vector
0018h
On-Chip
Program Memory
PIC18 devices also have two interrupt vector
addresses for handling high-priority and low-priority
interrupts. The high-priority interrupt vector is located at
0008h and the low-priority interrupt vector is at 0018h.
The locations of these vectors are shown, in relation to
the program memory map, in Figure 6-2.
Flash Configuration Words
6.1.2
FLASH CONFIGURATION WORDS
Because PIC18FXXJ94 devices do not have persistent
configuration memory, the top eight words of on-chip
program memory are reserved for configuration information. On Reset, the configuration information is copied
into the Configuration registers.
The Configuration Words are stored in their program
memory location in numerical order, starting with the
lower byte of CONFIG1 at the lowest address and ending with the upper byte of CONFIG8. The actual
addresses of the Flash Configuration Word for devices
in the PIC18FXXJ94 are shown in Table 6-1.
Their location in the memory map is shown with the
other memory vectors in Figure 6-2. Additional details
on the device Configuration Words are provided in
Section 28.1 “Configuration Bits”.
DS30000575C-page 118
(Top of Memory-17)
(Top of Memory)
Read ‘0’
1FFFFFh
Legend:
(Top of Memory) represents upper boundary
of on-chip program memory space (see
Figure 6-1 for device-specific values).
Shaded area represents unimplemented
memory. Areas are not shown to scale.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.1.3
PROGRAM COUNTER
The Program Counter (PC) specifies the address of the
instruction to fetch for execution. The PC is 21 bits wide
and contained in three separate 8-bit registers.
The low byte, known as the PCL register, is both
readable and writable. The high byte, or PCH register,
contains the PC bits and is not directly readable
or writable. Updates to the PCH register are performed
through the PCLATH register. The upper byte is called
PCU. This register contains the PC bits; it is
also not directly readable or writable. Updates to the
PCU register are performed through the PCLATU
register.
The contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are transferred
to the Program Counter by any operation that writes
PCL. Similarly, the upper two bytes of the Program
Counter are transferred to PCLATH and PCLATU by an
operation that reads PCL. This is useful for computed
offsets to the PC (see Section 6.1.6.1 “Computed
GOTO”).
The PC addresses bytes in the program memory. To
prevent the PC from becoming misaligned with word
instructions, the Least Significant bit of PCL is fixed to
a value of ‘0’. The PC increments by two to address
sequential instructions in the program memory.
The CALL, RCALL, GOTO and program branch
instructions write to the Program Counter directly. For
these instructions, the contents of PCLATH and
PCLATU are not transferred to the Program Counter.
6.1.4
RETURN ADDRESS STACK
The return address stack enables execution of any
combination of up to 31 program calls and interrupts.
The PC is pushed onto the stack when a CALL or
RCALL instruction is executed or an interrupt is
Acknowledged. The PC value is pulled off the stack on
a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction. The value
also is pulled off the stack on ADDULNK and SUBULNK
instructions, if the extended instruction set is enabled.
PCLATU and PCLATH are not affected by any of the
RETURN or CALL instructions.
FIGURE 6-3:
The stack operates as a 31-word by 21-bit RAM and a
5-bit Stack Pointer, STKPTR. The stack space is not
part of either program or data space. The Stack Pointer
is readable and writable and the address on the top of
the stack is readable and writable through the Top-ofStack Special Function Registers. Data can also be
pushed to, or popped from, the stack using these
registers.
A CALL type instruction causes a push onto the stack.
The Stack Pointer is first incremented and the location
pointed to by the Stack Pointer is written with the
contents of the PC (already pointing to the instruction
following the CALL). A RETURN type instruction causes
a pop from the stack. The contents of the location
pointed to by the STKPTR are transferred to the PC
and then the Stack Pointer is decremented.
The Stack Pointer is initialized to ‘00000’ after all
Resets. There is no RAM associated with the location
corresponding to a Stack Pointer value of ‘00000’; this
is only a Reset value. Status bits indicate if the stack is
full, has overflowed or has underflowed.
6.1.4.1
Top-of-Stack Access
Only the top of the return address stack (TOS) is
readable and writable. A set of three registers,
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL, holds the contents of the stack location pointed to by the STKPTR register (Figure 6-3). This
allows users to implement a software stack, if necessary. After a CALL, RCALL or interrupt (or ADDULNK and
SUBULNK instructions, if the extended instruction set is
enabled), the software can read the pushed value by
reading the TOSU:TOSH:TOSL registers. These values can be placed on a user-defined software stack. At
return time, the software can return these values to
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL and do a return.
While accessing the stack, users must disable the
Global Interrupt Enable bits to prevent inadvertent
stack corruption.
RETURN ADDRESS STACK AND ASSOCIATED REGISTERS
Return Address Stack
Top-of-Stack Registers
TOSU
00h
TOSH
1Ah
11111
11110
11101
TOSL
34h
Top-of-Stack
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
001A34h
000D58h
Stack Pointer
STKPTR
00010
00011
00010
00001
00000
DS30000575C-page 119
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.1.4.2
Return Stack Pointer (STKPTR)
The STKPTR register (Register 6-1) contains the Stack
Pointer value, the STKFUL (Stack Full) Status bit and
the STKUNF (Stack Underflow) Status bits. The value
of the Stack Pointer can be 0 through 31. The Stack
Pointer increments before values are pushed onto the
stack and decrements after values are popped off the
stack. On Reset, the Stack Pointer value will be zero.
When the stack has been popped enough times to
unload the stack, the next pop will return a value of zero
to the PC and set the STKUNF bit, while the Stack
Pointer remains at zero. The STKUNF bit will remain
set until cleared by software or until a POR occurs.
Note:
The user may read and write the Stack Pointer value.
This feature can be used by a Real-Time Operating
System (RTOS) for return-stack maintenance.
After the PC is pushed onto the stack, 31 times (without
popping any values off the stack), the STKFUL bit is
set. The STKFUL bit is cleared by software or by a
POR.
What happens when the stack becomes full depends
on the state of the STVREN (Stack Overflow Reset
Enable) Configuration bit. (For a description of the
device Configuration bits, see Section 28.1 “Configuration Bits”.) If STVREN is set (default), the 31st push
will push the (PC + 2) value onto the stack, set the
STKFUL bit and reset the device. The STKFUL bit will
remain set and the Stack Pointer will be set to zero.
If STVREN is cleared, the STKFUL bit will be set on the
31st push and the Stack Pointer will increment to 31.
Any additional pushes will not overwrite the 31st push
and the STKPTR will remain at 31.
REGISTER 6-1:
6.1.4.3
Returning a value of zero to the PC on an
underflow has the effect of vectoring the
program to the Reset vector, where the
stack conditions can be verified and
appropriate actions can be taken. This is
not the same as a Reset, as the contents
of the SFRs are not affected.
PUSH and POP Instructions
Since the Top-of-Stack is readable and writable, the
ability to push values onto the stack and pull values off
the stack, without disturbing normal program execution, is a desirable feature. The PIC18 instruction set
includes two instructions, PUSH and POP, that permit
the TOS to be manipulated under software control.
TOSU, TOSH and TOSL can be modified to place data
or a return address on the stack.
The PUSH instruction places the current PC value onto
the stack. This increments the Stack Pointer and loads
the current PC value onto the stack.
The POP instruction discards the current TOS by
decrementing the Stack Pointer. The previous value
pushed onto the stack then becomes the TOS value.
STKPTR: STACK POINTER REGISTER
R/C-0
R/C-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
STKFUL(1)
STKUNF(1)
—
SP4
SP3
SP2
SP1
SP0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
C = Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
STKFUL: Stack Full Flag bit(1)
1 = Stack has become full or overflowed
0 = Stack has not become full or overflowed
bit 6
STKUNF: Stack Underflow Flag bit(1)
1 = Stack underflow has occurred
0 = Stack underflow did not occur
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
SP: Stack Pointer Location bits
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
DS30000575C-page 120
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.1.4.4
Stack Full and Underflow Resets
Device Resets on stack overflow and stack underflow
conditions are enabled by setting the STVREN bit
(CONFIG1L). When STVREN is set, a full or underflow condition will set the appropriate STKFUL or
STKUNF bit and then cause a device Reset. When
STVREN is cleared, a full or underflow condition will set
the appropriate STKFUL or STKUNF bit, but not cause
a device Reset. The STKFUL or STKUNF bits are
cleared by user software or a Power-on Reset.
6.1.5
FAST REGISTER STACK
A Fast Register Stack is provided for the STATUS,
WREG and BSR registers to provide a “fast return”
option for interrupts. This stack is only one level deep
and is neither readable nor writable. It is loaded with the
current value of the corresponding register when the
processor vectors for an interrupt. All interrupt sources
will push values into the Stack registers. The values in
the registers are then loaded back into the working
registers if the RETFIE, FAST instruction is used to
return from the interrupt.
6.1.6
LOOK-UP TABLES IN PROGRAM
MEMORY
There may be programming situations that require the
creation of data structures, or look-up tables, in
program memory. For PIC18 devices, look-up tables
can be implemented in two ways:
• Computed GOTO
• Table Reads
6.1.6.1
Computed GOTO
A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset
to the Program Counter. An example is shown in
Example 6-2.
A look-up table can be formed with an ADDWF PCL
instruction and a group of RETLW nn instructions. The
W register is loaded with an offset into the table before
executing a call to that table. The first instruction of the
called routine is the ADDWF PCL instruction. The next
instruction executed will be one of the RETLW nn
instructions that returns the value, ‘nn’, to the calling
function.
If both low and high-priority interrupts are enabled, the
Stack registers cannot be used reliably to return from
low-priority interrupts. If a high-priority interrupt occurs
while servicing a low-priority interrupt, the Stack
register values stored by the low-priority interrupt will
be overwritten. In these cases, users must save the key
registers in software during a low-priority interrupt.
The offset value (in WREG) specifies the number of
bytes that the Program Counter should advance and
should be multiples of two (LSb = 0).
If interrupt priority is not used, all interrupts may use the
Fast Register Stack for returns from interrupt. If no
interrupts are used, the Fast Register Stack can be
used to restore the STATUS, WREG and BSR registers
at the end of a subroutine call. To use the Fast Register
Stack for a subroutine call, a CALL label, FAST
instruction must be executed to save the STATUS,
WREG and BSR registers to the Fast Register Stack. A
RETURN, FAST instruction is then executed to restore
these registers from the Fast Register Stack.
EXAMPLE 6-2:
Example 6-1 shows a source code example that uses
the Fast Register Stack during a subroutine call and
return.
EXAMPLE 6-1:
CALL SUB1, FAST
FAST REGISTER STACK
CODE EXAMPLE
;STATUS, WREG, BSR
;SAVED IN FAST REGISTER
;STACK
RETURN FAST
SUB1
;RESTORE VALUES SAVED
;IN FAST REGISTER STACK
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
In this method, only one data byte may be stored in
each instruction location and room on the return
address stack is required.
ORG
TABLE
6.1.6.2
MOVF
CALL
nn00h
ADDWF
RETLW
RETLW
RETLW
.
.
.
COMPUTED GOTO USING
AN OFFSET VALUE
OFFSET, W
TABLE
PCL
nnh
nnh
nnh
Table Reads
A better method of storing data in program memory
allows two bytes of data to be stored in each instruction
location.
Look-up table data may be stored, two bytes per
program word, while programming. The Table Pointer
(TBLPTR) specifies the byte address and the Table
Latch (TABLAT) contains the data that is read from the
program memory. Data is transferred from program
memory one byte at a time.
The table read operation is discussed further in
Section 7.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
DS30000575C-page 121
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.2
PIC18 Instruction Cycle
6.2.1
6.2.2
An “Instruction Cycle” consists of four Q cycles, Q1
through Q4. The instruction fetch and execute are pipelined in such a manner that a fetch takes one instruction
cycle, while the decode and execute take another
instruction cycle. However, due to the pipelining, each
instruction effectively executes in one cycle. If an
instruction (such as GOTO) causes the Program
Counter to change, two cycles are required to complete
the instruction. (See Example 6-3.)
CLOCKING SCHEME
The microcontroller clock input, whether from an
internal or external source, is internally divided by four
to generate four non-overlapping quadrature clocks
(Q1, Q2, Q3 and Q4). Internally, the Program Counter
is incremented on every Q1, with the instruction
fetched from the program memory and latched into the
Instruction Register (IR) during Q4.
The instruction is decoded and executed during the
following Q1 through Q4. The clocks and instruction
execution flow are shown in Figure 6-4.
FIGURE 6-4:
INSTRUCTION FLOW/PIPELINING
A fetch cycle begins with the Program Counter (PC)
incrementing in Q1.
In the execution cycle, the fetched instruction is latched
into the Instruction Register (IR) in cycle Q1. This
instruction is then decoded and executed during the
Q2, Q3 and Q4 cycles. Data memory is read during Q2
(operand read) and written during Q4 (destination
write).
CLOCK/INSTRUCTION CYCLE
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
Q1
Q2
Internal
Phase
Clock
Q3
Q4
PC
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
OSC2/CLKO
(RC mode)
Execute INST (PC – 2)
Fetch INST (PC)
EXAMPLE 6-3:
1. MOVLW 55h
4. BSF
Execute INST (PC + 2)
Fetch INST (PC + 4)
INSTRUCTION PIPELINE FLOW
TCY0
TCY1
Fetch 1
Execute 1
2. MOVWF PORTB
3. BRA
Execute INST (PC)
Fetch INST (PC + 2)
SUB_1
PORTA, BIT3 (Forced NOP)
5. Instruction @ address SUB_1
Fetch 2
TCY2
TCY3
TCY4
TCY5
Execute 2
Fetch 3
Execute 3
Fetch 4
Flush (NOP)
Fetch SUB_1 Execute SUB_1
All instructions are single cycle, except for any program branches. These take two cycles since the fetch instruction
is “flushed” from the pipeline while the new instruction is being fetched and then executed.
DS30000575C-page 122
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.2.3
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM
MEMORY
The program memory is addressed in bytes. Instructions are stored as two or four bytes in program
memory. The Least Significant Byte of an instruction
word is always stored in a program memory location
with an even address (LSB = 0). To maintain alignment
with instruction boundaries, the PC increments in steps
of two and the LSB will always read ‘0’ (see
Section 6.1.3 “Program Counter”).
Figure 6-5 shows an example of how instruction words
are stored in the program memory.
FIGURE 6-5:
The CALL and GOTO instructions have the absolute
program memory address embedded into the instruction. Since instructions are always stored on word
boundaries, the data contained in the instruction is a
word address. The word address is written to PC
which accesses the desired byte address in program
memory. Instruction #2 in Figure 6-5 shows how the
instruction, GOTO 0006h, is encoded in the program
memory. Program branch instructions, which encode a
relative address offset, operate in the same manner. The
offset value stored in a branch instruction represents the
number of single-word instructions that the PC will be
offset by. For more details on the instruction set, see
Section 29.0 “Instruction Set Summary”.
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM MEMORY
LSB = 1
LSB = 0
0Fh
EFh
F0h
C1h
F4h
55h
06h
00h
23h
56h
Program Memory
Byte Locations
6.2.4
Instruction 1:
Instruction 2:
MOVLW
GOTO
055h
0006h
Instruction 3:
MOVFF
123h, 456h
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
The standard PIC18 instruction set has four, two-word
instructions: CALL, MOVFF, GOTO and LSFR. In all
cases, the second word of the instructions always has
‘1111’ as its four Most Significant bits. The other 12 bits
are literal data, usually a data memory address.
The use of ‘1111’ in the 4 MSbs of an instruction
specifies a special form of NOP. If the instruction is
executed in proper sequence, immediately after the
first word, the data in the second word is accessed and
EXAMPLE 6-4:
Word Address
000000h
000002h
000004h
000006h
000008h
00000Ah
00000Ch
00000Eh
000010h
000012h
000014h
used by the instruction sequence. If the first word is
skipped, for some reason, and the second word is
executed by itself, a NOP is executed instead. This is
necessary for cases when the two-word instruction is
preceded by a conditional instruction that changes the
PC. Example 6-4 shows how this works.
Note:
For information on two-word instructions
in the extended instruction set, see
Section 6.5 “Program Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set”.
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
CASE 1:
Object Code
Source Code
0110 0110 0000 0000
TSTFSZ
REG1
1100 0001 0010 0011
MOVFF
REG1, REG2 ; No, skip this word
ADDWF
REG3
; continue code
; is RAM location 0?
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
; is RAM location 0?
; Execute this word as a NOP
CASE 2:
Object Code
Source Code
0110 0110 0000 0000
TSTFSZ
REG1
1100 0001 0010 0011
MOVFF
REG1, REG2 ; Yes, execute this word
ADDWF
REG3
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
; 2nd word of instruction
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
; continue code
DS30000575C-page 123
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.3
Note:
Data Memory Organization
The operation of some aspects of data
memory are changed when the PIC18
extended instruction set is enabled. See
Section 6.6 “Data Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set” for more
information.
The data memory in PIC18 devices is implemented as
static RAM. Each register in the data memory has a 12bit address, allowing up to 4,096 bytes of data memory.
The memory space is divided into as many as 16 banks
that contain 256 bytes each. PIC18FXXJ94 devices
implement all 16 banks, for a total of 4 Kbytes.
Figure 6-6 and Figure 6-7 show the data memory
organization for the devices.
The data memory contains Special Function Registers
(SFRs) and General Purpose Registers (GPRs). The
SFRs are used for control and status of the controller
and peripheral functions, while GPRs are used for data
storage and scratchpad operations in the user’s
application. Any read of an unimplemented location will
read as ‘0’s.
The instruction set and architecture allow operations
across all banks. The entire data memory may be
accessed by Direct, Indirect or Indexed Addressing
modes. Addressing modes are discussed later in this
section.
To ensure that commonly used registers (select SFRs
and select GPRs) can be accessed in a single cycle,
PIC18 devices implement an Access Bank. This is a
256-byte memory space that provides fast access to
select SFRs and the lower portion of GPR Bank 0 without using the Bank Select Register. For details on the
Access RAM, see Section 6.3.2 “Access Bank”.
6.3.1
BANK SELECT REGISTER
Large areas of data memory require an efficient
addressing scheme to make it possible for rapid access
to any address. Ideally, this means that an entire
address does not need to be provided for each read or
write operation. For PIC18 devices, this is accomplished with a RAM banking scheme. This divides the
memory space into 16 contiguous banks of 256 bytes.
Depending on the instruction, each location can be
addressed directly by its full 12-bit address, or an 8-bit,
low-order address and a four-bit Bank Pointer.
Most instructions in the PIC18 instruction set make use
of the Bank Pointer, known as the Bank Select Register
(BSR). This SFR holds the four Most Significant bits of
a location’s address. The instruction itself includes the
eight Least Significant bits. Only the four lower bits of
the BSR are implemented (BSR). The upper four
bits are unused, always read as ‘0’ and cannot be
written to. The BSR can be loaded directly by using the
MOVLB instruction.
The value of the BSR indicates the bank in data
memory. The eight bits in the instruction show the location in the bank and can be thought of as an offset from
the bank’s lower boundary. The relationship between
the BSR’s value and the bank division in data memory
is shown in Figure 6-7.
Since up to 16 registers may share the same low-order
address, the user must always be careful to ensure that
the proper bank is selected before performing a data
read or write. For example, writing what should be
program data to an 8-bit address of F9h, while the BSR
is 0Fh, will end up resetting the Program Counter.
While any bank can be selected, only those banks that
are actually implemented can be read or written to.
Writes to unimplemented banks are ignored, while
reads from unimplemented banks will return ‘0’s. Even
so, the STATUS register will still be affected as if the
operation was successful. The data memory map in
Figure 6-6 indicates which banks are implemented.
In the core PIC18 instruction set, only the MOVFF
instruction fully specifies the 12-bit address of the
source and target registers. When this instruction
executes, it ignores the BSR completely. All other
instructions include only the low-order address as an
operand and must use either the BSR or the Access
Bank to locate their target registers.
DS30000575C-page 124
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 6-6:
DATA MEMORY MAP FOR PIC18F97J94 FAMILY DEVICES
BSR
Data Memory Map
00h
= 0000
= 0001
= 0010
= 0011
= 0100
= 0101
= 0110
= 0111
= 1000
= 1001
= 1010
= 1011
= 1100
= 1101
= 1110
= 1111
Bank 0
FFh
00h
Bank 1
GPR
1FFh
200h
FFh
00h
Bank 2
GPR
FFh
00h
Bank 3
2FFh
300h
GPR
FFh
00h
Bank 4
3FFh
400h
6FFh
700h
GPR
FFh
00h
7FFh
800h
GPR
Bank 9
8FFh
900h
The BSR specifies the bank
used by the instruction.
Access Bank
Access RAM Low
00h
5Fh
Access RAM High 60h
(SFRs)
FFh
GPR
9FFh
A00h
FFh
00h
Bank 13
When a = 1:
GPR
FFh
00h
Bank 12
The second 160 bytes are
Special Function Registers
(from Bank 15).
5FFh
600h
FFh
00h
Bank 8
Bank 11
The first 96 bytes are general
purpose RAM (from Bank 0).
4FFh
500h
FFh
00h
Bank 10
The BSR is ignored and the
Access Bank is used.
GPR
Bank 5
Bank 7
When a = 0:
GPR
FFh
00h
Bank 6
000h
05Fh
060h
0FFh
100h
GPR
FFh
00h
FFh
00h
FFh
00h
FAh
FFh
00h
GPR
GPR
GPR
GPR
SFR
SFR
Bank 14
FFh
00h
Bank 15
SFR
FFh
Note 1:
Access RAM
AFFh
B00h
BFFh
C00h
CFFh
D00h
DFAh
DFFh
E00h
EFFh
F00h
F5Fh
F60h
FFFh
Addresses, DFAh through F5Fh, are also SFRs, but are not part of the Access RAM. Users must always use
the complete address, or load the proper BSR value, to access these registers.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 125
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 6-7:
USE OF THE BANK SELECT REGISTER (DIRECT ADDRESSING)
BSR(1)
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bank Select(2)
1
0
000h
Data Memory
Bank 0
100h
Bank 1
200h
300h
Bank 2
00h
7
FFh
00h
1
From Opcode(2)
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
FFh
00h
FFh
00h
Bank 3
through
Bank 13
E00h
Bank 14
F00h
FFFh
Note 1:
2:
6.3.2
Bank 15
FFh
00h
FFh
00h
FFh
The Access RAM bit of the instruction can be used to force an override of the selected bank (BSR)
to the registers of the Access Bank.
The MOVFF instruction embeds the entire 12-bit address in the instruction.
ACCESS BANK
While the use of the BSR, with an embedded 8-bit
address, allows users to address the entire range of data
memory, it also means that the user must ensure that the
correct bank is selected. If not, data may be read from,
or written to, the wrong location. This can be disastrous
if a GPR is the intended target of an operation, but an
SFR is written to instead. Verifying and/or changing the
BSR for each read or write to data memory can become
very inefficient.
To streamline access for the most commonly used data
memory locations, the data memory is configured with
an Access Bank, which allows users to access a
mapped block of memory without specifying a BSR.
The Access Bank consists of the first 96 bytes of
memory (00h-5Fh) in Bank 0 and the last 160 bytes of
memory (60h-FFh) in Bank 15. The lower half is known
as the “Access RAM” and is composed of GPRs. The
upper half is where the device’s SFRs are mapped.
These two areas are mapped contiguously in the
Access Bank and can be addressed in a linear fashion
by an 8-bit address (Figure 6-6).
The Access Bank is used by core PIC18 instructions
that include the Access RAM bit (the ‘a’ parameter in
the instruction). When ‘a’ is equal to ‘1’, the instruction
uses the BSR and the 8-bit address included in the
opcode for the data memory address. When ‘a’ is ‘0’,
however, the instruction is forced to use the Access
Bank address map. In that case, the current value of
the BSR is ignored entirely.
DS30000575C-page 126
Using this “forced” addressing allows the instruction to
operate on a data address in a single cycle without
updating the BSR first. For 8-bit addresses of 60h and
above, this means that users can evaluate and operate
on SFRs more efficiently. The Access RAM below 60h
is a good place for data values that the user might need
to access rapidly, such as immediate computational
results or common program variables.
Access RAM also allows for faster and more code
efficient context saving and switching of variables.
The mapping of the Access Bank is slightly different
when the extended instruction set is enabled (XINST
Configuration bit = 1). This is discussed in more detail
in Section 6.6.3 “Mapping the Access Bank in
Indexed Literal Offset Mode”.
6.3.3
GENERAL PURPOSE
REGISTER FILE
PIC18 devices may have banked memory in the GPR
area. This is data RAM which is available for use by all
instructions. GPRs start at the bottom of Bank 0
(address 000h) and grow upwards towards the bottom of
the SFR area. GPRs are not initialized by a Power-on
Reset and are unchanged on all other Resets.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.3.4
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The Special Function Registers (SFRs) are registers
used by the CPU and peripheral modules for controlling
the desired operation of the device. These registers are
implemented as static RAM. SFRs start at the top of
data memory (FFFh) and extend downward to occupy
all of Bank 15 (F00h to FFFh), Bank 14 (E00h to EFFh)
and part of Bank 13 (DFAh to DFFh).
A list of these registers is given in Table 6-2.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
The SFRs can be classified into two sets: those
associated with the “core” device functionality (ALU,
Resets and interrupts) and those related to the
peripheral functions. The Reset and Interrupt registers
are described in their respective chapters, while the
ALU’s STATUS register is described later in this section.
Registers related to the operation of the peripheral
features are described in the chapter for that peripheral.
The SFRs are typically distributed among the
peripherals whose functions they control. Unused SFR
locations are unimplemented and read as ‘0’s.
DS30000575C-page 127
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
—
—
—
Top-of-Stack Upper Byte (TOS)
Bit 1
Bit 0
FFFh
TOSU
FFEh
TOSH
Top-of-Stack High Byte (TOS)
FFDh
TOSL
Top-of-Stack Low Byte (TOS)
FFCh
STKPTR
STKFUL
STKUNF
—
STKPTR
FFBh
PCLATU
—
—
—
Holding Register for PC
FFAh
PCLATH
Holding Register for PC
FF9h
PCL
PC Low Byte (PC)
FF8h
TBLPTRU
FF7h
TBLPTRH
FF6h
TBLPTRL
Program Memory Table Pointer Low Byte (TBLPTR)
FF5h
TABLAT
Program Memory Table Latch
FF4h
PRODH
Product Register High Byte
FF3h
PRODL
Product Register Low Byte
FF2h
INTCON
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
IOCIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
IOCIF
FF1h
INTCON2
RBPU
INTEDG0
INTEDG1
INTEDG2
INTEDG3
TMR0IP
INT3IP
IOCIP
FF0h
INTCON3
INT2IP
INT1IP
INT3IE
INT2IE
INT1IE
INT3IF
INT2IF
INT1IF
FEFh
INDF0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 not changed (not a physical register)
FEEh
POSTINC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-incremented (not a physical register)
—
—
ACSS
Program Memory Table Pointer Upper Byte (TBLPTR)
Program Memory Table Pointer High Byte (TBLPTR)
FEDh POSTDEC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-decremented (not a physical register)
FECh PREINC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
FEBh
PLUSW0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register) – value of
FSR0 offset by W
FEAh
FSR0H
FE9h
FSR0L
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 High
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 Low Byte
FE8h
WREG
Working Register
FE7h
INDF1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 not changed (not a physical register)
FE6h
POSTINC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-incremented (not a physical register)
FE5h
POSTDEC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-decremented (not a physical register)
FE4h
PREINC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
FE3h
PLUSW1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register) – value of
FSR1 offset by W
FE2h
FSR1H
FE1h
FSR1L
FE0h
BSR
FDFh
INDF2
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 High
—
Bank Select Register
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 Low Byte
—
—
—
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 not changed (not a physical register)
FDEh POSTINC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-incremented (not a physical register)
FDDh POSTDEC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-decremented (not a physical register)
FDCh PREINC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
FDBh PLUSW2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register) – value of
FSR2 offset by W
FDAh FSR2H
—
—
FD9h
FSR2L
FD8h
STATUS
FD7h
TMR0H
Timer0 Register High Byte
FD6h
TMR0L
Timer0 Register Low Byte
FD5h
T0CON
FD4h
Unimplemented
FD3h
OSCCON
FD2h
FD1h
FD0h
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 High
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 Low Byte
—
—
—
N
OV
Z
DC
C
T0PS0
TMR0ON
T08BIT
T0CS1
T0CS0
PSA
T0PS2
T0PS1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IDLEN
COSC2
COSC1
COSC0
—
NOSC2
NOSC1
NOSC0
IPR5
—
ACTORSIP
ACTLOCKIP
TMR8IP
—
TMR6IP
TMR5IP
TMR4IP
IOCF
IOCF7
IOCF6
IOCF5
IOCF4
IOCF3
IOCF2
IOCF1
IOCF0
RCON
IPEN
—
CM
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 128
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
File Name
FCFh
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
TMR1H
Timer1 Register High Byte
FCEh TMR1L
Timer1 Register Low Byte
FCDh T1CON
TMR1CS1
TMR1CS0
FCCh TMR2
Timer2 Register
FCBh PR2
Timer2 Period Register
FCAh T2CON
—
T2OUTPS3
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
SOSCEN
T1SYNC
RD16
TMR1ON
T2OUTPS2
T2OUTPS1
T2OUTPS0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
FC9h
SSP1BUF
MSSP1 Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
FC8h
SSP1ADD
MSSP1 Address Register in I2C Slave Mode. MSSP1 Baud Rate Reload Register in I2C Master Mode.
FC7h
SSP1STAT
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
FC6h
SSP1CON1
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
FC5h
SSP1CON2
GCEN
ACKSTAT
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
FC4h
CMSTAT
—
—
—
—
—
C3OUT
C2OUT
C1OUT
FC3h
ADCBUF0H
A/D Result Register 0 High Byte
FC2h
ADCBUF0L
A/D Result Register 0 Low Byte
FC1h
ADCON1H
ADON
—
—
—
—
MODE12
FORM1
FORM0
FC0h
ADCON1L
SSRC3
SSRC2
SSRC1
SSRC0
—
ASAM
SAMP
DONE
FBFh
CVRCONH
—
—
—
CVR4
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
FBEh
CVRCONL
CVREN
CVROE
CVRPSS1
CVRPSS0
—
—
—
CVRNSS
FBDh ECCP1AS
ECCP1ASE
ECCP1AS2
ECCP1AS1
ECCP1AS0
PSS1AC1
PSS1AC0
PSS1BD1
PSS1BD0
FBCh ECCP1DEL
P1RSEN
P1DC6
P1DC5
P1DC4
P1DC3
P1DC2
P1DC1
P1DC0
CCP1M0
FBBh
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 High Byte
FBAh
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register1 Low Byte
FB9h
CCP1CON
P1M1
P1M0
CCP1X
CCP1Y
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
FB8h
PIR5
—
ACTORSIF
ACTLOCKIF
TMR8IF
—
TMR6IF
TMR5IF
TMR4IF
FB7h
PIE5
—
ACTORSIE
ACTLOCKIE
TMR8IE
—
TMR6IE
TMR5IE
TMR4IE
FB6h
IPR4
CCP10IP
CCP9IP
CCP8IP
CCP7IP
CCP6IP
CCP5IP
CCP4IP
ECCP3IP
FB5h
PIR4
CCP10IF
CCP9IF
CCP8IF
CCP7IF
CCP6IF
CCP5IF
CCP4IF
ECCP3IF
FB4h
PIE4
CCP10IE
CCP9IE
CCP8IE
CCP7IE
CCP6IE
CCP5IE
CCP4IE
ECCP3IE
FB3h
TMR3H
Timer3 Register High Byte
FB2h
TMR3L
Timer3 Register Low Byte
FB1h
T3CON
TMR3CS1
TMR3CS0
T3CKPS1
T3CKPS0
SOSCEN
T3SYNC
RD16
TMR3ON
TMR3GE
T3GPOL
T3GTM
T3GSPM
T3GGO/T3DONE
T3GVAL
T3GSS1
T3GSS0
FB0h
T3GCON
FAFh
SPBRG1
EUSART1 Baud Rate Generator
FAEh
RCREG1
EUSART1 Receive Register
FADh
TXREG1
EUSART1 Transmit Register
FACh
TXSTA1
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
FABh
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
FAAh
T1GCON
TMR1GE
T1GPOL
T1GTM
T1GSPM
T1GGO/T1DONE
T1GVAL
T1GSS1
T1GSS0
FA9h
IPR6
RC4IP
TX4IP
RC3IP
TX3IP
—
CMP3IP
CMP2IP
CMP1IP
FA8h
HLVDCON
VDIRMAG
BGVST
IRVST
HLVDEN
HLVDL3
HLVDL2
HLVDL1
HLVDL0
FA7h
PSPCON
IBF
OBF
IBOV
PSPMODE
—
—
—
—
FA6h
PIR6
RC4IF
TX4IF
RC3IF
TX3IF
—
CMP3IF
CMP2IF
CMP1IF
FA5h
IPR3
TMR5GIP
LCDIP
RC2IP
TX2IP
CTMUIP
CCP2IP
CCP1IP
RTCCIP
FA4h
PIR3
TMR5GIF
LCDIF
RC2IF
TX2IF
CTMUIF
CCP2IF
CCP1IF
RTCCIF
FA3h
PIE3
TMR5GIE
LCDIE
RC2IE
TX2IE
CTMUIE
CCP2IE
CCP1IE
RTCCIE
FA2h
IPR2
OSCFIP
SSP2IP
BCL2IP
USBIP
BCL1IP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
TMR3GIP
FA1h
PIR2
OSCFIF
SSP2IF
BCL2IF
USBIF
BCL1IF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
TMR3GIF
FA0h
PIE2
OSCFIE
SSP2IE
BCL2IE
USBIE
BCL1IE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
TMR3GIE
F9Fh
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSP1IP
TMR1GIP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
F9Eh
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSP1IF
TMR1GIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
F9Dh
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSP1IE
TMR1GIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 129
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
STRA
F9Ch
PSTR1CON
CMPL1
CMPL0
—
STRSYNC
STRD
STRC
STRB
F9Bh
OSCTUNE
—
—
TUN5
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
F9Ah
TRISJ
TRISJ7
TRISJ6
TRISJ5
TRISJ4
TRISJ3
TRISJ2
TRISJ1
TRISJ0
F99h
TRISH
TRISH7
TRISH6
TRISH5
TRISH4
TRISH3
TRISH2
TRISH1
TRISH0
F98h
TRISG
TRISG7
TRISG6
—
TRISG4
TRISG3
TRISG2
TRISG1
TRISG0
F97h
TRISF
TRISF7
TRISF6
TRISF5
—
—
TRISF2
—
—
F96h
TRISE
TRISE7
TRISE6
TRISE5
TRISE4
TRISE3
TRISE2
TRISE1
TRISE0
F95h
TRISD
TRISD7
TRISD6
TRISD5
TRISD4
TRISD3
TRISD2
TRISD1
TRISD0
F94h
TRISC
TRISC7
TRISC6
TRISC5
TRISC4
TRISC3
TRISC2
—
—
F93h
TRISB
TRISB7
TRISB6
TRISB5
TRISB4
TRISB3
TRISB2
TRISB1
TRISB0
F92h
TRISA
TRISA7
TRISA6
TRISA5
TRISA4
TRISA3
TRISA2
TRISA1
TRISA0
F91h
LATJ
LATJ7
LATJ6
LATJ5
LATJ4
LATJ3
LATJ2
LATJ1
LATJ0
F90h
LATH
LATH7
LATH6
LATH5
LATH4
LATH3
LATH2
LATH1
LATH0
LATG0
F8Fh
LATG
LATG7
LATG6
—
LATG4
LATG3
LATG2
LATG1
F8Eh
LATF
LATF7
LATF6
LATF5
—
—
LATF2
—
—
F8Dh
LATE
LATE7
LATE6
LATE5
LATE4
LATE3
LATE2
LATE1
LATE0
F8Ch
LATD
LATD7
LATD6
LATD5
LATD4
LATD3
LATD2
LATD1
LATD0
F8Bh
LATC
LATC7
LATC6
LATC5
LATC4
LATC3
LATC2
—
—
F8Ah
LATB
LATB7
LATB6
LATB5
LATB4
LATB3
LATB2
LATB1
LATB0
F89h
LATA
LATA7
LATA6
LATA5
LATA4
LATA3
LATA2
LATA1
LATA0
F88h
PORTJ
RJ7
RJ6
RJ5
RJ4
RJ3
RJ2
RJ1
RJ0
F87h
PORTH
RH7
RH6
RH5
RH4
RH3
RH2
RH1
RH0
RG0
F86h
PORTG
RG7
RG6
—
RG4
RG3
RG2
RG1
F85h
PORTF
RF7
RF6
RF5
RF4
RF3
RF2
—
—
F84h
PORTE
RE7
RE6
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2
RE1
RE0
F83h
PORTD
RD7
RD6
RD5
RD4
RD3
RD2
RD1
RD0
F82h
PORTC
RC7
RC6
RC5
RC4
RC3
RC2
RC1
RC0
F81h
PORTB
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
F80h
PORTA
RA7
RA6
RA5
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
F7Fh
EECON1
—
—
WWPROG
FREE
WRERR
WREN
WR
—
F7Eh
EECON2
F7Dh
RCON2
EXTR
—
SWDTEN
—
—
—
—
—
F7Ch
RCON3
STKERR
—
—
—
VDDBOR
VDDPOR
VBPOR
VBAT
F7Bh
RCON4
—
—
—
SRETEN
—
DPSLP
—
PMSLP
F7Ah
UFRML
FRM7
FRM6
FRM5
FRM4
FRM3
FRM2
FRM1
FRM0
F79h
UFRMH
—
—
—
—
—
FRM10
FRM9
FRM8
F78h
UIR
—
SOFIF
STALLIF
IDLEIF
TRNIF
ACTVIF
UERRIF
URSTIF
EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
F77h
UEIR
BTSEF
—
—
BTOEF
DFN8EF
CRC16EF
CRC5EF
PIDEF
F76H
USTAT
—
ENDP3
ENDP2
ENDP1
ENDP0
DIR
PPBI
—
F75h
UCON
—
PPBRST
SE0
PKTDIS
USBEN
RESUME
SUSPND
—
F74h
UADDR
—
ADDR6
ADDR5
ADDR4
ADDR3
ADDR2
ADDR1
ADDR0
F73h
TRISVP
TRISVP7
TRISVP6
TRISVP5
TRISVP4
TRISVP3
TRISVP2
TRISVP1
TRISVP0
F72h
LATVP
LATVP7
LATVP6
LATVP5
LATVP4
LATVP3
LATVP2
LATVP1
LATVP0
F71h
PORTVP
RVP7
RVP6
RVP5
RVP4
RVP3
RVP2
RVP1
RVP0
F70h
TXADDRL
F6Fh
TXADDRH
F6Eh
RXADDRL
F6Dh
RXADDRH
F6Ch
DMABCL
F6Bh
DMABCH
F6Ah
TXBUF
Legend:
SPI DMA Transmit Data Pointer Low Byte
—
—
—
—
SPI DMA Transmit Data Pointer High Byte
—
SPI DMA Receive Data Pointer High Byte
SPI DMA Receive Data Pointer Low Byte
—
—
—
SPI DMA Byte Count Low Byte
—
—
—
—
—
—
TXBUF7
TXBUF6
TXBUF5
TXBUF4
TXBUF3
TXBUF2
SPI DMA Byte Count High Byte
TXBUF1
TXBUF0
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 130
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
DHEN
F69h
SSP1CON3
ACKTIM
PCIE
SCIE
BOEN
SDAHT
SBCDE
AHEN
F68h
SSP1MSK
MSK7
MSK6
MSK5
MSK4
MSK3
MSK2
MSK1
MSK0
F67h
BAUDCON1
ABDOVF
RCIDL
RXDTP
TXCKP
BRG16
IREN
WUE
ABDEN
F66h
OSCCON2
CLKLOCK
IOLOCK
LOCK
—
CF
POSCEN
SOSCGO
—
F65h
OSCCON3
—
—
—
—
—
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
F64h
OSCCON4
CPDIV1
CPDIV0
PLLEN
—
—
—
—
—
F63h
ACTCON
ACTEN
—
ACTSIDL
ACTSRC
ACTLOCK
ACTLOCKPOL
ACTORS
ACTORSPOL
F62h
WPUB
WPUB7
WPUB6
WPUB5
WPUB4
WPUB3
WPUB2
WPUB1
WPUB0
F61h
PIE6
RC4IE
TX4IE
RC3IE
TX3IE
—
CMP3IE
CMP2IE
CMP1IE
F60h
DMACON1
SSCON1
SSCON0
TXINC
RXINC
DUPLEX1
DUPLEX0
DLYINTEN
DMAEN
F5Fh
RTCCON1
RTCEN
—
RTCWREN
RTCSYNC
HALFSEC
RTCOE
RTCPTR1
RTCPTR0
CAL7
CAL6
CAL5
CAL4
CAL3
CAL2
CAL1
CAL0
F5Eh
RTCCAL
F5Dh
RTCVALH
RTCC Value High Register Window Based on RTCPTR
F5Ch
RTCVALL
RTCC Value Low Register Window Based on RTCPTR
F5Bh
ALRMCFG
ALRMEN
CHIME
AMASK3
AMASK2
AMASK1
AMASK0
ALRMPTR1
ALRMPTR0
F5Ah
ALRMRPT
ARPT7
ARPT6
ARPT5
ARPT4
ARPT3
ARPT2
ARPT1
ARPT0
F59h
ALRMVALH
Alarm Value High Register Window Based on APTR
F58h
ALRMVALL
Alarm Value Low Register Window Based on APTR
F57h
RTCCON2
PWCEN
PWCPOL
PWCCPRE
PWCSPRE
RTCCLKSEL1
F56h
IOCP
IOCP7
IOCP6
IOCP5
IOCP4
IOCP3
IOCP2
IOCP1
IOCP0
F55h
IOCN
IOCN7
IOCN6
IOCN5
IOCN4
IOCN3
IOCN2
IOCN1
IOCN0
F54h
PADCFG1
RDPU
REPU
RFPU
RGPU
RHPU
RJPU
RKPU
RLPU
F53h
CM1CON
CON
COE
CPOL
EVPOL1
EVPOL0
CREF
CCH1
CCH0
F52h
ECCP2AS
ECCP2ASE
ECCP2AS2
ECCP2AS1
ECCP2AS0
PSS2AC1
PSS2AC0
PSS2BD1
PSS2BD0
F51h
ECCP2DEL
P2RSEN
P2DC6
P2DC5
P2DC4
P2DC3
P2DC2
P2DC1
P2DC0
F50h
CCPR2H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte
F4Fh
CCPR2L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte
F4Eh
CCP2CON
P2M1
P2M0
CCP2X
CCP2Y
CCP2M3
CCP2M2
CCP2M1
CCP2M0
F4Dh
ECCP3AS
ECCP3ASE
ECCP3AS2
ECCP3AS1
ECCP3AS0
PSS3AC1
PSS3AC0
PSS3BD1
PSS3BD0
F4Ch
ECCP3DEL
P3RSEN
P3DC6
P3DC5
P3DC4
P3DC3
P3DC2
P3DC1
P3DC0
F4Bh
CCPR3H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte
F4Ah
CCPR3L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte
F49H
CCP3CON
CCP3Y
CCP3M3
CCP3M2
CCP3M1
CCP3M0
F48h
CCPR8H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 8 High Byte
F47h
CCPR8L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 8 Low Byte
F46h
CCP8CON
CCP8Y
CCP8M3
CCP8M2
CCP8M1
CCP8M0
F45h
CCPR9H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 9 High Byte
F44h
CCPR9L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 9 Low Byte
F43h
CCP9CON
CCP9Y
CCP9M3
CCP9M2
CCP9M1
CCP9M0
F42h
CCPR10H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 10 High Byte
F41h
CCPR10L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 10 Low Byte
F40h
CCP10CON
CCP10X
CCP10Y
CCP10M3
CCP10M2
CCP10M1
CCP10M0
F3Fh
TMR6
Timer6 Register
F3Eh
PR6
Timer6 Period Register
F3Dh
T6CON
T6OUTPS2
T6OUTPS1
T6OUTPS0
TMR6ON
T6CKPS1
T6CKPS0
F3Ch
TMR8
Timer8 Register
F3Bh
PR8
Timer8 Period Register
F3Ah
T8CON
F39H
SSP2CON3
F38h
F37h
P3M1
P3M0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
T6OUTPS3
CCP3X
CCP8X
CCP9X
RTCCLKSEL0 RTCSECSEL1 RTCSECSEL0
—
T8OUTPS3
T8OUTPS2
T8OUTPS1
T8OUTPS0
TMR8ON
T8CKPS1
T8CKPS0
ACKTIM
PCIE
SCIE
BOEN
SDAHT
SBCDE
AHEN
DHEN
CM2CON
CON
COE
CPOL
EVPOL1
EVPOL0
CREF
CCH1
CCH0
CM3CON
CON
COE
CPOL
EVPOL1
EVPOL0
CREF
CCH1
CCH0
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 131
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
F36h
CCPTMRS0
C3TSEL1
C3TSEL0
C2TSEL2
C2TSEL1
C2TSEL0
C1TSEL2
C1TSEL1
C1TSEL0
F35h
CCPTMRS1
C7TSEL1
C7TSEL0
—
C6TSEL0
—
C5TSEL0
C4TSEL1
C4TSEL0
F34h
CCPTMRS2
—
—
—
C10TSEL0
—
C9TSEL0
C8TSEL1
C8TSEL0
F33h
RCSTA2
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
F32h
TXSTA2
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
F31h
BAUDCON2
ABDOVF
RCIDL
RXDTP
TXCKP
BRG16
IREN
WUE
ABDEN
F30h
SPBRGH1
F2Fh
RCSTA3
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
F2Eh
TXSTA3
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
F2Dh
BAUDCON3
ABDOVF
RCIDL
RXDTP
TXCKP
BRG16
IREN
WUE
ABDEN
F2Ch
SPBRGH3
EUSART3 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
F2Bh
SPBRG3
EUSART3 Baud Rate Generator
EUSART1 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
F2Ah
RCREG3
EUSART3 Receive Data FIFO
F29H
TXREG3
EUSART3 Transmit Data FIFO
F28h
DSCONL
—
—
—
—
—
ULPWDIS
DSBOR
RELEASE
F27h
DSCONH
DSEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
RTCWDIS
F26h
DSWAKEL
DSFLT
BOR
DSULP
DSWDT
DSRTC
DSMCLR
DSICD
DSPOR
F25h
DSWAKEH
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DSINT0
F24h
DSGPR0
Deep Sleep General Purpose Register 0
F23h
DSGPR1
Deep Sleep General Purpose Register 1
F22h
DSGPR2
Deep Sleep General Purpose Register 2
F21h
DSGPR3
Deep Sleep General Purpose Register 3
F20h
SPBRGH2
EUSART2 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
F1Fh
SPBRG2
EUSART2 Baud Rate Generator
F1Eh
RCREG2
Receive Data FIFO
F1Dh
TXREG2
Transmit Data FIFO
F1Ch
PSTR2CON
CMPL1
CMPL0
—
STRSYNC
STRD
STRC
STRB
STRA
F1Bh
PSTR3CON
CMPL1
CMPL0
—
STRSYNC
STRD
STRC
STRB
STRA
F1Ah
SSP2STAT
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
F19h
SSP2CON1
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
F18h
SSP2CON2
GCEN
ACKSTAT
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
F17h
SSP2MSK
MSK7
MSK6
MSK5
MSK4
MSK3
MSK2
MSK1
MSK0
F16h
TMR5H
Timer5 Register High Byte
F15h
TMR5L
Timer5 Register Low Byte
F14h
T5CON
F13h
T5GCON
F12h
CCPR4H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 4 High Byte
F11h
CCPR4L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 4 Low Byte
F10h
CCP4CON
F0Fh
CCPR5H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 5 High Byte
F0Eh
CCPR5L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 5 Low Byte
F0Dh
CCP5CON
F0Ch
CCPR6H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 6 High Byte
F0Bh
CCPR6L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 6 Low Byte
F0Ah
CCP6CON
F09h
CCPR7H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 7 High Byte
F08h
CCPR7L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 7 Low Byte
F07h
CCP7CON
F06h
TMR4
Timer4 Register
F05h
PR4
Timer4 Period Register
F04h
T4CON
Legend:
TMR5CS1
TMR5CS0
T5CKPS1
T5CKPS0
SOSCEN
T5SYNC
RD16
TMR5ON
TMR5GE
T5GPOL
T5GTM
T5GSPM
T5GGO/T5DONE
T5GVAL
T5GSS1
T5GSS0
DC4B0
CCP4M3
CCP4M2
CCP4M1
CCP4M0
DC5B0
CCP5M3
CCP5M2
CCP5M1
CCP5M0
DC6B0
CCP6M3
CCP6M2
CCP6M1
CCP6M0
DC7B1
DC7B0
CCP7M3
CCP7M2
CCP7M1
CCP7M0
T4OUTPS2
T4OUTPS1
T4OUTPS0
TMR4ON
T4CKPS1
T4CKPS0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
T4OUTPS3
DC4B1
DC5B1
DC6B1
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 132
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
F03h
SSP2BUF
MSSP2 Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
F02h
SSP2ADD
MSSP2 Address Register in I2C Slave Mode. MSSP1 Baud Rate Reload Register in I2C Master Mode.
F01h
ANCFG
F00h
DMACON2
Bit 1
Bit 0
—
—
—
—
—
VBG6EN
VBG2EN
VBGEN
DLYCYC3
DLYCYC2
DLYCYC1
DLYCYC0
INTLVL3
INTLVL2
INTLVL1
INTLVL0
RX9D
EFFh
RCSTA4
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
EFEh
TXSTA4
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
ABDOVF
RCIDL
RXDTP
TXCKP
BRG16
IREN
WUE
ABDEN
EFDh BAUDCON4
EFCh SPBRGH4
EUSART4 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
EFBh
SPBRG4
EUSART4 Baud Rate Generator
EFAh
RCREG4
EUSART4 Receive Data FIFO
EF9h
TXREG4
EUSART4 Transmit Data FIFO
EF8h
CTMUCON1
CTMUEN
—
CTMUSIDL
TGEN
EDGEN
EDGSEQEN
IDISSEN
TRIGEN
EF7h
CTMUCON2
ITRIM5
ITRIM4
ITRIM3
ITRIM2
ITRIM1
ITRIM0
IRNG1
IRNG0
EF6h
CTMUCON3
EDG2EN
EDG2POL
EDG2SEL3
EDG2SEL2
EDG2SEL1
EDG2SEL0
—
—
EF5h
CTMUCON4
EDG1EN
EDG1POL
EDG1SEL3
EDG1SEL2
EDG1SEL1
EDG1SEL0
EDG2STAT
EDG1STAT
ECCP3MD
EF4h
PMD0
CCP10MD
CCP9MD
CCP8MD
CCP7MD
CCP6MD
CCP5MD
CCP4MD
EF3h
PMD1
ECCP2MD
ECCP1MD
UART4MD
UART3MD
UART2MD
UART1MD
SSP2MD
SSP1MD
EF2h
PMD2
TMR8MD
TMR6MD
TMR5MD
TMR4MD
TMR3MD
TMR2MD
TMR1MD
TMR0MD
EF1h
PMD3
DSMMD
CTMUMD
ADCMD
RTCCMD
LCDMD
PSPMD
REFO1MD
REFO2MD
EF0h
PMD4
CMP1MD
CMP2MD
CMP3MD
USBMD
IOCMD
LVDMD
—
EMBMD
EEFh
MDCON
MDEN
MDOE
MDSLR
MDOPOL
MDO
—
—
MDBIT
MDSODIS
—
—
—
MDSRC3
MDSRC2
MDSRC1
MDSRC0
EEDh MDCARH
MDCHODIS
MDCHPOL
MDCHSYNC
—
MDCH3
MDCH2
MDCH1
MDCH0
EECh MDCARL
MDCLODIS
MDCLPOL
MDCLSYNC
—
MDCL3
MDCL2
MDCL1
MDCL0
EEBh ODCON1
ECCP2OD
ECCP1OD
USART4OD
USART3OD
USART2OD
USART1OD
SSP2OD
SSP1OD
EEAh ODCON2
EEEh MDSRC
CCP10OD
CCP9OD
CCP8OD
CCP7OD
CCP6OD
CCP5OD
CCP4OD
ECCP3OD
EE9h
TRISK
TRISK7
TRISK6
TRISK5
TRISK4
TRISK3
TRISK2
TRISK1
TRISK0
EE8h
LATK
LATK7
LATK6
LATK5
LATK4
LATK3
LATK2
LATK1
LATK0
EE7h
PORTK
RK7
RK6
RK5
RK4
RK3
RK2
RK1
RK0
EE6h
TRISL
TRISL7
TRISL6
TRISL5
TRISL4
TRISL3
TRISL2
TRISL1
TRISL0
EE5h
LATL
LATL7
LATL6
LATL5
LATL4
LATL3
LATL2
LATL1
LATL0
EE4h
PORTL
RL7
RL6
RL5
RL4
RL3
RL2
RL1
RL0
EE3h
MEMCON
EBDIS
—
WAIT1
WAIT0
—
—
WM1
WM0
EE2h
REFO1CON
ON
—
SIDL
OE
RSLP
—
DIVSWEN
ACTIVE
EE1h
REFO1CON1
—
—
—
—
ROSEL3
ROSEL2
ROSEL1
ROSEL0
EE0h
REFO1CON2
RODIV7
RODIV6
RODIV5
RODIV4
RODIV3
RODIV2
RODIV1
RODIV0
EDFh REFO1CON3
—
RODIV14
RODIV13
RODIV12
RODIV11
RODIV10
RODIV9
RODIV8
EDEh REFO2CON
ON
—
SIDL
OE
RSLP
—
DIVSWEN
ACTIVE
EDDh REFO2CON1
—
—
—
—
ROSEL3
ROSEL2
ROSEL1
ROSEL0
EDCh REFO2CON2
RODIV7
RODIV6
RODIV5
RODIV4
RODIV3
RODIV2
RODIV1
RODIV0
EDBh REFO2CON3
—
RODIV14
RODIV13
RODIV12
RODIV11
RODIV10
RODIV9
RODIV8
WFT
BIASMD
LCDA
WA
LP3
LP2
LP1
LP0
LCDEN
SLPEN
WERR
CS1
CS0
LMUX2
LMUX1
LMUX0
EDAh LCDPS
ED9h
LCDCON
ED8h
LCDREG
CPEN
—
BIAS2
BIAS1
BIAS0
MODE13
CLKSEL1
CLKSEL0
ED7h
LCDREF
LCDIRE
—
LCDCST2
LCDCST1
LCDCST0
VLCD3PE
VLCD2PE
VLCD1PE
ED6h
LCDRL
LRLAP1
LRLAP0
LRLBP1
LRLBP0
—
LRLAT2
LRLAT1
LRLAT0
ED5h
LCDSE7
SE63
SE62
SE61
SE60
SE59
SE58
SE57
SE56
ED4h
LCDSE6
SE55
SE54
SE53
SE52
SE51
SE50
SE49
SE48
ED3h
LCDSE5
SE47
SE46
SE45
SE44
SE43
SE42
SE41
SE40
ED2h
LCDSE4
SE39
SE38
S37
SE36
SE35
SE34
SE33
SE32
ED1h
LCDSE3
SE31
SE30
SE29
SE28
SE27
SE26
SE25
SE24
ED0h
LCDSE2
SE23
SE22
SE21
SE20
SE19
SE18
SE17
SE16
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 133
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
ECFh LCDSE1
SE15
SE14
SE13
SE12
SE11
SE10
SE09
SE08
ECEh LCDSE0
SE07
SE06
SE05
SE04
SE03
SE02
SE01
SE00
ECDh LCDDATA63
S63C7
S62C7
S61C7
S60C7
S59C7
S58C7
S57C7
S56C7
ECCh LCDDATA62
S55C7
S54C7
S53C7
S52C7
S51C7
S50C7
S49C7
S48C7
ECBh LCDDATA61
S47C7
S46C7
S45C7
S44C7
S43C7
S42C7
S41C7
S40C7
ECAh LCDDATA60
S39C7
S38C7
S37C7
S36C7
S35C7
S34C7
S33C7
S32C7
EC9h
LCDDATA59
S31C7
S30C7
S29C7
S28C7
S27C7
S26C7
S25C7
S24C7
EC8h
LCDDATA58
S23C7
S22C7
S21C7
S20C7
S19C7
S18C7
S17C7
S16C7
EC7h
LCDDATA57
S15C7
S14C7
S13C7
S12C7
S11C7
S10C7
S09C7
S08C7
EC6h
LCDDATA56
S07C7
S06C7
S05C7
S04C7
S03C7
S02C7
S01C7
S00C7
EC5h
LCDDATA55
S63C6
S62C6
S61C6
S60C6
S59C6
S58C6
S57C6
S56C6
EC4h
LCDDATA54
S55C6
S54C6
S53C6
S52C6
S51C6
S50C6
S49C6
S48C6
EC3h
LCDDATA53
S47C6
S46C6
S45C6
S44C6
S43C6
S42C6
S41C6
S40C6
EC2h
LCDDATA52
S39C6
S38C6
S37C6
S36C6
S35C6
S34C6
S33C6
S32C6
EC1h
LCDDATA51
S31C6
S30C6
S29C6
S28C6
S27C6
S26C6
S25C6
S24C6
EC0h
LCDDATA50
S23C6
S22C6
S21C6
S20C6
S19C6
S18C6
S17C6
S16C6
EBFh
LCDDATA49
S15C6
S14C6
S13C6
S12C6
S11C6
S10C6
S09C6
S08C6
EBEh LCDDATA48
S07C6
S06C6
S05C6
S04C6
S03C6
S02C6
S01C6
S00C6
EBDh LCDDATA47
S63C5
S62C5
S61C5
S60C5
S59C5
S58C5
S57C5
S56C5
EBCh LCDDATA46
S55C5
S54C5
S53C5
S52C5
S51C5
S50C5
S49C5
S48C5
EBBh LCDDATA45
S47C5
S46C5
S45C5
S44C5
S43C5
S42C5
S41C5
S40C5
EBAh LCDDATA44
S39C5
S38C5
S37C5
S36C5
S35C5
S34C5
S33C5
S32C5
EB9h
LCDDATA43
S31C5
S30C5
S29C5
S28C5
S27C5
S26C5
S25C5
S24C5
EB8h
LCDDATA42
S23C5
S22C5
S21C5
S20C5
S19C5
S18C5
S17C5
S16C5
EB7h
LCDDATA41
S15C5
S14C5
S13C5
S12C5
S11C5
S10C5
S09C5
S08C5
EB6h
LCDDATA40
S07C5
S06C5
S05C5
S04C5
S03C5
S02C5
S01C5
S00C5
EB5h
LCDDATA39
S63C4
S62C4
S61C4
S60C4
S59C4
S58C4
S57C4
S56C4
EB4h
LCDDATA38
S55C4
S54C4
S53C4
S52C4
S51C4
S50C4
S49C4
S48C4
EB3h
LCDDATA37
S47C4
S46C4
S45C4
S44C4
S43C4
S42C4
S41C4
S40C4
EB2h
LCDDATA36
S39C4
S38C4
S37C4
S36C4
S35C4
S34C4
S33C4
S32C4
EB1h
LCDDATA35
S31C4
S30C4
S29C4
S28C4
S27C4
S26C4
S25C4
S24C4
EB0h
LCDDATA34
S23C4
S22C4
S21C4
S20C4
S19C4
S18C4
S17C4
S16C4
EAFh
LCDDATA33
S15C4
S14C4
S13C4
S12C4
S11C4
S10C4
S09C4
S08C4
EAEh LCDDATA32
S07C4
S06C4
S05C4
S04C4
S03C4
S02C4
S01C4
S00C4
EADh LCDDATA31
S63C3
S62C3
S61C3
S60C3
S59C3
S58C3
S57C3
S56C3
EACh LCDDATA30
S55C3
S54C3
S53C3
S52C3
S51C3
S50C3
S49C3
S48C3
EABh LCDDATA29
S47C3
S46C3
S45C3
S44C3
S43C3
S42C3
S41C3
S40C3
EAAh LCDDATA28
S39C3
S38C3
S37C3
S36C3
S35C3
S34C3
S33C3
S32C3
EA9h
LCDDATA27
S31C3
S30C3
S29C3
S28C3
S27C3
S26C3
S25C3
S24C3
EA8h
LCDDATA26
S23C3
S22C3
S21C3
S20C3
S19C3
S18C3
S17C3
S16C3
EA7h
LCDDATA25
S15C3
S14C3
S13C3
S12C3
S11C3
S10C3
S09C3
S08C3
EA6h
LCDDATA24
S07C3
S06C3
S05C3
S04C3
S03C3
S02C3
S01C3
S00C3
EA5h
LCDDATA23
S63C2
S62C2
S61C2
S60C2
S59C2
S58C2
S57C2
S56C2
EA4h
LCDDATA22
S55C2
S54C2
S53C2
S52C2
S51C2
S50C2
S49C2
S48C2
EA3h
LCDDATA21
S47C2
S46C2
S45C2
S44C2
S43C2
S42C2
S41C2
S40C2
EA2h
LCDDATA20
S39C2
S38C2
S37C2
S36C2
S35C2
S34C2
S33C2
S32C2
EA1h
LCDDATA19
S31C2
S30C2
S29C2
S28C2
S27C2
S26C2
S25C2
S24C2
EA0h
LCDDATA18
S23C2
S22C2
S21C2
S20C2
S19C2
S18C2
S17C2
S16C2
E9Fh
LCDDATA17
S15C2
S14C2
S13C2
S12C2
S11C2
S10C2
S09C2
S08C2
E9Eh
LCDDATA16
S07C2
S06C2
S05C2
S04C2
S03C2
S02C2
S01C2
S00C2
E9Dh
LCDDATA15
S63C1
S62C1
S61C1
S60C1
S59C1
S58C1
S57C1
S56C1
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 134
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
E9Ch
LCDDATA14
S55C1
S54C1
S53C1
S52C1
S51C1
S50C1
S49C1
S48C1
E9Bh
LCDDATA13
S47C1
S46C1
S45C1
S44C1
S43C1
S42C1
S41C1
S40C1
E9Ah
LCDDATA12
S39C1
S38C1
S37C1
S36C1
S35C1
S34C1
S33C1
S32C1
E99h
LCDDATA11
S31C1
S30C1
S29C1
S28C1
S27C1
S26C1
S25C1
S24C1
E98h
LCDDATA10
S23C1
S22C1
S21C1
S20C1
S19C1
S18C1
S17C1
S16C1
E97h
LCDDATA9
S15C1
S14C1
S13C1
S12C1
S11C1
S10C1
S09C1
S08C1
E96h
LCDDATA8
S07C1
S06C1
S05C1
S04C1
S03C1
S02C1
S01C1
S00C1
E95h
LCDDATA7
S63C0
S62C0
S61C0
S60C0
S59C0
S58C0
S57C0
S56C0
E94h
LCDDATA6
S55C0
S54C0
S53C0
S52C0
S51C0
S50C0
S49C0
S48C0
E93h
LCDDATA5
S47C0
S46C0
S45C0
S44C0
S43C0
S42C0
S41C0
S40C0
E92h
LCDDATA4
S39C0
S38C0
S37C0
S36C0
S35C0
S34C0
S33C0
S32C0
E91h
LCDDATA3
S31C0
S30C0
S29C0
S28C0
S27C0
S26C0
S25C0
S24C0
E90h
LCDDATA2
S23C0
S22C0
S21C0
S20C0
S19C0
S18C0
S17C0
S16C0
E8Fh
LCDDATA1
S15C0
S14C0
S13C0
S12C0
S11C0
S10C0
S09C0
S08C0
E8Eh
LCDDATA0
S07C0
S06C0
S05C0
S04C0
S03C0
S02C0
S01C0
S00C0
E8Dh
ADCON2H
PVCFG1
PVCFG0
NVCFG0
OFFCAL
BUFREGEN
CSCNA
—
—
E8Ch
ADCON2L
BUFS
SMPI4
SMPI3
SMPI2
SMPI1
SMPI0
BUFM
ALTS
SAMC0
E8Bh
ADCON3H
ADRC
EXTSAM
PUMPEN
SAMC4
SAMC3
SAMC2
SAMC1
E8Ah
ADCON3L
ADCS7
ADCS6
ADCS5
ADCS4
ADCS3
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
E89h
ADCON5H
ASENA
LPENA
CTMUREQ
—
—
—
ASINTMD1
ASINTMD0
E88h
ADCON5L
—
—
—
—
WM1
WM0
CM1
CM0
E87h
ADCHS0H
CH0NB2
CH0NB1
CH0NB0
CH0SB4
CH0SB3
CH0SB2
CH0SB1
CH0SB0
E86h
ADCHS0L
CH0NA2
CH0NA1
CH0NA0
CH0SA4
CH0SA3
CH0SA2
CH0SA1
CH0SA0
E85h
ADCSS1H
—
CSS30
CSS29
CSS28
CSS27
CSS26
CSS25
CSS24
E84h
ADCSS1L
CSS23
CSS22
CSS21
CSS20
CSS19
CSS18
CSS17
CSS16
E83h
ADCSS0H
CSS15
CSS14
CSS13
CSS12
CSS11
CSS10
CSS9
CSS8
E82h
ADCSS0L
CSS7
CSS6
CSS5
CSS4
CSS3
CSS2
CSS1
CSS0
E81h
ADCHIT1H
—
CHH30
CHH29
CHH28
CHH27
CHH26
CHH25
CHH24
CHH16
E80h
ADCHIT1L
CHH23
CHH22
CHH21
CHH20
CHH19
CHH18
CHH17
E7Fh
ADCHIT0H
CHH15
CHH14
CHH13
CHH12
CHH11
CHH10
CHH9
CHH8
E7Eh
ADCHIT0L
CHH7
CHH6
CHH5
CHH4
CHH3
CHH2
CHH1
CHH0
E7Dh
ADCTMUEN1H
—
CTMUEN30
CTMUEN29
CTMUEN28
CTMUEN27
CTMUEN26
CTMUEN25
CTMUEN24
E7Ch
ADCTMUEN1L
CTMUEN23
CTMUEN22
CTMUEN21
CTMUEN20
CTMUEN19
CTMUEN18
CTMUEN17
CTMUEN16
E7Bh
ADCTMUEN0H
CTMUEN15
CTMUEN14
CTMUEN13
CTMUEN12
CTMUEN11
CTMUEN10
CTMUEN9
CTMUEN8
E7Ah
ADCTMUEN0L
CTMUEN7
CTMUEN6
CTMUEN5
CTMUEN4
CTMUEN3
CTMUEN2
CTMUEN1
CTMUEN0
E79h
ADCBUF25H
A/D Result Register 25 High Byte
E78h
ADCBUF25L
A/D Result Register 25 Low Byte
E77h
ADCBUF24H
A/D Result Register 24 High Byte
E76h
ADCBUF24L
A/D Result Register 24 Low Byte
E75h
ADCBUF23H
A/D Result Register 23 High Byte
E74h
ADCBUF23L
A/D Result Register 23 Low Byte
E73h
ADCBUF22H
A/D Result Register 22 High Byte
E72h
ADCBUF22L
A/D Result Register 22 Low Byte
E71h
ADCBUF21H
A/D Result Register 21 High Byte
E70h
ADCBUF21L
A/D Result Register 21 Low Byte
E6Fh
ADCBUF20H
A/D Result Register 20 High Byte
E6Eh
ADCBUF20L
A/D Result Register 20 Low Byte
E6Dh
ADCBUF19H
A/D Result Register 19 High Byte
E6Ch
ADCBUF19L
A/D Result Register 19 Low Byte
E6Bh
ADCBUF18H
A/D Result Register 18 High Byte
E6Ah
ADCBUF18L
A/D Result Register 18 Low Byte
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 135
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
E69h
ADCBUF17H
E68h
ADCBUF17L
A/D Result Register 17 Low Byte
E67h
ADCBUF16H
A/D Result Register 16 High Byte
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
A/D Result Register 17 High Byte
E66h
ADCBUF16L
A/D Result Register 16 Low Byte
E65h
ADCBUF15H
A/D Result Register 15 High Byte
E64h
ADCBUF15L
A/D Result Register 15 Low Byte
E63h
ADCBUF14H
A/D Result Register 14 High Byte
E62h
ADCBUF14L
A/D Result Register 14 Low Byte
E61h
ADCBUF13H
A/D Result Register 13 High Byte
E60h
ADCBUF13L
A/D Result Register 13 Low Byte
E5Fh
ADCBUF12H
A/D Result Register 12 High Byte
E5Eh
ADCBUF12L
A/D Result Register 12 Low Byte
E5Dh
ADCBUF11H
A/D Result Register 11 High Byte
E5Ch
ADCBUF11L
A/D Result Register 11 Low Byte
E5Bh
ADCBUF10H
A/D Result Register 10 High Byte
E5Ah
ADCBUF10L
A/D Result Register 10 Low Byte
E59h
ADCBUF9H
A/D Result Register 9 High Byte
E58h
ADCBUF9L
A/D Result Register 9 Low Byte
E57h
ADCBUF8H
A/D Result Register 8 High Byte
E56h
ADCBUF8L
A/D Result Register 8 Low Byte
E55h
ADCBUF7H
A/D Result Register 7 High Byte
E54h
ADCBUF7L
A/D Result Register 7 Low Byte
E53h
ADCBUF6H
A/D Result Register 6 High Byte
E52h
ADCBUF6L
A/D Result Register 6 Low Byte
E51h
ADCBUF5H
A/D Result Register 5 High Byte
E50h
ADCBUF5L
A/D Result Register 5 Low Byte
E4Fh
ADCBUF4H
A/D Result Register 4 High Byte
E4Eh
ADCBUF4L
A/D Result Register 4 Low Byte
E4Dh
ADCBUF3H
A/D Result Register 3 High Byte
E4Ch
ADCBUF3L
A/D Result Register 3 Low Byte
E4Bh
ADCBUF2H
A/D Result Register 2 High Byte
E4Ah
ADCBUF2L
A/D Result Register 2 Low Byte
E49h
ADCBUF1H
A/D Result Register 1 High Byte
E48h
ADCBUF1L
A/D Result Register 1 Low Byte
E47h
ANCON1
ANSEL7
ANSEL6
ANSEL5
ANSEL4
ANSEL3
ANSEL2
ANSEL1
ANSEL0
E46h
ANCON2
ANSEL15
ANSEL14
ANSEL13
ANSEL12
ANSEL11
ANSEL10
ANSEL9
ANSEL8
E45h
ANCON3
ANSEL23
ANSEL22
ANSEL21
ANSEL20
ANSEL19
ANSEL18
ANSEL17
ANSEL16
E44h
RPINR52_53
PBIO7R
PBIO6R
E43h
RPINR50_51
PBIO5R
PBIO4R
E42h
RPINR48_49
PBIO3R
PBIO2R
E41h
RPINR46_47
PBIO1R
PBIO0R
E40h
RPINR44_45
T5CKIR
T5GR
E3Fh
RPINR42_43
T3CKIR
T3GR
E3Eh
RPINR40_41
T1CKIR
T1GR
E3Dh
RPINR38_39
T0CKIR
CCP10R
E3Ch
RPINR36_37
CCP9R
CCP8R
E3Bh
RPINR34_35
CCP7R
CCP6R
E3Ah
RPINR32_33
CCP5R
CCP4R
E39h
RPINR30_31
MDCIN2R
MDCIN1R
E38h
RPINR28_29
MDMINR
INT3R
E37h
RPINR26_27
INT2R
INT1R
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 136
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
E36h
RPINR24_25
IOC7R
IOC6R
E35h
RPINR22_23
IOC5R
IOC4R
E34h
RPINR20_21
IOC3R
IOC2R
E33h
RPINR18_19
IOC1R
IOC0R
E32h
RPINR16_17
ECCP3R
ECCP2R
E31h
RPINR14_15
ECCP1R
FLT0R
E30h
RPINR12_13
SS2R
SDI2R
E2Fh
RPINR10_11
SCK2R
SS1R
E2Eh
RPINR8_9
SDI1R
SCK1R
E2Dh
RPINR6_7
U4TXR
U4RXR
E2Ch
RPINR4_5
U3TXR
U3RXR
E2Bh
RPINR2_3
U2TXR
U2RXR
E2Ah
RPINR0_1
E29h
RPOR46
E28h
RPOR44_45
RPO45R
RPO44R
E27h
RPOR42_43
RPO43R
RPO42R
E26h
RPOR40_41
RPO41R
RPO40R
E25h
RPOR38_39
RPO39R
RPO38R
E24h
RPOR36_37
RPO37R
RPO36R
E23h
RPOR34_35
RPO35R
RPO34R
E22h
RPOR32_33
RPO33R
RPO32R
E21h
RPOR30_31
RPO31R
RPO30R
E20h
RPOR28_29
RPO29R
RPO28R
E1Fh
RPOR26_27
RPO27R
RPO26R
E1Eh
RPOR24_25
RPO25R
RPO24R
E1Dh
RPOR22_23
RPP23R
RPO22R
E1Ch
RPOR20_21
RPO21R
RPO20R
E1Bh
RPOR18_19
RPO19R
RPO18R
E1Ah
RPOR16_17
RPO17R
RPO16R
E19h
RPOR14_15
RPO15R
RPO14R
E18h
RPOR12_13
RPO13R
RPO12R
E17h
RPOR10_11
RPO11R
RPO10R
E16h
RPOR8_9
RPO9R
RPO8R
E15h
RPOR6_7
RPO7R
RPO6R
E14h
RPOR4_5
RPO5R
RPO4R
E13h
RPOR2_3
RPO3R
RPO2R
E12h
RPOR0_1
RPO1R
E11h
UCFG
E10h
UIE
U1TXR
—
—
—
Bit 0
U1RXR
—
RPO46R
RPO0R
UTEYE
UOEMON
—
UPUEN
UTRDIS
FSEN
PPB1
PPB0
—
SOFIE
STALLIE
IDLEIE
TRNIE
ACTVIE
UERRIE
URSTIE
E0Fh
UEIE
BTSEE
—
—
BTOEE
DFN8EE
CRC16EE
CRC5EE
PIDEE
E0Eh
UEP15
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E0Dh
UEP14
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E0Ch
UEP13
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E0Bh
UEP12
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E0Ah
UEP11
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E09h
UEP10
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E08h
UEP9
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E07h
UEP8
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E06h
UEP7
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E05h
UEP6
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E04h
UEP5
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 137
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 6-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (CONTINUED)
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
E03h
UEP4
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E02h
UEP3
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E01h
UEP2
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
E00h
UEP1
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
DFFh
UEP0
—
—
—
EPHSHK
EPCONDIS
EPOUTEN
EPINEN
EPSTALL
DFEh Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DFDh Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DFCh Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DFBh Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DFAh
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Unimplemented
Legend:
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 138
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.3.5
STATUS REGISTER
The STATUS register, shown in Register 6-2, contains
the arithmetic status of the ALU. The STATUS register
can be the operand for any instruction, as with any
other register. If the STATUS register is the destination
for an instruction that affects the Z, DC, C, OV or N bits,
the write to these five bits is disabled.
These bits are set or cleared according to the device
logic. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the
STATUS register as destination may be different than
intended. For example, CLRF STATUS will set the Z bit
but leave the other bits unchanged. The STATUS
register then reads back as ‘000u u1uu’.
REGISTER 6-2:
U-0
For other instructions not affecting any Status bits, see
the instruction set summaries in Table 29-2 and
Table 29-3.
Note:
The C and DC bits operate, in subtraction,
as borrow and digit borrow bits, respectively.
STATUS REGISTER
U-0
—
It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF,
SWAPF, MOVFF and MOVWF instructions be used to
alter the STATUS register because these instructions
do not affect the Z, C, DC, OV or N bits in the STATUS
register.
—
U-0
—
R/W-x
N
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
Z
DC(1)
C(2)
OV
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
N: Negative bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates whether the result was negative
(ALU MSB = 1).
1 = Result was negative
0 = Result was positive
bit 3
OV: Overflow bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates an overflow of the seven-bit
magnitude which causes the sign bit (bit 7) to change state.
1 = Overflow occurred for signed arithmetic (in this arithmetic operation)
0 = No overflow occurred
bit 2
Z: Zero bit
1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
bit 1
DC: Digit Carry/Borrow bit(1)
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW and SUBWF instructions:
1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result
bit 0
C: Carry/Borrow bit(2)
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW and SUBWF instructions:
1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
Note 1:
2:
For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the 2’s complement of the second
operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either bit 4 or bit 3 of the source register.
For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the 2’s complement of the second
operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high or low-order bit of the
source register.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 139
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.4
Data Addressing Modes
Note:
The execution of some instructions in the
core PIC18 instruction set are changed
when the PIC18 extended instruction set is
enabled. For more information, see
Section 6.6 “Data Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set”.
While the program memory can be addressed in only
one way, through the Program Counter, information in
the data memory space can be addressed in several
ways. For most instructions, the addressing mode is
fixed. Other instructions may use up to three modes,
depending on which operands are used and whether or
not the extended instruction set is enabled.
The addressing modes are:
•
•
•
•
Inherent
Literal
Direct
Indirect
An additional addressing mode, Indexed Literal Offset,
is available when the extended instruction set is
enabled (XINST Configuration bit = 1). For details on
this mode’s operation, see Section 6.6.1 “Indexed
Addressing with Literal Offset”.
6.4.1
INHERENT AND LITERAL
ADDRESSING
Many PIC18 control instructions do not need any
argument at all. They either perform an operation that
globally affects the device or they operate implicitly on
one register. This addressing mode is known as Inherent
Addressing. Examples of this mode include SLEEP,
RESET and DAW.
Other instructions work in a similar way, but require an
additional explicit argument in the opcode. This method
is known as the Literal Addressing mode because the
instructions require some literal value as an argument.
Examples of this include ADDLW and MOVLW which,
respectively, add or move a literal value to the W
register. Other examples include CALL and GOTO,
which include a 20-bit program memory address.
6.4.2
DIRECT ADDRESSING
Direct Addressing specifies all or part of the source
and/or destination address of the operation within the
opcode itself. The options are specified by the
arguments accompanying the instruction.
In the core PIC18 instruction set, bit-oriented and byteoriented instructions use some version of Direct
Addressing by default. All of these instructions include
some 8-bit literal address as their Least Significant
Byte. This address specifies the instruction’s data
source as either a register address in one of the banks
DS30000575C-page 140
of data RAM (see Section 6.3.3 “General Purpose
Register File”) or a location in the Access Bank (see
Section 6.3.2 “Access Bank”).
The Access RAM bit, ‘a’, determines how the address
is interpreted. When ‘a’ is ‘1’, the contents of the BSR
(Section 6.3.1 “Bank Select Register”) are used with
the address to determine the complete 12-bit address
of the register. When ‘a’ is ‘0’, the address is interpreted
as being a register in the Access Bank. Addressing that
uses the Access RAM is sometimes also known as
Direct Forced Addressing mode.
A few instructions, such as MOVFF, include the entire
12-bit address (either source or destination) in their
opcodes. In these cases, the BSR is ignored entirely.
The destination of the operation’s results is determined
by the destination bit, ‘d’. When ‘d’ is ‘1’, the results are
stored back in the source register, overwriting its original contents. When ‘d’ is ‘0’, the results are stored in
the W register. Instructions without the ‘d’ argument
have a destination that is implicit in the instruction,
either the target register being operated on or the W
register.
6.4.3
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Indirect Addressing allows the user to access a location
in data memory without giving a fixed address in the
instruction. This is done by using File Select Registers
(FSRs) as pointers to the locations to be read or written
to. Since the FSRs are themselves located in RAM as
Special Function Registers, they can also be directly
manipulated under program control. This makes FSRs
very useful in implementing data structures such as
tables and arrays in data memory.
The registers for Indirect Addressing are also
implemented with Indirect File Operands (INDFs) that
permit automatic manipulation of the pointer value with
auto-incrementing, auto-decrementing or offsetting
with another value. This allows for efficient code using
loops, such as the example of clearing an entire RAM
bank in Example 6-5. It also enables users to perform
Indexed Addressing and other Stack Pointer
operations for program memory in data memory.
EXAMPLE 6-5:
NEXT
LFSR
CLRF
BTFSS
BRA
CONTINUE
HOW TO CLEAR RAM
(BANK 1) USING
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
FSR0, 100h ;
POSTINC0
; Clear INDF
; register then
; inc pointer
FSR0H, 1
; All done with
; Bank1?
NEXT
; NO, clear next
; YES, continue
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.4.3.1
FSR Registers and the
INDF Operand
mapped in the SFR space, but are not physically implemented. Reading or writing to a particular INDF register
actually accesses its corresponding FSR register pair.
A read from INDF1, for example, reads the data at the
address indicated by FSR1H:FSR1L.
At the core of Indirect Addressing are three sets of
registers: FSR0, FSR1 and FSR2. Each represents a
pair of 8-bit registers: FSRnH and FSRnL. The four
upper bits of the FSRnH register are not used, so each
FSR pair holds a 12-bit value. This represents a value
that can address the entire range of the data memory
in a linear fashion. The FSR register pairs, then, serve
as pointers to data memory locations.
Instructions that use the INDF registers as operands
actually use the contents of their corresponding FSR as
a pointer to the instruction’s target. The INDF operand
is just a convenient way of using the pointer.
Because Indirect Addressing uses a full 12-bit address,
data RAM banking is not necessary. Thus, the current
contents of the BSR and the Access RAM bit have no
effect on determining the target address.
Indirect Addressing is accomplished with a set of Indirect File Operands, INDF0 through INDF2. These can
be thought of as “virtual” registers. The operands are
FIGURE 6-8:
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
000h
Using an instruction with one of the
Indirect Addressing registers as the
operand....
Bank 0
ADDWF, INDF1, 1
100h
Bank 1
200h
...uses the 12-bit address stored in
the FSR pair associated with that
register....
300h
FSR1H:FSR1L
7
0
x x x x 1 1 1 1
7
Bank 2
0
1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0
Bank 3
through
Bank 13
...to determine the data memory
location to be used in that operation.
In this case, the FSR1 pair contains
FCCh. This means the contents of
location FCCh will be added to that
of the W register and stored back in
FCCh.
E00h
Bank 14
F00h
FFFh
Bank 15
Data Memory
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 141
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.4.3.2
FSR Registers and POSTINC,
POSTDEC, PREINC and PLUSW
In addition to the INDF operand, each FSR register pair
also has four additional indirect operands. Like INDF,
these are “virtual” registers that cannot be indirectly
read or written to. Accessing these registers actually
accesses the associated FSR register pair, but also
performs a specific action on its stored value.
These operands are:
• POSTDEC – Accesses the FSR value, then
automatically decrements it by ‘1’ afterwards
• POSTINC – Accesses the FSR value, then
automatically increments it by ‘1’ afterwards
• PREINC – Increments the FSR value by ‘1’, then
uses it in the operation
• PLUSW – Adds the signed value of the W register
(range of -127 to 128) to that of the FSR and uses
the new value in the operation
In this context, accessing an INDF register uses the
value in the FSR registers without changing them.
Similarly, accessing a PLUSW register gives the FSR
value, offset by the value in the W register, with neither
value actually changed in the operation. Accessing the
other virtual registers changes the value of the FSR
registers.
Operations on the FSRs with POSTDEC, POSTINC
and PREINC affect the entire register pair. Rollovers of
the FSRnL register, from FFh to 00h, carry over to the
FSRnH register. On the other hand, results of these
operations do not change the value of any flags in the
STATUS register (for example, Z, N and OV bits).
The PLUSW register can be used to implement a form
of Indexed Addressing in the data memory space. By
manipulating the value in the W register, users can
reach addresses that are fixed offsets from pointer
addresses. In some applications, this can be used to
implement some powerful program control structure,
such as software stacks, inside of data memory.
DS30000575C-page 142
6.4.3.3
Operations by FSRs on FSRs
Indirect Addressing operations that target other FSRs
or virtual registers represent special cases. For
example, using an FSR to point to one of the virtual
registers will not result in successful operations.
As a specific case, assume that the FSR0H:FSR0L
registers contain FE7h, the address of INDF1.
Attempts to read the value of the INDF1, using INDF0
as an operand, will return 00h. Attempts to write to
INDF1, using INDF0 as the operand, will result in a
NOP.
On the other hand, using the virtual registers to write to
an FSR pair may not occur as planned. In these cases,
the value will be written to the FSR pair, but without any
incrementing or decrementing. Thus, writing to INDF2
or POSTDEC2 will write the same value to the
FSR2H:FSR2L.
Since the FSRs are physical registers mapped in the
SFR space, they can be manipulated through all direct
operations. Users should proceed cautiously when
working on these registers, however, particularly if their
code uses Indirect Addressing.
Similarly, operations by Indirect Addressing are generally permitted on all other SFRs. Users should exercise
the appropriate caution, so that they do not inadvertently
change settings that might affect the operation of the
device.
6.5
Program Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set
The operation of program memory is unaffected by the
use of the extended instruction set.
Enabling the extended instruction set adds five
additional two-word commands to the existing PIC18
instruction set: ADDFSR, CALLW, MOVSF, MOVSS and
SUBFSR. These instructions are executed as described
in Section 6.2.4 “Two-Word Instructions”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.6
Data Memory and the Extended
Instruction Set
6.6.2
INSTRUCTIONS AFFECTED BY
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set (XINST
Configuration bit = 1) significantly changes certain
aspects of data memory and its addressing. Using the
Access Bank for many of the core PIC18 instructions
introduces a new addressing mode for the data memory
space. This mode also alters the behavior of Indirect
Addressing using FSR2 and its associated operands.
Any of the core PIC18 instructions that can use Direct
Addressing are potentially affected by the Indexed
Literal Offset Addressing mode. This includes all byteoriented and bit-oriented instructions, or almost onehalf of the standard PIC18 instruction set. Instructions
that only use Inherent or Literal Addressing modes are
unaffected.
What does not change is just as important. The size of
the data memory space is unchanged, as well as its
linear addressing. The SFR map remains the same.
Core PIC18 instructions can still operate in both Direct
and Indirect Addressing mode. Inherent and literal
instructions do not change at all. Indirect Addressing
with FSR0 and FSR1 also remains unchanged.
Additionally, byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions
are not affected if they do not use the Access Bank
(Access RAM bit = 1), or include a file address of 60h
or above. Instructions meeting these criteria will
continue to execute as before. A comparison of the
different possible addressing modes when the
extended instruction set is enabled is shown in
Figure 6-9.
6.6.1
Those who desire to use byte-oriented or bit-oriented
instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset mode should
note the changes to assembler syntax for this mode.
This is described in more detail in Section 29.2.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax”.
INDEXED ADDRESSING WITH
LITERAL OFFSET
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set changes
the behavior of Indirect Addressing using the FSR2
register pair and its associated file operands. Under the
proper conditions, instructions that use the Access
Bank – that is, most bit-oriented and byte-oriented
instructions – can invoke a form of Indexed Addressing
using an offset specified in the instruction. This special
addressing mode is known as Indexed Addressing with
Literal Offset or the Indexed Literal Offset mode.
When using the extended instruction set, this
addressing mode requires the following:
• Use of the Access Bank (‘a’ = 0)
• A file address argument that is less than or equal
to 5Fh
Under these conditions, the file address of the
instruction is not interpreted as the lower byte of an
address (used with the BSR in Direct Addressing) or as
an 8-bit address in the Access Bank. Instead, the value
is interpreted as an offset value to an Address Pointer
specified by FSR2. The offset and the contents of FSR2
are added to obtain the target address of the operation.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 143
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 6-9:
COMPARING ADDRESSING OPTIONS FOR BIT-ORIENTED AND BYTEORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS (EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET ENABLED)
EXAMPLE INSTRUCTION: ADDWF, f, d, a (Opcode: 0010 01da ffff ffff)
When a = 0 and f 60h:
The instruction executes in
Direct Forced mode. ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in the
Access RAM between 060h
and FFFh. This is the same as
locations, F60h to FFFh
(Bank 15), of data memory.
Locations below 060h are not
available in this addressing
mode.
000h
060h
Bank 0
100h
00h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
F00h
60h
Valid range
for ‘f’
Access RAM
FFh
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
When a = 0 and f5Fh:
The instruction executes in
Indexed Literal Offset mode. ‘f’
is interpreted as an offset to the
address value in FSR2. The
two are added together to
obtain the address of the target
register for the instruction. The
address can be anywhere in
the data memory space.
Note that in this mode, the
correct syntax is now:
ADDWF [k], d
where ‘k’ is the same as ‘f’.
When a = 1 (all values of f):
The instruction executes in
Direct mode (also known as
Direct Long mode). ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in
one of the 16 banks of the data
memory space. The bank is
designated by the Bank Select
Register (BSR). The address
can be in any implemented
bank in the data memory
space.
Data Memory
000h
Bank 0
060h
100h
001001da ffffffff
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
FSR2H
FSR2L
F00h
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
BSR
00000000
000h
Bank 0
060h
100h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
001001da ffffffff
F00h
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
DS30000575C-page 144
Data Memory
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
6.6.3
MAPPING THE ACCESS BANK IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
The use of Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
effectively changes how the lower part of Access RAM
(00h to 5Fh) is mapped. Rather than containing just the
contents of the bottom part of Bank 0, this mode maps
the contents from Bank 0 and a user-defined “window”
that can be located anywhere in the data memory
space.
The value of FSR2 establishes the lower boundary of
the addresses mapped into the window, while the
upper boundary is defined by FSR2 plus 95 (5Fh).
Addresses in the Access RAM above 5Fh are mapped
as previously described. (See Section 6.3.2 “Access
Bank”.) An example of Access Bank remapping in this
addressing mode is shown in Figure 6-10.
FIGURE 6-10:
Remapping the Access Bank applies only to operations
using the Indexed Literal Offset mode. Operations that
use the BSR (Access RAM bit = 1) will continue to use
Direct Addressing as before. Any Indirect or Indexed
Addressing operation that explicitly uses any of the
indirect file operands (including FSR2) will continue to
operate as standard Indirect Addressing. Any instruction that uses the Access Bank, but includes a register
address of greater than 05Fh, will use Direct
Addressing and the normal Access Bank map.
6.6.4
BSR IN INDEXED LITERAL
OFFSET MODE
Although the Access Bank is remapped when the
extended instruction set is enabled, the operation of the
BSR remains unchanged. Direct Addressing, using the
BSR to select the data memory bank, operates in the
same manner as previously described.
REMAPPING THE ACCESS BANK WITH INDEXED LITERAL
OFFSET ADDRESSING
Example Situation:
ADDWF f, d, a
FSR2H:FSR2L = 120h
Locations in the region
from the FSR2 Pointer
(120h) to the pointer plus
05Fh (17Fh) are mapped
to the bottom of the
Access RAM (000h-05Fh).
000h
05Fh
Bank 0
100h
120h
17Fh
200h
Window
Bank 1
00h
Bank 1 “Window”
5Fh
60h
Special Function Registers
at F60h through FFFh are
mapped to 60h through
FFh, as usual.
Bank 0 addresses below
5Fh are not available in
this mode. They can still
be addressed by using the
BSR.
Not Accessible
Bank 2
through
Bank 14
SFRs
FFh
Access Bank
F00h
Bank 15
F60h
FFFh
SFRs
Data Memory
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 145
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.0
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
7.1
Table Reads and Table Writes
The Flash program memory is readable, writable and
erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD
range.
In order to read and write program memory, there are
two operations that allow the processor to move bytes
between the program memory space and the data RAM:
A read from program memory is executed on 1 byte at
a time. A write to program memory is executed on
blocks of 64 bytes at a time or 2 bytes at a time.
Program memory is erased in blocks of 512 bytes at a
time. A bulk erase operation may not be issued from
user code.
• Table Read (TBLRD)
• Table Write (TBLWT)
Writing or erasing program memory will cease
instruction fetches until the operation is complete. The
program memory cannot be accessed during the write
or erase, therefore, code cannot execute. An internal
programming timer terminates program memory writes
and erases.
A value written to program memory does not need to be
a valid instruction. Executing a program memory
location that forms an invalid instruction results in a
NOP.
The program memory space is 16 bits wide, while the
data RAM space is 8 bits wide. Table reads and table
writes move data between these two memory spaces
through an 8-bit register (TABLAT).
Table read operations retrieve data from program
memory and place it into the data RAM space.
Figure 7-1 shows the operation of a table read with
program memory and data RAM.
Table write operations store data from the data memory
space into holding registers in program memory. The
procedure to write the contents of the holding registers
into program memory is detailed in Section 7.5 “Writing
to Flash Program Memory”. Figure 7-2 shows the
operation of a table write with program memory and data
RAM.
Table operations work with byte entities. A table block
containing data, rather than program instructions, is not
required to be word-aligned. Therefore, a table block can
start and end at any byte address. If a table write is being
used to write executable code into program memory,
program instructions will need to be word-aligned.
FIGURE 7-1:
TABLE READ OPERATION
Instruction: TBLRD*
Program Memory
Table Pointer(1)
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
Table Latch (8-bit)
TBLPTRL
TABLAT
Program Memory
(TBLPTR)
Note 1: Table Pointer register points to a byte in program memory.
DS30000575C-page 146
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 7-2:
TABLE WRITE OPERATION
Instruction: TBLWT*
Program Memory
Holding Registers
Table Pointer(1)
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
Table Latch (8-bit)
TBLPTRL
TABLAT
Program Memory
(TBLPTR)
Note 1: The Table Pointer actually points to one of 64 holding registers; the address of which is determined by
TBLPTRL. The process for physically writing data to the program memory array is discussed in
Section 7.5 “Writing to Flash Program Memory”.
7.2
Control Registers
Several control registers are used in conjunction with
the TBLRD and TBLWT instructions. These include:
The WWPROG bit, when set, will allow programming
two bytes per word on the execution of the WR
command. If this bit is cleared, the WR command will
result in programming on a block of 64 bytes.
•
•
•
•
The FREE bit, when set, will allow a program memory
erase operation. When FREE is set, the erase
operation is initiated on the next WR command. When
FREE is clear, only writes are enabled.
EECON1 register
EECON2 register
TABLAT register
TBLPTR registers
7.2.1
EECON1 AND EECON2 REGISTERS
The EECON1 register (Register 7-1) is the control
register for memory accesses. The EECON2 register is
not a physical register; it is used exclusively in the
memory write and erase sequences. Reading
EECON2 will read all ‘0’s.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation.
On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is
set in hardware when the WR bit is set, and cleared
when the internal programming timer expires and the
write operation is complete.
Note:
During normal operation, the WRERR is
read as ‘1’. This can indicate that a write
operation was prematurely terminated by
a Reset or a write operation was
attempted improperly.
DS30000575C-page 147
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Register 7-1:
EECON1: EEPROM CONTROL REGISTER 1 (ACCESS FA6h)
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-x
R/W-0
R/S-0
U-0
—
—
WWPROG
FREE
WRERR(1)
WREN
WR
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
S = Settable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
WWPROG: One Word-Wide Program bit
1 = Programs 2 bytes on the next WR command
0 = Programs 64 bytes on the next WR command
bit 4
FREE: Flash Erase Enable bit
1 = Performs an erase operation on the next WR command (cleared by hardware after completion
of erase)
0 = Performs write-only
bit 3
WRERR: Flash Program Error Flag bit(1)
1 = A write operation is prematurely terminated (any Reset during self-timed programming in normal
operation or an improper write attempt)
0 = The write operation completed
bit 2
WREN: Flash Program Write Enable bit
1 = Allows write cycles to Flash program memory
0 = Inhibits write cycles to Flash program memory
bit 1
WR: Write Control bit
1 = Initiates a program memory erase cycle or write cycle (the operation is self-timed and the bit is
cleared by hardware once the write is complete)
The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software.
0 = Write cycle is complete
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1:
When a WRERR error occurs, the EEPGD and CFGS bits are not cleared. This allows tracing of the error
condition.
DS30000575C-page 148
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.2.2
TABLE LATCH REGISTER (TABLAT)
7.2.4
TABLE POINTER BOUNDARIES
The Table Latch (TABLAT) is an 8-bit register mapped
into the Special Function Register (SFR) space. The
Table Latch register is used to hold 8-bit data during
data transfers between program memory and data
RAM.
TBLPTR is used in reads, writes and erases of the
Flash program memory.
7.2.3
When a TBLWT is executed, the seven Least Significant
bits (LSbs) of the Table Pointer register
(TBLPTR) determine which of the 64 program
memory holding registers is written to. When the timed
write to program memory begins (via the WR bit), the
12 Most Significant bits (MSbs) of the TBLPTR
(TBLPTR) determine which program memory
block of 1024 bytes is written to. For more detail, see
Section 7.5 “Writing to Flash Program Memory”.
When a TBLRD is executed, all 22 bits of the TBLPTR
determine which byte is read from program memory
into TABLAT.
TABLE POINTER REGISTER
(TBLPTR)
The Table Pointer (TBLPTR) register addresses a byte
within the program memory. The TBLPTR is comprised
of three SFR registers: Table Pointer Upper Byte, Table
Pointer High Byte and Table Pointer Low Byte
(TBLPTRU:TBLPTRH:TBLPTRL). These three registers join to form a 22-bit wide pointer. The low-order
21 bits allow the device to address up to 2 Mbytes of
program memory space. The 22nd bit allows access to
the Device ID, the User ID and the Configuration bits.
When an erase of program memory is executed, the
12 MSbs of the Table Pointer register point to the
1024-byte block that will be erased. The LSbs are
ignored.
The Table Pointer register, TBLPTR, is used by the
TBLRD and TBLWT instructions. These instructions can
update the TBLPTR in one of four ways, based on the
table operation. These operations are shown in
Table 7-1 and only affect the low-order 21 bits.
TABLE 7-1:
Figure 7-3 describes the relevant boundaries of the
TBLPTR based on Flash program memory operations.
TABLE POINTER OPERATIONS WITH TBLRD AND TBLWT INSTRUCTIONS
Example
Operation on Table Pointer
TBLRD*
TBLWT*
TBLPTR is not modified
TBLRD*+
TBLWT*+
TBLPTR is incremented after the read/write
TBLRD*TBLWT*-
TBLPTR is decremented after the read/write
TBLRD+*
TBLWT+*
TBLPTR is incremented before the read/write
FIGURE 7-3:
21
TABLE POINTER BOUNDARIES BASED ON OPERATION
TBLPTRU
16
15
TBLPTRH
8
7
TBLPTRL
0
ERASE: TBLPTR
TABLE WRITE: TBLPTR
TABLE READ – TBLPTR
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 149
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.3
Reading the Flash Program
Memory
The TBLPTR points to a byte address in program
space. Executing TBLRD places the byte pointed to into
TABLAT. In addition, the TBLPTR can be modified
automatically for the next table read operation.
The TBLRD instruction is used to retrieve data from
program memory and places it into data RAM. Table
reads from program memory are performed one byte at
a time.
The internal program memory is typically organized by
words. The Least Significant bit of the address selects
between the high and low bytes of the word.
Figure 7-4 shows the interface between the internal
program memory and the TABLAT.
FIGURE 7-4:
READS FROM FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
Program Memory
(Even Byte Address)
(Odd Byte Address)
TBLPTR = xxxxx1
Instruction Register
(IR)
EXAMPLE 7-1:
FETCH
TBLPTR = xxxxx0
TABLAT
Read Register
TBLRD
READING A FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY WORD
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; Load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the word
READ_WORD
TBLRD*+
MOVF
MOVWF
TBLRD*+
MOVF
MOVWF
DS30000575C-page 150
TABLAT, W
WORD_EVEN
TABLAT, W
WORD_ODD
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.4
Erasing Flash Program Memory
The minimum erase block is 256 words or 512 bytes.
Only through the use of an external programmer, or
through ICSP control, can larger blocks of program
memory be bulk erased. Word erase in the Flash array
is not supported.
When initiating an erase sequence from the microcontroller itself, a block of 512 bytes of program memory is
erased. The Most Significant 12 bits of the
TBLPTR point to the block being erased;
TBLPTR are ignored.
The EECON1 register commands the erase operation.
The WREN bit must be set to enable write operations.
The FREE bit is set to select an erase operation. For
protection, the write initiate sequence for EECON2
must be used.
7.4.1
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
ERASE SEQUENCE
The sequence of events for erasing a block of internal
program memory location is:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Load Table Pointer register with address of row
being erased.
Set the WREN and FREE bits (EECON1)
to enable the erase operation.
Disable interrupts.
Write 55h to EECON2.
Write 0AAh to EECON2.
Set the WR bit; this will begin the erase cycle.
The CPU will stall for the duration of the erase
for TIE (see Parameter D133B).
Re-enable interrupts.
A long write is necessary for erasing the internal Flash.
Instruction execution is halted while in a long write
cycle. The long write will be terminated by the internal
programming timer.
EXAMPLE 7-2:
ERASING A FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY ROW
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the memory block
BSF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BSF
EECON1,
EECON1,
INTCON,
0x55
EECON2
0xAA
EECON2
EECON1,
INTCON,
; enable write to memory
; enable Row Erase operation
; disable interrupts
ERASE_ROW
Required
Sequence
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
WREN
FREE
GIE
; write 55h
WR
GIE
; write 0AAh
; start erase (CPU stall)
; re-enable interrupts
DS30000575C-page 151
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.5
Writing to Flash Program Memory
The on-chip timer controls the write time. The write/
erase voltages are generated by an on-chip charge
pump, rated to operate over the voltage range of the
device.
The programming block is 32 words or 64 bytes.
Programming one word or 2 bytes at a time is also supported.
Note 1: Unlike previous PIC® MCUs, devices of
the PIC18FXXJ94 do not reset the holding registers after a write occurs. The
holding registers must be cleared or
overwritten before a programming
sequence.
Table writes are used internally to load the holding
registers needed to program the Flash memory. There
are 64 holding registers used by the table writes for
programming.
Since the Table Latch (TABLAT) is only a single byte, the
TBLWT instruction may need to be executed 64 times for
each programming operation (if WWPROG = 0). All of
the table write operations will essentially be short writes
because only the holding registers are written. At the
end of updating the 64 holding registers, the EECON1
register must be written to in order to start the
programming operation with a long write.
2: To maintain the endurance of the
program memory cells, each Flash byte
should not be programmed more than
once between erase operations. Before
attempting to modify the contents of the
target cell a second time, an erase of the
target page, or a bulk erase of the entire
memory, must be performed.
The long write is necessary for programming the internal
Flash. Instruction execution is halted while in a long write
cycle. The long write will be terminated by the internal
programming timer.
FIGURE 7-5:
TABLE WRITES TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
TABLAT
Write Register
8
8
TBLPTR = xxxxx0
Holding Register
8
TBLPTR = xxxxx2
TBLPTR = xxxxx1
Holding Register
8
TBLPTR = xxxx3F
Holding Register
Holding Register
Program Memory
7.5.1
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY WRITE
SEQUENCE
The sequence of events for programming an internal
program memory location should be:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Read the 512 bytes into RAM.
Update the data values in RAM as necessary.
Load the Table Pointer register with the address
being erased.
Execute the erase procedure.
Load the Table Pointer register with the address
of the first byte being written, minus 1.
Write the 64 bytes into the holding registers with
auto-pre-increment.
Set the WREN bit (EECON1) to enable byte
writes.
DS30000575C-page 152
8.
9.
10.
11.
Disable the interrupts.
Write 55h to EECON2.
Write 0xAAh to EECON2.
Set the WR bit. This will begin the write cycle.
The CPU will stall for duration of the write for TIW
(see Parameter D133A).
12. Re-enable the interrupts.
13. Verify the memory (table read).
An example of the required code is shown in
Example 7-3 on the following Page 153.
Note:
Before setting the WR bit, the Table
Pointer address needs to be within the
intended address range of the 64 bytes in
the holding register.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 7-3:
WRITING TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; Load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the memory block, minus 1
BSF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BSF
MOVLW
MOVWF
EECON1, WREN
EECON1, FREE
INTCON, GIE
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1, WR
INTCON, GIE
D’8’
WRITE_COUNTER
; enable write to memory
; enable Erase operation
; disable interrupts
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
D'64'
COUNTER
BUFFER_ADDR_HIGH
FSR0H
BUFFER_ADDR_LOW
FSR0L
ERASE_BLOCK
; write 55h
; write 0AAh
; start erase (CPU stall)
; re-enable interrupts
; Need to write 8 blocks of 64 to write
; one erase block of 512
RESTART BUFFER
; point to buffer
FILL_BUFFER
...
; read the new data from I2C, SPI,
; PSP, USART, etc.
WRITE_BUFFER
MOVLW
MOVWF
WRITE_BYTE_TO_HREGS
MOVFF
MOVWF
TBLWT+*
D’64
COUNTER
; number of bytes in holding register
POSTINC0, WREG
TABLAT
;
;
;
;
;
DECFSZ COUNTER
BRA
WRITE_BYTE_TO_HREGS
get low byte of buffer data
present data to table latch
write data, perform a short write
to internal TBLWT holding register.
loop until buffers are full
PROGRAM_MEMORY
Required
Sequence
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BSF
BCF
EECON1,
INTCON,
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1,
INTCON,
EECON1,
WREN
GIE
; write 55h
WR
GIE
WREN
DECFSZ WRITE_COUNTER
BRA
RESTART_BUFFER
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
; enable write to memory
; disable interrupts
;
;
;
;
write 0AAh
start program (CPU stall)
re-enable interrupts
disable write to memory
; done with one write cycle
; if not done replacing the erase block
DS30000575C-page 153
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.5.2
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY WRITE
SEQUENCE (WORD PROGRAMMING)
The PIC18FXXJ94 of devices has a feature that allows
programming a single word (two bytes). This feature is
enabled when the WWPROG bit is set. If the memory
location is already erased, the following sequence is
required to enable this feature:
1.
2.
Load the Table Pointer register with the address
of the data to be written. (It must be an even
address.)
Write the 2 bytes into the holding registers by
performing table writes. (Do not post-increment
on the second table write).
EXAMPLE 7-4:
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Set the WREN bit (EECON1) to enable
writes and the WWPROG bit (EECON1) to
select Word Write mode.
Disable interrupts.
Write 55h to EECON2.
Write 0AAh to EECON2.
Set the WR bit; this will begin the write cycle.
The CPU will stall for the duration of the write for
TIW (see Parameter D133A).
Re-enable interrupts.
SINGLE-WORD WRITE TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
TBLWT*+
MOVLW
MOVWF
TBLWT*
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
DATA0
TABLAT
; Load TBLPTR with the base address
DATA1
TABLAT
; MSB of word to be written
BSF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BSF
BCF
BCF
EECON1,
EECON1,
INTCON,
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1,
INTCON,
EECON1,
EECON1,
; The table pointer must be loaded with an even address
; LSB of word to be written
; The last table write must not increment the
table pointer! The table pointer needs to
point to the MSB before starting the write operation.
PROGRAM_MEMORY
Required
Sequence
DS30000575C-page 154
WWPROG
WREN
GIE
; enable single word write
; enable write to memory
; disable interrupts
; write 55h
WR
GIE
WWPROG
WREN
;
;
;
;
;
write AAh
start program (CPU stall)
re-enable interrupts
disable single word write
disable write to memory
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
7.5.3
WRITE VERIFY
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the
memory should be verified against the original value.
This should be used in applications where excessive
writes can stress bits near the specification limit.
7.5.4
7.6
Flash Program Operation During
Code Protection
See Section 28.4.5 “Program Verification and Code
Protection” for details on code protection of Flash
program memory.
UNEXPECTED TERMINATION OF
WRITE OPERATION
If a write is terminated by an unplanned event, such as
loss of power or an unexpected Reset, the memory
location just programmed should be verified and reprogrammed if needed. If the write operation is interrupted
by a MCLR Reset, or a WDT time-out Reset during normal operation, the user can check the WRERR bit and
rewrite the location(s) as needed
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 155
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.0
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS
Note:
The External Memory Bus
implemented on 64-pin devices.
is
not
The External Memory Bus (EMB) allows the device to
access external memory devices (such as Flash,
EPROM or SRAM) as program or data memory. It
supports both 8 and 16-Bit Data Width modes, and
three address widths of up to 20 bits.
TABLE 8-1:
The bus is implemented with 28 pins, multiplexed
across four I/O ports. Three ports (PORTD, PORTE
and PORTH) are multiplexed with the address/data bus
for a total of 20 available lines, while PORTJ is
multiplexed with the bus control signals.
A list of the pins and their functions is provided in
Table 8-1.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY EXTERNAL BUS – I/O PORT FUNCTIONS
Name
Port
Bit
External Memory Bus Function
RD0/AD0
PORTD
0
Address Bit 0 or Data Bit 0
RD1/AD1
PORTD
1
Address Bit 1 or Data Bit 1
RD2/AD2
PORTD
2
Address Bit 2 or Data Bit 2
RD3/AD3
PORTD
3
Address Bit 3 or Data Bit 3
RD4/AD4
PORTD
4
Address Bit 4 or Data Bit 4
RD5/AD5
PORTD
5
Address Bit 5 or Data Bit 5
RD6/AD6
PORTD
6
Address Bit 6 or Data Bit 6
RD7/AD7
PORTD
7
Address Bit 7 or Data Bit 7
RE0/AD8
PORTE
0
Address Bit 8 or Data Bit 8
RE1/AD9
PORTE
1
Address Bit 9 or Data Bit 9
RE2/AD10
PORTE
2
Address Bit 10 or Data Bit 10
RE3/AD11
PORTE
3
Address Bit 11 or Data Bit 11
RE4/AD12
PORTE
4
Address Bit 12 or Data Bit 12
RE5/AD13
PORTE
5
Address Bit 13 or Data Bit 13
RE6/AD14
PORTE
6
Address Bit 14 or Data Bit 14
RE7/AD15
PORTE
7
Address Bit 15 or Data Bit 15
RH0/A16
PORTH
0
Address Bit 16
RH1/A17
PORTH
1
Address Bit 17
RH2/A18
PORTH
2
Address Bit 18
RH3/A19
PORTH
3
Address Bit 19
RJ0/ALE
PORTJ
0
Address Latch Enable (ALE) Control Pin
RJ1/OE
PORTJ
1
Output Enable (OE) Control Pin
RJ2/WRL
PORTJ
2
Write Low (WRL) Control Pin
RJ3/WRH
PORTJ
3
Write High (WRH) Control Pin
RJ4/BA0
PORTJ
4
Byte Address Bit 0 (BA0)
RJ5/CE
PORTJ
5
Chip Enable (CE) Control Pin
RJ6/LB
PORTJ
6
Lower Byte Enable (LB) Control Pin
RJ7/UB
PORTJ
7
Upper Byte Enable (UB) Control Pin
Note:
For the sake of clarity, only I/O port and external bus assignments are shown here. One or more additional
multiplexed features may be available on some pins.
DS30000575C-page 156
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.1
External Memory Bus Control
The operation of the interface is controlled by the
MEMCON register (Register 8-1). This register is
available in all program memory operating modes,
except Microcontroller mode. In this mode, the register
is disabled and cannot be written to.
The EBDIS bit (MEMCON) controls the operation
of the bus and related port functions. Clearing EBDIS
enables the interface and disables the I/O functions of
the ports, as well as any other functions multiplexed to
those pins. Setting the bit enables the I/O ports and
other functions, but allows the interface to override
everything else on the pins when an external memory
operation is required. By default, the external bus is
always enabled and disables all other I/O.
REGISTER 8-1:
The operation of the EBDIS bit is also influenced by the
program memory mode being used. This is discussed
in more detail in Section 8.5 “Program Memory
Modes and the External Memory Bus”.
The WAITx bits allow for the addition of Wait states to
external memory operations. The use of these bits is
discussed in Section 8.3 “Wait States”.
The WMx bits select the particular operating mode
used when the bus is operating in 16-Bit Data Width
mode. This is discussed in more detail in Section 8.6
“16-Bit Data Width Modes”. These bits have no effect
when an 8-Bit Data Width mode is selected.
MEMCON: EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS CONTROL REGISTER(1)
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EBDIS
—
WAIT1
WAIT0
—
—
WM1
WM0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
EBDIS: External Bus Disable bit
1 = External bus is enabled when microcontroller accesses external memory; otherwise, all external
bus drivers are mapped as I/O ports
0 = External bus is always enabled, I/O ports are disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
WAIT: Table Reads and Writes Bus Cycle Wait Count bits
11 = Table reads and writes will wait 0 TCY
10 = Table reads and writes will wait 1 TCY
01 = Table reads and writes will wait 2 TCY
00 = Table reads and writes will wait 3 TCY
bit 3-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1-0
WM: TBLWT Operation with 16-Bit Data Bus Width Select bits
1x = Word Write mode: TABLAT word output, WRH is active when TABLAT is written
01 = Byte Select mode: TABLAT data is copied on both MSB and LSB, WRH and (UB or LB) will activate
00 = Byte Write mode: TABLAT data is copied on both MSB and LSB, WRH or WRL will activate
Note 1:
This register is unimplemented on 64-pin devices, read as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 157
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.2
Address and Data Width
8.2.1
The PIC18FXXJ94 of devices can be independently
configured for different address and data widths on the
same memory bus. Both address and data width are
set by Configuration bits in the CONFIG5L register. As
Configuration bits, this means that these options can
only be configured by programming the device and are
not controllable in software.
The BW bit selects an 8-bit or 16-bit data bus width.
Setting this bit (default) selects a data width of 16 bits.
The ABW bits determine both the program memory operating mode and the address bus width. The
available options are 20-bit, 16-bit and 12-bit, as well
as Microcontroller mode (external bus disabled).
Selecting a 16-bit or 12-bit width makes a corresponding number of high-order lines available for I/O
functions. These pins are no longer affected by the
setting of the EBDIS bit. For example, selecting a 16Bit Addressing mode (ABW = 01) disables
A and allows PORTH to function without
interruptions from the bus. Using the smaller address
widths allows users to tailor the memory bus to the size
of the external memory space for a particular design
while freeing up pins for dedicated I/O operation.
Because the ABWx bits have the effect of disabling
pins for memory bus operations, it is important to
always select an address width at least equal to the
data width. If a 12-bit address width is used with a 16bit data width, the upper four bits of data will not be
available on the bus.
All combinations of address and data widths require
multiplexing of address and data information on the
same lines. The address and data multiplexing, as well
as I/O ports made available by the use of smaller
address widths, are summarized in Table 8-2.
TABLE 8-2:
ADDRESS SHIFTING ON THE
EXTERNAL BUS
By default, the address presented on the external bus
is the value of the PC. In practical terms, this means
that addresses in the external memory device, below
the top of on-chip memory, are unavailable to the
microcontroller. To access these physical locations, the
glue logic between the microcontroller and the external
memory must somehow translate addresses.
To simplify the interface, the external bus offers an
extension of Extended Microcontroller mode that
automatically performs address shifting. This feature is
controlled by the EASHFT Configuration bit. Setting
this bit offsets addresses on the bus by the size of the
microcontroller’s on-chip program memory and sets
the bottom address at 0000h. This allows the device to
use the entire range of physical addresses of the
external memory.
8.2.2
21-BIT ADDRESSING
As an extension of 20-bit address width operation, the
External Memory Bus can also fully address a 2-Mbyte
memory space. This is done by using the Bus Address
Bit 0 (BA0) control line as the Least Significant bit of the
address. The UB and LB control signals may also be
used with certain memory devices to select the upper
and lower bytes within a 16-bit wide data word.
This addressing mode is available in both 8-Bit and
certain 16-Bit Data Width modes. Additional details are
provided in Section 8.6.3 “16-Bit Byte Select Mode”
and Section 8.7 “8-Bit Data Width Mode”.
ADDRESS AND DATA LINES FOR DIFFERENT ADDRESS AND DATA WIDTHS
Data Width
Address Width
Multiplexed Data and
Address Lines (and
Corresponding Ports)
12-bit
8-bit
16-bit
AD
(PORTD)
20-bit
16-bit
16-bit
DS30000575C-page 158
20-bit
AD
(PORTD,
PORTE)
Address Only Lines
(and Corresponding
Ports)
Ports Available
for I/O
AD
(PORTE)
PORTE,
All of PORTH
AD
(PORTE)
All of PORTH
A, AD
(PORTH,
PORTE)
—
—
All of PORTH
A
(PORTH)
—
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.3
Wait States
While it may be assumed that external memory devices
will operate at the microcontroller clock rate, this is
often not the case. In fact, many devices require longer
times to write or retrieve data than the time allowed by
the execution of table read or table write operations.
To compensate for this, the External Memory Bus can
be configured to add a fixed delay to each table operation using the bus. Wait states are enabled by setting
the WAIT Configuration bit. When enabled, the amount
of delay is set by the WAIT bits (MEMCON).
The delay is based on multiples of microcontroller
instruction cycle time and is added following the
instruction cycle when the table operation is executed.
The range is from no delay to 3 TCY (default value).
8.4
Port Pin Weak Pull-ups
With the exception of the upper address lines,
A, the pins associated with the External Memory Bus are equipped with weak pull-ups. The pull-ups
are controlled by the upper nibble of the PADCFG
register (PADCFG). They are named RDPU,
REPU, RHPU and RJPU, and control pull-ups on
PORTD, PORTE, PORTH and PORTJ, respectively.
Setting one of these bits enables the corresponding
pull-ups for that port. All pull-ups are disabled by default
on all device Resets.
functions. When EBDIS = 0, the pins function as the
external bus. When EBDIS = 1, the pins function as I/O
ports.
If the device fetches or accesses external memory
while EBDIS = 1, the pins will switch to the external
bus. If the EBDIS bit is set by a program executing from
external memory, the action of setting the bit will be
delayed until the program branches into the internal
memory. At that time, the pins will change from external
bus to I/O ports.
If the device is executing out of internal memory when
EBDIS = 0, the memory bus address/data and control
pins will not be active. They will go to a state where the
active address/data pins are tri-state; the CE, OE,
WRH, WRL, UB and LB signals are ‘1’, and ALE and
BA0 are ‘0’. Note that only those pins associated with
the current address width are forced to tri-state; the
other pins continue to function as I/O. In the case of 16bit address width, for example, only AD
(PORTD and PORTE) are affected; A
(PORTH) continue to function as I/O.
In all external memory modes, the bus takes priority
over any other peripherals that may share pins with it.
This includes the Parallel Master Port and serial
communication modules which would otherwise take
priority over the I/O port.
8.6
16-Bit Data Width Modes
In Extended Microcontroller mode, the port pull-ups
can be useful in preserving the memory state on the
external bus while the bus is temporarily disabled
(EBDIS = 1).
In 16-Bit Data Width mode, the external memory
interface can be connected to external memories in
three different configurations:
8.5
• 16-Bit Byte Write
• 16-Bit Word Write
• 16-Bit Byte Select
Program Memory Modes and the
External Memory Bus
The PIC18FXXJ94 of devices is capable of operating in
one of two program memory modes, using combinations of on-chip and external program memory. The
functions of the multiplexed port pins depend on the
program memory mode selected, as well as the setting
of the EBDIS bit.
In Microcontroller Mode, the bus is not active and the
pins have their port functions only. Writes to the
MEMCOM register are not permitted. The Reset value
of EBDIS (‘0’) is ignored and the ABWx pins behave as
I/O ports.
In Extended Microcontroller Mode, the external
program memory bus shares I/O port functions on the
pins. When the device is fetching or doing table read/
table write operations on the external program memory
space, the pins will have the external bus function.
If the device is fetching and accessing internal program
memory locations only, the EBDIS control bit will
change the pins from external memory to I/O port
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
The configuration to be used is determined by the
WM
bits
in
the
MEMCON
register
(MEMCON). These three different configurations
allow the designer maximum flexibility in using both 8bit and 16-bit devices with 16-bit data.
For all 16-bit modes, the Address Latch Enable (ALE)
pin indicates that the address bits, AD, are available on the external memory interface bus. Following
the address latch, the Output Enable (OE) signal will
enable both bytes of program memory at once to form
a 16-bit instruction word. The Chip Enable (CE signal)
is active at any time that the microcontroller accesses
external memory, whether reading or writing; it is
inactive (asserted high) whenever the device is in
Sleep mode.
In Byte Select mode, JEDEC® standard Flash memories will require BA0 for the byte address line and one
I/O line to select between Byte and Word mode. The
other 16-bit modes do not need BA0. JEDEC standard
static RAM memories will use the UB or LB signals for
byte selection.
DS30000575C-page 159
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.6.1
16-BIT BYTE WRITE MODE
Figure 8-1 shows an example of 16-Bit Byte Write
mode for PIC18FXXJ94 devices. This mode is used for
two separate 8-bit memories connected for 16-bit operation. This generally includes basic EPROM and Flash
devices. It allows table writes to byte-wide external
memories.
FIGURE 8-1:
During a TBLWT instruction cycle, the TABLAT data is
presented on the upper and lower bytes of the
AD bus. The appropriate WRH or WRL control
line is strobed on the LSb of the TBLPTR.
16-BIT BYTE WRITE MODE EXAMPLE
D
PIC18F97J94
AD
(LSB)
(MSB)
373
A
D
A
A
D
D
CE
AD
373
OE
D
CE
WR(2)
OE
WR(2)
ALE
A(1)
CE
OE
WRH
WRL
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
2:
Upper order address lines are used only for 20-bit address widths.
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 7.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
DS30000575C-page 160
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.6.2
16-BIT WORD WRITE MODE
Figure 8-2 shows an example of 16-Bit Word Write
mode for PIC18FXXJ94 devices. This mode is used for
word-wide memories, which includes some of the
EPROM and Flash-type memories. This mode allows
opcode fetches and table reads from all forms of 16-bit
memory, and table writes to any type of word-wide
external memories. This method makes a distinction
between TBLWT cycles to even or odd addresses.
During a TBLWT cycle to an even address
(TBLPTR = 0), the TABLAT data is transferred to a
holding latch and the external address data bus is tristated for the data portion of the bus cycle. No write signals are activated.
FIGURE 8-2:
During a TBLWT cycle to an odd address
(TBLPTR = 1), the TABLAT data is presented on
the upper byte of the AD bus. The contents of
the holding latch are presented on the lower byte of the
AD bus.
The WRH signal is strobed for each write cycle; the
WRL pin is unused. The signal on the BA0 pin indicates
the LSb of the TBLPTR, but it is left unconnected.
Instead, the UB and LB signals are active to select both
bytes. The obvious limitation to this method is that the
table write must be done in pairs on a specific word
boundary to correctly write a word location.
16-BIT WORD WRITE MODE EXAMPLE
PIC18F97J94
AD
373
A
D
AD
A
JEDEC® Word
EPROM Memory
D
CE
OE
WR(2)
373
ALE
A(1)
CE
OE
WRH
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
2:
Upper order address lines are used only for 20-bit address widths.
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 7.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 161
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.6.3
16-BIT BYTE SELECT MODE
Figure 8-3 shows an example of 16-Bit Byte Select
mode. This mode allows table write operations to wordwide external memories with byte selection capability.
This generally includes both word-wide Flash and
SRAM devices.
During a TBLWT cycle, the TABLAT data is presented
on the upper and lower byte of the AD bus. The
WRH signal is strobed for each write cycle; the WRL
pin is not used. The BA0 or UB/LB signals are used to
select the byte to be written, based on the Least
Significant bit of the TBLPTR register.
FIGURE 8-3:
Flash and SRAM devices use different control signal
combinations to implement Byte Select mode. JEDEC
standard Flash memories require that a controller I/O
port pin be connected to the memory’s BYTE/WORD
pin to provide the select signal. They also use the BA0
signal from the controller as a byte address. JEDEC
standard static RAM memories, on the other hand, use
the UB or LB signals to select the byte.
16-BIT BYTE SELECT MODE EXAMPLE
PIC18F97J94
AD
373
A
A
JEDEC® Word
FLASH Memory
D
D
138(3)
AD
373
CE
A0
BYTE/WORD
ALE
OE WR(1)
A(2)
OE
WRH
WRL
A
A
BA0
JEDEC® Word
SRAM Memory
I/O
D
LB
CE
LB
UB
UB
D
OE WR(1)
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 7.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
2:
Upper order address lines are used only for 20-bit address width.
3:
Demultiplexing is only required when multiple memory devices are accessed.
DS30000575C-page 162
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.6.4
16-BIT MODE TIMING
The presentation of control signals on the External
Memory Bus is different for the various operating
modes. Typical signal timing diagrams are shown in
Figure 8-4 and Figure 8-5.
FIGURE 8-4:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD
(EXTENDED MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
0Ch
A
9256h
CF33h
AD
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Opcode Fetch
TBLRD *
from 000100h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 000102h
TBLRD 92h
from 199E67h
Opcode Fetch
ADDLW 55h
from 000104h
Instruction
Execution
INST(PC – 2)
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
MOVLW
FIGURE 8-5:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR SLEEP
(EXTENDED MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q4
Q1
Q2
3AAAh
Q3
Q4
Q1
00h
00h
A
AD
Q3
0003h
3AABh
0E55h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
Opcode Fetch
SLEEP
from 007554h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
INST(PC – 2)
SLEEP
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Sleep Mode, Bus Inactive
DS30000575C-page 163
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.7
8-Bit Data Width Mode
will enable one byte of program memory for a portion of
the instruction cycle, then BA0 will change and the
second byte will be enabled to form the 16-bit instruction word. The Least Significant bit of the address, BA0,
must be connected to the memory devices in this
mode. The Chip Enable (CE) signal is active at any
time that the microcontroller accesses external
memory, whether reading or writing. It is inactive
(asserted high) whenever the device is in Sleep mode.
In 8-Bit Data Width mode, the External Memory Bus
operates only in Multiplexed mode; that is, data shares
the 8 Least Significant bits of the address bus.
Figure 8-6 shows an example of 8-Bit Multiplexed
mode for 100-pin devices. This mode is used for a
single, 8-bit memory, connected for 16-bit operation.
The instructions will be fetched as two 8-bit bytes on a
shared data/address bus. The two bytes are sequentially fetched within one instruction cycle (TCY).
Therefore, the designer must choose external memory
devices, according to timing calculations based on 1/
2 TCY (2 times the instruction rate). For proper memory
speed selection, glue logic propagation delay times
must be considered, along with setup and hold times.
This generally includes basic EPROM and Flash
devices. It allows table writes to byte-wide external
memories.
During a TBLWT instruction cycle, the TABLAT data is
presented on the upper and lower bytes of the
AD bus. The appropriate level of the BA0 control
line is strobed on the LSb of the TBLPTR.
The Address Latch Enable (ALE) pin indicates that the
address bits, AD, are available on the External
Memory Bus interface. The Output Enable (OE) signal
FIGURE 8-6:
8-BIT MULTIPLEXED MODE EXAMPLE
D
PIC18F97J94
AD
ALE
373
A
A
A0
D
D
AD(1)
A
CE
(1)
OE
WR(2)
BA0
CE
OE
WRL
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
2:
Upper order address bits are only used for 20-bit address width. The upper AD byte is used for all
address widths except 8-bit.
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 7.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
DS30000575C-page 164
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.7.1
8-BIT MODE TIMING
The presentation of control signals on the External
Memory Bus is different for the various operating
modes. Typical signal timing diagrams are shown in
Figure 8-7 and Figure 8-8.
FIGURE 8-7:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD
(EXTENDED MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
A
0Ch
AD
CFh
33h
AD
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
92h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
FIGURE 8-8:
Opcode Fetch
TBLRD *
from 000100h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 000102h
TBLRD 92h
from 199E67h
Opcode Fetch
ADDLW 55h
from 000104h
INST(PC – 2)
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
MOVLW
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR SLEEP
(EXTENDED MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q4
Q1
Q2
3Ah
AD
AAh
00h
Q3
Q4
Q1
00h
00h
A
AD
Q3
3Ah
03h
ABh
0Eh
55h
BA0
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
Opcode Fetch
SLEEP
from 007554h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
INST(PC – 2)
SLEEP
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Sleep Mode, Bus Inactive
DS30000575C-page 165
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
8.8
Operation in Power-Managed
Modes
In Sleep and Idle modes, the microcontroller core does
not need to access data; bus operations are suspended. The state of the external bus is frozen, with the
address/data pins and most of the control pins holding
at the same state they were in when the mode was
invoked. The only potential changes are to the CE, LB
and UB pins, which are held at logic high.
In alternate, power-managed Run modes, the external
bus continues to operate normally. If a clock source
with a lower speed is selected, bus operations will run
at that speed. In these cases, excessive access times
for the external memory may result if Wait states have
been enabled and added to external memory operations. If operations in a lower power Run mode are
anticipated, users should provide in their applications
for adjusting memory access times at the lower clock
speeds.
TABLE 8-3:
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
MEMCON(1)
EBDIS
—
WAIT1
WAIT0
—
—
WM1
WM0
RJPU
RKPU
RLPU
LVDMD
—
EMBMD
PADCFG
PMD4
Bit 3
RDPU
REPU
RFPU
RGPU
RHPU
CMP1MD
CMP2MD
CMP3MD
USBMD
IOCMD
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used during External Memory Bus access.
Note 1: This register is unimplemented on 64-pin devices read as ‘0’.
DS30000575C-page 166
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
9.0
8 x 8 HARDWARE MULTIPLIER
9.1
Introduction
EXAMPLE 9-1:
MOVF
MULWF
All PIC18 devices include an 8 x 8 hardware multiplier
as part of the ALU. The multiplier performs an unsigned
operation and yields a 16-bit result that is stored in the
product register pair, PRODH:PRODL. The multiplier’s
operation does not affect any flags in the STATUS
register.
ARG1, W
ARG2
;
; ARG1 * ARG2 ->
; PRODH:PRODL
EXAMPLE 9-2:
Making multiplication a hardware operation allows it to
be completed in a single instruction cycle. This has the
advantages of higher computational throughput and
reduced code size for multiplication algorithms and
allows PIC18 devices to be used in many applications
previously reserved for digital-signal processors. A
comparison of various hardware and software multiply
operations, along with the savings in memory and
execution time, is shown in Table 9-1.
9.2
8 x 8 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
8 x 8 SIGNED MULTIPLY
ROUTINE
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1, W
ARG2
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, SB
PRODH, F
MOVF
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, W
ARG1, SB
PRODH, F
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1 * ARG2 ->
PRODH:PRODL
Test Sign Bit
PRODH = PRODH
- ARG1
; Test Sign Bit
; PRODH = PRODH
;
- ARG2
Operation
Example 9-1 shows the instruction sequence for an 8 x 8
unsigned multiplication. Only one instruction is required
when one of the arguments is already loaded in the
WREG register.
Example 9-2 shows the sequence to do an 8 x 8 signed
multiplication. To account for the sign bits of the arguments, each argument’s Most Significant bit (MSb) is
tested and the appropriate subtractions are done.
TABLE 9-1:
Routine
8 x 8 Unsigned
8 x 8 Signed
16 x 16
Unsigned
16 x 16 Signed
PERFORMANCE COMPARISON FOR VARIOUS MULTIPLY OPERATIONS
Multiply Method
Without Hardware Multiply
Program
Cycles
Memory
(Max)
(Words)
13
Time
@ 64 MHz
@ 48 MHz
@ 10 MHz
@ 4 MHz
69
4.3 s
5.7 s
27.6 s
69 s
Hardware Multiply
1
1
62.5 ns
83.3 ns
400 ns
1 s
Without Hardware Multiply
33
91
5.6 s
7.5 s
36.4 s
91 s
Hardware Multiply
6
6
375 ns
500 ns
2.4 s
6 s
Without Hardware Multiply
21
242
15.1 s
20.1 s
96.8 s
242 s
Hardware Multiply
28
28
1.7 s
2.3 s
11.2 s
28 s
Without Hardware Multiply
52
254
15.8 s
21.2 s
101.6 s
254 s
Hardware Multiply
35
40
2.5 s
3.3 s
16.0 s
40 s
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 167
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Example 9-3 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
unsigned multiplication. Equation 9-1 shows the
algorithm that is used. The 32-bit result is stored in four
registers (RES3:RES0).
EQUATION 9-1:
RES3:RES0
=
=
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
ARG1H:ARG1L · ARG2H:ARG2L
(ARG1H · ARG2H · 216) +
(ARG1H · ARG2L · 28) +
(ARG1L · ARG2H · 28) +
(ARG1L · ARG2L)
EXAMPLE 9-3:
EQUATION 9-2:
RES3:RES0= ARG1H:ARG1L · ARG2H:ARG2L
=
(ARG1H · ARG2H · 216) +
(ARG1H · ARG2L · 28) +
(ARG1L · ARG2H · 28) +
(ARG1L · ARG2L) +
(-1 · ARG2H · ARG1H:ARG1L ·
(-1 · ARG1H · ARG2H:ARG2L ·
EXAMPLE 9-4:
MOVF
MULWF
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES1
PRODL, RES0
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES3
PRODL, RES2
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2H
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
; ARG1L * ARG2L->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
ARG1L * ARG2H->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
ARG1H * ARG2L->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
Example 9-4 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
signed multiply. Equation 9-2 shows the algorithm
used. The 32-bit result is stored in four registers
(RES3:RES0). To account for the sign bits of the
arguments, the MSb for each argument pair is tested
and the appropriate subtractions are done.
DS30000575C-page 168
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
MOVFF
MOVFF
; ARG1L * ARG2L ->
; PRODH:PRODL
PRODH, RES1 ;
PRODL, RES0 ;
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
MOVFF
MOVFF
; ARG1H * ARG2H ->
; PRODH:PRODL
PRODH, RES3 ;
PRODL, RES2 ;
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2H
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1L * ARG2H ->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
216) +
216)
;
;
; ARG1H * ARG2H->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1H * ARG2L ->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
;
BTFSS
ARG2H, 7
BRA SIGN_ARG1
MOVF
ARG1L, W
SUBWF
RES2
MOVF
ARG1H, W
SUBWFB RES3
SIGN_ARG1
BTFSS
ARG1H, 7
BRA
CONT_CODE
MOVF
ARG2L, W
SUBWF
RES2
MOVF
ARG2H, W
SUBWFB RES3
;
CONT_CODE
:
; ARG2H:ARG2L neg?
; no, check ARG1
;
;
;
;
; ARG1H:ARG1L neg?
; no, done
;
;
;
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.0
INTERRUPTS
Members of the PIC18F97J94 family of devices have
multiple interrupt sources and an interrupt priority
feature that allows most interrupt sources to be
assigned a high-priority level or a low-priority level. The
high-priority interrupt vector is at 0008h and the lowpriority interrupt vector is at 0018h. High-priority interrupt events will interrupt any low-priority interrupts that
may be in progress.
The registers for controlling interrupt operation are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
RCON
INTCON
INTCON2
INTCON3
PIR1, PIR2, PIR3, PIR4, PIR5 and PIR6
PIE1, PIE2, PIE3, PIE4, PIE5 and PIE6
IPR1, IPR2, IPR3, IPR5, IPR5 and IPR6
It is recommended that the Microchip header files, supplied with MPLAB® IDE, be used for the symbolic bit
names in these registers. This allows the assembler/
compiler to automatically take care of the placement of
these bits within the specified register.
In general, interrupt sources have three bits to control
their operation. They are:
• Flag bit – Indicating that an interrupt event
occurred
• Enable bit – Enabling program execution to
branch to the interrupt vector address when the
flag bit is set
• Priority bit – Specifying high priority or low priority
10.1
Mid-Range Compatibility
When the IPEN bit is cleared (default state), the
interrupt priority feature is disabled and interrupts are
compatible with PIC® microcontroller mid-range
devices. In Compatibility mode, the interrupt priority
bits of the IPRx registers have no effect. The PEIE/
GIEL bit of the INTCON register is the global interrupt
enable for the peripherals. The PEIE/GIEL bit disables
only the peripheral interrupt sources and enables the
peripheral interrupt sources when the GIE/GIEH bit is
also set. The GIE/GIEH bit of the INTCON register is
the global interrupt enable which enables all nonperipheral interrupt sources and disables all interrupt
sources, including the peripherals. All interrupts
branch to address 0008h in Compatibility mode.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
10.2
Interrupt Priority
The interrupt priority feature is enabled by setting the
IPEN bit of the RCON register. When interrupt priority
is enabled the GIE/GIEH and PEIE/GIEL global
interrupt enable bits of Compatibility mode are
replaced by the GIEH high priority, and GIEL low
priority, global interrupt enables. When set, the GIEH
bit of the INTCON register enables all interrupts that
have their associated IPRx register or INTCONx
register priority bit set (high priority). When clear, the
GIEH bit disables all interrupt sources including those
selected as low priority. When clear, the GIEL bit of
the INTCON register disables only the interrupts that
have their associated priority bit cleared (low priority).
When set, the GIEL bit enables the low priority
sources when the GIEH bit is also set. When the
interrupt flag, enable bit and appropriate Global
Interrupt Enable (GIE) bit are all set, the interrupt will
vector immediately to address 0008h for high priority,
or 0018h for low priority, depending on level of the
interrupting source’s priority bit. Individual interrupts
can be disabled through their corresponding interrupt
enable bits.
10.3
Interrupt Response
When an interrupt is responded to, the Global Interrupt
Enable bit is cleared to disable further interrupts. The
GIE/GIEH bit is the global interrupt enable when the
IPEN bit is cleared. When the IPEN bit is set, enabling
interrupt priority levels, the GIEH bit is the high priority
global interrupt enable and the GIEL bit is the low
priority global interrupt enable. High priority interrupt
sources can interrupt a low priority interrupt. Low
priority interrupts are not processed while high priority
interrupts are in progress.
The return address is pushed onto the stack and the
PC is loaded with the interrupt vector address (0008h
or 0018h). Once in the Interrupt Service Routine, the
source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling
the interrupt flag bits in the INTCONx and PIRx
registers. The interrupt flag bits must be cleared by
software before re-enabling interrupts to avoid
repeating the same interrupt.
The “return from interrupt” instruction, RETFIE, exits
the interrupt routine and sets the GIE/GIEH bit (GIEH
or GIEL if priority levels are used), which re-enables
interrupts.
DS30000575C-page 169
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
For external interrupt events, such as the INT pins or
the PORTB interrupt-on-change, the interrupt latency
will be three to four instruction cycles. The exact
latency is the same for one-cycle or two-cycle
instructions. Individual interrupt flag bits are set,
regardless of the status of their corresponding enable
bits or the Global Interrupt Enable bit.
Note:
Do not use the MOVFF instruction to modify
any of the Interrupt Control registers while
any interrupt is enabled. Doing so may
cause erratic microcontroller behavior.
FIGURE 10-1:
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY INTERRUPT LOGIC
PIR1
PIE1
IPR1
PIR2
PIE2
IPR2
PIR3
PIE3
IPR3
PIR4
PIE4
IPR4
PIR5
PIE5
IPR5
Wake-up if in
Idle or Sleep modes
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
INT0IF
INT0IE
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
INT3IF
INT3IE
INT3IP
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0008h
GIE/GIEH
IPEN
PIR6
PIE6
IPR6
IPEN
PEIE/GIEL
IPEN
High-Priority Interrupt Generation
Low-Priority Interrupt Generation
PIR1
PIE1
IPR1
PIR2
PIE2
IPR2
PIR3
PIE3
IPR3
PIR4
PIE4
IPR4
PIR5
PIE5
IPR5
PIR6
PIE6
IPR6
DS30000575C-page 170
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
INT3IF
INT3IE
INT3IP
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0018h
IPEN
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.4
INTCON Registers
Note:
The INTCON registers are readable and writable
registers that contain various enable, priority and flag
bits.
REGISTER 10-1:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the Global
Interrupt Enable bit. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
This feature allows for software polling.
INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
IOCIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
IOCIF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
GIE/GIEH: Global Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1 = Enables all unmasked interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts including peripherals
When IPEN = 1:
1 = Enables all high-priority interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts including low priority
bit 6
PEIE/GIEL: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1 = Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts
When IPEN = 1:
1 = Enables all low-priority peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all low-priority peripheral interrupts
bit 5
TMR0IE: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
bit 4
INT0IE: INT0 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT0 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT0 external interrupt
bit 3
IOCIE: I/O Change Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the I/O port change interrupt
0 = Disables the I/O port change interrupt
bit 2
TMR0IF: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR0 register has not overflowed
bit 1
INT0IF: INT0 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT0 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT0 external interrupt did not occur
bit 0
IOCIF: I/O Port Change Interrupt Flag bit
1 = At least one of the IOC pins changed state (must be cleared by clearing all the IOCF bits in
the IOC module)
0 = None of the IOC pins have changed state
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 171
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-2:
INTCON2: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
RBPU
INTEDG0
INTEDG1
INTEDG2
INTEDG3
TMR0IP
INT3IP
IOCIP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
RBPU: PORTB Pull-up Enable bit
1 = All PORTB pull-ups are disabled
0 = PORTB pull-ups are enabled by individual port latch values
bit 6
INTEDG0: External Interrupt 0 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 5
INTEDG1: External Interrupt 1 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 4
INTEDG2: External Interrupt 2 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 3
INTEDG3: External Interrupt 3 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 2
TMR0IP: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
INT3IP: INT3 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
IOCIP: RB Port Change Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
Note:
x = Bit is unknown
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding
enable bit or the Global Interrupt Enable bit. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. This feature allows for software polling.
DS30000575C-page 172
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-3:
INTCON3: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 3
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
INT2IP
INT1IP
INT3IE
INT2IE
INT1IE
INT3IF
INT2IF
INT1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
INT2IP: INT2 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
INT1IP: INT1 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
INT3IE: INT3 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT3 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT3 external interrupt
bit 4
INT2IE: INT2 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT2 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT2 external interrupt
bit 3
INT1IE: INT1 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT1 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT1 external interrupt
bit 2
INT3IF: INT3 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT3 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT3 external interrupt did not occur
bit 1
INT2IF: INT2 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT2 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT2 external interrupt did not occur
bit 0
INT1IF: INT1 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT1 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT1 external interrupt did not occur
Note:
x = Bit is unknown
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs regardless of the state of its corresponding
enable bit or the Global Interrupt Enable bit. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. This feature allows for software polling.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 173
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.5
PIR Registers
The PIR registers contain the individual flag bits for the
peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of peripheral
interrupt sources, there are six Peripheral Interrupt
Request (Flag) registers (PIR1 through PIR5).
Note 1: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit or
the Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE
(INTCON).
2: User software should ensure the
appropriate interrupt flag bits are cleared
prior to enabling an interrupt and after
servicing that interrupt.
REGISTER 10-4:
PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSP1IF
TMR1GIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
PSPIF: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A read or write operation has taken place (must be cleared in software)
0 = No read or write operation has occurred
bit 6
ADIF: A/D Converter Interrupt Flag bit
1 = An A/D conversion completed (must be cleared in software)
0 = The A/D conversion is not complete
bit 5
RC1IF: EUSART1 Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART1 receive buffer, RCREG1, is full (cleared when RCREG1 is read)
0 = The EUSART1 receive buffer is empty
bit 4
TX1IF: EUSART1 Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART1 transmit buffer, TXREG1, is empty (cleared when TXREG1 is written)
0 = The EUSART1 transmit buffer is full
bit 3
SSP1IF: Master Synchronous Serial Port 1 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The transmission/reception is complete (must be cleared in software)
0 = Waiting to transmit/receive
bit 2
TMR1GIF: Timer1 Gate Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Timer gate interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No timer gate interrupt occurred
bit 1
TMR2IF: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR2 to PR2 match occurred
bit 0
TMR1IF: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR1 register did not overflow
DS30000575C-page 174
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-5:
PIR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
OSCFIF
SSP2IF
BCL2IF
USBIF
BCL1IF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
TMR3GIF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
OSCFIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Device oscillator failed, clock input has changed to INTOSC (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = Device clock operating
bit 6
SSP2IF: Master Synchronous Serial Port 2 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The transmission/reception is complete (must be cleared in software)
0 = Waiting to transmit/receive
bit 5
BCL2IF: Bus Collision Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A bus collision has occurred while the MSSP1 module configured in I2C master was transmitting
(must be cleared in software)
0 = No bus collision occurred
bit 4
USBIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit
1 = USB requested an interrupt (must be cleared in software)
0 = No USB interrupt request
bit 3
BCL1IF: Bus Collision Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A bus collision occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No bus collision occurred
bit 2
HLVDIF: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A low-voltage condition occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = The device voltage is above the regulator’s low-voltage trip point
bit 1
TMR3IF: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR3 register overflowed (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR3 register did not overflow
bit 0
TMR3GIF: TMR3 Gate Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Timer gate interrupt occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No timer gate interrupt occurred
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 175
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-6:
PIR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 3
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR5GIF
LCDIF
RC2IF
TX2IF
CTMUIF
CCP2IF
CCP1IF
RTCCIF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
TMR5GIF: TMR5 Gate Interrupt Flag bits
1 = TMR gate interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR gate occurred
bit 6
LCDIF: LCD Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A write is allowed to the Segment Data Registers
0 = A write is not allowed to the Segment Data Register
bit 5
RC2IF: EUSART2 Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART2 receive buffer, RCREG2, is full (cleared when RCREG2 is read)
0 = The EUSART2 receive buffer is empty
bit 4
TX2IF: EUSART2 Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART2 transmit buffer, TXREG2, is empty (cleared when TXREG2 is written)
0 = The EUSART2 transmit buffer is full
bit 3
CTMUIF: CTMU Interrupt Flag bit
1 = CTMU interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No CTMU interrupt occurred
bit 2
CCP2IF: CCP2 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 1
CCP1IF: ECCP1 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 0
RTCCIF: RTCC Interrupt Flag bit
1 = RTCC interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No RTCC interrupt occurred
DS30000575C-page 176
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-7:
PIR4: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 4
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCP10IF
CCP9IF
CCP8IF
CCP7IF
CCP6IF
CCP5IF
CCP4IF
ECCP3IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CCP10IF: CCP10 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 6
CCP9IF: CCP9 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 5
CCP8IF: CCP8 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 4
CCP7IF: CCP7 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 177
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-7:
PIR4: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 4 (CONTINUED)
bit 3
CCP6IF: CCP6 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 2
CCP5IF: CCP5 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 1
CCP4IF: CCP4 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
bit 0
ECCP3IF: ECCP3 Interrupt Flag bits
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR register capture occurred (bit must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Not used in PWM mode.
DS30000575C-page 178
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-8:
PIR5: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 5
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
ACTORSIF
ACTLOCKIF
TMR8IF
—
TMR6IF
TMR5IF
TMR4IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6
ACTORSIF: Active Clock Tuning Out-of-Range Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Active clock tuning out-of-range occurred
0 = Active tuning out-of-range did not occur
bit 5
ACTLOCKIF: Active Clock Tuning Lock Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Active clock tuning lock/unlock occurred
0 = Active clock tuning lock/unlock did not occur
bit 4
TMR8IF: TMR8 to PR8 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR8 to PR8 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR8 to PR8 match occurred
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
TMR6IF: TMR6 to PR6 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR6 to PR6 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR6 to PR6 match occurred
bit 1
TMR5IF: TMR5 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR5 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR5 register did not overflow
bit 0
TMR4IF: TMR4 to PR4 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR4 to PR4 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR4 to PR4 match occurred
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 179
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-9:
PIR6: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 6
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RC4IF
TX4IF
RC3IF
TX3IF
—
CMP3IF
CMP2IF
CMP1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
RC4IF: EUSART4 Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART4 receive buffer is full (cleared by reading RCREG4)
0 = The EUSART4 receive buffer is empty
bit 6
TX4IF: EUSART4 Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART4 transmit buffer is empty (cleared by writing to TXREG4)
0 = The EUSART4 transmit buffer is full
bit 5
RC3IF: EUSART3 Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART3 receive buffer is full (cleared by reading RCREG3)
0 = The EUSART3 receive buffer is empty
bit 4
TX3IF: EUSART3 Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART3 transmit buffer is empty (cleared by writing to TXREG3)
0 = The EUSART3 transmit buffer is full
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
CMP3IF: CMP3 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = CMP3 interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No CMP3 interrupt occurred
bit 1
CMP2IF: CMP2 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = CMP2 interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No CMP2 interrupt occurred
bit 0
CMP1IF: CM1 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = CMP1 interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No CMP1 interrupt occurred
DS30000575C-page 180
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.6
PIE Registers
The PIE registers contain the individual enable bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are six Peripheral
Interrupt Enable registers (PIE1 through PIE6). When
IPEN (RCON) = 0, the PEIE bit must be set to
enable any of these peripheral interrupts.
REGISTER 10-10: PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSP1IE
TMR1GIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
PSPIE: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the PSP read/write interrupt
0 = Disables the PSP read/write interrupt
bit 6
ADIE: A/D Converter Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the A/D interrupt
0 = Disables the A/D interrupt
bit 5
RC1IE: EUSART1 Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the EUSART1 receive interrupt
0 = Disables the EUSART1 receive interrupt
bit 4
TX1IE: EUSART1 Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the EUSART1 transmit interrupt
0 = Disables the EUSART1 transmit interrupt
bit 3
SSP1IE: Master Synchronous Serial Port 1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the MSSP1 interrupt
0 = Disables the MSSP1 interrupt
bit 2
TMR1GIE: TMR1 Gate Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the gate
0 = Disables the gate
bit 1
TMR2IE: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
bit 0
TMR1IE: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 181
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-11: PIE2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
OSCFIE
SSP2IE
BCL2IE
USBIE
BCL1IE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
TMR3GIE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
OSCFIE: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 6
SSP2IE: Master Synchronous Serial Port 2 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the MSSP2 interrupt
0 = Disables the MSSP2 interrupt
bit 5
BCL2IE: Bus Collision Interrupt Enable bit (MSSP)
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 4
USBIE: USB Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 3
BCLIE: Bus Collision Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 2
HLVDIE: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 1
TMR3IE: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 0
TMR3GIE: Timer3 Gate Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
DS30000575C-page 182
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-12: PIE3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 3
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR5GIE
LCDIE
RC2IE
TX2IE
CTMUIE
CCP2IE
CCP1IE
RTCCIE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
TMR5GIE: TMR5 Gate Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 6
LCDIE: LCD Ready Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 5
RC2IE: EUSART2 Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 4
TX2IE: EUSART2 Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 3
CTMUIE: CTMU Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 2
CCP2IE: CCP2 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 1
CCP1IE: ECCP1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 0
RTCCIE: RTCC Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 183
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-13: PIE4: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 4
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCP10IE
CCP9IE
CCP8IE
CCP7IE
CCP6IE
CCP5IE
CCP4IE
ECCP3IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CCP10IE: CCP10 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 6
CCP9IE: CCP9 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 5
CCP8IE: CCP8 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 4
CCP7IE: CCP7 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 3
CCP6IE: CCP6 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 2
CCP5IE: CCP5 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 1
CCP4IE: CCP4 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 0
ECCP3IE: ECCP3 Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
DS30000575C-page 184
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-14: PIE5: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 5
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
ACTORSIE
ACTLOCKIE
TMR8IE
—
TMR6IE
TMR5IE
TMR4IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6
ACTORSIE: Active Clock Tuning Out-of-Range Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the active clock tuning out-of-range interrupt
0 = Disables the active clock tuning out-of-range interrupt
bit 5
ACTLOCKIE: Active Clock Tuning Lock Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the active clock tuning lock/unlock interrupt
0 = Disables the active clock tuning lock/unlock interrupt
bit 4
TMR8IE: TMR8 to PR8 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR8 to PR8 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR8 to PR8 match interrupt
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
TMR6IE: TMR6 to PR6 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR6 to PR6 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR6 to PR6 match interrupt
bit 1
TMR5IE: TMR5 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR5 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR5 overflow interrupt
bit 0
TMR4IE: TMR4 to PR4 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR4 to PR4 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR4 to PR4 match interrupt
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 185
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-15: PIE6: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 6
R/W-0
R/W-0
RC4IE
TX4IE
R/W-0
RC3IE
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TX3IE
—
CMP3IE
CMP2IE
CMP1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
RC4IE: EUSART4 Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 6
TX4IE: EUSART4 Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 5
RC34IE: EUSART3 Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 4
TX3IE: EUSART3 Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
CMP3IE: Comparator 3 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 1
CMP2IE: Comparator 2 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 0
CMP1IE: Comparator 1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
DS30000575C-page 186
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.7
IPR Registers
The IPR registers contain the individual priority bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are six Peripheral
Interrupt Priority registers (IPR1 through IPR6). Using
the priority bits requires that the Interrupt Priority
Enable (IPEN) bit (RCON) be set.
REGISTER 10-16: IPR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSP1IP
TMR1GIP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
PSPIP: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
ADIP: A/D Converter Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
RC1IP: EUSART1 Receive Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TX1IP: EUSART1 Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
x = Bit is unknown
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
SSP1IP: Master Synchronous Serial Port 1 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
TMR1GIP: Timer1 Gate Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
TMR2IP: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
TMR1IP: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 187
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-17: IPR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 2
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
OSCFIP
SSP2IP
BCL2IP
USBIP
BCL1IP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
TMR3GIP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
OSCFIP: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
SSP2IP: Master Synchronous Serial Port 2 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
BCL2IP: Bus Collision Interrupt Priority bit (MSSP)
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
USBIP: USB Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
BCL1IP: Bus Collision Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
HLVDIP: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
TMR3IP: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
TMR3GIP: TMR3 Gate Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
DS30000575C-page 188
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-18: IPR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 3
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TMR5GIP
LCDIP
RC2IP
TX2IP
CTMUIP
CCP2IP
CCP1IP
RTCCIP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
TMR5GIP: TMR5 Gate Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
LCDIP: LCD Ready Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
RC2IP: EUSART2 Receive Priority Flag bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TX2IP: EUSART2 Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
CTMUIP: CTMU Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
CCP2IP: CCP2 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
CCP1IP: ECCP1 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
RTCCIP: RTCC Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 189
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-19: IPR4: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 4
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
CCP10IP
CCP9IP
CCP8IP
CCP7IP
CCP6IP
CCP5IP
CCP4IP
ECCP3IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CCP10IP: CCP10 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
CCP9IP: CCP9 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
CCP8IP: CCP8 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
CCP7IP: CCP7 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
CCP6IP: CCP6 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
CCP5IP: CCP5 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
CCP4IP: CCP4 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
ECCP3IP: ECCP3 Interrupt Priority bits
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
DS30000575C-page 190
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-20: IPR5: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 5
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
—
ACTORSIP
ACTLOCKIP
TMR8IP
—
TMR6IP
TMR5IP
TMR4IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6
ACTORSIP: Active Clock Tuning Out-of-Range Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
ACTLOCKIP: Active Clock Tuning Lock Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TMR8IP: TMR8 to PR8 Match Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
TMR6IP: TMR6 to PR6 Match Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
TMR5IP: TMR5 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
TMR4IP: TMR4 to PR4 Match Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 191
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-21: IPR6: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 6
R/W-1
R/W-1
RC4IP
TX4IP
R/W-1
RC3IP
R/W-1
U-O
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TX3IP
—
CMP3IP
CMP2IP
CMP1IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
RCP4IP: EUSART4 Receive Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
TX4IP: EUSART4 Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
RC3IP: EUSART3 Receive Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TX3IP: EUSART3 Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
CMP3IP: CMP3 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
CMP2IP: CMP2 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
CMP1IP: CMP1 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
DS30000575C-page 192
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.8
RCON Register
The RCON register contains bits used to determine the
cause of the last Reset or wake-up from Idle or Sleep
modes. RCON also contains the bit that enables
interrupt priorities (IPEN).
REGISTER 10-22: RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R-1
R-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
IPEN
—
CM
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable bit
1 = Enables priority levels on interrupts
0 = Disables priority levels on interrupts (PIC16CXXX Compatibility mode)
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
CM: Configuration Mismatch Flag bit
1 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset has not occurred
0 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset has occurred (must be subsequently set in software)
bit 4
RI: RESET Instruction Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 5-1.
bit 3
TO: Watchdog Timer Time-out Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 5-1.
bit 2
PD: Power-Down Detection Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 5-1.
bit 1
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 5-1.
bit 0
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 5-1.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 193
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.9
INTx Pin Interrupts
External interrupts on INT0, INT1, INT2 and INT3 are
edge-triggered. INT0 is multiplexed with RB0 pin
whereas INT1, INT2 and INT3 can only be used via
remappable pins as shown in Table 11-13. If the
corresponding INTEDGx bit in the INTCON2 register is
set (= 1), the interrupt is triggered by a rising edge. If
that bit is clear, the trigger is on the falling edge.
When a valid edge appears on the RBx/INTx pin, the
corresponding flag bit, INTxIF, is set. This interrupt can
be disabled by clearing the corresponding enable bit,
INTxIE. Before re-enabling the interrupt, the flag bit
(INTxIF) must be cleared in software in the Interrupt
Service Routine.
All external interrupts (INT0, INT1, INT2 and INT3) can
wake-up the processor from the power-managed
modes if bit, INTxIE, was set prior to going into the
power-managed modes. If the Global Interrupt Enable
bit (GIE) is set, the processor will branch to the interrupt
vector following wake-up.
The interrupt priority for INT1, INT2 and INT3 is
determined by the value contained in the Interrupt
Priority bits, INT1IP (INTCON3), INT2IP
(INTCON3) and INT3IP (INTCON2).
There is no priority bit associated with INT0. It is always
a high-priority interrupt source.
The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing
enable bit, TMR0IE (INTCON). Interrupt priority for
Timer0 is determined by the value contained in the interrupt priority bit, TMR0IP (INTCON2). For further
details on the Timer0 module, see Section 14.0 “Timer0
Module”.
10.11 Edge-Selectable Interrupt-onChange
Interrupt-on-change pins are selected via the PPS
register settings and have the option of generating an
interrupt on positive or negative transitions, or both.
Positive edge events are enabled by setting the corresponding bits in the IOCP register, while negative edge
events are enabled by setting the corresponding bits in
the IOCN register. For compatibility with the previous
interrupt-on-change feature, both the IOCP and IOCN
bits should be set. The interrupt can be enabled by
setting/clearing the IOCIE (INTCON) bit. Each
individual pin can be disabled by clearing both of the
corresponding IOCN/IOCP bits. A change event (either
positive or negative edge) will cause the corresponding
IOCF flag to be set.
Interrupt priority for the edge selectable interrupt-onchange is determined by the interrupt priority bit,
IOCIP (INTCON2).
10.10 TMR0 Interrupt
In 8-bit mode (the default), an overflow in the TMR0
register (FFh 00h) will set flag bit, TMR0IF. In 16-bit
mode, an overflow in the TMR0H:TMR0L register pair
(FFFFh 0000h) will set TMR0IF.
DS30000575C-page 194
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 10-23: IOCP: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE POSITIVE EDGE REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
IOCP7
IOCP6
IOCP5
IOCP4
IOCP3
IOCP2
IOCP1
IOCP0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
IOCP: Interrupt-on-Change Positive Edge Enable bits
1 = Interrupt-on-change is enabled on the pin for a rising edge; associated Status bit and interrupt flag
will be set upon detecting an edge
0 = Interrupt-on-change is disabled for the associated pin
REGISTER 10-24: IOCN: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE NEGATIVE EDGE REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
IOCN7
IOCN6
IOCN5
IOCN4
IOCN3
IOCN2
IOCN1
IOCN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
IOCN: Interrupt-on-Change Negative Edge Enable bits
1 = Interrupt-on-change is enabled on the pin for a falling edge; associated Status bit and interrupt
flag will be set upon detecting an edge
0 = Interrupt-on-change is disabled for the associated pin
REGISTER 10-25: IOCF: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE FLAG REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
IOCF7
IOCF6
IOCF5
IOCF4
IOCF3
IOCF2
IOCF1
IOCF0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
IOCF: Interrupt-on-Change Flag bits
1 = An enabled change was detected on the associated pin; this is set when IOCP = 1 and a positive
edge was detected on the input pin or when IOCN = 1 and a negative edge was detected on the
input pin (clear in software to clear the IOCIF bit)
0 = No change was detected or the user cleared the detected change
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 195
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
10.12 Context Saving During Interrupts
During interrupts, the return PC address is saved on
the stack. Additionally, the WREG, STATUS and BSR
registers are saved on the Fast Return Stack.
If a fast return from interrupt is not used (see
Section 6.3 “Data Memory Organization”), the user
may need to save the WREG, STATUS and BSR registers on entry to the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR).
Depending on the user’s application, other registers
also may need to be saved.
Example 10-1 saves and restores the WREG, STATUS
and BSR registers during an Interrupt Service Routine.
EXAMPLE 10-1:
MOVWF
MOVFF
MOVFF
;
; USER
;
MOVFF
MOVF
MOVFF
SAVING STATUS, WREG AND BSR REGISTERS IN RAM
W_TEMP
STATUS, STATUS_TEMP
BSR, BSR_TEMP
; W_TEMP is in virtual bank
; STATUS_TEMP located anywhere
; BSR_TMEP located anywhere
ISR CODE
BSR_TEMP, BSR
W_TEMP, W
STATUS_TEMP, STATUS
DS30000575C-page 196
; Restore BSR
; Restore WREG
; Restore STATUS
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.0
I/O PORTS
11.1
Depending on the device selected and features
enabled, there are up to eleven ports available. Some
pins of the I/O ports are multiplexed with an alternate
function from the peripheral features on the device. In
general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may not
be used as a general purpose I/O pin.
Each port has three memory mapped registers for its
operation:
• TRIS register (Data Direction register)
• PORT register (reads the levels on the pins of the
device)
• LAT register (Output Latch register)
Reading the PORT register reads the current status of
the pins, whereas writing to the PORT register, writes
to the Output Latch (LAT) register.
Setting a TRIS bit (= 1) makes the corresponding
PORT pin an input (putting the corresponding output
driver in a High-Impedance mode). Clearing a TRIS bit
(= 0) makes the corresponding port pin an output (i.e.,
driving the contents of the corresponding LAT bit on the
selected pin).
The Output Latch (LAT register) is useful for readmodify-write operations on the value that the I/O pins
are driving. Read-modify-write operations on the LAT
register read and write the latched output value for the
PORT register.
A simplified model of a generic I/O port, without the
interfaces to other peripherals, is shown in Figure 11-1.
FIGURE 11-1:
GENERIC I/O PORT
OPERATION
RD LAT
Data
Bus
WR LAT
or PORT
D
I/O Port Pin Capabilities
When developing an application, the capabilities of the
port pins must be considered.
The Absolute Maximum Ratings of the I/O pins are as
follows:
• RA2, RA3 = -300mV to (VDD + 300 mV)
• RA6, RA7, RC0, RC1 = -300 mV to (VDD
+300 mV)(1)
• RF3/RF4 (the USB D+/D- pins) = supports “USB
specific levels” (e.g.: -1.0V to +4.6V, but only
when the external source impedance is >/= 28
ohms, and the VUSB3V3 pin voltage is >/= 3.0V,
otherwise: -500 mV to (VUSB3V3 +500 mV)
• All other general purpose I/O pins (including
MCLR), when VDD is < 2.0V: -300 mV to +4.0V.
• All other general purpose I/O pins (including
MCLR), when VDD is >= 2.0V: -300 mV to
+6.0V(2).
Note 1: When the pins are used to drive a
crystal or ceramic resonator, natural
oscillation waveforms slightly exceeding
the -300 mV to (VDD +300 mV) range
may sometimes occur, and if present,
such waveforms are allowed. If these
pins are instead used as general
purpose inputs, the external driving
source should adhere to the -300 mV to
(VDD +300 mV) specification.
2: In addition to the above absolute
maximums, any I/O pin voltage that is
actively selected at runtime by the ADC
channel select MUX must also meet the
VAIN requirements (parameter A25 in
Table 30-40).
Q
I/O Pin
CKx
Data Latch
D
WR TRIS
Q
CKx
TRIS Latch
Input
Buffer
RD TRIS
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 197
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.1.1
OUTPUT PIN DRIVE
When used as digital I/O, the output pin drive strengths
vary, according to the pins’ grouping, to meet the needs
for a variety of applications. In general, there are two
classes of output pins in terms of drive capability:
• Outputs designed to drive higher current loads,
such as LEDs:
- PORTB
- PORTC
• Outputs with lower drive levels, but capable of
driving normal digital circuit loads with a high input
impedance. Able to drive LEDs, but only those
with smaller current requirements:
- PORTA
- PORTD
- PORTE
- PORTF
- PORTG
- PORTH(1)
- PORTJ(1)
- PORTK(2)
(2)
- PORTL
Note 1: These ports are not available on 64-pin
devices.
2: These ports are not available on 64-pin or
80-pin devices.
11.1.2
PULL-UP CONFIGURATION
Nine of the I/O ports (all ports except PORTA and
PORTC) implement configurable weak pull-ups on all
pins. These are internal pull-ups that allow floating
digital input signals to be pulled to a consistent level
without the use of external resistors.
Pull-ups for PORTB are enabled by clearing the RBPU
bit (INTCON2). PORTB pull-ups are individually
selectable through the WPUB register.
Pull-ups for PORTD, PORTE, PORTF, PORTG,
PORTH, PORTJ, PORTK and PORTL are enabled
through their corresponding enable bits in the PADCFG
register, but are not pin-selectable.
DS30000575C-page 198
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 11-1:
PADCFG1: PAD CONFIGURATION REGISTER 1(1)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RDPU
REPU
RFPU
RGPU
RHPU
RJPU
RKPU
RLPU
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
RDPU: PORTD Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTD pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTD pull-ups are disabled
bit 6
REPU: PORTE Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTE pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTE pull-ups are disabled
bit 5
RFPU: PORTF Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTF pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTF pull-ups are disabled
bit 4
RGPU: PORTG Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTG pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTG pull-ups are disabled
bit 3
RHPU: PORTH Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTH pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTH pull-ups are disabled
bit 2
RJPU: PORTJ Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTJ pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTJ pull-ups are disabled
bit 1
RKPU: PORTK Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTK pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTK pull-ups are disabled
bit 0
RLPU: PORTL Pull-up Enable bit
1 = PORTL pull-ups are enabled for any input pad
0 = All PORTL pull-ups are disabled
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
If a particular PORT is not available on a package, the corresponding RnPU register bit will be
unimplemented and read back as ‘0’.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 199
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.1.3
OPEN-DRAIN OUTPUTS
FIGURE 11-2:
The output pins for several peripherals are also
equipped with a configurable, open-drain output option.
This allows the peripherals to communicate with
external digital logic, operating at a higher voltage
level, without the use of level translators.
USING THE OPEN-DRAIN
OUTPUT (USART SHOWN
AS EXAMPLE)
3.3V
+5V
PIC18F97J94
The open-drain option is implemented on the
EUSARTs, the MSSPx modules (in SPI mode) and the
CCP modules. These modules are assigned to an I/O
pin using the PPS (Peripheral Pin Select) feature. The
open-drain option is enabled by setting the open-drain
control bits in the ODCON1 and ODCON2 registers.
VDD
TXX
(at logic ‘1’)
3.3V
5V
When the open-drain option is required, the output pin
must also be tied through an external pull-up resistor,
provided by the user, to a higher voltage level, up to 5V
(Figure 11-2). When a digital logic high signal is output,
it is pulled up to the higher voltage level.
REGISTER 11-2:
ODCON1: PERIPHERAL OPEN-DRAIN CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ECCP2OD
ECCP1OD
USART4OD
USART3OD
USART2OD
USART1OD
SSP2OD
SSP1OD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
ECCP2OD: ECCP2 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 6
ECCP1OD: ECCP1 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 5
USART4OD: EUSART4 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 4
USART3OD: EUSART3 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 3
USART2OD: EUSART2 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 2
USART1OD: EUSART1 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 1
SSP2OD: Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 0
SSP1OD: SPI1 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
DS30000575C-page 200
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 11-3:
ODCON2: PERIPHERAL OPEN-DRAIN CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCP10OD
CCP9OD
CCP8OD
CCP7OD
CCP6OD
CCP5OD
CCP4OD
ECCP3OD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CCP10OD: CCP10 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 6
CCP9OD: CCP9 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 5
CCP8OD: CCP8 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 4
CCP7OD: CCP7 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 3
CCP6OD: CCP6 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 2
CCP5OD: CCP5 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 1
CCP4OD: CCP4 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
bit 0
ECCP3OD: ECCP3 Open-Drain Output Enable bit
1 = Open-drain capability is enabled
0 = Open-drain capability is disabled
11.1.4
ANALOG AND DIGITAL PORTS
Many of the ports multiplex analog and digital functionality, providing a lot of flexibility for hardware designers.
PIC18FXXJ94 devices can make any analog pin analog or digital, depending on an application’s needs. The
ports’ analog/digital functionality is controlled by the
registers: ANCON1, ANCON2 and ANCON3.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
Setting these registers makes the corresponding pins
analog and clearing the registers makes the ports
digital. For details on these registers, see Section 22.0
“12-Bit A/D Converter with Threshold Scan”
DS30000575C-page 201
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.2
PORTA, LATA and TRISA
Registers
PORTA is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers are
TRISA and LATA.
All PORTA pins have Schmitt Trigger input levels and
full CMOS output drivers.
RA are multiplexed with analog inputs for the A/D
Converter.
The operation of the analog inputs as A/D Converter
inputs is selected by clearing or setting the ANSELx
control bits in the ANCON1 register. The corresponding
TRISA bits control the direction of these pins, even
when they are being used as analog inputs. The user
must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are
maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
Note:
RA are configured as analog inputs
on any Reset and are read as ‘0’.
TABLE 11-1:
EXAMPLE 11-1:
CLRF
PORTA
CLRF
LATA
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
BANKSEL
MOVLW
ANCON1
00h
ANCON1
TRISA
0BFh
MOVWF
TRISA
INITIALIZING PORTA
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTA by
clearing output latches
Alternate method to
clear output data latches
Select bank with ANCON1 register
Configure A/D
for digital inputs
Select bank with TRISA register
Value used to initialize
data direction
Set RA as inputs,
RA as output
PORTA FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RA0/AN0/AN1-/RP0/
SEG19
RA1/AN1/RP1/SEG18
RA2/AN2/VREF-/RP2/
SEG21
Legend:
OSC2/CLKO/RA6 and OSC1/CLKI/RA7 normally
serve as the external circuit connections for the External (Primary) Oscillator circuit (HS Oscillator modes),
or the external clock input and output (EC Oscillator
modes). In these cases, RA6 and RA7 are not available
as digital I/O, and their corresponding TRIS and LAT
bits are read as ‘0’. When the device is configured to
use either the FRC or LPRC Internal Oscillators as the
default oscillator mode, RA6 and RA7 are automatically
configured as digital I/O; the oscillator and clock in/
clock out functions are disabled.
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RA0
0
O
DIG
Description
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
AN0
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 0. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN1-
1
I
ANA
Quasi-differential A/D negative input channel.
RP0
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 0 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of the module.
SEG19
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 19 output; disables all other pin functions.
RA1
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN1
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 1. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RP1
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 1 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
LCD Segment 18 output; disables all other pin functions.
SEG18
0
O
ANA
RA2
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
AN2
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 2. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
VREF-
1
I
ANA
A/D and Comparator Low Reference Voltage input.
RP2
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 2 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG21
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 21 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 202
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-1:
PORTA FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
RA3/AN3/VREF+/RP3
RA4/AN6/RP4/SEG14
RA5/AN4/RP5/LVDIN/
C1INA/C2INA/C3INA/
SEG15
RA6/RP6/CLKO/OSC2
RA7/RP10/CLKI/OSC1
Legend:
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RA3
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN3
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 3. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
VREF+
1
I
ANA
A/D and Comparator High Reference Voltage input.
RP3
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 3 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
RA4
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN6
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 6. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RP4
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 4 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG14
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 14 output; disables all other pin functions.
RA5
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN4
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 4. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RP5
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 5 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
LVDIN
1
I
ANA
High/Low-Voltage Detect (HLVD) external trip point input.
C1INA
1
I
ANA
Comparator 1 Input A.
Description
C2INA
1
I
ANA
Comparator 2 Input A.
C3INA
1
I
ANA
Comparator 3 Input A.
SEG15
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 15 output; disables all other pin functions.
RA6
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; disabled when OSC2 Configuration bit is set.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when OSC2 Configuration bit is set.
RP6
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 6 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
CLKO
x
O
DIG
System cycle clock output (FOSC/4, EC and Internal Oscillator
modes).
OSC2
x
O
ANA
Main oscillator feedback output connection (HS, MS and LP
modes).
RA7
0
O
DIG
LATA data output; disabled when OSC2 Configuration bit is set.
1
I
ST
PORTA data input; disabled when OSC2 Configuration bit is set.
RP10
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 10 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
CLKI
x
O
DIG
Main external clock source input (EC modes).
OSC1
x
O
ANA
Main oscillator input connection (HS, MS and LP modes).
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 203
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.3
PORTB, LATB and TRISB
Registers
PORTB is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISB and LATB. All pins on PORTB are digital only.
EXAMPLE 11-2:
CLRF
PORTB
CLRF
LATB
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISB
TABLE 11-2:
INITIALIZING PORTB
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
The RB pins are multiplexed as CTMU edge
inputs.
Initialize PORTB by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RB as inputs
RB as outputs
RB as inputs
PORTB FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RB0/INT0/CTED13/
RP8/VLCAP1
RB1/RP9/VLCAP2
RB2/CTED1/RP14/
SEG9
RB3/CTED2/RP7/
SEG10
Legend:
Each of the PORTB pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn on all the pull-ups. This is
performed by clearing bit, RBPU (INTCON2), and
setting the associated WPUB bit. The weak pull-up is
automatically turned off when the port pin is configured
as an output. The pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on
Reset.
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RB0
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
External Interrupt 0 input.
Description
INT0
1
I
ST
CTED13
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 13 input.
RP8
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 8 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
VLCAP1
x
x
ANA
External capacitor connection for LCD module.
RB1
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
RP9
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 9 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
VLCAP2
x
x
ANA
External capacitor connection for LCD module.
RB2
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
CTED1
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 1 input.
RP14
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 14 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG9
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 9 output; disables all other pin functions.
RB3
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
PORTB data input.
1
I
ST
CTED2
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 2 input.
RP7
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 7 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG10
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 10 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 204
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-2:
Pin Name
RB4/CTED3/RP12/
SEG11
RB5/CTED4/RP13/
SEG8
RB6/CTED5/PGC
RB7/CTED6/PGD
Legend:
PORTB FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RB4
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
CTED3
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 3 input.
RP12
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 12 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG11
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 11 output; disables all other pin functions.
RB5
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
PORTB data input.
Description
1
I
ST
CTED4
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 4 input.
RP13
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 13 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match
input/output of module.
SEG8
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 8 output; disables all other pin functions.
RB6
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
CTED5
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 5 input.
PGC
x
I
ST
Serial execution (ICSP™) clock input for ICSP and ICD
operations.
RB7
0
O
DIG
LATB data output.
1
I
ST
PORTB data input.
CTED6
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 6 input.
PGD
x
I/O
ST/DIG Serial execution (ICSP™) data input/output for ICSP and ICD
operations.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 205
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.4
PORTC, LATC and TRISC
Registers
PORTC is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISC and LATC. Only PORTC pins, RC2 through
RC7, are digital only pins. The pins have Schmitt Trigger
input buffers.
The contents of the TRISC register are affected by
peripheral overrides. Reading TRISC always returns
the current contents, even though a peripheral device
may be overriding one or more of the pins.
EXAMPLE 11-3:
When enabling peripheral functions, use care in defining TRIS bits for each PORTC pin. Some peripherals
can override the TRIS bit to make a pin an output or
input. Consult the corresponding peripheral section for
the correct TRIS bit settings.
Note:
These pins are configured as digital inputs
on any device Reset.
TABLE 11-3:
CLRF
PORTC
CLRF
LATC
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISC
INITIALIZING PORTC
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTC by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RC as inputs
RC as outputs
RC as inputs
PORTC FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RC0/
PWRLCLK/
SCLKI/SOSCO
RC0
1
I
ST
PORTC data input.
PWRLCLK
1
I
ST
Optional RTCC input from power line clock (50 or 60 Hz).
ST
Digital SOSC input.
RC1/SOSCI
RC2/CTED7/
RP11/AN9/
SEG13
RC3/CTED8/
RP15/SCL1/
SEG17
RC4/CTED9/
RP17/SDA1/
SEG16
Legend:
SCLKI
x
I
SOSCO
x
O
Description
ANA Secondary Oscillator (SOSC) feedback output connection.
RC1
1
I
SOSCI
x
I
ANA Secondary Oscillator (SOSC) input connection.
ST
PORTC data input.
RC2
0
O
DIG
LATC data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTC data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
CTED7
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 7 input.
RP11
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 11 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
AN9
1
I
ANA A/D Input Channel 9. Default input configuration on POR; does not affect digital
output.
SEG13
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 13 output; disables all other pin functions.
RC3
0
O
DIG
LATC data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC data input.
CTED8
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 8 input.
RP15
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 15 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
SCL1
x
I/O
I2C
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C mode.
SEG17
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 17 output; disables all other pin functions
RC4
0
O
DIG
LATC data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC data input.
CTED9
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 9 input.
RP17
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 17 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
SDA1
x
I/O
I2C
I2C mode data I/O
SEG16
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 16 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input, I2C = I2C/SMBus,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 206
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-3:
Pin Name
RC5/CTED10/
RP16/SEG12
RC6/CTED11/
UOE/RP18/
SEG27
RC7/CTED12/
RP19/SEG22
Legend:
PORTC FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RC5
0
O
DIG
LATC data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC data input.
CTED10
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 10 input.
RP16
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 16 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
Description
SEG12
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 12 output; disables all other pin functions.
RC6
0
O
DIG
LATC data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC data input.
CTED11
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 11 input.
UOE
0
O
DIG
USB Output Enable control (for external transceiver).
RP18
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 18 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
SEG27
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 27 output; disables all other pin functions.
RC7
0
O
DIG
LATC data output.
PORTC data input.
1
I
ST
CTED12
1
I
ST
CTMU Edge 12 input.
RP19
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 19 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/output of
module.
SEG22
0
O
ANA LCD Segment 22 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input, I2C = I2C/SMBus,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 207
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.5
PORTD, LATD and
TRISD Registers
PORTD is the low-order byte of the multiplexed
Address/Data bus (AD). The TRISD bits are also
overridden.
PORTD is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISD and LATD.
All pins on PORTD are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
These pins are configured as digital inputs
on any device Reset.
PORTD also has I2C functionality on RD5 and RD6.
EXAMPLE 11-4:
Each of the PORTD pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn off all the pull-ups. This is
performed by setting bit, RDPU (PADCFG). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on all device Resets.
On 80-pin and 100-pin devices, PORTD is multiplexed
with the system bus as part of the external memory
interface. I/O port and other functions are only available
when the interface is disabled by setting the EBDIS bit
(MEMCON). When the interface is enabled,
TABLE 11-4:
PORTD can also be configured as an 8-bit wide microprocessor port (Parallel Slave Port) by setting control
bit, PSPMODE (PSPCON). In this mode, the input
buffers are TTL. For additional information, see
Section 11.13 “Parallel Slave Port”.
CLRF
PORTD
CLRF
LATD
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISD
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RD0/PSP0/
RP20/SEG0/AD0
RD0
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP0
x
I/O
RP20
x
x
SEG0
0
O
AD0
x
I/O
RD1
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP1
x
I/O
RP21
x
x
SEG1
0
O
AD1
x
I/O
RD2
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP2
x
I/O
RP22
x
x
SEG2
0
O
AD2
x
I/O
RD2/PSP2/
RP22/SEG2/AD2
Legend:
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTD by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RD as inputs
RD as outputs
RD as inputs
PORTD FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RD1/PSP1/
RP21/SEG1/AD1
INITIALIZING PORTD
Description
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 0.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 20 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Segment 0 output; disables all other pin functions.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 0.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 1.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 21 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Segment 1 output; disables all other pin functions.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 1.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 2.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 22 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Segment 2 output; disables all other pin functions.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 2.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
I2C = I2C/SMBus, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 208
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-4:
PORTD FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RD3/PSP3/
RP23/SEG3/AD3
RD3
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP3
x
I/O
RP23
x
x
RD4/PSP4/
RP24/SEG4/AD4
RD5/PSP5/
RP25/SDA2/
SEG5/AD5
RD6/PSP6/
RP26/SCL2/
SEG6/AD6
RD7/PSP7/
RP27/REFO2/
SEG7/AD7
Legend:
Description
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 3.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 23 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Segment 3 output; disables all other pin functions.
SEG3
0
O
AD3
x
I/O
RD4
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP4
x
I/O
RP24
x
x
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 3.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 4.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 24 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Segment 4 output; disables all other pin functions.
SEG4
0
O
AD4
x
I/O
RD5
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP5
x
I/O
RP25
x
x
SDA2
x
I/O
SEG5
0
O
AD5
x
I/O
RD6
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP6
x
I/O
RP26
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 26 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
SCL2
x
I/O
I2C
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C mode.
SEG6
0
O
AD6
x
I/O
RD7
0
O
DIG
LATD data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD data input.
PSP7
x
I/O
RP27
x
x
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 4.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 5.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 25 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ST/DIG I2C mode data I/O.
ANA
LCD Segment 5 output; disables all other pin functions.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 5.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 6.
ANA
LCD Segment 6 output; disables all other pin functions.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 6.
ST/DIG Parallel Slave Port Data Bus Bit 7.
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 27 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
REFO2
0
O
DIG
Reference Clock 2 output.
SEG7
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 7 output; disables all other pin functions.
AD7
x
I/O
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 7.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
I2C = I2C/SMBus, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 209
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.6
PORTE, LATE and
TRISE Registers
PORTE is also multiplexed with the Parallel Slave Port
address lines. RE2, RE1 and RE0 are multiplexed with
the control signals, CS, WR and RD.
PORTE is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISE and LATE.
All pins on PORTE are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
These pins are configured as digital inputs
on any device Reset.
Each of the PORTE pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn off all the pull-ups. This is
performed by setting bit, REPU (PADCFG). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on any device Reset.
RE3 can also be configured as the Reference Clock
Output (REFO) from the system clock. For further
details, see Section 3.4 “Reference Clock Output
Control Module”.
EXAMPLE 11-5:
CLRF
PORTE
CLRF
LATE
MOVLW
03h
MOVWF
TRISE
For devices operating in Microcontroller mode, the RE7
pin can be configured as the alternate peripheral pin for
the ECCP2 module and Enhanced PWM Output 2A.
TABLE 11-5:
Pin Name
RE0//RD/RP28/
LCDBIAS1/AD8
RE1//WR/RP29/
LCDBIAS2/AD9
RE2/CS/RP30/
LCDBIAS3/AD10
Legend:
INITIALIZING PORTE
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTE by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RE as inputs
RE as outputs
PORTE FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RE0
0
O
DIG
LATE data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
Description
RD
1
I
ST
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Read (RD) signal.
RP28
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 28 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
LCDBIAS1
x
I
ANA
LCD Module Bias Voltage Input 1.
AD8
x
I/O
RE1
0
O
DIG
LATE data output.
PORTE data input.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 8.
1
I
ST
WR
1
I
ST
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Write (WR) signal.
RP29
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 29 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
LCDBIAS2
x
I
ANA
LCD Module Bias Voltage Input 2.
AD9
x
I/O
RE2
0
O
DIG
LATE data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 9.
CS
1
I
ST
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Chip Select (CS) signal.
RP30
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 30 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
LCDBIAS3
x
I
ANA
LCD Module Bias Voltage Input 3.
AD10
x
I/O
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 10.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 210
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-5:
Pin Name
RE3/REFO1/
RP33/COM0/
AD11
RE4/RP32/
COM1/AD12
RE5/RP37/
COM2/AD13
RE6/RP34/
COM3/AD14
RE7/RP31/
LCDBIAS0/
AD15
Legend:
PORTE FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RE3
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
REFO1
0
O
DIG
Reference Clock Output 1.
RP33
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 33 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
ANA
LCD Common 0 output; disables all other outputs.
Description
LATE data output.
COM0
x
O
AD11
x
I/O
RE4
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
RP32
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 32 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
COM1
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 1 output; disables all other outputs.
AD12
x
I/O
RE5
0
O
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 11.
LATE data output.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 12.
DIG
LATE data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
RP37
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 37 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
COM2
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 2 output; disables all other outputs.
AD13
x
I/O
RE6
0
O
DIG
LATE data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
RP34
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 34 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
COM3
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 3 output; disables all other outputs.
AD14
x
I/O
RE7
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTE data input.
RP31
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 31 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
LCDBIAS0
x
I
ANA
LCD Module Bias Voltage Input 0.
AD15
x
I/O
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 13.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 14.
LATE data output.
ST/DIG External Memory Bus Address Line 15.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 211
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.7
PORTF, LATF and TRISF Registers
EXAMPLE 11-6:
PORTF is a 6-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISF and LATF. All pins on PORTF are
implemented with Schmitt Trigger input buffers. Each pin
is individually configurable as an input or output.
CLRF
PORTF
CLRF
LATF
Pins, RF2 through RF6, may be used as comparator
inputs or outputs by setting the appropriate bits in the
CMCON register. To use RF as digital inputs, it is
also necessary to turn off the comparators.
BANKSEL ANCON1
MOVLW
BFh
MOVWF
ANCON1
BANKSELANCON2;
MOVLW
F1h
MOVWF
ANCON2
BANKSEL TRISF
MOVLW
0F3h
Note 1: On device Resets, pins, RF, are
configured as analog inputs and are read
as ‘0’.
2: To configure PORTF as a digital I/O, turn
off the comparators and clear ANCON1
and ANCON2 to digital.
TABLE 11-6:
MOVWF
INITIALIZING PORTF
TRISF
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTF by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Select bank with ANCON1 register
Make RF2 digital
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Make RF5, RF6, RF7 digital
Select bank with TRISF register
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RF3:RF2 as outputs
RF7:RF4 as inputs
PORTF FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RF0
—
—
—
—
PORTF is not implemented.
RF1
—
—
—
—
PORTF is not implemented.
RF2
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTF data input.
RP36
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 36 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
Pin Name
RF2/RP36/C2INB/
CTMUI/SEG20/
AN7
RF3/D-
RF4/D+
RF5/RP35/C1INB/
AN10/CVREF/
SEG23
Legend:
Description
LATF data output.
C2INB
1
I
ANA
Comparator 2 Input B.
CTMUI
1
I
ANA
CTMU comparator input.
SEG20
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 20 output; disables all other pin functions.
AN7
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 7. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RF3
1
I
ST
D-
x
I
XCVR
USB bus minus line output.
x
O
XCVR
USB bus minus line input.
RF4
1
I
ST
PORTF data input.
D+
x
I
XCVR
USB bus plus line input.
x
O
XCVR
USB bus plus line output.
RF5
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTF data input.
RP35
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 35 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
C1INB
1
I
ANA
Comparator 1 Input B.
AN10
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 10. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
CVREF
0
O
ANA
Comparator reference voltage output.
SEG23
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 23 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTF data input.
LATF data output.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
XCVR = USB Transceiver, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 212
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-6:
PORTF FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RF6/RP40/C1INA/
AN11/SEG24
RF6
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTF data input.
RP40
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 40 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
C1INA
1
I
ANA
Comparator 1 Input A.
AN11
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 11. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG24
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 24 output; disables all other pin functions.
RF7
0
O
DIG
LATF data output.
1
I
ST
PORTF data input.
RP38
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 38 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
AN5
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 5. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG25
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 25 output; disables all other pin functions.
RF7/RP38/AN5/
SEG25
Legend:
Description
LATF data output.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
XCVR = USB Transceiver, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 213
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.8
PORTG, LATG and TRISG
Registers
EXAMPLE 11-7:
CLRF
PORTG width varies depending on pin count. For
64- and 80-pin devices, PORTG is a 6-bit wide, bidirectional port. For 100-pin devices, PORTG is an 8-bit wide
bidirectional port. The corresponding Data Direction and
Output Latch registers are TRISG and LATG.
PORTG is multiplexed with the EUSART, and CCP,
ECCP, Analog, Comparator, RTCC and Timer input
functions (Table 11-7). When operating as I/O, all
PORTG pins have Schmitt Trigger input buffers. The
open-drain functionality for the CCPx and EUSARTx
can be configured using ODCONx.
When enabling peripheral functions, care should be
taken in defining TRIS bits for each PORTG pin. Some
peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an
output, while other peripherals override the TRIS bit to
make a pin an input. The user should refer to the
corresponding peripheral section for the correct TRIS bit
settings. The pin override value is not loaded into the
TRIS register. This allows read-modify-write of the TRIS
register without concern due to peripheral overrides.
TABLE 11-7:
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RG0/RP46/AN8/
SEG28/COM4
RG0
0
O
DIG
RG2/RP42/
C3INA/AN18/
SEG30/COM6
Legend:
;
;
;
BCF
CM1CON, CON ;
;
CLRF
LATG
;
;
;
BANKSEL ANCON2
;
MOVLW
0F0h
;
;
MOVWF
ANCON2
BANKSEL TRISG
;
MOVLW
04h
;
;
;
MOVWF
TRISG
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTG by
clearing output
data latches
disable
comparator 1
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Select bank with ACON2 register
make AN16 to AN19
digital
Select bank with TRISG register
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RG1:RG0 as
outputs
RG2 as input
RG4:RG3 as inputs
PORTG FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RG1/RP39/
AN19/SEG29/
COM5
PORTG
INITIALIZING PORTG
Description
LATG data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
RP46
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 46 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
AN8
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 8. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG28
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 28 output; disables all other pin functions.
COM4
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 4 output; disables all other outputs.
RG1
0
O
DIG
LATG data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
RP39
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 39 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
AN19
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 19. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG29
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 29 output; disables all other pin functions.
COM5
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 5 output; disables all other outputs.
0
O
DIG
LATG data output; not affected by analog input.
RG2
1
I
ST
PORTG data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
RP42
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 42 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
C3INA
1
I
ANA
Comparator 3 Input A.
AN18
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 18. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG30
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 30 output; disables all other pin functions.
COM6
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 6 output; disables all other outputs.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 214
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-7:
Pin Name
RG3/RP43/
C3INB/AN17/
SEG31/COM7
RG4/RTCC/
RP44/C3INC/
AN16/SEG26
RG6
RG7
Legend:
PORTG FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RG3
0
O
DIG
LATG data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
RP43
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 43 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
C3INB
1
I
ANA
Comparator 3 Input B.
AN17
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 17. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG31
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 31 output; disables all other pin functions.
COM7
x
O
ANA
LCD Common 7 output; disables all other outputs.
RG4
0
O
DIG
LATG data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
RTCC
x
O
DIG
RTCC output.
RP44
x
x
DIG
Reconfigurable Pin 44 for PPS-Lite; TRIS must be set to match input/
output of module.
C3INC
1
I
ANA
Comparator 3 Input C.
AN16
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 16. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG26
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 26 output; disables all other pin functions.
RG6
0
O
DIG
LATG data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input.
0
O
DIG
LATG data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG data input.
RG7
Description
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 215
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.9
Note:
PORTH, LATH and
TRISH Registers
EXAMPLE 11-8:
PORTH is available only on 80-pin and
100-pin devices.
PORTH is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional I/O port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISH and LATH.
All pins on PORTH are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
TABLE 11-8:
Pin Name
RH0/AN23/
SEG47/A16
RH2/AN21/
SEG45/A18
RH3/AN20/
SEG44/A19
RH4/C2INC/
AN12/SEG40
Legend:
PORTH
CLRF
LATH
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BANKSEL
MOVLW
ANCON2
0Fh
ANCON2
0Fh
ANCON1
TRISH
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISH
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTH by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Select bank with ANCON2 register
Configure PORTH as
digital I/O
Configure PORTH as
digital I/O
Select bank with TRISH register
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RH3:RH0 as inputs
RH5:RH4 as outputs
RH7:RH6 as inputs
PORTH FUNCTIONS
Function
RH0
RH1/AN22/
SEG46/A17
CLRF
INITIALIZING PORTH
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
Description
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input.
AN23
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 23. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG47
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 47 output; disables all other pin functions.
A16
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address output.
RH1
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input.
AN22
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 22. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG46
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 46 output; disables all other pin functions.
A17
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address output.
RH2
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
AN21
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 21. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG45
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 45 output; disables all other pin functions.
A18
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address output.
RH3
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input.
AN20
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 20. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG44
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 44 output; disables all other pin functions.
A19
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address output.
RH4
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
C2INC
1
I
ANA
Comparator 2 Input C.
AN12
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 12. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG40
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 40 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTH data input.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 216
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-8:
Pin Name
RH5/C2IND/
AN13/SEG41
RH6/C1INC/
AN14/SEG42
RH7/AN15/
SEG43
Legend:
PORTH FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Function
RH5
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
Description
C2IND
1
I
ANA
Comparator 2 Input D.
AN13
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 13. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG41
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 41 output; disables all other pin functions.
RH6
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
C1INC
1
I
ANA
Comparator 1 Input C.
AN14
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 14. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG42
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 42 output; disables all other pin functions.
RH7
0
O
DIG
LATH data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
PORTH data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
AN15
1
I
ANA
A/D Input Channel 15. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
SEG43
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 43 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTH data input; disabled when analog input is enabled.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 217
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.10 PORTJ, LATJ and TRISJ Registers
Note:
PORTJ is available only on 80-pin and
100-pin devices.
PORTJ is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers
are TRISJ and LATJ.
All pins on PORTJ are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
These pins are configured as digital inputs
on any device Reset.
When the external memory interface is enabled, all of
the PORTJ pins function as control outputs for the interface. This occurs automatically when the interface is
enabled by clearing the EBDIS control bit
(MEMCON). The TRISJ bits are also overridden.
TABLE 11-9:
Pin Name
RJ0/SEG32/
ALE
RJ1/SEG33/OE
RJ3/SEG35/
WRH
RJ4/SEG39/
BA0
RJ5/SEG38/CE
Legend:
EXAMPLE 11-9:
CLRF
PORTJ
CLRF
LATJ
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISJ
INITIALIZING PORTJ
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTJ by
clearing output latches
Alternate method
to clear output latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RJ3:RJ0 as inputs
RJ5:RJ4 as output
RJ7:RJ6 as inputs
PORTJ FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
RJ0
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
SEG32
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 32 output; disables all other pin functions.
ALE
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address Latch Enable (ALE) signal.
RJ1
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
1
I
ST
0
O
ANA
SEG33
RJ2/SEG34/
WRL
Each of the PORTJ pins has a weak internal pull-up.
The pull-ups are provided to keep the inputs at a known
state for the external memory interface while powering
up. A single control bit can turn off all the pull-ups. This
is performed by clearing bit, RJPU (PADCFG). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on any device Reset.
Description
LATJ data output.
PORTJ data input.
PORTJ data input.
LCD Segment 33 output; disables all other pin functions.
OE
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Address Latch Enable (OE) signal.
RJ2
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ data input.
SEG34
0
O
ANA
WRL
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Write Low (WRL) signal.
RJ3
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
LCD Segment 34 output; disables all other pin functions.
1
I
ST
SEG35
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 35 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTJ data input.
WRH
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Write High (WRH) signal.
RJ4
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
1
I
ST
SEG39
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 39 output; disables all other pin functions.
BA0
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Byte Access 0 (BA0) signal.
RJ5
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
1
I
ST
SEG38
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 38 output; disables all other pin functions.
CE
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Chip Enable (CE) signal.
PORTJ data input.
PORTJ data input.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 218
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-9:
PORTJ FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
RJ6/SEG37/LB
RJ6
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
0
O
ANA
SEG37
RJ7/SEG36/UB
Legend:
Description
LATJ data output.
PORTJ data input.
LCD Segment 37 output; disables all other pin functions.
LB
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Lower Byte (LB) signal.
RJ7
0
O
DIG
LATJ data output.
1
I
ST
SEG36
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 36 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTJ data input.
UB
x
O
DIG
External Memory Bus Upper Byte (UB) signal.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 219
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.11 PORTK, LATK and TRISK
Registers
Note:
PORTK is available only on 100-pin
devices.
PORTK is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers are
TRISK and LATK.
All pins on PORTK are implemented with Schmitt Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually configurable
as an input or output.
Each of the PORTK pins has a weak internal pull-up.
The pull-ups are provided to keep the inputs at a known
state for the external memory interface while powering
up. A single control bit can turn off all the pull-ups. This
is performed by clearing bit, RKPU (PADCFG).
The weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the
port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on any device Reset.
EXAMPLE 11-10:
BANKSEL
CLRF
LATK
LATK
BANKSEL
MOVLW
TRISK
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISK
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
INITIALIZING PORTK
select bank with LATK register
Initialize LATK
by clearing output
data latches
Select bank with TRISK register
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RH3:RH0 as inputs
RH5:RH4 as outputs
RH7:RH6 as inputs
TABLE 11-10: PORTK FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RK0/SEG56
RK1/SEG57
RK2/SEG58
RK3/SEG59
RK4/SEG60
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
RK0
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
SEG56
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 56 output; disables all other pin functions.
RK1
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
1
I
ST
SEG57
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 57 output; disables all other pin functions.
RK2
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
RK6/SEG62
PORTK data input.
I
ST
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 58 output; disables all other pin functions.
RK3
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
1
I
ST
PORTK data input.
SEG59
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 59 output; disables all other pin functions.
RK4
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
1
I
ST
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 60 output; disables all other pin functions.
LATK data output.
RK5
PORTK data input.
PORTK data input.
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
SEG61
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 61 output; disables all other pin functions.
RK6
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
RK7
SEG63
Legend:
PORTK data input.
1
SEG62
RK7/SEG63
LATK data output.
SEG58
SEG60
RK5/SEG61
Description
PORTK data input.
1
I
ST
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 62 output; disables all other pin functions.
PORTK data input.
0
O
DIG
LATK data output.
1
I
ST
PORTK data input.
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 63 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS30000575C-page 220
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.12 PORTL, LATL and TRISL Registers
Note:
The pull-ups are provided to keep the inputs at a known
state for the external memory interface while powering
up. A single control bit can turn off all the pull-ups. This
is performed by clearing bit, RLPU (PADCFG).
PORTL is available only on 100-pin
devices.
The weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the
port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on any device Reset.
PORTL is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding Data Direction and Output Latch registers are
TRISL and LATL.
All pins on PORTL are implemented with Schmitt Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually configurable
as an input or output.
EXAMPLE 11-11:
BANKSEL PORTL
CLRF
PORTL
Each of the PORTL pins has a weak internal pull-up.
CLRF
LATL
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISL
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
INITIALIZING PORTL
select correct bank
Initialize PORTL by
clearing output latches
Alternate method
to clear output latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RL3:RL0 as inputs
RL5:RL4 as output
RL7:RL6 as inputs
TABLE 11-11: PORTL FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RL0/SEG48
RL1/SEG49
RL2/SEG50
RL3/SEG51
RL4/SEG52
RL5/SEG53
RL6/SEG54
RL7/SEG55
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O Type
RL0
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
SEG48
0
O
ANA
RL1
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
SEG49
0
O
ANA
RL2
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
SEG50
0
O
ANA
RL3
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
SEG51
0
O
ANA
LCD Segment 51 output; disables all other pin functions.
RL4
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
PORTL data input.
LCD Segment 48 output; disables all other pin functions.
LCD Segment 49 output; disables all other pin functions.
LCD Segment 50 output; disables all other pin functions.
1
I
ST
SEG52
0
O
ANA
RL5
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
SEG53
0
O
ANA
RL6
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
SEG54
0
O
ANA
RL7
0
O
DIG
LATL data output.
1
I
ST
PORTL data input.
0
O
ANA
SEG55
Legend:
Description
PORTL data input.
LCD Segment 52 output; disables all other pin functions.
LCD Segment 53 output; disables all other pin functions.
LCD Segment 54 output; disables all other pin functions.
LCD Segment 55 output; disables all other pin functions.
O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Trigger Buffer Input,
x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 221
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.13 Parallel Slave Port
PORTD can function as an 8-bit-wide Parallel Slave
Port (PSP), or microprocessor port, when control bit,
PSPMODE (PSPCON), is set. The port is
asynchronously readable and writable by the external
world through the RD control input pin (RE0/AD8/LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD) and WR control input pin (RE1/AD9/
LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR).
Note:
The Parallel Slave Port is available only in
Microcontroller mode.
The PSP can directly interface to an 8-bit microprocessor data bus. The external microprocessor can
read or write the PORTD latch as an 8-bit latch.
Setting bit, PSPMODE, enables port pin, RE0/AD8/
LCDBIAS1/RP28/RD, to be the RD input, RE1/AD9/
LCDBIAS2/RP29/WR to be the WR input and RE2/
AD10/LCDBIAS3/RP30/CS to be the CS (Chip Select)
input. For this functionality, the corresponding data
direction bits of the TRISE register (TRISE) must
be configured as inputs (‘111’).
A write to the PSP occurs when both the CS and WR
lines are first detected low and ends when either are
detected high. The PSPIF and IBF flag bits (PIR1
and PSPCON, respectively) are set when the write
ends.
A read from the PSP occurs when both the CS and RD
lines are first detected low. The data in PORTD is read
out and the OBF bit (PSPCON) is set. If the user
writes new data to PORTD to set OBF, the data is
immediately read out, but the OBF bit is not set.
When either the CS or RD line is detected high, the
PORTD pins return to the input state and the PSPIF bit
is set. User applications should wait for PSPIF to be set
before servicing the PSP. When this happens, the IBF
and OBF bits can be polled and the appropriate action
taken.
FIGURE 11-3:
Data Bus
WR LATD
or
PORTD
PORTD AND PORTE
BLOCK DIAGRAM
(PARALLEL SLAVE PORT)
D
Q
RDx
Pin
CK
Data Latch
Q
RD PORTD
TTL
D
ENEN
TRIS Latch
RD LATD
One Bit of PORTD
Set Interrupt Flag
PSPIF (PIR1)
Read
TTL
RD
Chip Select
TTL
CS
Write
TTL
WR
Note: The I/O pin has protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
The timing for the control signals in Write and Read
modes is shown in Figure 11-4 and Figure 11-5,
respectively.
DS30000575C-page 222
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 11-4:
PSPCON: PARALLEL SLAVE PORT CONTROL REGISTER
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
IBF
OBF
IBOV
PSPMODE
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IBF: Input Buffer Full Status bit
1 = A word has been received and is waiting to be read by the CPU
0 = No word has been received
bit 6
OBF: Output Buffer Full Status bit
1 = The output buffer still holds a previously written word
0 = The output buffer has been read
bit 5
IBOV: Input Buffer Overflow Detect bit
1 = A write occurred when a previously input word had not been read (must be cleared in software)
0 = No overflow occurred
bit 4
PSPMODE: Parallel Slave Port Mode Select bit
1 = Parallel Slave Port mode
0 = General Purpose I/O mode
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FIGURE 11-4:
PARALLEL SLAVE PORT WRITE WAVEFORMS
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
CS
WR
RD
PORTD
IBF
OBF
PSPIF
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 223
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 11-5:
PARALLEL SLAVE PORT READ WAVEFORMS
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
CS
WR
RD
PORTD
IBF
OBF
PSPIF
11.14 Virtual PORT
11.15.1
This device includes a single virtual port, which is used to
construct a logically addressed 8-bit PORT from
8 physically unrelated pins on the device. The virtual
PORT is controlled through the PORTVP, LATVP and
TRISVP registers. These function identically to the PORT,
LAT and TRIS registers of the actual I/O ports. Refer to
Section 11.1 “I/O Port Pin Capabilities” for more information.
The PPS-Lite feature is used with a range of pins. All
devices in the PIC18FXXJ94 family contain a total of
47 remappable peripheral pins, labeled RP0 through
RP46. Pins that support PPS-Lite feature include the designation, “RPn” in their full pin designation, where “RP”
designates a remappable peripheral and “n” is the remappable pin number. For PIC18FXXJ94 devices, RP41
through RP45 are digital inputs only.
11.15 PPS-Lite
Previous PIC18 devices had I/O pins that were “hardwired” to a set of peripherals. For example, a port pin
might have had the option of serving as an I/O pin, an
analog input or as an interrupt source. In an effort to
increase the flexibility of the parts, PIC18FXXJ94 devices
contain PPS-Lite (Peripheral Pin Select-Lite), which
allows the developer to connect an internal peripheral to
a subset of pins. PPS-Lite is similar to PPS (available on
PIC18F products), but limits the user to interconnections
within four sets of pin/peripheral groups.
The PPS-Lite feature allows some flexibility in choosing
which peripheral connects to any particular pin. This
allows designs to be maximized for layout efficiency, and
also may allow component changes without changing the
printed circuit board design. The Peripheral Pin Select
feature operates over a fixed subset of digital I/O pins
(those designated as RPn pins). Users may independently map the input and/or output of most digital
peripherals to a limited set of these I/O pins. The PPS-Lite
configuration is performed in software and does not
require the device to be reprogrammed. Hardware safeguards are included that prevent accidental or spurious
changes to the peripheral mapping once it has been
established.
DS30000575C-page 224
11.15.2
AVAILABLE PINS
AVAILABLE PERIPHERALS
The peripherals managed by the Peripheral Pin Select
are all “digital only” peripherals. These include general
serial communications (USART and SPI), general purpose timer clock inputs, timer related peripherals (input
capture and output compare) and external interrupt
inputs.
In comparison, some digital only peripheral modules are
not currently included in the Peripheral Pin Select feature.
This is because the peripheral’s function requires special
I/O circuitry on a specific port and cannot be easily connected to multiple pins. These modules include I2C, USB,
change notification inputs, RTCC alarm output and all
modules with analog inputs, such as the A/D Converter.
A key difference between remappable and non-remappable peripherals is that remappable peripherals are not
associated with a default I/O pin. The peripheral must
always be assigned to a specific I/O pin before it can be
used. In contrast, non-remappable peripherals are always
available on a default pin, assuming that the peripheral is
active and not conflicting with another peripheral.
When a remappable peripheral is active on a given I/O
pin, it takes priority over all other digital I/O and digital
communication peripherals associated with the pin. Priority is given, regardless of the type of peripheral that is
mapped. Remappable peripherals never take priority
over any analog functions associated with the pin.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 11-6:
STRUCTURE OF PORT SHARED WITH PPS PERIPHERALS
Open-Drain Selection
Output Multiplexers
Peripheral Pin Select
Output Function
Select for the Pin
Peripheral ‘n’ Output Enable
Peripheral 2 Output Enable
Peripheral 1 Output Enable
I/O TRIS Enable
n
1
0
I/O
0
1
Peripheral ‘n’ Output Data
Peripheral 2 Output Data
Peripheral 1 Output Data
I/O LAT/PORT Data
PIO Module
Read TRIS
Data Bus
WR TRIS
D
Q
CK
Q
n
1
0
I/O Pin
TRIS Latch
WR LAT/
WR PORT
D
Q
CK
Data Latch
Read LAT
Read PORT
Peripheral Input
Pin Selection
0
Peripheral Input
1
n
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
I/O Pin 0
I/O Pin 1
I/O Pin n
DS30000575C-page 225
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.15.3
CONTROLLING PERIPHERAL PIN
SELECT
fields, with each set associated with one of the remappable peripherals. Programming a given peripheral’s
bit field with an RPn value maps the RPn pin to that
peripheral. For any given device, the valid range of values for any of the bit fields corresponds to the maximum number of peripheral Pin Selections supported by
the device.
Peripheral Pin Select features are controlled through
two sets of Special Function Registers (SFRs): one to
map peripheral inputs and one to map peripheral
outputs. Because they are separately controlled, a particular peripheral’s input and output (if the peripheral
has both) can be placed on any selectable function with
the only constraint being that RPn peripherals and pins
can only be mapped within their own group. It is not
possible to map a peripheral to a pin outside of its
group or vice versa.
The PPS-Lite peripheral inputs and associated RPn
pins have been organized into four groups. It is not possible to map a peripheral to an RPn pin which is outside
of its group. To map a peripheral input signal to an RPn
pin, use the 4-step process as indicated in Table 11-13.
Choose the signal and the RPn pin, and the column on
the right shows which value to write to the associated
RPIN register.
The association of a peripheral to a peripheral-selectable
pin is handled in two different ways, depending if an input
or output is being mapped.
11.15.3.1
The peripheral inputs that support Peripheral Pin
Selection have no default pins. Since the implemented
bit fields of RPINRx registers reset to all ‘1’s, the inputs
are all tied to VSS in the device’s default (Reset) state.
Input Mapping
The inputs of the Peripheral Pin Select options are
mapped on the basis of the peripheral; that is, a bit field
associated with a peripheral dictates the pin it will be
mapped to. The RPINRx registers (refer to registers in
Table 11-12 and Table 11-13) contain sets of 4-bit
FIGURE 11-7:
For example, to assign U1RX to RP3, write the value,
h’0, to RPINR0_1. Figure 11-7 illustrates
remappable pin selection for the U1RX input.
REMAPPABLE INPUT FOR U1RX
RPINR0_1
0
RP3
1
RP7
2
U1RX Input
to Peripheral
RP11
A
RP(4n+3)
DS30000575C-page 226
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-12: RPINR REGISTERS
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RPINR52_53
RVP7R3
RVP7R2
RVP7R1
RVP7R0
RVP6R3
RVP6R2
RVP6R1
RVP6R0
RPINR50_51
RVP5R3
RVP5R2
RVP5R1
RVP5R0
RVP4R3
RVP4R2
RVP4R1
RVP4R0
RPINR48_49
RVP3R3
RVP3R2
RVP3R1
RVP3R0
RVP2R3
RVP2R2
RVP2R1
RVP2R0
RPINR46_47
RVP1R3
RVP1R2
RVP1R1
RVP1R0
RVP0R3
RVP0R2
RVP0R1
RVP0R0
RPINR44_45
T5CKIR3
T5CKIR2
T5CKIR1
T5CKIR0
T5GR3
T5GR2
T5GR1
T5GR0
RPINR42_43
T3CKIR3
T3CKIR2
T3CKIR1
T3CKIR0
T3GR3
T3GR2
T3GR1
T3GR0
RPINR40_41
T1CKIR3
T1CKIR2
T1CKIR1
T1CKIR0
T1GR3
T1GR2
T1GR1
T1GR0
RPINR38_39
T0CKIR3
T0CKIR2
T0CKIR1
T0CKIR0
CCP10R3
CCP10R2
CCP10R1
CCP10R0
RPINR36_37
CCP9R3
CCP9R2
CCP9R1
CCP9R0
CCP8R3
CCP8R2
CCP8R1
CCP8R0
RPINR34_35
CCP7R3
CCP7R2
CCP7R1
CCP7R0
CCP6R3
CCP6R2
CCP6R1
CCP6R0
RPINR32_33
CCP5R3
CCP5R2
CCP5R1
CCP5R0
CCP4R3
CCP4R2
CCP4R1
CCP4R0
RPINR30_31
MDCIN2R3
MDCIN2R2
MDCIN2R1
MDCIN2R0
RPINR28_29
MDMINR3
MDMINR2
MDMINR1
MDMINR0
INT3R3
INT3R2
INT3R1
RPINR26_27
INT2R3
INT2R2
INT2R1
INT2R0
INT1R3
INT1R2
INT1R1
INT1R0
RPINR24_25
IOC7R3
IOC7R2
IOC7R1
IOC7R0
IOC6R3
IOC6R2
IOC6R1
IOC6R0
RPINR22_23
IOC5R3
IOC5R2
IOC5R1
IOC5R0
IOC4R3
IOC4R2
IOC4R1
IOC4R0
RPINR20_21
IOC3R3
IOC3R2
IOC3R1
IOC3R0
IOC2R3
IOC2R2
IOC2R1
IOC2R0
RPINR18_19
IOC1R3
IOC1R2
IOC1R1
IOC1R0
IOC0R3
IOC0R2
IOC0R1
IOC0R0
RPINR16_17
ECCP3R3
ECCP3R2
ECCP3R1
ECCP3R0
ECCP2R3
ECCP2R2
ECCP2R1
ECCP2R0
RPINR14_15
ECCP1R3
ECCP1R2
ECCP1R1
ECCP1R0
FLT0R3
FLT0R2
FLT0R1
FLT0R0
SDI2R0
MDCIN1R3 MDCIN1R2 MDCIN1R1 MDCIN1R0
INT3R0
RPINR12_13
SS2R3
SS2R2
SS2R1
SS2R0
SDI2R3
SDI2R2
SDI2R1
RPINR10_11
SCK2R3
SCK2R2
SCK2R1
SCK2R0
SS1R3
SS1R2
SS1R1
SS1R0
RPINR8_9
SDI1R3
SDI1R2
SDI1R1
SDI1R0
SCK1R3
SCK1R2
SCK1R1
SCK1R0
RPINR6_7
U4TXR3
U4TXR2
U4TXR1
U4TXR0
U4RXR3
U4RXR2
U4RXR1
U4RXR0
RPINR4_5
U3TXR3
U3TXR2
U3TXR1
U3TXR0
U3RXR3
U3RXR2
U3RXR1
U3RXR0
RPINR2_3
U2TXR3
U2TXR2
U2TXR1
U2TXR0
U2RXR3
U2RXR2
U2RXR1
U2RXR0
RPINR0_1
U1TXR3
U1TXR2
U1TXR1
U1TXR0
U1RXR3
U1RXR2
U1RXR1
U1RXR0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 227
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-13: RPIN REGISTERS AND AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS
PPS-Lite Input Peripheral Group 4n
(1) To Map this signal (4) to the Associated RPIN Register
SDI1
RPINR8_9
PPS-Lite Input Peripheral Group 4n + 1
(1) To Map this Signal
(4) to the Associated RPIN Register
SDI2
RPINR12_13
FLT0
RPINR14_15
INT1
RPINR26_27
IOC0
RPINR18_19
IOC1
RPINR18_19
IOC4
RPINR22_23
IOC5
RPINR22_23
MDCIN1
RPINR30_31
MDCIN2
RPINR30_31
T0CKI
RPINR38_39
T1CKI
RPINR40_41
T5G
RPINR44_45
T1G
RPINR40_41
U3RX
RPINR4_5
T3CKI
RPINR42_43
U4RX
RPINR6_7
T3G
RPINR42_43
CCP5
RPINR32_33
T5CKI
RPINR44_45
CCP8
RPINR36_37
U3TX
RPINR4_5
RVP0
RPINR46_47
U4TX
RPINR6_7
RVP4
RPINR50_51
CCP7
RPINR34_35
CCP9
RPINR36_37
RVP1
RPINR46_47
RVP5
RPINR50_51
(2) with this RPn Pin
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
(2) with this RPn Pin
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
RP0
h’0
RP1
h’0
RP4
h’1
RP5
h’1
RP8
h’2
RP9
h’2
RP12
h’3
RP13
h’3
RP16
h’4
RP17
h’4
RP20
h’5
RP21
h’5
RP24
h’6
RP25
h’6
RP28
h’7
RP29
h’7
RP32
h’8
RP33
h’8
RP36
h’9
RP37
h’9
RP40
h’A
RP41
h’A
RP44
h’B
RP45
h’B
—
h’C
—
h’C
—
h’D
—
h’D
—
h’E
—
h’E
VSS
h’F
VSS
h’F
DS30000575C-page 228
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-13: RPIN REGISTERS AND AVAILABLE FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
PPS-Lite Input Peripheral Group 4n + 2
(1) To Map this Signal (4) to the Associated RPIN Register
RPINR10_11
SS1
PPS-Lite Input Peripheral Group 4n + 3
(1) To Map this Signal
(4) to the Associated RPIN Register
SS2
RPINR12_13
INT2
RPINR26_27
INT3
RPINR28_29
IOC2
RPINR20_21
IOC3
RPINR20_21
IOC6
RPINR24_25
IOC7
RPINR24_25
MDMIN
RPINR28_29
U1RX
RPINR0_1
RPINR2_3
U1TX
RPINR0_1
U2TX
U2RX
RPINR2_3
SCK1
RPINR8_9
SCK2
RPINR10_11
ECCP1
RPINR14_15
ECCP3
RPINR16_17
ECCP2
RPINR16_17
CCP6
RPINR34_35
CCP4
RPINR32_33
CCP10
RPINR38_39
RVP3
RPINR48_49
RVP2
RPINR48_49
RVP7
RPINR52_53
RVP6
RPINR52_53
(2) with this RPn Pin
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
(2) with this RPn Pin
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
RP2
h’0
RP3
h’0
RP6
h’1
RP7
h’1
RP10
h’2
RP11
h’2
RP14
h’3
RP15
h’3
RP18
h’4
RP19
h’4
RP22
h’5
RP23
h’5
RP26
h’6
RP27
h’6
RP30
h’7
RP31
h’7
RP34
h’8
RP35
h’8
RP38
h’9
RP39
h’9
RP42
h’A
RP43
h’A
RP46
h’B
—
h’B
—
h’C
—
h’C
—
h’D
—
h’D
—
h’E
—
h’E
VSS
h’F
VSS
h’F
11.15.3.2
Output Mapping
In contrast to the inputs, the outputs of the Peripheral
Pin Select options are mapped on the basis of the pin.
In this case, a bit field associated with a particular pin
dictates the peripheral output to be mapped. The
RPORx registers contain sets of 4-bit fields, with each
associated with one RPn pin (see Register 11-5). The
value of the bit field corresponds to one of the peripherals and that peripheral’s output is mapped to the pin.
Each pin has a limited set of peripherals to choose
from.
The PPS-Lite peripheral outputs and associated RPn
pins have been organized into four groups. It is not
possible to map a peripheral to an RPn pin which is outside of its group. To map a peripheral output signal to
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
an RPn pin, use the 4-step process, as indicated in
Table 11-14. Choose the RPn pin and the signal; the
column on the right shows which value to write to the
associated RPORx register.
The peripheral outputs that support Peripheral Pin
Selection have no default pins. Since the RPORx registers reset to all ‘0’s, the outputs are all disconnected
in the device’s default (Reset) state.
The list of peripherals for output mapping also includes
a null value of b’0000’ because of the mapping
technique. This allows unused peripherals to not be
connected to a pin. Not all peripherals are available on
all pins. For example, the “SDO2” signal is only available on RP0, RP4, RP8, etc. The “SDO2” signal is not
available on RP1.
DS30000575C-page 229
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 11-8:
MULTIPLEXING OF REMAPPABLE OUTPUT FOR RPn
RPORn
I/O TRIS Setting
0
U1TX Output Enable
3
U1RTS Output Enable 4
Output Enable
OC5 Output Enable
I/O LAT/PORT Content
22
0
U1TX Output
3
U1RTS Output 4
RPn
Output Data
OC5 Output
REGISTER 11-5:
22
RPORn_n: REMAPPED PERIPHERAL OUTPUT REGISTER n
(FUNCTION MAPS TO PIN)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RPORn_3
RPORn_2
RPORn_1
RPORn_0
RPmR_3
RPmR_2
RPmR_1
RPmR_0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-4
RPORn_: RPn peripheral output function mapping
bit 3-0
RPmR: RPm peripheral output function mapping
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
Register values can only be changed if IOLOCK = 0.
DS30000575C-page 230
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-14: PPS-LITE OUTPUT
PPS-Lite Output Peripheral Group 4n
PPS-Lite Output Peripheral Group 4n + 1
(1) To Map this RPn Pin
(4) to the Associated RPOR Register
(1) To Map this RPn Pin
(4) to the Associated RPOR Register
RP0
RPOR0_1
RP1
RPOR0_1
RP4
RPOR4_5
RP5
RPOR4_5
RP8
RPOR8_9
RP9
RPOR8_9
RP12
RPOR12_13
RP13
RPOR12_13
RP16
RPOR16_17
RP17
RPOR16_17
RP20
RPOR20_21
RP21
RPOR20_21
RP24
RPOR24_25
RP25
RPOR24_25
RP28
RPOR28_29
RP29
RPOR28_29
RP32
RPOR32_33
RP33
RPOR32_33
RP36
RPOR36_37
RP37
RPOR36_37
RP40
RPOR40_41
RP41
RPOR40_41
RP44
RPOR44_45
RP45
RPOR44_45
(2) with this Output Signal
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
(2) with this Output Signal
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
Disabled
h’0
Disabled
h’0
U2BCLK
h’1
U1BCLK
h’1
U3RX_DT
h’2
U3TX_CK
h’2
U4RX_DT
h’3
U4TX_CK
h’3
SDO2
h’4
SDO1
h’4
P1D
h’5
P1C
h’5
P2D
h’6
P2C
h’6
P3B
h’7
P3C
h’7
CTPLS
h’8
CCP7
h’8
CCP5
h’9
CCP9
h’9
CCP8
h’A
C2OUT
h’A
C1OUT
h’B
Unused
h’B
Unused
h’C
Unused
h’C
RVP0
h’D
RVP1
h’D
RVP4
h’E
RVP5
h’E
Reserved
h’F
Reserved
h’F
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 231
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 11-14: PPS-LITE OUTPUT (CONTINUED)
PPS-Lite Output Peripheral Group 4n + 2
PPS-Lite Output Peripheral Group 4n +3
(1) To Map this RPn Pin
(4) to the Associated RPOR Register
(1) To Map this RPn Pin
(4) to the Associated RPOR Register
RP2
RPOR2_3
RP3
RPOR2_3
RP6
RPOR6_7
RP7
RPOR6_7
RP10
RPOR10_11
RP11
RPOR10_11
RP14
RPOR14_15
RP15
RPOR14_15
RP18
RPOR18_19
RP19
RPOR18_19
RP22
RPOR22_23
RP23
RPOR22_23
RP26
RPOR26_27
RP27
RPOR26_27
RP30
RPOR30_31
RP31
RPOR30_31
RP34
RPOR34_35
RP35
RPOR34_35
RP38
RPOR38_39
RP39
RPOR38_39
RP42
RPOR42_43
RP43
RPOR42_43
RP46
RPOR46
(2) with this Output Signal
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
(2) with this Output Signal
(3) Write this Corresponding Value
Disabled
h’0
Disabled
h’0
U1TX_CK
h’1
U1RX_DT
h’1
U2RX_DT
h’2
U2TX_CK
h’2
U3BCLK
h’3
SCK1
h’3
U4BCLK
h’4
ECCP1/P1A
h’4
SCK2
h’5
ECCP2/P2A
h’5
P1B
h’6
P3D
h’6
h’7
P2B
h’7
MDOUT
ECCP3/P3A
h’8
CCP4
h’8
CCP6
h’9
C3OUT
h’9
CCP10
h’A
Unused
h’A
Unused
h’B
Unused
h’B
Unused
h’C
Unused
h’C
RVP2
h’D
RVP3
h’D
RVP6
h’E
RVP7
h’E
Reserved
h’F
Reserved
h’F
11.15.3.3
I/O Mapping
While most peripheral signals are defined as either
input or output, some peripheral signals switch
between input and output: UnRX_DT, UnTX_CK, PBIO
and CCP. Most commonly, these signals are mapped
so that both the input and output map to the same RPn
pin. If desired, the input and output can be mapped to
separate pins. For standard peripheral operation,
ensure that both the input and output mapping
configurations select the same RPn pin.
11.15.3.4
Mapping Limitations
The control schema of Peripheral Select Pins is not limited to a small range of fixed peripheral configurations.
There are no mutual or hardware enforced lockouts
between any of the peripheral mapping SFRs. While
such mappings may be technically possible from a
DS30000575C-page 232
configuration point of view, the user must ensure the
selected configurations are supportable from an
electrical point of view.
11.15.4
CONTROLLING CONFIGURATION
CHANGES
Because peripheral remapping can be changed during
run time, some restrictions on peripheral remapping
are needed to prevent accidental configuration
changes. PIC18FXXJ94 devices include two features
to prevent alterations to the peripheral map:
• Continuous state monitoring
• Configuration bit remapping lock
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
11.15.4.1
Control Register Lock
The contents of RPINRx and RPORx registers are constantly monitored in hardware by shadow registers. If
an unexpected change in any of the registers occurs
(such as cell disturbances caused by ESD or other
external events), a Configuration Mismatch Reset will
trigger.
11.15.4.2
Configuration Bit Pin Select Lock
As an additional level of safety, the device can be
configured to prevent more than one write session to
the RPINRx and RPORx registers. The IOL1WAY Configuration bit (CONFIG5H) blocks the IOLOCK bit
from being cleared after it has been set once.
In the default (unprogrammed) state, IOL1WAY is set,
restricting users to one write session. Programming
IOL1WAY allows users unlimited access to the Peripheral Pin Select registers. It is good programming practice to always set the IOLOCK bit (OSCCON2) after
all changes have been made to PPS-Lite registers.
11.15.5
CONSIDERATIONS FOR
PERIPHERAL PIN SELECTION
The ability to control Peripheral Pin Selection introduces several considerations into application design
that should be considered. This is particularly true for
several common peripherals which are only available
as remappable peripherals.
The assignment of an RPn pin to the peripheral input or
output depends on the peripheral and its use in the
application. It is good programming practice to map
peripherals to pins immediately after Reset. This
should be done before any configuration changes to
the peripheral itself.
The assignment of a peripheral output to a particular
pin does not automatically perform any other configuration of the pin’s I/O circuitry. This means adding a pinselectable output to a pin may mean inadvertently driving an existing peripheral input when the output is
driven. Users must be familiar with the behavior of
other fixed peripherals that share a remappable pin. To
be safe, fixed digital peripherals that share the same
pin should be disabled when not in use.
Configuring a remappable pin for a specific peripheral
input does not automatically turn that feature on. The
peripheral must be specifically configured for operation
and enabled, as if it were tied to a fixed pin.
A final consideration is that Peripheral Pin Select functions neither override analog inputs, nor reconfigure
pins with analog functions for digital I/O. If a pin is
configured as an analog input on device Reset, it must
be explicitly reconfigured as digital I/O when used with
a Peripheral Pin Select.
11.15.5.1
Before any other application code is executed, the user
must initialize the device with the proper peripheral
configuration. Since the IOLOCK is not active in the
Reset state, the peripherals can be configured, and the
IOLOCK bit can be set when configuration is complete.
1.
Choosing the configuration requires the review of all
Peripheral Pin Selects and their pin assignments,
especially those that will not be used in the application.
In all cases, unused pin-selected peripherals should be
disabled. Unused peripherals should have their inputs
assigned to VSS. I/O pins with unused RPn functions
should be configured with the NULL (‘0’) peripheral
output.
3.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
2.
4.
5.
6.
Basic Steps to Use Peripheral Pin
Selection Lite (PPS-Lite)
Disable any fixed digital peripherals on the pins
to be used.
Switch pins to be used for digital functionality (if
they have analog functionality) using the
ANCONx registers.
Clear the IOLOCK bit (OSCCON) if needed
(not needed after a device Reset).
Set RPINRx and RPORx registers appropriately.
Set the IOLOCK bit (OSCCON).
Enable and configure newly mapped PPS-Lite
peripherals.
DS30000575C-page 233
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
12.0
DATA SIGNAL MODULATOR
The Data Signal Modulator (DSM) is a peripheral which
allows the user to mix a data stream, also known as a
modulator signal, with a carrier signal to produce a
modulated output.
Both the carrier and the modulator signals are supplied
to the DSM module, either internally from the output of
a peripheral, or externally through an input pin.
The carrier signal is comprised of two distinct and
separate signals: a Carrier High (CARH) signal and a
Carrier Low (CARL) signal. During the time in which the
Modulator (MOD) signal is in a logic high state, the DSM
mixes the Carrier High signal with the Modulator signal.
When the Modulator signal is in a logic low state, the
DSM mixes the Carrier Low signal with the Modulator
signal.
DS30000575C-page 234
Using this method, the DSM can generate the following
types of key modulation schemes:
• Frequency-Shift Keying (FSK)
• Phase-Shift Keying (PSK)
• On-Off Keying (OOK)
Additionally, the following features are provided within
the DSM module:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Carrier Synchronization
Carrier Source Polarity Select
Carrier Source Pin Disable
Programmable Modulator Data
Modulator Source Pin Disable
Modulator Output Polarity Select
Slew Rate Control
Figure 12-1 shows a simplified block diagram of the
Data Signal Modulator peripheral.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 12-1:
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE DATA SIGNAL MODULATOR
MDCH
VSS
MDCIN1
MDCIN2
REFO1 Clock
ECCP1
ECCP2
ECCP3
CCP4
CCP5
CCP6
CCP7
CCP8
CCP9
CCP10
System Clock
REFO2 Clock
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110 CARH
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
MDEN
EN
Data Signal
Modulator
MDCHPOL
D
SYNC
Q
1
MDSRC
MDBIT
MDMIN
MSSP1 (SDO)
MSSP2 (SDO)
EUSART1 (TXX)
EUSART2 (TXX)
EUSART3 (TXX)
EUSART4 (TXX)
ECCP1
ECCP2
ECCP3
CCP4
CCP5
CCP6
CCP7
CCP8
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110 MOD
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
0
MDCHSYNC
MDOUT
MDOPOL
D
SYNC
MDCL
VSS
MDCIN1
MDCIN2
REFO1 Clock
ECCP1
ECCP2
ECCP3
CCP4
CCP5
CCP6
CCP7
CCP8
CCP9
CCP10
System Clock
REFO2 CLOCK
MDOE
Switches Between
PORT Function
and DSM Output
Q
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110 CARL
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
1
0
MDCLSYNC
MDCLPOL
DS30000575C-page 235
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
12.1
DSM Operation
The DSM module can be enabled by setting the MDEN
bit in the MDCON register. Clearing the MDEN bit in the
MDCON register disables the DSM module by automatically switching the Carrier High and Carrier Low
signals to the VSS signal source. The Modulator signal
source is also switched to the MDBIT in the MDCON
register. This not only assures that the DSM module is
inactive, but that it is also consuming the least amount
of current.
12.3
Carrier Signal Sources
The Carrier High signal and Carrier Low signal can be
supplied from the following sources:
The Modulation Carrier High and Modulation Carrier
Low Control registers are not affected when the MDEN
bit is cleared, and the DSM module is disabled. The
values inside these registers remain unchanged while
the DSM is inactive. The sources for the Carrier High,
Carrier Low and Modulator signals will once again be
selected when the MDEN bit is set, and the DSM
module is again enabled and active.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The modulated output signal can be disabled without
shutting down the DSM module. The DSM module will
remain active and continue to mix signals, but the output value will not be sent to the MDOUT pin. During the
time that the output is disabled, the MDOUT pin will
remain low. The modulated output can be disabled by
clearing the MDOE bit in the MDCON register.
The Carrier High signal is selected by configuring the
MDCH bits in the MDCARH register. The Carrier
Low signal is selected by configuring the MDCL
bits in the MDCARL register.
12.2
Modulator Signal Sources
The Modulator signal can be supplied from the following
sources:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
ECCP1 Signal
ECCP2 Signal
ECCP3 Signal
CCP2 Signal
CCP3 Signal
CCP4 Signal
CCP5 Signal
CCP6 Signal
CCP7 Signal
CCP8 Signal
MSSP1 SDO Signal (SPI mode only)
MSSP2 SDO Signal (SPI mode only)
EUSART1 TX1 Signal
EUSART2 TX2 Signal
EUSART3 TX3 Signal
EUSART4 TX4 Signal
External Signal on MDMIN Pin (RF0/MDMIN)
MDBIT bit in the MDCON Register
ECCP1 Signal
ECCP2 Signal
ECCP3 Signal
CCP5 Signal
CCP6 Signal
CCP7 Signal
CCP8 Signal
CCP9 Signal
CCP10 Signal
Reference Clock Output Module Signal (REFO1)
Reference Clock Output Module Signal (REFO2)
System Clock
External Signals on the MDCIN1 and MDCIN2
pins are available though PPS. Refer to
Section 11.15 “PPS-Lite” for setup.
• VSS
12.4
Carrier Synchronization
During the time when the DSM switches between
Carrier High and Carrier Low signal sources, the carrier
data in the modulated output signal can become
truncated. To prevent this, the carrier signal can be
synchronized to the Modulator signal. When synchronization is enabled, the carrier pulse that is being mixed
at the time of the transition is allowed to transition low
before the DSM switches over to the next carrier
source.
Synchronization is enabled separately for the Carrier
High and Carrier Low signal sources. Synchronization
for the Carrier High signal can be enabled by setting
the MDCHSYNC bit in the MDCARH register. Synchronization for the Carrier Low signal can be enabled by
setting the MDCLSYNC bit in the MDCARL register.
Figure 12-1 through Figure 12-6 show timing diagrams
using various synchronization methods.
The Modulator signal is selected by configuring the
MDSRC bits in the MDSRC register.
DS30000575C-page 236
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 12-2:
ON-OFF KEYING (OOK) SYNCHRONIZATION
Carrier Low (CARL)
Carrier High (CARH)
Modulator (MOD)
MDCHSYNC = 1
MDCLSYNC = 0
MDCHSYNC = 1
MDCLSYNC = 1
MDCHSYNC = 0
MDCLSYNC = 0
MDCHSYNC = 0
MDCLSYNC = 1
FIGURE 12-3:
NO SYNCHRONIZATION (MDCHSYNC = 0, MDCLSYNC = 0)
Carrier High (CARH)
Carrier Low (CARL)
Modulator (MOD)
MDCHSYNC = 0
MDCLSYNC = 0
Active Carrier
State
FIGURE 12-4:
CARH
CARL
CARL
CARH
CARRIER HIGH SYNCHRONIZATION (MDCHSYNC = 1, MDCLSYNC = 0)
Carrier High (CARH)
Carrier Low (CARL)
Modulator (MOD)
MDCHSYNC = 1
MDCLSYNC = 0
Active Carrier
State
CARH
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
both
CARL
CARH
both
CARL
DS30000575C-page 237
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 12-5:
CARRIER LOW SYNCHRONIZATION (MDCHSYNC = 0, MDCLSYNC = 1)
Carrier High (CARH)
Carrier Low (CARL)
Modulator (MOD)
MDCHSYNC = 0
MDCLSYNC = 1
Active Carrier
State
FIGURE 12-6:
CARH
CARL
CARH
CARL
FULL SYNCHRONIZATION (MDCHSYNC = 1, MDCLSYNC = 1)
Carrier High (CARH)
Carrier Low (CARL)
Modulator (MOD)
Falling edges
used to sync
MDCHSYNC = 1
MDCLSYNC = 1
Active Carrier
State
DS30000575C-page 238
CARH
CARL
CARH
CARL
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
12.5
Carrier Source Polarity Select
The signal provided from any selected input source for
the Carrier High and Carrier Low signals can be
inverted. Inverting the signal for the Carrier High source
is enabled by setting the MDCHPOL bit of the
MDCARH register. Inverting the signal for the Carrier
Low source is enabled by setting the MDCLPOL bit of
the MDCARL register.
12.6
Carrier Source Pin Disable
Some peripherals assert control over their corresponding output pin when they are enabled. For example,
when the CCP1 module is enabled, the output of CCP1
is connected to the CCP1 pin.
This default connection to a pin can be disabled by
setting the MDCHODIS bit in the MDCARH register for
the Carrier High source and the MDCLODIS bit in the
MDCARL register for the Carrier Low source.
12.7
Programmable Modulator Data
The MDBIT of the MDCON register can be selected as
the source for the Modulator signal. This gives the user
the ability to program the value used for modulation.
12.8
Modulator Source Pin Disable
The Modulator source default connection to a pin can
be disabled by setting the MDSODIS bit in the MDSRC
register.
12.9
Modulated Output Polarity
The modulated output signal provided on the MDOUT
pin can also be inverted. Inverting the modulated output signal is enabled by setting the MDOPOL bit of the
MDCON register.
12.10 Slew Rate Control
When modulated data streams of 20 MHz or greater
are required, the slew rate limitation on the output port
pin can be disabled. The slew rate limitation can be
removed by clearing the MDSLR bit in the MDCON
register.
12.11 Operation In Sleep Mode
The DSM module is not affected by Sleep mode. The
DSM can still operate during Sleep if the carrier and
Modulator input sources are also still operable during
Sleep.
12.12 Effects of a Reset
Upon any device Reset, the Modulator data signal
module is disabled. The user’s firmware is responsible
for initializing the module before enabling the output.
The registers are reset to their default values.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 239
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 12-1:
R/W-0
MDCON: MODULATION CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
MDEN
MDOE
R/W-1
MDSLR
R/W-0
MDOPOL
R/W-0
MDOUT
(2)
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
MDBIT(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
MDEN: Modulator Module Enable bit
1 = Modulator module is enabled and mixing input signals
0 = Modulator module is disabled and has no output
bit 6
MDOE: Modulator Module Pin Output Enable bit
1 = Modulator pin output is enabled
0 = Modulator pin output is disabled
bit 5
MDSLR: MDOUT Pin Slew Rate Limiting bit
1 = MDOUT pin slew rate limiting is enabled
0 = MDOUT pin slew rate limiting is disabled
bit 4
MDOPOL: Modulator Output Polarity Select bit
1 = Modulator output signal is inverted
0 = Modulator output signal is not inverted
bit 3
MDOUT: Modulator Output bit(2)
Displays the current output value of the Modulator module.
bit 2-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
MDBIT: Modulator Source Input bit(1)
Allows software to manually set modulation source input to the module.
Note 1:
2:
The MDBIT must be selected as the modulation source in the MDCON register for this operation.
The modulated output frequency can be greater and asynchronous from the clock that updates this
register bit. The bit value may not be valid for higher speed Modulator or carrier signals.
DS30000575C-page 240
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 12-2:
MDSRC: MODULATION SOURCE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
MDSODIS
—
—
—
MDSRC3
MDSRC2
MDSRC1
MDSRC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
MDSODIS: Modulation Source Output Disable bit
1 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDMS) is disabled
0 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDMS) is enabled
bit 6-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
MDSRC Modulation Source Selection bits
1111 = CCP8 output (PWM Output mode only)
1110 = CCP7 output (PWM Output mode only)
1101 = CCP6 output (PWM Output mode only)
1100 = CCP5 output (PWM Output mode only)
1011 = CCP4 output (PWM Output mode only)
1010 = ECCP3 output (PWM Output mode only)
1001 = ECCP2 output (PWM Output mode only)
1000 = ECCP1 output (PWM Output mode only)
0111 = EUSART4 TXx output
0110 = EUSART3 TXx output
0101 = EUSART2 TXx output
0100 = EUSART1 TXx output
0011 = MSSP2 SDO signal (SPI mode only)
0010 = MSSP1 SDO signal (SPI mode only)
0001 = MDMIN pin
0000 = MDBIT bit of MDCON register is the modulation source
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 241
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 12-3:
R/W-x
MDCARH: MODULATION CARRIER HIGH CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
MDCHODIS
MDCHPOL
R/W-x
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
MDCHSYNC
—
MDCH3(1)
MDCH2(1)
MDCH1(1)
MDCH0(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
MDCHODIS: Modulator Carrier High Output Disable bit
1 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDCH) is disabled
0 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDCH) is enabled
bit 6
MDCHPOL: Modulator Carrier High Polarity Select bit
1 = Selected Carrier High signal is inverted
0 = Selected Carrier High signal is not inverted
bit 5
MDCHSYNC: Modulator Carrier High Synchronization Enable bit
1 = Modulator waits for a falling edge on the Carrier High time signal before allowing a switch to the
Carrier Low time
0 = Modulator output is not synchronized to the Carrier High time signal(1)
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
MDCH: Modulator Data Carrier High Selection bits(1)
1111 = Reference Clock Output Module 2 (REFO2) signal
1110 = System clock
1101 = CCP10 output (PWM Output mode only)
1100 = CCP9 output (PWM Output mode only)
1011 = CCP8 output (PWM Output mode only)
1010 = CCP7 output (PWM Output mode only)
1001 = CCP6 output (PWM Output mode only)
1000 = CCP5 output (PWM Output mode only)
0111 = CCP4 output (PWM Output mode only)
0110 = ECCP3 output (PWM Output mode only)
0101 = ECCP2 output (PWM Output mode only)
0100 = ECCP1 output (PWM Output mode only)
0011 = Reference Clock Output Module 1 (REFO1) signal
0010 = MDCIN2 pin
0001 = MDCIN1 pin
0000 = No carrier input (tied to ground)
Note 1:
Narrowed carrier pulse widths or spurs may occur in the signal stream during transitions.
DS30000575C-page 242
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 12-4:
R/W-x
MDCARL: MODULATION CARRIER LOW CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
MDCLODIS
MDCLPOL
R/W-x
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
MDCLSYNC
—
MDCL3(1)
MDCL2(1)
MDCL1(1)
MDCL0(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
MDCLODIS: Modulator Carrier Low Output Disable bit
1 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDCL) is disabled
0 = Output signal driving the peripheral output pin (selected by MDCL) is enabled
bit 6
MDCLPOL: Modulator Carrier Low Polarity Select bit
1 = Selected Carrier Low signal is inverted
0 = Selected Carrier Low signal is not inverted
bit 5
MDCLSYNC: Modulator Carrier Low Synchronization Enable bit
1 = Modulator waits for a falling edge on the Carrier Low time signal before allowing a switch to the
Carrier High time
0 = Modulator output is not synchronized to the Carrier Low time signal(1)
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
MDCL: Modulator Data Carrier Low Selection bits(1)
1111 = Reference Clock Output Module 2 (REFO2) signal
1110 = System clock
1101 = CCP10 output (PWM Output mode only)
1100 = CCP9 output (PWM Output mode only)
1011 = CCP8 output (PWM Output mode only)
1010 = CCP7 output (PWM Output mode only)
1001 = CCP6 output (PWM Output mode only)
1000 = CCP5 output (PWM Output mode only)
0111 = CCP4 output (PWM Output mode only)
0110 = ECCP3 output (PWM Output mode only)
0101 = ECCP2 output (PWM Output mode only)
0100 = ECCP1 output (PWM Output mode only)
0011 = Reference Clock Output Module 1 (REFO1) signal
0010 = MDCIN2 pin
0001 = MDCIN1 pin
0000 = No carrier input (tied to ground)
Note 1:
Narrowed carrier pulse widths or spurs may occur in the signal stream during transitions.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 243
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.0
LIQUID CRYSTAL DISPLAY
(LCD) CONTROLLER
• Up to 60 segments (in 100-pin devices when
1/5-1/8 multiplex is selected), 64 (in 100-pin
devices when up to 1/4 multiplex is selected), 46
(in 80-pin devices when 1/5-1/8 multiplex is
selected), 50 (in 80-pin devices when up to
1/4 multiplex is selected), 30 (in 64-pin devices
when 1/5-1/8 multiplex is selected) and 34 (in
64-pin devices when up to 1/4 multiplex is
selected)
• Static, 1/2 or 1/3 LCD bias
• On-chip bias generator with dedicated charge
pump to support a range of fixed and variable bias
options
• Internal resistors for bias voltage generation
• Software contrast control for LCD using the
internal biasing
The Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) driver module generates the timing control to drive a static or multiplexed
LCD panel. In 100-pin devices (PIC18F97J94), the
module drives panels of up to eight commons and up to
60 segments when 5 to 8 commons are used, and up
to 64 segments when 1 to 4 commons are used. It also
provides control of the LCD pixel data.
The LCD driver module supports:
• Direct driving of LCD panel
• Three LCD clock sources with selectable prescaler
• Up to eight commons:
- Static (One common)
- 1/2 multiplex (two commons)
- 1/3 multiplex (three commons)
- 1/8 multiplex (eight commons)
FIGURE 13-1:
A simplified block diagram of the module is shown in
Figure 13-1.
LCD CONTROLLER MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
LCD DATA
64 x 8
8
LCDDATA63
512
LCDDATA62
.
.
.
to
64
LCDDATA1
MUX
64
SEG
LCDDATA0
Bias
Voltage
To I/O Pins
Timing Control
LCDCON
8
LCDPS
LCDSEx
COM
LCD Bias Generation
Resistor Ladder
FRC Oscillator
LPRC Oscillator
SOSC
(Secondary Oscillator)
DS30000575C-page 244
LCD Clock
Source Select
LCD
Charge Pump
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.1
LCD Registers
The LCDCON register, shown in Register 13-1, controls the overall operation of the module. Once the
module is configured, the LCDEN (LCDCON) bit is
used to enable or disable the LCD module. The LCD
panel can also operate during Sleep by clearing the
SLPEN (LCDCON) bit.
The LCD controller has up to 77 registers:
• LCD Control Register (LCDCON)
• LCD Phase Register (LCDPS)
• LCD Voltage Regulator Control Register
(LCDREG)
• LCD Reference Ladder Control Register
(LCDREF and LCDRL)
• Eight LCD Segment Enable Registers
(LCDSE7:LCDSE0)
• 64 LCD Data Registers (LCDDATA63:LCDDATA0)
REGISTER 13-1:
The LCDPS register, shown in Register 13-3, configures
the LCD clock source prescaler and the type of waveform: Type-A or Type-B. For details on these features,
see Section 13.3 “LCD Clock Source Selection” and
Section 13.12 “LCD Waveform Generation”.
LCDCON: LCD CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/C-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LCDEN
SLPEN
WERR
CS1
CS0
LMUX2
LMUX1
LMUX0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
C = Clearable bit
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
LCDEN: LCD Driver Enable bit
1 = LCD driver module is enabled
0 = LCD driver module is disabled
bit 6
SLPEN: LCD Driver Enable in Sleep mode bit
1 = LCD driver module is disabled in Sleep mode
0 = LCD driver module is enabled in Sleep mode
bit 5
WERR: LCD Write Failed Error bit
1 = LCDDATAx register is written while WA (LCDPS) = 0 (must be cleared in software)
0 = No LCD write error
bit 4-3
CS: Clock Source Select bits
00 = FRC (8 MHz)/8192
01 = SOSC Oscillator (32.768 kHz)/32
1x = INTRC (31.25 kHz)/32
bit 2-0
LMUX: Commons Select bits
LMUX
Multiplex
Bias
111
110
101
100
011
010
001
000
1/8 MUX (COM)
1/7 MUX (COM)
1/6 MUX (COM)
1/5 MUX (COM)
1/4 MUX (COM)
1/3 MUX (COM)
1/2 MUX (COM)
Static (COM0)
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/3
1/2 or 1/3
1/2 or 1/3
Static
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 245
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 13-2:
LCDREG: LCD CHARGE PUMP CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
RW-1
RW-1
RW-1
RW-1
RW-0
RW-0
CPEN
—
BIAS2
BIAS1
BIAS0
MODE13
CLKSEL1
CLKSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CPEN: 3.6V Charge Pump Enable bit
1 = The regulator generates the highest (3.6V) voltage
0 = Highest voltage in the system is supplied externally (VDD)
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-3
BIAS: Regulator Voltage Output Control bits
111 =3.60V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0V)
110 =3.47V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.13V)
101 =3.34V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.26V)
100 =3.21V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.39V)
011 =3.08V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.52V)
010 =2.95V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.65V)
001 =2.82V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.78V)
000 =2.69V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.91V)
bit 2
MODE13: 1/3 LCD BIAS Enable bit
1 = Regulator output supports 1/3 LCD BIAS mode
0 = Regulator output supports Static LCD BIAS mode
bit 1-0
CLKSEL: Regulator Clock Select Control bits
11 =LPRC
10 =FRC
01 =SOSC
00 =Disable regulator and float regulator voltage output.
DS30000575C-page 246
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 13-3:
LCDPS: LCD PHASE REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
WFT
BIASMD
LCDA
WA
LP3
LP2
LP1
LP0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
WFT: Waveform Type Select bit
1 = Type-B waveform (phase changes on each frame boundary)
0 = Type-A waveform (phase changes within each common type)
bit 6
BIASMD: Bias Mode Select bit
When LMUX = 000 or 011 through 111:
0 = Static Bias mode (LMUX = 000) / 1/3 Bias mode (LMUX = 011 through 111) (do not
set this bit to ‘1’)
When LMUX = 001 or 010:
1 = 1/2 Bias mode
0 = 1/3 Bias mode
bit 5
LCDA: LCD Active Status bit
1 = LCD driver module is active
0 = LCD driver module is inactive
bit 4
WA: LCD Write Allow Status bit
1 = Writes into the LCDDATAx registers is allowed
0 = Writes into the LCDDATAx registers is not allowed
bit 3-0
LP: LCD Prescaler Select bits
1111 = 1:16
1110 = 1:15
1101 = 1:14
1100 = 1:13
1011 = 1:12
1010 = 1:11
1001 = 1:10
1000 = 1:9
0111 = 1:8
0110 = 1:7
0101 = 1:6
0100 = 1:5
0011 = 1:4
0010 = 1:3
0001 = 1:2
0000 = 1:1
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 247
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.2
LCD Segment Pins Configuration
The LCDSEx registers configure the functions of the
port pins. Setting the segment enable bit for a particular
segment configures that pin as an LCD driver. There
TABLE 13-1:
are four LCD Segment Enable registers, as shown in
Table 13-1. The prototype LCDSEx register is shown in
Register 13-4.
LCDSEx REGISTERS AND ASSOCIATED SEGMENTS
Register
Segments
LCDSE0
Seg 7:Seg 0
LCDSE1
Seg 15:Seg 8
LCDSE2
Seg 23:Seg 16
LCDSE3
Seg 31:Seg 24
LCDSE4
Seg 39:Seg 32
LCDSE5
Seg 47:Seg 40
LCDSE6
Seg 55:Seg 48
LCDSE7
Seg 63:Seg 56
Once the module is initialized for the LCD panel, the
individual bits of the LCDDATAx registers are cleared
or set to represent a clear or dark pixel, respectively.
Specific sets of LCDDATA registers are used with
specific segments and common signals. Each bit represents a unique combination of a specific segment
connected to a specific common.
REGISTER 13-4:
Individual LCDDATA bits are named by the convention,
“SxxCy”, with “xx” as the segment number and “y” as
the common number. The relationship is summarized
in Register 13-3. The prototype LCDDATAx register is
shown in Register 13-5.
LCDSEx: LCD SEGMENT x ENABLE REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
SE(n)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
SE(n): Segment Enable bits
For LCDSE0: n = 0-7
For LCDSE1: n = 8-15
For LCDSE2: n = 16-23
For LCDSE3: n = 24-31
For LCDSE0: n = 32-39
For LCDSE0: n = 40-47
For LCDSE0: n = 48-55
For LCDSE0: n = 56-63
1 = Segment function of the pin is enabled, digital I/O is disabled
0 = Segment function of the pin is disabled, digital I/O is enabled
DS30000575C-page 248
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 13-5:
LCDDATAx: LCD DATA x REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
S(n)Cy
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
S(n)Cy: Pixel On bits
For registers LCDDATA0 through LCDDATA7: n = (0-63), y = 0
For registers LCDDATA8 through LCDDATA15: n = (0-63), y = 1
For registers LCDDATA16 through LCDDATA23: n = (0-63), y = 2
For registers LCDDATA24 through LCDDATA31: n = (0-63), y = 3
For registers LCDDATA32 through LCDDATA39: n = (0-63), y = 4
For registers LCDDATA40 through LCDDATA47: n = (0-63), y = 5
For registers LCDDATA48 through LCDDATA55: n = (0-63), y = 6
For registers LCDDATA56 through LCDDATA63: n = (0-63), y = 7
1 = Pixel on
0 = Pixel off
TABLE 13-2:
COM
Lines
x = Bit is unknown
LCDDATA REGISTERS AND BITS FOR SEGMENT AND COM COMBINATIONS
Segments
0 to 7
8 to 15
16 to 23
24 to 31
32 to 39
0
LCDDATA0
S00C0:S07C0
LCDDATA1
S08C0:S15C0
LCDDATA2
S16C0:S23C0
LCDDATA3
S24C0:S31C0
LCDDATA4
S32C0:S39C0
LCDDATA5
LCDDATA6
LCDDATA7
S40C0:S47C0 S48C0:S55C0 S56C0:S63C0
1
LCDDATA8
S00C1:S07C1
LCDDATA9
S08C1:S15C1
LCDDATA10
S16C1:S23C1
LCDDATA11
S24C1:S31C1
LCDDATA12
S32C1:S39C1
LCDDATA13
LCDDATA14
LCDDATA15
S40C1:S47C1 S48C1:S55C1 S56C1:S63C1
2
LCDDATA16
S00C2:S07C2
LCDDATA17
S08C2:S15C2
LCDDATA18
S16C2:S23C2
LCDDATA19
S24C2:S31C2
LCDDATA20
S32C2:S39C2
3
LCDDATA24
S00C3:S07C3
LCDDATA25
S08C3:S15C3
LCDDATA26
S16C3:S23C3
LCDDATA27
S24C3:S31C3
LCDDATA28
S32C3:S39C3
LCDDATA29
LCDDATA30
LCDDATA31
S40C3:S47C3 S48C3:S55C3 S56C3:S63C3
4
LCDDATA32
S00C4:S07C4
LCDDATA33
S08C4:S15C4
LCDDATA34
S16C4:S23C4
LCDDATA35
S24C4:S31C4
LCDDATA36
S32C4:S39C4
LCDDATA37
LCDDATA38
LCDDATA39
S40C4:S47C4 S48C4:S55C4 S56C4:S63C4
5
LCDDATA40
S00C5:S07C5
LCDDATA41
S08C5:S15C5
LCDDATA42
S16C5:S23C5
LCDDATA43
S24C5:S31C5
LCDDATA44
S32C5:S39C5
LCDDATA46
LCDDATA47
LCDDATA45
S40C5:S47C5 S48C5:S55C5 S56C5:S63C5
6
LCDDATA48
S00C6:S07C6
LCDDATA49
S08C6:S15C6
LCDDATA50
S16C6:S23C6
LCDDATA51
S24C6:S31C6
LCDDATA52
S32C6:S39C6
LCDDATA53
LCDDATA54
LCDDATA55
S40C6:S47C6 S48C6:S55C6 S56C6:S63C6
7
LCDDATA56
S00C7:S07C7
LCDDATA57
S08C7:S15C7
LCDDATA58
S16C7:S23C7
LCDDATA59
S24C7:S31C7
LCDDATA60
S32C7:S39C7
LCDDATA61
LCDDATA62
LCDDATA63
S40C7:S47C7 S48C7:S55C7 S56C7:S63C7
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
40 to 47
LCDDATA21
40C2:S47C2
48 to 55
56 to 63
LCDDATA22
LCDDATA23
S48C2:S55C2 S56C2:S63C2
DS30000575C-page 249
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.3
LCD Clock Source Selection
The LCD driver module has three possible clock
sources:
• FRC/8192
• SOSC Clock/32
The third clock source is a 31.25 kHz internal LPRC
Oscillator/32 that provides approximately 1 kHz output.
The second and third clock sources may be used to
continue running the LCD while the processor is in
Sleep.
These clock sources are selected through the bits,
CS (LCDCON).
• LPRC/32
The first clock source is the 8 MHz Fast Internal RC
(FRC) Oscillator divided by 8,192. This divider ratio is
chosen to provide about 1 kHz output. The divider is
not programmable. Instead, the LCD prescaler bits,
LCDPS, are used to set the LCD frame clock
rate.
13.3.1
The second clock source is the SOSC Oscillator/32.
This also outputs about 1 kHz when a 32.768 kHz
crystal is used with the SOSC Oscillator. To use the
SOSC Oscillator as a clock source, set the SOSCEN
(T1CON) bit.
Selectable prescale values are from 1:1 through 1:16,
in increments of one.
A 16-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the LCD
clock. The prescaler is not directly readable or writable.
Its value is set by the LP bits (LCDPS) that
determine the prescaler assignment and prescale ratio.
LCD CLOCK GENERATION
FRC Oscillator
(8 MHZ)
SOSC Oscillator
(32 kHz)
COM0
COM1
COM2
COM7
FIGURE 13-2:
LCD PRESCALER
÷8192
÷32
÷4
STAT
÷2
1/2 MUX
4-Bit Prog Prescaler
÷1, 2, 3....8
Ring Counter
1/3 to 1/8
LPRC Oscillator
(31.25 kHz)
÷32
CS
(LCDCON)
DS30000575C-page 250
MUX
LP
(LCDPS)
LMUX
(LCDCON)
LMUX
(LCDCON)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.4
LCD Bias Types
13.5
The LCD module can be configured in one of three bias
types:
Internal Resistor Biasing
This mode does not use external resistors, but rather
internal resistor ladders that are configured to generate
the bias voltage.
• Static bias (two voltage levels: VSS and VDD)
• 1/2 bias (three voltage levels: VSS, 1/2 VDD and
VDD)
• 1/3 bias (four voltage levels: VSS, 1/3 VDD, 2/3
VDD and VDD)
The internal reference ladder actually consists of three
separate ladders. Disabling the internal reference ladder disconnects all of the ladders, allowing external
voltages to be supplied.
Depending on the total resistance of the resistor
ladders, the biasing can be classified as low, medium
or high power.
LCD bias voltages can be generated with internal
resistor ladders, internal bias generator or external
resistor ladder.
Table 13-3 shows the total resistance of each of the
ladders. Table 13-3 shows the internal resister ladder
connections. When the internal resistor ladder is
selected, the bias voltage can either be from VDD or
from VDDCORE, depending on the LCDIRS setting. It
can also provide software contrast control (using
LCDCST)
.
TABLE 13-3:
INTERNAL RESISTANCE LADDER POWER MODES
Power Mode
Nominal
Resistance of
Entire Ladder
IDD
Low
3 MΩ
1 µA
Medium
300 kΩ
10 µA
High
30 kΩ
100 µA
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 251
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-3:
LCD BIAS INTERNAL RESISTOR LADDER CONNECTION DIAGRAM
DD
VVDD
VDDCORE
3x Band
Gap
LCDIRS
LCDIRE
LCDCST
VLCD3PE
LCDBIAS3
VLCD2PE
LCDBIAS2
VLCD1PE
LCDBIAS1
Low
Resistor
Ladder
Medium
Resistor
Ladder
High
Resistor
Ladder
A Power Mode
B Power Mode
LRLAT
LRLAP
LRLBP
There are two power modes, designated as “Mode A”
and “Mode B”. Mode A is set by the LRLAP bits
and Mode B by the LRLB bits. The resistor ladder
to use for Modes A and B are selected by the bits,
LRLAP and LRLBP, respectively.
Each ladder has a matching contrast control ladder,
tuned to the nominal resistance of the reference ladder.
This contrast control resistor can be controlled by the
LCDCST bits (LCDREF). Disabling the
internal reference ladder results in all of the ladders
being disconnected, allowing external voltages to be
supplied.
DS30000575C-page 252
To get additional current in High-Power mode, when
LRLAP (LCDRL) = 11, both the medium
and high-power resistor ladders are activated.
Whenever the LCD module is inactive, LCDA
(LCDPS) = 0), the reference ladder will be turned
off.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.5.1
AUTOMATIC POWER MODE
SWITCHING
(LCDRL) select how long or if the Mode A is
active. Mode B Power mode is active for the remaining
time before the segments or commons change again.
As an LCD segment is electrically only a capacitor, current is drawn only during the interval when the voltage
is switching. To minimize total device current, the LCD
reference ladder can be operated in a different power
mode for the transition portion of the duration. This is
controlled by the LCDREF and LCDRL registers.
As shown in Figure 13-4, there are 32 counts in a single
segment time. Type-A can be chosen during the time
when the wave form is in transition. Type-B can be
used when the clock is stable or not in transition.
By using this feature of automatic power switching
using Type-A/Type-B, the power consumption can be
optimized for a given contrast.
Mode A Power mode is active for a programmable
time, beginning at the time when the LCD segment
waveform is transitioning. The LRLAT bits
FIGURE 13-4:
LCD REFERENCE LADDER POWER MODE SWITCHING DIAGRAM
Single Segment Time
lcd_32x_clk
cnt
'H00
'H01
'H02
'H03
'H04
'H05
'H06
'H07
'H1E
'H1F
'H00
'H01
lcd_clk
'H3
LRLAT
Segment Data
LRLAT
Power Mode
Power Mode A
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Power Mode B
Mode A
DS30000575C-page 253
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.5.2
CONTRAST CONTROL
The LCD contrast control circuit consists of a 7-tap
resistor ladder, controlled by the LCDCSTx bits (see
Figure 13-5)
FIGURE 13-5:
INTERNAL REFERENCE AND CONTRAST CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM
7 Stages
VDD
R
R
R
R
Analog
MUX
7
0
To Top of
Reference Ladder
LCDCST
3
Internal Reference
13.5.3
Contrast Control
INTERNAL REFERENCE
Under firmware control, an internal reference for the
LCD bias voltages can be enabled. When enabled, the
source of this voltage can be VDD.
When no internal reference is selected, the LCD contrast control circuit is disabled and LCD bias must be
provided externally. Whenever the LCD module is inactive (LCDA = 0), the internal reference will be turned
off.
DS30000575C-page 254
13.5.4
VLCDxPE PINS
The VLCD3PE, VLCD2PE and VLCD1PE pins provide
the ability for an external LCD bias network to be used
instead of the internal ladder. Use of the VLCDxPE pins
does not prevent use of the internal ladder.
Each VLCDxPE pin has an independent control in the
LCDREF register, allowing access to any or all of the
LCD bias signals.
This architecture allows for maximum flexibility in different applications. The VLCDxPE pins could be used to
add capacitors to the internal reference ladder for
increasing the drive capacity. For applications where
the internal contrast control is insufficient, the firmware
can choose to enable only the VLCD3PE pin, allowing
an external contrast control circuit to use the internal
reference divider.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 13-6:
LCDREF: LCD REFERENCE LADDER CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LCDIRE
—
LCDCST2
LCDCST1
LCDCST0
VLCD3PE
VLCD2PE
VLCD1PE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
LCDIRE: LCD Internal Reference Enable bit
1 = Internal LCD reference is enabled and connected to the internal contrast control circuit
0 = Internal LCD reference is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-3
LCDCST: LCD Contrast Control bits
Selects the Resistance of the LCD Contrast Control Resistor Ladder:
111 =Resistor ladder is at maximum resistance (minimum contrast)
110 =Resistor ladder is at 6/7th of maximum resistance
101 =Resistor ladder is at 5/7th of maximum resistance
100 =Resistor ladder is at 4/7th of maximum resistance
011 =Resistor ladder is at 3/7th of maximum resistance
010 =Resistor ladder is at 2/7th of maximum resistance
001 =Resistor ladder is at 1/7th of maximum resistance
000 =Minimum resistance (maximum contrast); resistor ladder is shorted
bit 2
VLCD3PE: Bias3 Pin Enable bit
1 = BIAS3 level is connected to the external pin, LCDBIAS3
0 = BIAS3 level is internal (internal resistor ladder)
bit 1
VLCD2PE: Bias2 Pin Enable bit
1 = BIAS2 level is connected to the external pin, LCDBIAS2
0 = BIAS2 level is internal (internal resistor ladder)
bit 0
VLCD1PE: Bias1 Pin Enable bit
1 = BIAS1 level is connected to the external pin, LCDBIAS1
0 = BIAS1 level is internal (internal resistor ladder)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 255
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 13-7:
LCDRL: LCD REFERENCE LADDER CONTROL REGISTER LOW
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LRLAP1
LRLAP0
LRLBP1
LRLBP0
—
LRLAT2
LRLAT1
LRLAT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
LRLAP: LCD Reference Ladder A Time Power Control bits
During Time Interval A:
11 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in High-Power mode
10 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in Medium Power mode
01 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in Low-Power mode
00 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered down and unconnected
bit 5-4
LRLBP: LCD Reference Ladder B Time Power Control bits
During Time Interval B:
11 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in High-Power mode
10 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in Medium Power mode
01 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered in Low-Power mode
00 = Internal LCD reference ladder is powered down and unconnected
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
LRLAT: LCD Reference Ladder A Time Interval Control bits
Sets the number of 32 clock counts when the A Time Interval Power mode is active.
For Type-A Waveforms (WFT = 0):
111 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 7 clocks and B Power mode for 9 clocks
110 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 6 clocks and B Power mode for 10 clocks
101 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 5 clocks and B Power mode for 11 clocks
100 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 4 clocks and B Power mode for 12 clocks
011 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 3 clocks and B Power mode for 13 clocks
010 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 2 clocks and B Power mode for 14 clocks
001 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 1 clock and B Power mode for 15 clocks
000 = Internal LCD reference ladder is always in B Power mode
For Type-B Waveforms (WFT = 1):
111 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 7 clocks and B Power mode for 25 clocks
110 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 6 clocks and B Power mode for 26 clocks
101 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 5 clocks and B Power mode for 27 clocks
100 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 4 clocks and B Power mode for 28 clocks
011 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 3 clocks and B Power mode for 29 clocks
010 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 2 clocks and B Power mode for 30 clocks
001 = Internal LCD reference ladder is in A Power mode for 1 clock and B Power mode for 31 clocks
000 = Internal LCD reference ladder is always in B Power mode
DS30000575C-page 256
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.5.5
LCD BIAS GENERATION
13.5.7
The LCD driver module is capable of generating the
required bias voltages for LCD operation with a minimum of external components. This includes the ability
to generate the different voltage levels required by the
different bias types that are required by the LCD. The
driver module can also provide bias voltages, both
above and below microcontroller VDD, through the use
of an on-chip LCD voltage regulator.
13.5.6
LCD BIAS TYPES
PIC18F97J94 family devices support three bias types,
based on the waveforms generated to control
segments and commons:
• Static (two discrete levels)
• 1/2 Bias (three discrete levels)
• 1/3 Bias (four discrete levels)
LCD VOLTAGE REGULATOR
The purpose of the LCD regulator is to provide proper
bias voltage and good contrast for the LCD, regardless
of VDD levels. This module contains a charge pump and
internal voltage reference. The regulator can be configured by using external components to boost bias
voltage above VDD. It can also operate a display at a
constant voltage below VDD. The regulator can also be
selectively disabled to allow bias voltages to be
generated by an external resistor network.
The LCD regulator is controlled through the LCDREG
register. It is enabled or disabled using the
CLKSEL bits, while the charge pump can be
selectively enabled using the CPEN bit. When the regulator is enabled, the MODE13 bit is used to select the
bias type. The peak LCD bias voltage, measured as a
difference between the potentials of LCDBIAS3 and
LCDBIAS0, is configured with the BIAS bits.
The use of different waveforms in driving the LCD is discussed in more detail in Section 13.12 “LCD Waveform
Generation”.
REGISTER 13-8:
LCDREG: LCD VOLTAGE REGULATOR CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
CPEN
—
BIAS2
BIAS1
BIAS0
MODE13
CLKSEL1
CLKSEL 0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CPEN: LCD Charge Pump Enable bit
1 = Charge pump is enabled; highest LCD bias voltage is 3.6V
0 = Charge pump is disabled; highest LCD bias voltage is VDD
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-3
BIAS: Regulator Voltage Output Control bits
111 = 3.60V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0V)
110 = 3.47V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.13V)
101 = 3.34V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.26V)
100 = 3.21V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.39V)
011 = 3.08V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.52V)
010 = 2.95V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.65V)
001 = 2.82V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.78V)
000 = 2.69V peak (offset on LCDBIAS0 of 0.91V)
bit 2
MODE13: 1/3 LCD Bias Enable bit
1 = Regulator output supports 1/3 LCD Bias mode
0 = Regulator output supports Static LCD Bias mode
bit 1-0
CLKSEL: Regulator Clock Source Select bits
11 = 31 kHz LPRC
10 = 8 MHz FRC
01 = SOSC
00 = LCD regulator disabled
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 257
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.6
BIAS CONFIGURATIONS
PIC18F97J94 family devices have four distinct circuit
configurations for LCD bias generation:
•
•
•
•
M0: Regulator with Boost
M1: Regulator without Boost
M2: Resistor Ladder with Software Contrast
M3: Resistor Ladder with Hardware Contrast
13.6.1
M0 (REGULATOR WITH BOOST)
In M0 operation, the LCD charge pump feature is
enabled. This allows the regulator to generate voltages
up to +3.6V to the LCD (as measured at LCDBIAS3).
M0 uses a flyback capacitor connected between
VLCAP1 and VLCAP2, as well as filter capacitors on
LCDBIAS0 through LCDBIAS3, to obtain the required
voltage boost (Figure 13-6). The output voltage (VBIAS)
is the difference of the potential between LCDBIAS3
and LCDBIAS0. It is set by the BIAS bits which
adjust the offset between LCDBIAS0 and VSS. The
flyback capacitor (CFLY) acts as a charge storage element for large LCD loads. This mode is useful in those
cases where the voltage requirements of the LCD are
higher than the microcontroller’s VDD. It also permits
software control of the display’s contrast, by adjustment of bias voltage, by changing the value of the BIAS
bits.
M0 supports static and 1/3 bias types. Generation of
the voltage levels for 1/3 bias is handled automatically,
but must be configured in software.
13.6.2
M1 (REGULATOR WITHOUT
BOOST)
M1 operation is similar to M0, but does not use the LCD
charge pump. It can provide VBIAS up to the voltage
level supplied directly to LCDBIAS3. It can be used in
cases where VDD for the application is expected to
never drop below a level that can provide adequate
contrast for the LCD. The connection of external components is very similar to M0, except that LCDBIAS3
must be tied directly to VDD (Figure 13-6).
Note:
When the device is put to Sleep while operating in mode M0 or M1, make sure that the
bias capacitors are fully discharged to get
the lowest Sleep current.
The BIAS bits can still be used to adjust contrast
in software by changing the VBIAS. As with M0, changing these bits changes the offset between LCDBIAS0
and VSS. In M1, this is reflected in the change between
the LCDBIAS0 and the voltage tied to LCDBIAS3.
Thus, if VDD should change, VBIAS will also change;
where in M0, the level of VBIAS is constant.
Like M0, M1 supports static and 1/3 bias types.
Generation of the voltage levels for 1/3 bias is handled
automatically but must be configured in software. M1 is
enabled by selecting a valid regulator clock source
(CLKSEL set to any value except ‘00’) and clearing the CPEN bit. If 1/3 bias type is required, the
MODE13 bit should also be set.
M0 is enabled by selecting a valid regulator clock
source (CLKSEL set to any value except ‘00’)
and setting the CPEN bit. If static bias type is required,
the MODE13 bit must be cleared.
DS30000575C-page 258
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-6:
LCD REGULATOR CONNECTIONS FOR M0 AND M1 CONFIGURATIONS
PIC18F97J94
VLCAP1
VLCAP2
LCDBIAS3
LCDBIAS2
LCDBIAS1
LCDBIAS0
Mode 0 (VBIAS up to 3.6V)
Note 1:
CFLY
0.47 F(1)
0.47 F(1)
VDD
C3
0.47 F(1)
C2
0.47 F(1)
C1
0.47 F(1)
C0
0.47 F(1)
C2
0.47 F(1)
C1
0.47 F(1)
C0
0.47 F(1)
Mode 1 (VBIAS VDD)
These values are provided for design guidance only; they should be optimized for the application by the designer
based on the actual LCD specifications.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 259
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.6.3
M2 (EXTERNAL RESISTOR LADDER
WITH SOFTWARE CONTRAST)
LCDBIAS0. The bias type is determined by the voltages on the LCDBIAS pins, which are controlled by the
configuration of the resistor ladder. Most applications,
using M2, will use a 1/3 or 1/2 bias type. While static
bias can also be used, it offers extremely limited contrast range and additional current consumption over
other bias generation modes.
M2 operation also uses the LCD regulator but disables
the charge pump. The regulator’s internal voltage reference remains active as a way to regulate contrast. It is
used in cases where the current requirements of the
LCD exceed the capacity of the regulator’s charge
pump.
Like M1, the LCDBIAS bits can be used to control contrast, limited by the level of VDD supplied to the device.
Also, since there is no capacitor required across
VLCAP1 and VLCAP2, these pins are available as digital
I/O ports, RG2 and RG3. M2 is selected by clearing the
CLKSEL bits and setting the CPEN bit.
In this configuration, the LCD bias voltage levels are
created by an external resistor voltage divider,
connected across LCDBIAS0 through LCDBIAS3, with
the top of the divider tied to VDD (Figure 13-7). The
potential at the bottom of the ladder is determined by
the LCD regulator’s voltage reference, tied internally to
FIGURE 13-7:
RESISTOR LADDER CONNECTIONS FOR M2 CONFIGURATION
PIC18F97J94
VDD
VDD
LCDBIAS3
10 k(1)
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS2
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS1
10 k(1)
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS0
1/2 Bias
Bias Level at Pin
Note 1:
1/3 Bias
Bias Type
1/2 Bias
1/3 Bias
LCDBIAS0
(Internal Low Reference Voltage)
(Internal Low Reference Voltage)
LCDBIAS1
1/2 VBIAS
1/3 VBIAS
LCDBIAS2
1/2 VBIAS
2/3 VBIAS
LCDBIAS3
VBIAS (up to VDD)
VBIAS (up to VDD)
These values are provided for design guidance only; they should be optimized for the application by the designer
based on the actual LCD specifications.
DS30000575C-page 260
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.6.4
M3 (HARDWARE CONTRAST)
In M3, the LCD regulator is completely disabled. Like
M2, LCD bias levels are tied to VDD and are generated
using an external divider. The difference is that the
internal voltage reference is also disabled and the bottom of the ladder is tied to ground (VSS); see Figure 138. The value of the resistors, and the difference
between VSS and VDD, determine the contrast range;
no software adjustment is possible. This configuration
FIGURE 13-8:
is also used where the LCD’s current requirements
exceed the capacity of the charge pump and software
contrast control is not needed.
Depending on the bias type required, resistors are connected between some or all of the pins. A potentiometer can also be connected between LCDBIAS3 and
VDD to allow for hardware controlled contrast adjustment.
M3 is selected by clearing the CLKSEL and
CPEN bits.
RESISTOR LADDER CONNECTIONS FOR M3 CONFIGURATION
PIC18F97J94
VDD
VDD
VDD
(2)
LCDBIAS3
10 k(1)
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS2
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS1
10 k(1)
10 k(1)
LCDBIAS0
Static Bias
Bias Level at Pin
Note 1:
2:
1/2 Bias
1/3 Bias
Bias Type
Static
1/2 Bias
1/3 Bias
LCDBIAS0
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
LCDBIAS1
AVSS
1/2 VDD
1/3 VDD
LCDBIAS2
VDD
1/2 VDD
2/3 VDD
LCDBIAS3
VDD
VDD
VDD
These values are provided for design guidance only; they should be optimized for the application by the
designer based on the actual LCD specifications.
A potentiometer for manual contrast adjustment is optional; it may be omitted entirely.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 261
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.7
Design Considerations for the
LCD Charge Pump
When designing applications that use the LCD regulator with the charge pump enabled, users must always
consider both the dynamic current and RMS (static)
current requirements of the display, and what the
charge pump can deliver. Both dynamic and static
current can be determined by Equation 13-1:
EQUATION 13-1:
LCD STATIC, DYNAMIC
CURRENT
I=Cx
dV
dt
For dynamic current, C, is the value of the capacitors
attached to LCDBIAS3 and LCDBIAS2. The variable,
dV, is the voltage drop allowed on C2 and C3 during a
voltage switch on the LCD display, and dt is the duration
of the transient current after a clock pulse occurs.
For practical design purposes, it will be assumed to be
0.047 µF for C, 0.1V for dV and 1 µs for dt. This yields
a dynamic current of 4.7 mA for 1 µs.
RMS current is determined by the value of CFLY for C,
the voltage across VLCAP1 and VLCAP2 for dV and the
regulator clock period (TPER) for dt. Assuming a CFLY
value of 0.047 µF, a value of 1.02V across CFLY and
TPER of 30 µs, the maximum theoretical static current
will be 1.8 mA. Since the charge pump must charge five
capacitors, the maximum current becomes 360 µA.
For a real-world assumption of 50% efficiency, this
yields a practical current of 180 µA. Users should compare the calculated current capacity against the
TABLE 13-4:
LMUX
requirements of the LCD. While dV and dt are relatively
fixed by device design, the values of CFLY and the
capacitors on the LCDBIAS pins can be changed to
increase or decrease current. As always, any changes
should be evaluated in the actual circuit for their impact
on the application.
13.8
LCD Multiplex Types
The LCD driver module can be configured into four
multiplex types:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Static (only COM0 used)
1/2 multiplex (COM0 and COM1 are used)
1/3 multiplex (COM0, COM1 and COM2 are used)
1/4 multiplex (COM0, COM1, COM2 and COM3
are used)
1/5 multiplex (COM0, COM1, COM2, COM3 and
COM4 are used)
1/6 multiplex (COM0, COM1, COM2, COM3,
COM4 and COM5 are used)
1/7 multiplex (COM0, COM1, COM2, COM3,
COM4, COM5 and COM6 are used)
1/8 multiplex (COM0, COM1, COM2, COM3,
COM4, COM5, COM6 and COM7 are used)
The LMUX setting (LCDCON) decides the
function of the COM pins. (For details, see Table 13-4).
If the pin is a digital I/O, the corresponding TRIS bit
controls the data direction. If the pin is a COM drive, the
TRIS setting of that pin is overridden.
Note:
On a Power-on Reset, the LMUX
bits are ‘000’.
COM PIN FUNCTIONS
COM7 Pin COM6 Pin COM5 Pin COM4 Pin COM3 Pin COM2 Pin COM1 Pin COM0 Pin
111
COM7
COM6
COM5
COM4
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
110
I/O Pin
COM6
COM5
COM4
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
101
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM5
COM4
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
100
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM4
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
011
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
010
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM2
COM1
COM0
001
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM1
COM0
000
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
I/O Pin
COM0
Note:
Pins, COM, can also be used as SEG pins when ¼ multiplex to static multiplex are used. These pins
can be used as I/O pins only if respective bits in the LCDSEx registers are set to ‘0’.
13.9
Segment Enables
The LCDSEx registers are used to select the pin function
for each segment pin. The selection allows each pin to
operate as either an LCD segment driver or a digital only
pin. To configure the pin as a segment pin, the corresponding bits in the LCDSEx registers must be set to ‘1’.
DS30000575C-page 262
If the pin is a digital I/O, the corresponding TRIS bit
controls the data direction. Any bit set in the LCDSEx
registers overrides any bit settings in the corresponding
TRIS register.
Note:
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital I/O.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.10 Pixel Control
The LCDDATAx registers contain bits that define the
state of each pixel. Each bit defines one unique pixel.
Table 13-2 shows the correlation of each bit in the
LCDDATAx registers to the respective common and
segment signals.
TABLE 13-5:
Any LCD pixel location not being used for display can
be used as general purpose RAM.
13.11 LCD Frame Frequency
The rate at which the COM and SEG outputs change is
called the LCD frame frequency.
FRAME FREQUENCY FORMULAS
Multiplex
Note:
Static (‘000’)
1/2 (‘001’)
1/3 (‘010’)
1/4 (‘011’)
1/5 (‘100’)
1/6 (‘101’)
1/7 (‘110’)
1/8 (‘111’)
The clock source is FRC/8192, SOSC/32 or LPRC/32.
Frame Frequency =
Clock Source/(4 x 1 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(2 x 2 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 3 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 4 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 5 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 6 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 7 x (LP + 1))
Clock Source/(1 x 8 x (LP + 1))
13.12 LCD Waveform Generation
LCD waveform generation is based on the philosophy
that the net AC voltage across the dark pixel should be
maximized and the net AC voltage across the clear
pixel should be minimized. The net DC voltage across
any pixel should be zero.
The COM signal represents the time slice for each
common, while the SEG contains the pixel data.
The pixel signal (COM-SEG) will have no DC component and can take only one of the two rms values. The
higher rms value will create a dark pixel and a lower
rms value will create a clear pixel.
As the number of commons increases, the delta
between the two rms values decreases. The delta represents the maximum contrast that the display can
have.
The LCDs can be driven by two types of waveforms:
Type-A and Type-B. In a Type-A waveform, the phase
changes within each common type, whereas a Type-B
waveform’s phase changes on each frame boundary.
Thus, Type-A waveforms maintain 0 VDC over a single
frame, whereas Type-B waveforms take two frames.
Note:
If Sleep has to be executed with LCD Sleep
enabled (SLPEN (LCDCON) = 1),
care must be taken to execute Sleep only
when VDC on all the pixels is ‘0’.
Figure 13-9 through Figure 13-21 provide waveforms
for static, half-multiplex, one-third multiplex and quarter
multiplex drives for Type-A and Type-B waveforms.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 263
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-9:
TYPE-A/TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN STATIC DRIVE
V1
COM0
V0
COM0
V1
SEG0
V0
V1
SEG1
SEG0
SEG2
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG1
V0
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
COM0-SEG1
V0
1 Frame
DS30000575C-page 264
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-10:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/2 MUX, 1/2 BIAS DRIVE
V2
COM0
V1
V0
COM1
V2
COM0
COM1
V1
V0
V2
V1
SEG0
V0
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
V2
V1
SEG1
V0
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
1 Frame
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 265
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-11:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/2 MUX, 1/2 BIAS DRIVE
V2
V1
COM0
COM1
V0
COM0
V2
COM1
V1
V0
V2
SEG0
V1
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
V0
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
2 Frames
DS30000575C-page 266
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-12:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/2 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
V3
V2
COM0
V1
COM1
V0
V3
COM0
V2
COM1
V1
V0
V3
V2
SEG0
V1
V0
V2
SEG1
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
V3
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
1 Frame
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
-V3
DS30000575C-page 267
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-13:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/2 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
V3
V2
COM0
V1
COM1
V0
V3
COM0
V2
COM1
V1
V0
V3
V2
SEG0
V1
V0
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG3
V3
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
2 Frames
DS30000575C-page 268
-V3
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-14:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/3 MUX, 1/2 BIAS DRIVE
V2
COM0
V1
V0
COM2
V2
COM1
V1
V0
COM1
COM0
V2
COM2
V1
V0
V2
SEG0
SEG2
V1
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
V0
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
1 Frame
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 269
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-15:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/3 MUX, 1/2 BIAS DRIVE
V2
COM0
V1
V0
COM2
V2
COM1
V1
COM1
V0
COM0
V2
COM2
V1
V0
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG0
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
2 Frames
DS30000575C-page 270
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-16:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/3 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
V3
V2
COM0
V1
V0
V3
COM2
V2
COM1
V1
COM1
V0
COM0
V3
V2
COM2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG0
SEG2
V3
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
-V3
1 Frame
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 271
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-17:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/3 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
V3
V2
COM0
V1
V0
V3
COM2
V2
COM1
V1
COM1
V0
COM0
V3
V2
COM2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
SEG1
SEG2
SEG0
V3
V2
SEG1
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG1
-V1
-V2
-V3
2 Frames
DS30000575C-page 272
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-18:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/4 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
COM3
COM0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM3
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
COM0-SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
COM2
COM1
SEG0
SEG1
COM0
1 Frame
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 273
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-19:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/4 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
COM3
COM2
COM1
COM0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM3
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM0-SEG0
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
COM0-SEG1
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
SEG0
SEG1
COM0
2 Frames
DS30000575C-page 274
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-20:
TYPE-A WAVEFORMS IN 1/8 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
COM4
COM0
COM5
COM3
COM7
COM2
COM6
COM1
COM1
COM0
COM2
COM7
SEG0
SEG0
COM0-SEG0
COM1-SEG0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
DS30000575C-page 275
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-21:
TYPE-B WAVEFORMS IN 1/8 MUX, 1/3 BIAS DRIVE
COM4
COM3
COM5
COM0
COM7
COM2
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM6
COM1
COM0
COM7
SEG0
SEG0
COM0 - SEG0
COM1 - SEG0
DS30000575C-page 276
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
V3
V2
V1
V0
-V1
-V2
-V3
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.13 LCD Interrupts
When the LCD driver is running with Type-B waveforms, and the LMUX bits are not equal to ‘000’,
there are some additional issues.
The LCD timing generation provides an interrupt that
defines the LCD frame timing. This interrupt can be
used to coordinate the writing of the pixel data with the
start of a new frame, which produces a visually crisp
transition of the image.
Since the DC voltage on the pixel takes two frames to
maintain 0V, the pixel data must not change between
subsequent frames. If the pixel data were allowed to
change, the waveform for the odd frames would not
necessarily be the complement of the waveform generated in the even frames and a DC component would be
introduced into the panel.
This interrupt can also be used to synchronize external
events to the LCD. For example, the interface to an
external segment driver can be synchronized for
segment data updates to the LCD frame.
Because of this, using Type-B waveforms requires
synchronizing the LCD pixel updates to occur within a
subframe after the frame interrupt.
A new frame is defined as beginning at the leading
edge of the COM0 common signal. The interrupt will be
set immediately after the LCD controller completes
accessing all pixel data required for a frame. This will
occur at a fixed interval before the frame boundary
(TFINT), as shown in Figure 13-22.
To correctly sequence writing in Type-B, the interrupt
only occurs on complete phase intervals. If the user
attempts to write when the write is disabled, the WERR
bit (LCDCON) is set.
The LCD controller will begin to access data for the
next frame within the interval from the interrupt to when
the controller begins accessing data after the interrupt
(TFWR). New data must be written within TFWR, as this
is when the LCD controller will begin to access the data
for the next frame.
FIGURE 13-22:
Note:
The interrupt is not generated when the
Type-A waveform is selected and when
the Type-B with no multiplex (static) is
selected.
EXAMPLE WAVEFORMS AND INTERRUPT TIMING IN QUARTER
DUTY CYCLE DRIVE
LCD
Interrupt
Occurs
Controller Accesses
Next Frame Data
COM0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
V3
V2
V1
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM3
2 Frames
TFINT
Frame
Boundary
Frame
Boundary
TFWR
Frame
Boundary
TFWR = TFRAME/2 * (LMUX + 1) + TCY/2
TFINT = (TFWR/2 – (2 TCY + 40 ns)) Minimum = 1.5(TFRAME/4) – (2 TCY + 40 ns)
(TFWR/2 – (1 TCY + 40 ns)) Maximum = 1.5(TFRAME/4) – (1 TCY + 40 ns)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 277
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
13.14 Configuring the LCD Module
13.15 Operation During Sleep
To configure the LCD module.
The LCD module can operate during Sleep. The selection is controlled by the SLPEN bit (LCDCON).
Setting the SLPEN bit allows the LCD module to go to
Sleep. Clearing the SLPEN bit allows the module to
continue to operate during Sleep.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Select the frame clock prescale using bits,
LP (LCDPS).
Configure the appropriate pins to function as
segment drivers using the LCDSEx registers.
If using the internal reference resistors for
biasing, enable the internal reference ladder
and:
• Define the Mode A and Mode B interval by
using the LRLAT bits (LCDRL)
• Define the low, medium or high ladder for
Mode A and Mode B by using the
LRLAP bits (LCDRL) and the
LRLBP bits (LCDRL),
respectively
• Set the VLCDxPE bits and enable the
LCDIRE bit (LCDREF)
Configure the following LCD module functions
using the LCDCON register:
• Multiplex and Bias mode – LMUX bits
• Timing Source – CS bits
• Sleep mode – SLPEN bit
Write initial values to the Pixel Data registers,
LCDDATA0 through LCDDATA63.
Clear the LCD Interrupt Flag, LCDIF, and if
desired, enable the interrupt by setting bit,
LCDIE.
Enable the LCD module by setting the LCDEN
bit (LCDCON)
DS30000575C-page 278
If a SLEEP instruction is executed and SLPEN = 1, the
LCD module will cease all functions and go into a very
Low-Current Consumption mode. The module will stop
operation immediately and drive the minimum LCD voltage on both segment and common lines. Figure 13-23
shows this operation.
The LCD module current consumption will not
decrease in this mode, but the overall consumption of
the device will be lower due to shut down of the core
and other peripheral functions.
To ensure that no DC component is introduced on the
panel, the SLEEP instruction should be executed immediately after an LCD frame boundary. The LCD interrupt
can be used to determine the frame boundary. See
Section 13.13 “LCD Interrupts” for the formulas to
calculate the delay.
If a SLEEP instruction is executed and SLPEN = 0, the
module will continue to display the current contents of
the LCDDATA registers. The LCD data cannot be
changed.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 13-23:
SLEEP ENTRY/EXIT WHEN SLPEN = 1 OR CS = 00.
V3
V2
V1
COM0
V0
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM1
V3
V2
V1
V0
COM2
V3
V2
V1
V0
SEG0
2 Frames
SLEEP Instruction Execution
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Wake-up
DS30000575C-page 279
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
14.0
TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module incorporates the following features:
• Software-selectable operation as a timer or
counter in both 8-bit or 16-bit modes
• Readable and writable registers
• Dedicated 8-bit, software programmable
prescaler
• Selectable clock source (internal or external)
• Edge select for external clock
• Interrupt-on-overflow
REGISTER 14-1:
The T0CON register (Register 14-1) controls all
aspects of the module’s operation, including the
prescale selection. It is both readable and writable.
Figure 14-1 provides a simplified block diagram of the
Timer0 module in 8-bit mode. Figure 14-2 provides a
simplified block diagram of the Timer0 module in 16-bit
mode.
T0CON: TIMER0 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TMR0ON
T08BIT
T0CS1
T0CS0
PSA
T0PS2
T0PS1
T0PS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
TMR0ON: Timer0 On/Off Control bit
1 = Enables Timer0
0 = Stops Timer0
bit 6
T08BIT: Timer0 8-Bit/16-Bit Control bit
1 = Timer0 is configured as an 8-bit timer/counter
0 = Timer0 is configured as a 16-bit timer/counter
bit 5-4
T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit
11 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
10 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
01 = Internal clock (FOSC/4)
00 = INTOSC
bit 3
PSA: Timer0 Prescaler Assignment bit
1 = Timer0 prescaler is not assigned; Timer0 clock input bypasses prescaler
0 = Timer0 prescaler is assigned; Timer0 clock input comes from prescaler output
bit 2-0
T0PS: Timer0 Prescaler Select bits
111 = 1:256 Prescale value
110 = 1:128 Prescale value
101 = 1:64 Prescale value
100 = 1:32 Prescale value
011 = 1:16 Prescale value
010 = 1:8 Prescale value
001 = 1:4 Prescale value
000 = 1:2 Prescale value
DS30000575C-page 280
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
14.1
Timer0 Operation
14.2
Timer0 can operate in one of these two modes:
TMR0H is not the actual high byte of Timer0 in 16-bit
mode. It is actually a buffered version of the real high
byte of Timer0, which is not directly readable nor
writable (see Figure 14-2). TMR0H is updated with the
contents of the high byte of Timer0 during a read of
TMR0L. This provides the ability to read all 16 bits of
Timer0 without having to verify that the read of the high
and low byte were valid, due to a rollover between
successive reads of the high and low byte.
• As an 8-bit (T08BIT = 1) or 16-bit (T08BIT = 0)
timer
• As an asynchronous 8-bit (T08BIT = 1) or 16-bit
(T08BIT = 0) counter
14.1.1
TIMER MODE
In Timer mode, Timer0 either increments every CPU
clock cycle, or every instruction cycle, depending on
the clock select bit, TMR0CS (T0CON).
14.1.2
Similarly, a write to the high byte of Timer0 must also
take place through the TMR0H Buffer register. The high
byte is updated with the contents of TMR0H when a
write occurs to TMR0L. This allows all 16 bits of Timer0
to be updated at once.
COUNTER MODE
In this mode, Timer0 is incremented via a rising or falling edge of an external source on the T0CKI pin. The
clock select bits, TMR0CS, must be set to ‘1x’.
FIGURE 14-1:
Timer0 Reads and Writes in 16-Bit
Mode
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM (8-BIT MODE)
FOSC/4
0
1
1
Programmable
Prescaler
T0CKI Pin
T0SE
T0CS
0
Sync with
Internal
Clocks
Set
TMR0IF
on Overflow
TMR0L
(2 TCY Delay)
8
3
T0PS
8
PSA
Internal Data Bus
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI max. prescale.
FIGURE 14-2:
FOSC/4
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM (16-BIT MODE)
0
1
1
T0CKI Pin
T0SE
T0CS
Programmable
Prescaler
0
Sync with
Internal
Clocks
TMR0
High Byte
TMR0L
8
Set
TMR0IF
on Overflow
(2 TCY Delay)
3
Read TMR0L
T0PS
Write TMR0L
PSA
8
8
TMR0H
8
8
Internal Data Bus
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI max. prescale.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 281
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
14.3
Prescaler
An 8-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the Timer0
module. The prescaler is not directly readable or writable.
Its value is set by the PSA and T0PS bits
(T0CON), which determine the prescaler
assignment and prescale ratio.
Clearing the PSA bit assigns the prescaler to the Timer0 module. When it is assigned, prescale values from
1:2 through 1:256 in power-of-two increments are
selectable.
When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions
writing to the TMR0 register (for example, CLRF TMR0,
MOVWF TMR0, BSF TMR0) clear the prescaler count.
Note:
Writing to TMR0 when the prescaler is
assigned to Timer0 will clear the prescaler
count but will not change the prescaler
assignment.
DS30000575C-page 282
14.3.1
SWITCHING PRESCALER
ASSIGNMENT
The prescaler assignment is fully under software
control and can be changed “on-the-fly” during program
execution.
14.4
Timer0 Interrupt
The TMR0 interrupt is generated when the TMR0
register overflows from FFh to 00h in 8-bit mode, or
from FFFFh to 0000h in 16-bit mode. This overflow sets
the TMR0IF flag bit. The interrupt can be masked by
clearing the TMR0IE bit (INTCON). Before reenabling the interrupt, the TMR0IF bit must be cleared
in software by the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR).
Since Timer0 is shutdown in Sleep mode, the TMR0
interrupt cannot awaken the processor from Sleep.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.0
TIMER1/3/5 MODULES
The Timer1/3/5 timer/counter modules incorporate
these features:
• Software-selectable operation as a 16-bit timer or
counter
• Readable and writable 8-bit registers (TMRxH
and TMRxL)
• Selectable clock source (internal or external) with
device clock or SOSC Oscillator internal options
• Interrupt-on-overflow
• Module Reset on ECCP Special Event Trigger
A simplified block diagram of the Timer1/3/5 module is
shown in Figure 15-1.
The Timer1/3/5 module is controlled through the
TxCON register (Register 15-1). It also selects the
clock source options for the ECCP modules. (For more
information, see Section 18.1.1 “ECCP Module and
Timer Resources”).
The FOSC clock source should not be used with the
ECCP capture/compare features. If the timer will be
used with the capture or compare features, always
select one of the other timer clocking options.
Note: Throughout this section, generic references
are used for register and bit names that are the
same – except for an ‘x’ variable that indicates
the item’s association with the Timer1, Timer3
or Timer5 module. For example, the control
register is named TxCON and refers to
T1CON, T3CON and T5CON.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 283
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 15-1:
TxCON: TIMERx CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMRxCS1
TMRxCS0
TxCKPS1
TxCKPS0
SOSCEN
TxSYNC
RD16
TMRxON
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
TMRxCS: Timerx Clock Source Select bits
11 = Timerx Clock source is INTOSC
10 = Timerx clock source depends on the SOSCEN bit:
SOSCEN = 0:
External clock from the TxCKI pin (on the rising edge).
SOSCEN = 1:
Depending on the SOSCSEL fuses, either a crystal oscillator on the SOSCI/SOSCO pins or an external
clock from the SCLKI pin.
01 = Timerx clock source is the system clock (FOSC)(1)
00 = Timerx clock source is the instruction clock (FOSC/4)
bit 5-4
TxCKPS: Timerx Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11 = 1:8 Prescale value
10 = 1:4 Prescale value
01 = 1:2 Prescale value
00 = 1:1 Prescale value
bit 3
SOSCEN: SOSC Oscillator Enable bit
1 = SOSC/SCLKI are enabled for Timerx (based on the SOSCSEL fuses)
0 = SOSC/SCLKI are disabled for Timerx and TxCKI is enabled
bit 2
TxSYNC: Timerx External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit
(Not usable if the device clock comes from Timer1/3/5.)
When TMRxCS = 10:
1 = Do not synchronize external clock input
0 = Synchronize external clock input
When TMRxCS = 0x:
This bit is ignored; Timer1/3/5 uses the internal clock.
bit 1
RD16: 16-Bit Read/Write Mode Enable bit
1 = Enables register read/write of Timerx in one 16-bit operation
0 = Enables register read/write of Timerx in two 8-bit operations
bit 0
TMRxON: Timerx On bit
1 = Enables Timerx
0 = Stops Timerx
Note 1:
The FOSC clock source should not be selected if the timer will be used with the ECCP capture/compare
features.
DS30000575C-page 284
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.1
Timer1/3/5 Gate Control Register
The Timer1/3/5 Gate Control register (TxGCON),
provided in Register 15-2, is used to control the Timerx
gate.
REGISTER 15-2:
TxGCON: TIMERx GATE CONTROL REGISTER(1)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-x
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMRxGE
TxGPOL
TxGTM
TxGSPM
TxGGO/TxDONE
TxGVAL
TxGSS1
TxGSS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
TMRxGE: Timerx Gate Enable bit
If TMRxON = 0:
This bit is ignored.
If TMRxON = 1:
1 = Timerx counting is controlled by the Timerx gate function
0 = Timerx counts regardless of Timerx gate function
bit 6
TxGPOL: Timerx Gate Polarity bit
1 = Timerx gate is active-high (Timerx counts when gate is high)
0 = Timerx gate is active-low (Timerx counts when gate is low)
bit 5
TxGTM: Timerx Gate Toggle Mode bit
1 = Timerx Gate Toggle mode is enabled.
0 = Timerx Gate Toggle mode is disabled and toggle flip-flop is cleared
Timerx gate flip-flop toggles on every rising edge.
bit 4
TxGSPM: Timerx Gate Single Pulse Mode bit
1 = Timerx Gate Single Pulse mode is enabled and is controlling Timerx gate
0 = Timerx Gate Single Pulse mode is disabled
bit 3
TxGGO/TxDONE: Timerx Gate Single Pulse Acquisition Status bit
1 = Timerx gate single pulse acquisition is ready, waiting for an edge
0 = Timerx gate single pulse acquisition has completed or has not been started
This bit is automatically cleared when TxGSPM is cleared.
bit 2
TxGVAL: Timerx Gate Current State bit
Indicates the current state of the Timerx gate that could be provided to TMRxH:TMRxL; unaffected by the
Timerx Gate Enable (TMRxGE) bit.
bit 1-0
TxGSS: Timerx Gate Source Select bits
11 = Comparator 2 output
10 = Comparator 1 output
01 = TMR(x+1) to match PR(x+1) output(2)
00 = Timer1 gate pin
The Watchdog Timer Oscillator is turned on if TMRxGE = 1, regardless of the state of TMRxON.
Note 1:
2:
Programming the TxGCON prior to TxCON is recommended.
Timer(x+1) will be Timer1/3/5 for Timerx (Timer1/3/5), respectively.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 285
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.2
Timer1/3/5 Operation
The operating mode is determined by the clock select
bits, TMRxCSx (TxCON). When the TMRxCSx bits
are cleared (= 00), Timer1/3/5 increments on every internal instruction cycle (FOSC/4). When TMRxCSx = 01, the
Timer1/3/5 clock source is the system clock (FOSC).
When it is ‘10’, Timer1/3/5 works as a counter from the
external clock from the TxCKI pin (on the rising edge after
the first falling edge) or the SOSC Oscillator. When it is
‘11’, the Timer1/3/5 clock source is INTOSC.
Timer1, Timer3 and Timer5 can operate in these
modes:
•
•
•
•
Timer
Synchronous Counter
Asynchronous Counter
Timer with Gated Control
FIGURE 15-1:
TIMER1/3/5 BLOCK DIAGRAM
T3GSS
T3G
00
From TMR4
Match PR4
01
From Comparator 1
Output
10
From Comparator 2
Output
11
T3GSPM
0
T3G_IN
1
TMR3ON
T3GPOL
T3GVAL
Single Pulse
Acq. Control
0
D
Q
CK
R
Q
1
Q1
T3GGO/
T3DONE
D
Q
Data Bus
RD
T3GCON
EN
Interrupt
det
Set
TMR3GIF
T3GTM
TMR3GE
Set Flag bit
TMR3IF on
Overflow
TMR3ON
TMR3(2)
TMR3H
EN
TMR3L
Q
D
Synchronized
Clock Input
0
T3CLK
1
TMR3CS
SOSCO/SCLKI
SOSC
SOSCI
det
10
EN
T1CON.SOSCEN
T1CON.SOSCEN
SOSCGO
NOSC = 100
(1)
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Synchronize(3)
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
1
0
T3CKI
T3SYNC
OUT(4)
FOSC
Internal
Clock
01
Timer3 Clock
is INTOSC
01
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
00
2
T3CKPS
FOSC/2
Internal
Clock
Sleep Input
ST buffer is a high-speed type when using T3CKI.
Timer3 registers increment on the rising edge.
Synchronization does not operate while in Sleep.
The output of SOSC is determined by the SOSCSEL Configuration bits.
DS30000575C-page 286
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.3
Timer1/3/5 16-Bit Read/Write Mode
Timer1/3/5 can be configured for 16-bit reads and
writes (see Figure 15-3). When the RD16 control bit
(TxCON) is set, the address for TMRxH is mapped
to a buffer register for the high byte of Timer1/3/5. A
read from TMRxL will load the contents of the high byte
of Timer1/3/5 into the Timerx High Byte Buffer register.
This provides users with the ability to accurately read
all 16 bits of Timer1/3/5 without having to determine
whether a read of the high byte, followed by a read of
the low byte, has become invalid due to a rollover
between reads.
15.4
Using the SOSC Oscillator as the
Timer1/3/5 Clock Source
The SOSC Internal Oscillator may be used as the clock
source for Timer1/3/5. It can be enabled in one of these
ways:
• Setting the SOSCEN bit in either of the TxCON
registers (TxCON)
• Setting the SOSCGO bit in the OSCCON2
register (OSCCON2)
• Setting the NOSC bits to secondary clock source
in the OSCCON register (OSCCON = 100)
A write to the high byte of Timer1/3/5 must also take
place through the TMRxH Buffer register. The Timer1/3/5 high byte is updated with the contents of
TMRxH when a write occurs to TMRxL. This allows
users to write all 16 bits to both the high and low
bytes of Timer1/3/5 at once.
The SOSCGO bit is used to warm up the SOSC so that
it is ready before any peripheral requests it.
The high byte of Timer1/3/5 is not directly readable or
writable in this mode. All reads and writes must take
place through the Timerx High Byte Buffer register.
The SOSC Oscillator is described in Section 15.4
“Using the SOSC Oscillator as the Timer1/3/5 Clock
Source”.
To use it as the Timer3 clock source, the TMR3CSx bits
must also be set. As previously noted, this also configures Timer3 to increment on every rising edge of the
oscillator source.
Writes to TMRxH do not clear the Timer1/3/5 prescaler.
The prescaler is only cleared on writes to TMRxL.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 287
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.5
Timer1/3/5 Gates
When Timerx Gate Enable mode is enabled, Timer1/3/5
will increment on the rising edge of the Timer1/3/5 clock
source. When Timerx Gate Enable mode is disabled, no
incrementing will occur and Timer1/3/5 will hold the
current count. See Figure 15-2 for timing details.
Timer1/3/5 can be configured to count freely or the count
can be enabled and disabled using the Timer1/3/5 gate
circuitry. This is also referred to as the Timer1/3/5 gate
count enable.
TABLE 15-1:
The Timer1/3/5 gate can also be driven by multiple
selectable sources.
15.5.1
TIMER1/3/5 GATE COUNT ENABLE
TxCLK(†)
The Timerx Gate Enable mode is enabled by setting
the TMRxGE bit (TxGCON). The polarity of the
Timerx Gate Enable mode is configured using the
TxGPOL bit (TxGCON).
TIMER1/3/5 GATE ENABLE
SELECTIONS
TxGPOL
TxG Pin
(TxGCON)
Timerx
Operation
0
0
Counts
0
1
Holds Count
1
0
Holds Count
1
1
Counts
† The clock on which TMR1/3/5 is running. For
more information, see TxCLK in Figure 15-1.
FIGURE 15-2:
TIMER1/3/5 GATE COUNT ENABLE MODE
TMRxGE
TxGPOL
TxG_IN
TxCKI
TxGVAL
Timer1/3/5
DS30000575C-page 288
N
N+1
N+2
N+3
N+4
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.5.2
TIMER1/3/5 GATE SOURCE
SELECTION
The Timer1/3/5 gate source can be selected from one
of four different sources. Source selection is controlled
by the TxGSS bits (TxGCON). The polarity
for each available source is also selectable and is
controlled by the TxGPOL bit (TxGCON ).
TABLE 15-2:
TIMER1/3/5 GATE SOURCES
TxGSS
Timerx Gate Source
00
Timerx Gate Pin
01
TMR(x+1) to Match PR(x+1)
(TMR(x+1) increments to match
PR(x+1))
10
Comparator 1 Output
(comparator logic high output)
11
Comparator 2 Output
(comparator logic high output)
15.5.2.1
TxG Pin Gate Operation
The TxG pin is one source for Timer1/3/5 gate control. It
can be used to supply an external source to the Timerx
gate circuitry.
15.5.2.2
Timer2/4/6/8 Match Gate Operation
The TMR(x+1) register will increment until it matches the
value in the PR(x+1) register. On the very next increment
cycle, TMR2 will be reset to 00h. When this Reset
occurs, a low-to-high pulse will automatically be generated and internally supplied to the Timerx gate circuitry.
The pulse will remain high for one instruction cycle and
will return back to a low state until the next match.
FIGURE 15-3:
Depending on TxGPOL, Timerx increments differently
when
TMR(x+1)
matches
PR(x+1).
When
TxGPOL = 1, Timerx increments for a single instruction
cycle following a TMR(x+1) match with PR(x+1). When
TxGPOL = 0, Timerx increments continuously, except
for the cycle following the match, when the gate signal
goes from low-to-high.
15.5.2.3
Comparator 1 Output Gate Operation
The output of Comparator1 can be internally supplied
to the Timerx gate circuitry. After setting up
Comparator 1 with the CM1CON register, Timerx will
increment depending on the transitions of the C1OUT
(CMSTAT) bit.
15.5.2.4
Comparator 2 Output Gate Operation
The output of Comparator 2 can be internally supplied
to the Timerx gate circuitry. After setting up
Comparator 2 with the CM2CON register, Timerx will
increment depending on the transitions of the C2OUT
(CMSTAT) bit.
15.5.3
TIMER1/3/5 GATE TOGGLE MODE
When Timer1/3/5 Gate Toggle mode is enabled, it is possible to measure the full cycle length of a Timer1/3/5 gate
signal, as opposed to the duration of a single level pulse.
The Timerx gate source is routed through a flip-flop that
changes state on every incrementing edge of the
signal. (For timing details, see Figure 15-3.)
The TxGVAL bit will indicate when the Toggled mode is
active and the timer is counting.
Timer1/3/5 Gate Toggle mode is enabled by setting the
TxGTM bit (TxGCON). When the TxGTM bit is
cleared, the flip-flop is cleared and held clear. This is
necessary in order to control which edge is measured.
TIMER1/3/5 GATE TOGGLE MODE
TMRxGE
TxGPOL
TxGTM
TxG_IN
TxCKI
TxGVAL
Timer1/3/5
N
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
N+1 N+2 N+3
N+4
N+5 N+6 N+7
N+8
DS30000575C-page 289
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.5.4
TIMER1/3/5 GATE SINGLE PULSE
MODE
No other gate events will be allowed to increment Timer1/3/5 until the TxGGO/TxDONE bit is once again set
in software.
When Timer1/3/5 Gate Single Pulse mode is enabled,
it is possible to capture a single pulse gate event. Timer1/3/5 Gate Single Pulse mode is first enabled by setting the TxGSPM bit (TxGCON). Next, the TxGGO/
TxDONE bit (TxGCON) must be set.
Clearing the TxGSPM bit also will clear the TxGGO/
TxDONE bit. (For timing details, see Figure 15-4.)
Simultaneously enabling the Toggle mode and the
Single Pulse mode will permit both sections to work
together. This allows the cycle times on the Timer1/3/5
gate source to be measured. (For timing details, see
Figure 15-5.)
The Timer1/3/5 will be fully enabled on the next incrementing edge. On the next trailing edge of the pulse,
the TxGGO/TxDONE bit will automatically be cleared.
FIGURE 15-4:
TIMER1/3/5 GATE SINGLE PULSE MODE
TMRxGE
TxGPOL
TxGSPM
TxGGO/
Cleared by Hardware on
Falling Edge of TxGVAL
Set by Software
TxDONE
Counting Enabled on
Rising Edge of TxG
TxG_IN
TxCKI
TxGVAL
Timer1/3/5
TMRxGIF
DS30000575C-page 290
N
Cleared by Software
N+1
N+2
Set by Hardware on
Falling Edge of TxGVAL
Cleared by
Software
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 15-5:
TIMER1/3/5 GATE SINGLE PULSE AND TOGGLE COMBINED MODE
TMRxGE
TxGPOL
TxGSPM
TxGTM
TxGGO/
Cleared by Hardware on
Falling Edge of TxGVAL
Set by Software
TxDONE
Counting Enabled on
Rising Edge of TxG
TxG_IN
TxCKI
TxGVAL
Timer1/3/5
TMRxGIF
15.5.5
N
Cleared by Software
TIMER1/3/5 GATE VALUE STATUS
When Timer1/3/5 gate value status is utilized, it is
possible to read the most current level of the gate control value. The value is stored in the TxGVAL bit
(TxGCON). The TxGVAL bit is valid even when the
Timer1/3/5 gate is not enabled (TMRxGE bit is
cleared).
N+1
N+2
N+3
Set by Hardware on
Falling Edge of TxGVAL
15.5.6
N+4
Cleared by
Software
TIMER1/3/5 GATE EVENT
INTERRUPT
When the Timer1/3/5 gate event interrupt is enabled, it
is possible to generate an interrupt upon the completion of a gate event. When the falling edge of TxGVAL
occurs, the TMRxGIF flag bit in the PIRx register will be
set. If the TMRxGIE bit in the PIEx register is set, then
an interrupt will be recognized.
The TMRxGIF flag bit operates even when the Timer1/3/5 gate is not enabled (TMRxGE bit is cleared).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 291
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
15.6
Timer1/3/5 Interrupt
The TMRx register pair (TMRxH:TMRxL) increments
from 0000h to FFFFh and overflows to 0000h. The
Timerx interrupt, if enabled, is generated on overflow
and is latched in the interrupt flag bit, TMRxIF.
Table 15-3 gives each module’s flag bit.
TABLE 15-3:
TIMER1/3/5 INTERRUPT
FLAG BITS
Timer Module
Flag Bit
1
PIR1
3
PIR2
5
PIR5
This interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or
clearing the TMRxIE bit, respectively. Table 15-4 gives
each module’s enable bit.
TABLE 15-4:
TIMER1/3/5 INTERRUPT
ENABLE BITS
Timer Module
Flag Bit
1
PIE1
3
PIE2
5
PIE5
DS30000575C-page 292
15.7
Resetting Timer1/3/5 Using the
ECCP Special Event Trigger
If the ECCP modules are configured to use Timerx and
to generate a Special Event Trigger in Compare mode
(CCPxM = 1011), this signal will reset Timerx. The
trigger from ECCP2 will also start an A/D conversion if
the A/D module is enabled (For more information, see
Section 18.3.4 “Special Event Trigger”.)
The module must be configured as either a timer or
synchronous counter to take advantage of this feature.
When used this way, the CCPRxH:CCPRxL register
pair effectively becomes a Period register for Timerx.
If Timerx is running in Asynchronous Counter mode,
the Reset operation may not work.
In the event that a write to Timerx coincides with a
Special Event Trigger from an ECCP module, the write
will take precedence.
Note:
The Special Event Triggers from the
ECCPx module will only clear the TMR3
register’s content, but not set the TMR3IF
interrupt flag bit (PIR1).
Note:
The CCP and ECCP modules use Timers,
1 through 8, for some modes. The assignment of a particular timer to a CCP/ECCP
module is determined by the Timer to CCP
enable bits in the CCPTMRSx registers.
For more details, see Register 18-2,
Register 18-3 and Register 19-2
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
16.0
TIMER2/4/6/8 MODULES
The Timer2/4/6/8 timer modules have the following
features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
8-Bit Timer register (TMRx)
8-Bit Period register (PRx)
Readable and Writable (all registers)
Software Programmable Prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16)
Software Programmable Postscaler (1:1 to 1:16)
Interrupt on TMRx Match of PRx
Note: Throughout this section, generic references
are used for register and bit names that are the
same, except for an ‘x’ variable that indicates
the item’s association with the Timer2, Timer4,
Timer6 or Timer8 module. For example, the
control register is named TxCON and refers to
T2CON, T4CON, T6CON and T8CON.
The Timer2/4/6/8 modules have a control register,
shown in Register 16-1. Timer2/4/6/8 can be shut off by
clearing control bit, TMRxON (TxCON), to minimize
power consumption. The prescaler and postscaler
selection of Timer2/4/6/8 also are controlled by this
register. Figure 16-1 is a simplified block diagram of the
Timer2/4/6/8 modules.
16.1
Timer2/4/6/8 Operation
Timer2/4/6/8 can be used as the PWM time base for
the PWM mode of the ECCP modules. The TMRx registers are readable and writable, and are cleared on
any device Reset. The input clock (FOSC/4) has a
prescale option of 1:1, 1:4 or 1:16, selected by control
bits, TxCKPS (TxCON). The match output
of TMRx goes through a four-bit postscaler (that gives
a 1:1 to 1:16 inclusive scaling) to generate a TMRx
interrupt, latched in the flag bit, TMRxIF. Table 16-1
gives each module’s flag bit.
TABLE 16-1:
The interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or
clearing the Timerx Interrupt Enable bit (TMRxIE),
shown in Table 16-2.
TABLE 16-2:
TIMER2/4/6/8 INTERRUPT
ENABLE BITS
Timer Module
Flag Bit
2
PIE1
4
PIE5
6
PIE5
8
PIE5
The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared
when any of the following occurs:
• A write to the TMRx register
• A write to the TxCON register
• Any device Reset – Power-on Reset (POR),
MCLR Reset, Watchdog Timer Reset (WDTR) or
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
A TMRx is not cleared when a TxCON is written.
Note:
The CCP and ECCP modules use Timers,
1 through 8, for some modes. The assignment of a particular timer to a CCP/ECCP
module is determined by the Timer to CCP
enable bits in the CCPTMRSx registers.
For more details, see Register 18-2,
Register 18-3 and Register 19-2.
TIMER2/4/6/8 FLAG BITS
Timer Module
Flag Bit
2
PIR1
4
PIR5
6
PIR5
8
PIR5
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 293
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 16-1:
TxCON: TIMERx CONTROL REGISTER (TIMER2/4/6/8)
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
TxOUTPS3
TxOUTPS2
TxOUTPS1
TxOUTPS0
TMRxON
TxCKPS1
TxCKPS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-3
TxOUTPS: Timerx Output Postscale Select bits
0000 = 1:1 Postscale
0001 = 1:2 Postscale
•
•
•
1111 = 1:16 Postscale
bit 2
TMRxON: Timerx On bit
1 = Timerx is on
0 = Timerx is off
bit 1-0
TxCKPS: Timerx Clock Prescale Select bits
00 = Prescaler is 1
01 = Prescaler is 4
1x = Prescaler is 16
16.2
Timer2/4/6/8 Interrupt
16.3
The Timer2/4/6/8 modules have 8-bit Period registers,
PRx, that are both readable and writable. Timer2/4/6/8
increment from 00h until they match PR2/4/6/8 and
then reset to 00h on the next increment cycle. The PRx
registers are initialized to FFh upon Reset.
FIGURE 16-1:
TIMER2/4/6/8 BLOCK DIAGRAM
4
1:1 to 1:16
Postscaler
Set TMRxIF
2
TMRx Output
(to PWM)
Reset
FOSC/4
Output of TMRx
The outputs of TMRx (before the postscaler) are used
only as a PWM time base for the ECCP modules. They
are not used as baud rate clocks for the MSSPx
modules as is the Timer2 output.
TxOUTPS
TxCKPS
x = Bit is unknown
1:1, 1:4, 1:16
Prescaler
TMRx
8
TMRx/PRx
Match
Comparator
8
PRx
8
Internal Data Bus
DS30000575C-page 294
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.0
REAL-TIME CLOCK AND
CALENDAR (RTCC)
The key features of the Real-Time Clock and Calendar
(RTCC) module are:
• Hardware Real-Time Clock and Calendar (RTCC)
• Provides hours, minutes and seconds using
24- hour format
• Visibility of one-half second period
• Provides calendar – weekday, date, month and
year
• Alarm configurable for half a second, one second,
10 seconds, one minute, 10 minutes, one hour,
one day, one week or one month
• Alarm repeat with decrementing counter
• Alarm with indefinite repeat – chime
• Year 2000 to 2099 leap year correction
• BCD format for smaller software overhead
• Optimized for long term battery operation
• Fractional second synchronization
• Multiple clock sources
- SOSC
- LPRC
- 50 Hz
- 60 Hz
• User calibration of the 32.768 kHz clock crystal
frequency with periodic auto-adjust
• Calibration to within ±2.64 seconds error per
month
• Calibrates up to 260 ppm of crystal error
The RTCC module is intended for applications where
accurate time must be maintained for an extended
period with minimum to no intervention from the CPU.
The module is optimized for low-power usage in order
to provide extended battery life, while keeping track of
time.
The module is a 100-year clock and calendar with automatic leap year detection. The range of the clock is
from 00:00:00 (midnight) on January 1, 2000 to
23:59:59 on December 31, 2099.
Hours are measured in 24-hour (military time) format.
The clock provides a granularity of one second with
half-second visibility to the user.
FIGURE 17-1:
RTCC BLOCK DIAGRAM
RTCC Clock Domain
32.768 kHz Input
from SOSC Oscillator
CPU Clock Domain
RTCCON1
RTCC Prescalers
Internal RC
(LF-INTOSC)
ALRMRPT
YEAR
0.5s
MTHDY
RTCC Timer
Alarm
Event
RTCVALx
WKDYHR
MINSEC
Comparator
ALMTHDY
Compare Registers
with Masks
ALRMVALx
ALWDHR
ALMINSEC
Repeat Counter
RTCC Interrupt
RTCC Interrupt Logic
Alarm Pulse
RTCC Pin
RTCOE
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 295
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.1
RTCC MODULE REGISTERS
The RTCC module registers are divided into the
following categories:
RTCC Control Registers
•
•
•
•
•
•
RTCCON1
RTCCON2
RTCCAL
PADCFG
ALRMCFG
ALRMRPT
RTCC Value Registers
• RTCVALH
• RTCVALL
Both registers access the following registers:
- YEAR
- MONTH
- DAY
- WEEKDAY
- HOUR
- MINUTE
- SECOND
DS30000575C-page 296
Alarm Value Registers
• ALRMVALH
• ALRMVALL
Both registers access the following registers:
- ALRMMNTH
- ALRMDAY
- ALRMWD
- ALRMHR
- ALRMMIN
- ALRMSEC
Note:
The RTCVALH and RTCVALL registers
can be accessed through RTCRPT
(RTCCON1). ALRMVALH and
ALRMVALL can be accessed through
ALRMPTR (ALRMCFG).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.1.1
RTCC CONTROL REGISTERS
REGISTER 17-1:
R/W-0
RTCCON1: RTCC CONFIGURATION REGISTER 1(1)
U-0
RTCEN(2)
—
R/W-0
R-0
(4)
RTCWREN
R-0
(3)
RTCSYNC HALFSEC
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RTCOE
RTCPTR1
RTCPTR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
RTCEN: RTCC Enable bit(2)
1 = RTCC module is enabled
0 = RTCC module is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
RTCWREN: RTCC Value Registers Write Enable bit(4)
1 = RTCVALH, RTCVALL and RTCCON2 registers can be written to by the user
0 = RTCVALH, RTCVALL and RTCCON2 registers are locked out from being written to by the user
bit 4
RTCSYNC: RTCC Value Registers Read Synchronization bit
1 = RTCVALH, RTCVALL and ALRMRPT registers can change while reading if a rollover ripple
results in an invalid data read. If the register is read twice and results in the same data, the data
can be assumed to be valid.
0 = RTCVALH, RTCVALL or ALRMRPT registers can be read without concern over a rollover ripple
bit 3
HALFSEC: Half-Second Status bit(3)
1 = Second half period of a second
0 = First half period of a second
bit 2
RTCOE: RTCC Output Enable bit
1 = RTCC clock output is enabled
0 = RTCC clock output is disabled
bit 1-0
RTCPTR: RTCC Value Register Window Pointer bits
Points to the corresponding RTCC Value registers when reading the RTCVALH and RTCVALL
registers. The RTCPTR value decrements on every read or write of RTCVALH until it
reaches ‘00’.
RTCVALH:
00 = Minutes
01 = Weekday
10 = Month
11 = Reserved
RTCVALL:
00 = Seconds
01 = Hours
10 = Day
11 = Year
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
The RTCCON1 register is only affected by a POR.
A write to the RTCEN bit is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
This bit is read-only; it is cleared to ‘0’ on a write to the lower half of the MINSEC register.
RTCWREN can only be written with the unlock sequence (see Example 17-1).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 297
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-2:
RTCCAL: RTCC CALIBRATION REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CAL7
CAL6
CAL5
CAL4
CAL3
CAL2
CAL1
CAL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
CAL: RTC Drift Calibration bits
01111111 = Maximum positive adjustment; adds 508 RTC clock pulses every minute
.
.
.
00000001 = Minimum positive adjustment; adds four RTC clock pulses every minute
00000000 = No adjustment
11111111 = Minimum negative adjustment; subtracts four RTC clock pulses every minute
.
.
.
10000000 = Maximum negative adjustment; subtracts 512 RTC clock pulses every minute
DS30000575C-page 298
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
Register 17-3:
R/W-0
R/W-0
RTCCON2: RTC CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2(1)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PWCEN(1) PWCPOL(1) PWCCPRE(1) PWCSPRE(1) RTCCLKSEL1 RTCCLKSEL0 RTCSECSEL1 RTCSECSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
PWCEN: Power Control Enable bit(1)
1 = Power control is enabled
0 = Power control is disabled
bit 6
PWCPOL: Power Control Polarity bit(1)
1 = Power control output is active-high
0 = Power control output is active-low
bit 5
PWCCPRE: Power Control/Stability Prescaler bits(1)
1 = PWC stability window clock is divide-by-2 of source RTCC clock
0 = PWC stability window clock is divide-by-1 of source RTCC clock
bit 4
PWCSPRE: Power Control Sample Prescaler bits(1)
01 =PWC sample window clock is divide-by-2 of source RTCC clock
00 =PWC sample window clock is divide-by-1 of source RTCC clock
bit 3-2
RTCCLKSEL: RTCC Clock Select bits
Determines the source of the internal RTCC clock, which is used for all RTCC timer operations.
11 =60 Hz Powerline
10 =50 Hz Powerline
01 =INTOSC
00 =SOSC
bit 1-0
RTSECSEL: RTCC Seconds Clock Output Select bit
11 =Power control
10 =RTCC source clock is selected for the RTCC pin (pin can be LF-INTOSC or SOSC, depending on the
RTCOSC (CONFIG3L) bit setting
01 =RTCC seconds clock is selected for the RTCC pin
00 =RTCC alarm pulse is selected for the RTCC pin
Note 1:
The RTCCON2 register is only affected by a POR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 299
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-4:
ALRMCFG: ALARM CONFIGURATION REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ALRMEN
CHIME
AMASK3
AMASK2
AMASK1
AMASK0
ALRMPTR1
ALRMPTR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ALRMEN: Alarm Enable bit
1 = Alarm is enabled (cleared automatically after an alarm event whenever ARPT = 00h
and CHIME = 0)
0 = Alarm is disabled
bit 6
CHIME: Chime Enable bit
1 = Chime is enabled; ARPT bits are allowed to roll over from 00h to FFh
0 = Chime is disabled; ARPT bits stop once they reach 00h
bit 5-2
AMASK: Alarm Mask Configuration bits
0000 = Every half second
0001 = Every second
0010 = Every 10 seconds
0011 = Every minute
0100 = Every 10 minutes
0101 = Every hour
0110 = Once a day
0111 = Once a week
1000 = Once a month
1001 = Once a year (except when configured for February 29th, once every four years)
101x = Reserved – Do not use
11xx = Reserved – Do not use
bit 1-0
ALRMPTR: Alarm Value Register Window Pointer bits
Points to the corresponding Alarm Value registers when reading the ALRMVALH and ALRMVALL
registers. The ALRMPTR value decrements on every read or write of ALRMVALH until it reaches
‘00’.
ALRMVALH:
00 = ALRMMIN
01 = ALRMWD
10 = ALRMMNTH
11 = Unimplemented
ALRMVALL:
00 = ALRMSEC
01 = ALRMHR
10 = ALRMDAY
11 = Unimplemented
DS30000575C-page 300
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-5:
ALRMRPT: ALARM REPEAT REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ARPT7
ARPT6
ARPT5
ARPT4
ARPT3
ARPT2
ARPT1
ARPT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
17.1.2
x = Bit is unknown
ARPT: Alarm Repeat Counter Value bits
11111111 = Alarm will repeat 255 more times
.
.
.
00000000 = Alarm will not repeat
The counter decrements on any alarm event. The counter is prevented from rolling over from 00h to
FFh unless CHIME = 1.
RTCVALH AND RTCVALL
REGISTER MAPPINGS
The registers described in this section are the targets
or sources for writes or reads to the RTCVALH and
RTCVALL in the order they will appear when accessed
through the RTCCON1 pointer. For more
information on RTCVAL register mapping, see
Section 17.2.8 “Register Mapping”.
REGISTER 17-6:
RESERVED REGISTER (RTCVALH when RTCPTR = 11)
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
Note:
x = Bit is unknown
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
A read or write to the RTCVALH register
when RTCPTR = 11 is necessary to
automatically decrement RTCPTR.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 301
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
YEAR: YEAR VALUE REGISTER(1) (RTCVALL when RTCPTR = 11)
REGISTER 17-7:
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
YRTEN3
YRTEN2
YRTEN1
YRTEN0
YRONE3
YRONE2
YRONE1
YRONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
YRTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Year’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
bit 3-0
YRONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Year’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
A write to the YEAR register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
MONTH: MONTH VALUE REGISTER(1) (RTCVALH when RTCPTR = 10)
REGISTER 17-8:
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
MTHTEN0
MTHONE3
MTHONE2
MTHONE1
MTHONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
MTHTEN0: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Month’s Tens Digit bit
Contains a value of 0 or 1.
bit 3-0
MTHONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Month’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
DS30000575C-page 302
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-9:
DAY: DAY VALUE REGISTER(1) (RTCVALL when RTCPTR = 10)
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
DAYTEN1
DAYTEN0
DAYONE3
DAYONE2
DAYONE1
DAYONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
DAYTEN: Binary Coded Decimal value of Day’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 3.
bit 3-0
DAYONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Day’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
REGISTER 17-10: WEEKDAY: WEEKDAY VALUE REGISTER(1)
(RTCVALH when RTCPTR = 01)
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
—
—
WDAY2
WDAY1
WDAY0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
WDAY: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Weekday Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 6.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
REGISTER 17-11: HOUR: HOUR VALUE REGISTER(1) (RTCVALL when RTCPTR = 01)
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
HRTEN1
HRTEN0
HRONE3
HRONE2
HRONE1
HRONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
HRTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Hour’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 2.
bit 3-0
HRONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Hour’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 303
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-12: MINUTE: MINUTE VALUE REGISTER (RTCVALH when RTCPTR = 00)
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
MINTEN2
MINTEN1
MINTEN0
MINONE3
MINONE2
MINONE1
MINONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
MINTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Minute’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 5.
bit 3-0
MINONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Minute’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
REGISTER 17-13: SECOND: SECOND VALUE REGISTER (RTCVALL when RTCPTR = 00)
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
SECTEN2
SECTEN1
SECTEN0
SECONE3
SECONE2
SECONE1
SECONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
SECTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Second’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 5.
bit 3-0
SECONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Second’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
DS30000575C-page 304
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.1.3
ALRMVALH AND ALRMVALL
REGISTER MAPPINGS
The registers described in this section are the targets
or sources for writes or reads to the ALRMVALH and
ALRMVALL in the order they will appear when
accessed through the ALRMCFG pointer.
For more information on ALRMVAL register mapping,
see Section 17.2.8 “Register Mapping”.
REGISTER 17-14: ALRMMNTH: ALARM MONTH VALUE REGISTER(1)
(ALRMVALH when ALRMPTR = 10)
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
MTHTEN0
MTHONE3
MTHONE2
MTHONE1
MTHONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
MTHTEN0: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Month’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value of 0 or 1.
bit 3-0
MTHONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Month’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
REGISTER 17-15: ALRMDAY: ALARM DAY VALUE REGISTER(1)
(ALRMVALL when ALRMPTR = 10)
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
DAYTEN1
DAYTEN0
DAYONE3
DAYONE2
DAYONE1
DAYONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
DAYTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Day’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 3.
bit 3-0
DAYONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Day’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 305
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-16: ALRMWD: ALARM WEEKDAY VALUE REGISTER(1)
(ALRMVALH WHEN ALRMPTR = 01)
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
—
—
WDAY2
WDAY1
WDAY0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
WDAY: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Weekday Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 6.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
REGISTER 17-17: ALRMHR: ALARM HOURS VALUE REGISTER(1)
(ALRMVALL when ALRMPTR = 01)
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
HRTEN1
HRTEN0
HRONE3
HRONE2
HRONE1
HRONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
HRTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Hour’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 2.
bit 3-0
HRONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Hour’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
Note 1:
A write to this register is only allowed when RTCWREN = 1.
DS30000575C-page 306
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 17-18: ALRMMIN: ALARM MINUTES VALUE REGISTER
(ALRMVALH when ALRMPTR = 00)
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
MINTEN2
MINTEN1
MINTEN0
MINONE3
MINONE2
MINONE1
MINONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
MINTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Minute’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 5.
bit 3-0
MINONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Minute’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
REGISTER 17-19: ALRMSEC: ALARM SECONDS VALUE REGISTER
(ALRMVALL when ALRMPTR = 00)
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
SECTEN2
SECTEN1
SECTEN0
SECONE3
SECONE2
SECONE1
SECONE0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
SECTEN: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Second’s Tens Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 5.
bit 3-0
SECONE: Binary Coded Decimal Value of Second’s Ones Digit bits
Contains a value from 0 to 9.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 307
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.1.4
17.2
RTCEN BIT WRITE
RTCWREN (RTCCON1) must be set before a write
to RTCEN can take place. Any write to the RTCEN bit,
while RTCWREN = 0, will be ignored.
Like the RTCEN bit, the RTCVALH and RTCVALL
registers can only be written to when RTCWREN = 1.
A write to these registers, while RTCWREN = 0, will be
ignored.
FIGURE 17-2:
17.2.1
Operation
REGISTER INTERFACE
The register interface for the RTCC and alarm values is
implemented using the Binary Coded Decimal (BCD)
format. This simplifies the firmware when using the
module, as each of the digits is contained within its own
4-bit value (see Figure 17-2 and Figure 17-3).
TIMER DIGIT FORMAT
Year
0-9
0-9
0-1
Hours
(24-hour format)
0-2
FIGURE 17-3:
Day
Month
0-9
0-9
0-3
Minutes
0-5
0-9
0-5
0-9
0-6
1/2 Second Bit
(binary format)
0/1
ALARM DIGIT FORMAT
0-1
Hours
(24-hour format)
DS30000575C-page 308
0-9
Seconds
Day
Month
0-2
Day of Week
0-9
0-9
0-3
Minutes
0-5
Day of Week
0-9
0-6
Seconds
0-9
0-5
0-9
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.2.2
CLOCK SOURCE
Calibration of the crystal can be done through this
module to yield an error of 3 seconds or less per month.
(For further details, see Section 17.2.9 “Calibration”.)
As mentioned earlier, the RTCC module is intended to
be clocked by an external Real-Time Clock (RTC) crystal, oscillating at 32.768 kHz, but an internal oscillator
can be used. The RTCC clock selection is decided by
the RTCOSC bit (CONFIG3L).
FIGURE 17-4:
CLOCK SOURCE MULTIPLEXING
32.768 kHz XTAL
from SOSC
1:16384
Half-Second
Clock
Half Second(1)
Clock Prescaler(1)
Internal RC
One Second Clock
RTCCON1
Second
Note 1:
17.2.2.1
Hour:Minute
Day
Month
Day of Week
Writing to the lower half of the MINSEC register resets all counters, allowing fraction of a second synchronization;
clock prescaler is held in Reset when RTCEN = 0.
Real-Time Clock Enable
TABLE 17-1:
The RTCC module can be clocked by an external,
32.768 kHz crystal (SOSC Oscillator) or the LF-INTOSC
Oscillator, which can be selected in CONFIG3L.
DIGIT CARRY RULES
This section explains which timer values are affected
when there is a rollover:
• Time of Day: From 23:59:59 to 00:00:00 with a
carry to the Day field
• Month: From 12/31 to 01/01 with a carry to the
Year field
• Day of Week: From 6 to 0 with no carry (see
Table 17-1)
• Year Carry: From 99 to 00; this also surpasses the
use of the RTCC
DAY OF WEEK SCHEDULE
Day of Week
If the external clock is used, the SOSC Oscillator
should be enabled. If LF-INTOSC is providing the clock,
the INTOSC clock can be brought out to the RTCC pin
by the RTSECSEL bits (RTCCON2).
17.2.3
Year
Sunday
0
Monday
1
Tuesday
2
Wednesday
3
Thursday
4
Friday
5
Saturday
6
TABLE 17-2:
DAY TO MONTH ROLLOVER
SCHEDULE
Month
Maximum Day Field
01 (January)
31
02 (February)
28 or 29(1)
03 (March)
31
04 (April)
30
For the day-to-month rollover schedule, see Table 17-2.
05 (May)
31
Because the following values are in BCD format, the
carry to the upper BCD digit occurs at the count of 10,
not 16 (SECONDS, MINUTES, HOURS, WEEKDAY,
DAYS and MONTHS).
06 (June)
30
07 (July)
31
08 (August)
31
09 (September)
30
10 (October)
31
11 (November)
30
12 (December)
31
Note 1:
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
See Section 17.2.4 “Leap Year”.
DS30000575C-page 309
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.2.4
LEAP YEAR
Since the year range on the RTCC module is 2000 to
2099, the leap year calculation is determined by any year
divisible by four in the above range. Only February is
affected in a leap year.
February will have 29 days in a leap year and 28 days in
any other year.
17.2.5
GENERAL FUNCTIONALITY
All Timer registers containing a time value of seconds or
greater are writable. The user configures the time by
writing the required year, month, day, hour, minutes and
seconds to the Timer registers, via register pointers.
(See Section 17.2.8 “Register Mapping”.)
The timer uses the newly written values and proceeds
with the count from the required starting point.
The RTCC is enabled by setting the RTCEN bit (RTCCON1). If enabled, while adjusting these registers,
the timer still continues to increment. However, any time
the MINSEC register is written to, both of the timer prescalers are reset to ‘0’. This allows fraction of a second
synchronization.
The Timer registers are updated in the same cycle as
the WRITE instruction’s execution by the CPU. The
user must ensure that when RTCEN = 1, the updated
registers will not be incremented at the same time. This
can be accomplished in several ways:
• By checking the RTCSYNC bit (RTCCON1)
• By checking the preceding digits from which a
carry can occur
• By updating the registers immediately following
the seconds pulse (or an alarm interrupt)
The user has visibility to the half-second field of the
counter. This value is read-only and can be reset only
by writing to the lower half of the SECONDS register.
17.2.6
SAFETY WINDOW FOR REGISTER
READS AND WRITES
The RTCSYNC bit indicates a time window during
which the RTCC clock domain registers can be safely
read and written without concern about a rollover.
When RTCSYNC = 0, the registers can be safely
accessed by the CPU.
Whether RTCSYNC = 1 or 0, the user should employ a
firmware solution to ensure that the data read did not
fall on a rollover boundary, resulting in an invalid or
partial read. This firmware solution would consist of
reading each register twice and then comparing the two
values. If the two values matched, then a rollover did
not occur.
DS30000575C-page 310
17.2.7
WRITE LOCK
In order to perform a write to any of the RTCC Timer
registers, the RTCWREN bit (RTCCON1) must be
set.
To avoid accidental writes to the RTCC Timer register,
it is recommended that the RTCWREN bit
(RTCCON1) be kept clear when not writing to the
register. For the RTCWREN bit to be set, there is only
one instruction cycle time window allowed between the
55h/AA sequence and the setting of RTCWREN. For
that reason, it is recommended that users follow the
code example in Example 17-1.
EXAMPLE 17-1:
movlw
movwf
movlw
movwf
bsf
17.2.8
SETTING THE RTCWREN
BIT
0x55
EECON2
0xAA
EECON2
RTCCON1,RTCWREN
REGISTER MAPPING
To limit the register interface, the RTCC Timer and
Alarm Timer registers are accessed through
corresponding register pointers. The RTCC Value
register window (RTCVALH and RTCVALL) uses the
RTCPTRx bits (RTCCON1) to select the required
Timer register pair.
By reading or writing to the RTCVALH register, the
RTCC Pointer value (RTCPTR) decrements by ‘1’
until it reaches ‘00’. When ‘00’ is reached, the
MINUTES and SECONDS value is accessible through
RTCVALH and RTCVALL until the pointer value is
manually changed.
TABLE 17-3:
RTCPTR
RTCVALH AND RTCVALL
REGISTER MAPPING
RTCC Value Register Window
RTCVALH
RTCVALL
00
MINUTES
SECONDS
01
WEEKDAY
HOURS
10
MONTH
DAY
11
—
YEAR
The Alarm Value register windows (ALRMVALH and
ALRMVALL) use the ALRMPTR bits (ALRMCFG)
to select the desired Alarm register pair.
By reading or writing to the ALRMVALH register, the
Alarm Pointer value, ALRMPTR, decrements by ‘1’
until it reaches ‘00’. When it reaches ‘00’, the ALRMMIN
and ALRMSEC values are accessible through
ALRMVALH and ALRMVALL until the pointer value is
manually changed.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 17-4:
17.3
ALRMVAL REGISTER
MAPPING
ALRMPTR
00
The Alarm features and characteristics are:
Alarm Value Register Window
ALRMVALH
ALRMVALL
ALRMMIN
ALRMSEC
01
ALRMWD
ALRMHR
10
ALRMMNTH
ALRMDAY
11
—
—
17.2.9
CALIBRATION
The real-time crystal input can be calibrated using the
periodic auto-adjust feature. When properly calibrated,
the RTCC can provide an error of less than three
seconds per month.
To perform this calibration, find the number of error
clock pulses and store the value into the lower half of
the RTCCAL register. The 8-bit signed value, loaded
into RTCCAL, is multiplied by four and will either be
added or subtracted from the RTCC timer, once every
minute.
To calibrate the RTCC module:
1.
2.
Use another timer resource on the device to find
the error of the 32.768 kHz crystal.
Convert the number of error clock pulses per
minute (see Equation 17-1).
EQUATION 17-1:
CONVERTING ERROR
CLOCK PULSES
(Ideal Frequency (32,758) – Measured Frequency) * 60 =
Error Clocks per Minute
3.
Alarm
• Configurable from half a second to one year
• Enabled using the ALRMEN bit (ALRMCFG,
Register 17-4)
• Offers one-time and repeat alarm options
17.3.1
CONFIGURING THE ALARM
The alarm feature is enabled using the ALRMEN bit.
This bit is cleared when an alarm is issued. The bit will
not be cleared if the CHIME bit = 1 or if ALRMRPT 0.
The interval selection of the alarm is configured
through the ALRMCFG bits (AMASK); see
Figure 17-5. These bits determine which and how
many digits of the alarm must match the clock value for
the alarm to occur.
The alarm can also be configured to repeat based on a
preconfigured interval. The number of times this
occurs, after the alarm is enabled, is stored in the
ALRMRPT register.
Note:
While the alarm is enabled (ALRMEN = 1),
changing any of the registers, other than
the RTCCAL, ALRMCFG and ALRMRPT
registers and the CHIME bit, can result in a
false alarm event leading to a false alarm
interrupt. To avoid this, only change the
timer and alarm values while the alarm is
disabled (ALRMEN = 0). It is recommended
that the ALRMCFG and ALRMRPT
registers and CHIME bit be changed when
RTCSYNC = 0.
• If the oscillator is faster than ideal (negative
result from Step 2), the RCFGCALL register
value needs to be negative. This causes the
specified number of clock pulses to be
subtracted from the timer counter once every
minute.
• If the oscillator is slower than ideal (positive
result from Step 2), the RCFGCALL register
value needs to be positive. This causes the
specified number of clock pulses to be added to
the timer counter once every minute.
Load the RTCCAL register with the correct
value.
Writes to the RTCCAL register should occur only when
the timer is turned off or immediately after the rising
edge of the seconds pulse.
Note:
In determining the crystal’s error value, it
is the user’s responsibility to include the
crystal’s initial error from drift due to
temperature or crystal aging.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 311
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 17-5:
ALARM MASK SETTINGS
Alarm Mask Setting
AMASK
Day of the
Week
Month
Day
Hours
Minutes
Seconds
0000 – Every half second
0001 – Every second
0010 – Every 10 seconds
s
0011 – Every minute
s
s
m
s
s
m
m
s
s
0100 – Every 10 minutes
0101 – Every hour
0110 – Every day
0111 – Every week
d
1000 – Every month
1001 – Every year(1)
Note 1:
m
m
h
h
m
m
s
s
h
h
m
m
s
s
d
d
h
h
m
m
s
s
d
d
h
h
m
m
s
s
Annually, except when configured for February 29.
When ALRMCFG = 00 and the CHIME bit = 0
(ALRMCFG), the repeat function is disabled and
only a single alarm will occur. The alarm can be
repeated up to 255 times by loading the ALRMRPT
register with FFh.
After each alarm is issued, the ALRMRPT register is
decremented by one. Once the register has reached
‘00’, the alarm will be issued one last time.
After the alarm is issued a last time, the ALRMEN bit is
cleared automatically and the alarm turned off. Indefinite
repetition of the alarm can occur if the CHIME bit = 1.
When CHIME = 1, the alarm is not disabled when the
ALRMRPT register reaches ‘00’, but it rolls over to FF
and continues counting indefinitely.
17.3.2
ALARM INTERRUPT
At every alarm event, an interrupt is generated. Additionally, an alarm pulse output is provided that operates
at half the frequency of the alarm.
The alarm pulse output is completely synchronous with
the RTCC clock and can be used as a trigger clock to
other peripherals. This output is available on the RTCC
pin. The output pulse is a clock with a 50% duty cycle
and a frequency half that of the alarm event (see
Figure 17-6).
The RTCC pin can also output the seconds clock. The
user can select between the alarm pulse, generated by
the RTCC module, or the seconds clock output.
The RTSECSEL bits (RTCCON2) select
between these two outputs:
• Alarm pulse – RTSECSEL = 00
• Seconds clock – RTSECSEL = 01
DS30000575C-page 312
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 17-6:
TIMER PULSE GENERATION
RTCEN bit
ALRMEN bit
RTCC Alarm Event
RTCC Pin
17.4
Sleep Mode
17.5.2
POWER-ON RESET (POR)
The timer and alarm continue to operate while in Sleep
mode. The operation of the alarm is not affected by
Sleep, as an alarm event can always wake-up the
CPU.
The RTCCON1 and ALRMRPT registers are reset only
on a POR. Once the device exits the POR state, the
clock registers should be reloaded with the desired
values.
The Idle mode does not affect the operation of the timer
or alarm.
The timer prescaler values can be reset only by writing
to the SECONDS register. No device Reset can affect
the prescalers.
17.5
17.5.1
Reset
DEVICE RESET
When a device Reset occurs, the ALRMRPT register is
forced to its Reset state, causing the alarm to be
disabled (if enabled prior to the Reset). If the RTCC
was enabled, it will continue to operate when a basic
device Reset occurs.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 313
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
17.6
Register Maps
Table 17-5, Table 17-6 and Table 17-7 summarize the
registers associated with the RTCC module.
TABLE 17-5:
File Name
RTCC CONTROL REGISTERS
Bit 7
RTCCON1 RTCEN
RTCCAL
CAL7
Bit 6
Bit 5
—
Bit 4
RTCWREN RTCSYNC
CAL6
CAL5
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
HALFSEC
RTCOE
RTCPTR1
RTCPTR0
CAL3
CAL2
CAL1
CAL0
CAL4
RTCCON2 PWCEN PWCPOL PWCCPRE PWCSPRE RTCCLKSEL1 RTCCLKSEL0 RTCSECSEL1 RTCSECSEL
ALRMCFG ALRMEN
CHIME
ALRMRPT
ARPT7
ARPT6
PMD3
DSMMD CTMUMD
Legend:
AMASK3
AMASK2
AMASK1
AMASK0
ALRMPTR1
ALRMPTR0
ARPT5
ARPT4
ARPT3
ARPT2
ARPT1
ARPT0
ADCMD
RTCCMD
LCDMD
PSPMD
REFO1MD
REFO2MD
— = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Reset values are shown in hexadecimal for 80-pin devices.
TABLE 17-6:
File Name
RTCC VALUE REGISTERS
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
RTCVALH
RTCC Value High Register Window based on RTCPTR
RTCVALL
RTCC Value Low Register Window based on RTCPTR
TABLE 17-7:
File Name
Bit 0
ALARM VALUE REGISTERS
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
ALRMVALH
Alarm Value High Register Window based on ALRMPTR
ALRMVALL
Alarm Value Low Register Window based on ALRMPTR
DS30000575C-page 314
Bit 0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.0
ENHANCED CAPTURE/
COMPARE/PWM (ECCP)
MODULE
PIC18FXXJ94 devices have three Enhanced Capture/
Compare/PWM (ECCP) modules: ECCP1, ECCP2 and
ECCP3. These modules contain a 16-bit register, which
can operate as a 16-bit Capture register, a 16-bit
Compare register or a PWM Master/Slave Duty Cycle
register. These ECCP modules are upward compatible
with CCP
Note:
Throughout this section, generic references
are used for register and bit names that are
the same, except for an ‘x’ variable that indicates the item’s association with the CCP1,
CCP2 or CCP3 module. For example, the
control register is named CCPxCON and
refers to CCP1CON, CCP2CON and
CCP3CON.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
ECCP1, ECCP2 and ECCP3 are implemented as standard CCP modules with enhanced PWM capabilities.
These include:
•
•
•
•
•
Provision for two or four output channels
Output Steering modes
Programmable polarity
Programmable dead-band control
Automatic shutdown and restart
The enhanced features are discussed in detail in
Section 18.4 “PWM (Enhanced Mode)”.
The ECCP1, ECCP2 and ECCP3 modules use the
ECCP Control registers, CCP1CON, CCP2CON and
CCP3CON. The control registers, CCP4CON through
CCP10CON, are for the modules, CCP4 through
CCP10.
DS30000575C-page 315
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 18-1:
R/W-0
PxM1
CCPxCON: ENHANCED CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM x CONTROL
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PxM0
DCxB1
DCxB0
CCPxM3
CCPxM2
CCPxM1
CCPxM0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
PxM: Enhanced PWM Output Configuration bits
If CCPxM = 00, 01, 10:
xx =PxA is assigned as the capture/compare input/output; PxB, PxC and PxD are assigned as port pins
If CCPxM = 11:
00 =Single output: PxA, PxB, PxC and PxD are controlled by steering (see Section 18.4.7 “Pulse
Steering Mode”)
01 =Full-bridge output forward: PxD is modulated; PxA is active; PxB, PxC are inactive
10 =Half-bridge output: PxA, PxB are modulated with dead-band control; PxC and PxD are assigned
as port pins
11 =Full-bridge output reverse: PxB is modulated; PxC is active; PxA and PxD are inactive
bit 5-4
DCxB: PWM Duty Cycle bit
Capture mode:
Unused.
Compare mode:
Unused.
PWM mode:
These bits are the two LSbs of the 10-bit PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs of the duty cycle are found
in CCPRxL.
bit 3-0
CCPxM: CCPx Mode Select bits
0000 = Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets ECCPx module)
0001 = Reserved
0010 = Compare mode: Toggle output on match
0011 = Reserved
0100 = Capture mode: Every falling edge
0101 = Capture mode: Every rising edge
0110 = Capture mode: Every fourth rising edge
0111 = Capture mode: Every 16th rising edge
1000 = Compare mode: Initialize ECCPx pin low, set output on compare match (set CCPxIF)
1001 = Compare mode: Initialize ECCPx pin high, clear output on compare match (set CCPxIF)
1010 = Compare mode: Generate software interrupt only, ECCPx pin reverts to I/O state
1011 = Compare mode: Trigger special event (ECCPx resets TMR1 or TMR3, starts A/D conversion,
sets CCPxIF bit)
1100 = PWM mode: PxA and PxC are active-high; PxB and PxD are active-high
1101 = PWM mode: PxA and PxC are active-high; PxB and PxD are active-low
1110 = PWM mode: PxA and PxC are active-low; PxB and PxD are active-high
1111 = PWM mode: PxA and PxC are active-low; PxB and PxD are active-low
DS30000575C-page 316
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 18-2:
CCPTMRS0: CCP TIMER SELECT 0 REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
C3TSEL1
C3TSEL0
C2TSEL2
C2TSEL1
C2TSEL0
C1TSEL2
C1TSEL1
C1TSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
C3TSEL: CCP3 Timer Selection bits
00 = CCP3 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
01 = CCP3 is based off of TMR3/TMR4
10 = CCP3 is based off of TMR3/TMR6
11 = CCP3 is based off of TMR3/TMR8
bit 5-3
C2TSEL: CCP2 Timer Selection bits
000 = CCP2 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
001 = CCP2 is based off of TMR3/TMR4
010 = CCP2 is based off of TMR3/TMR6
011 = CCP2 is based off of TMR3/TMR8
100 = Reserved; do not use
101 = Reserved; do not use
110 = Reserved; do not use
111 = Reserved; do not use
bit 2-0
C1TSEL: CCP1 Timer Selection bits
000 = CCP1 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
001 = CCP1 is based off of TMR3/TMR4
010 = CCP1 is based off of TMR3/TMR6
011 = CCP1 is based off of TMR3/TMR8
100 = Reserved; do not use
101 = Reserved; do not use
110 = Reserved; do not use
111 = Reserved; do not use
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 317
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
In addition to the expanded range of modes available
through the CCPxCON, the ECCP modules have three
additional registers associated with Enhanced PWM
operation, Pulse Steering Control and auto-shutdown
features. They are:
• ECCPxDEL – Enhanced PWM x Control
• PSTRxCON – Pulse Steering x Control
• ECCPxAS – Auto-Shutdown x Control
18.1
ECCP Outputs and Configuration
The Enhanced CCP module may have up to four PWM
outputs, depending on the selected operating mode.
These outputs, designated as PxA through PxD, are
routed through the PPS-Lite module. Therefore, individual functions can be mapped to any of the remappable I/
O pins (RPn). The outputs that are active depend on the
ECCP operating mode selected. The pin assignments
are summarized in Table 18-3.
To configure the I/O pins as PWM outputs, the proper
PWM mode must be selected by setting the PxM
and CCPxM bits. The appropriate TRIS direction
bits for the port pins must also be set as outputs
Table 18-3.
DS30000575C-page 318
18.1.1
ECCP MODULE AND TIMER
RESOURCES
The ECCP modules use Timers, 1, 2, 3, 4, 6 or 8,
depending on the mode selected. These timers are
available to CCP modules in Capture, Compare or PWM
modes, as shown in Table 18-1.
TABLE 18-1:
ECCP Mode
ECCP MODE – TIMER
RESOURCE
Timer Resource
Capture
Timer1 or Timer3
Compare
Timer1 or Timer3
PWM
Timer2, Timer4, Timer6 or Timer8
The assignment of a particular timer to a module is
determined by the timer to ECCP enable bits in the
CCPTMRS0 register (Register 18-2). The interactions
between the two modules are depicted in Figure 18-1.
Capture operations are designed to be used when the
timer is configured for Synchronous Counter mode.
Capture operations may not work as expected if the
associated timer is configured for Asynchronous Counter
mode.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.2
Capture Mode
18.2.2
In Capture mode, the CCPRxH:CCPRxL register pair
captures the 16-bit value of the TMR1 or TMR3
registers when an event occurs on the corresponding
ECCPx pin. An event is defined as one of the following:
•
•
•
•
Every falling edge
Every rising edge
Every fourth rising edge
Every 16th rising edge
TIMER1/2/3/4/5/6/8 MODE
SELECTION
The timers that are to be used with the capture feature
(Timer1/2/3/4/5/6 or 8) must be running in Timer mode
or Synchronized Counter mode. In Asynchronous
Counter mode, the capture operation will not work. The
timer to be used with each ECCP module is selected in
the CCPTMRS0 register (Register 18-2).
18.2.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
The event is selected by the mode select bits,
CCPxM (CCPxCON). When a capture is
made, the interrupt request flag bit, CCPxIF, is set (see
Table 18-2). The flag must be cleared by software. If
another capture occurs before the value in the
CCPRxH/L register is read, the old captured value is
overwritten by the new captured value.
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture
interrupt may be generated. The user should keep the
CCPxIE interrupt enable bit clear to avoid false interrupts.
The interrupt flag bit, CCPxIF, should also be cleared
following any such change in operating mode.
TABLE 18-2:
There are four prescaler settings in Capture mode; they
are specified as part of the operating mode selected by
the mode select bits (CCPxM). Whenever the
ECCP module is turned off, or Capture mode is disabled, the prescaler counter is cleared. This means
that any Reset will clear the prescaler counter.
ECCP1/2/3 INTERRUPT FLAG
BITS
ECCP Module
Flag Bit
1
PIR3
2
PIR3
3
PIR4
18.2.1
ECCP PIN CONFIGURATION
In Capture mode, the appropriate ECCPx pin should be
configured as an input by setting the corresponding
TRIS direction bit.
Note:
If the ECCPx pin is configured as an output, a write to the port can cause a capture
condition.
18.2.4
Switching from one capture prescaler to another may
generate an interrupt. Also, the prescaler counter will
not be cleared; therefore, the first capture may be from
a non-zero prescaler. Example 18-1 provides the
recommended method for switching between capture
prescalers. This example also clears the prescaler
counter and will not generate the “false” interrupt.
EXAMPLE 18-1:
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
FIGURE 18-1:
ECCP PRESCALER
CHANGING BETWEEN
CAPTURE PRESCALERS
CCP1CON
; Turn ECCP module off
NEW_CAPT_PS ; Load WREG with the
; new prescaler mode
; value and ECCP ON
CCP1CON
; Load CCP1CON with
; this value
CAPTURE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR3H
Set CCP1IF
ECCP1 Pin
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
C1TSEL0
C1TSEL1
C1TSEL2
and
Edge Detect
CCP1CON
Q1:Q4
4
TMR3
Enable
CCPR1H
C1TSEL0
C1TSEL1
C1TSEL2
TMR3L
CCPR1L
TMR1
Enable
TMR1H
TMR1L
4
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 319
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.3
Compare Mode
18.3.2
In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPRx register value is
constantly compared against the Timer register pair
value selected in the CCPTMR0 register. When a
match occurs, the ECCPx pin can be:
•
•
•
•
Driven high
Driven low
Toggled (high-to-low or low-to-high)
Unchanged (that is, reflecting the state of the I/O
latch)
The action on the pin is based on the value of the mode
select bits (CCPxM). At the same time, the
interrupt flag bit, CCPxIF, is set.
18.3.1
ECCPx PIN CONFIGURATION
Users must configure the ECCPx pin as an output by
clearing the appropriate TRIS bit.
Note:
Clearing the CCPxCON register will force
the ECCPx compare output latch (depending on device configuration) to the default
low level. This is not the PORTx I/O data
latch.
TIMER1/2/3/4/5/6/8 MODE
SELECTION
Timer1/2/3/4, 6 or 8, must be running in Timer mode or
Synchronized Counter mode if the ECCP module is
using the compare feature. In Asynchronous Counter
mode, the compare operation will not work reliably.
18.3.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
When the Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen
(CCPxM = 1010), the ECCPx pin is not affected;
only the CCPxIF interrupt flag is affected.
18.3.4
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
The ECCP module is equipped with a Special Event
Trigger. This is an internal hardware signal generated
in Compare mode to trigger actions by other modules.
The Special Event Trigger is enabled by selecting
the Compare Special Event Trigger mode
(CCPxM = 1011).
The Special Event Trigger resets the Timer register pair
for whichever timer resource is currently assigned as the
module’s time base. This allows the CCPRx registers to
serve as a programmable period register for either timer.
The Special Event Trigger can also start an A/D conversion. In order to do this, the A/D Converter must
already be enabled.
FIGURE 18-2:
COMPARE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
0
TMR1H
TMR1L
1
TMR3H
TMR3L
Special Event Trigger
(Timer1/Timer3 Reset, A/D Trigger)
C1TSEL0
C1TSEL1
C1TSEL2
Set CCP1IF
Comparator
CCPR1H
CCPR1L
Compare
Match
ECCP1 Pin
Output
Logic
4
S
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
CCP1CON
DS30000575C-page 320
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4
PWM (Enhanced Mode)
The PWM outputs are multiplexed with I/O pins and are
designated: PxA, PxB, PxC and PxD. The polarity of the
PWM pins is configurable and is selected by setting the
CCPxM bits in the CCPxCON register appropriately.
The Enhanced PWM mode can generate a PWM signal
on up to four different output pins, with up to 10 bits of
resolution. It can do this through four different PWM
Output modes:
•
•
•
•
Table 18-1 provides the pin assignments for each
Enhanced PWM mode.
Single PWM
Half-Bridge PWM
Full-Bridge PWM, Forward mode
Full-Bridge PWM, Reverse mode
Figure 18-3 provides an example of a simplified block
diagram of the Enhanced PWM module.
Note:
To select an Enhanced PWM mode, the PxM bits of the
CCPxCON register must be set appropriately.
FIGURE 18-3:
To prevent the generation of an
incomplete waveform when the PWM is
first enabled, the ECCP module waits until
the start of a new PWM period before
generating a PWM signal.
EXAMPLE SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE ENHANCED PWM MODE
Duty Cycle Registers
DCxB
CCPxM
4
PxM
2
CCPRxL
ECCP1/Output Pin(3)
ECCPx/PxA
TRIS(2)
CCPRxH (Slave)
Output Pin(3)
PxB
Comparator
R
Q
Output
Controller
TRIS(2)
Output Pin(3)
PxC
TMR2
Comparator
PR2
Note 1:
(1)
TRIS(2)
S
PxD
Clear Timer2,
Toggle PWM Pin and
Latch Duty Cycle
Output Pin(3)
TRIS(2)
ECCPxDEL
The 8-bit TMR2 register is concatenated with the 2-bit internal Q clock, or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the
10-bit time base.
2:
The TRIS register value for each PWM output must be configured appropriately.
3:
Any pin not used by an Enhanced PWM mode is available for alternate pin functions.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 321
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 18-3:
EXAMPLE PIN ASSIGNMENTS FOR VARIOUS PWM ENHANCED MODES
ECCP Mode
PxM
PxA
PxB
PxC
PxD
Single
00
Yes(1)
Yes(1)
Yes(1)
Yes(1)
Half-Bridge
10
Yes
Yes
No
No
Full-Bridge, Forward
01
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Full-Bridge, Reverse
11
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Note 1:
Outputs are enabled by pulse steering in Single mode (see Register 18-5).
FIGURE 18-4:
EXAMPLE PWM (ENHANCED MODE) OUTPUT RELATIONSHIPS
(ACTIVE-HIGH STATE)
Signal
PxM
0
PR2 + 1
Pulse Width
Period
00
(Single Output)
PxA Modulated
Delay(1)
Delay(1)
PxA Modulated
10
(Half-Bridge)
PxB Modulated
PxA Active
01
(Full-Bridge,
Forward)
PxB Inactive
PxC Inactive
PxD Modulated
PxA Inactive
11
(Full-Bridge,
Reverse)
PxB Modulated
PxC Active
PxD Inactive
Relationships:
• Period = 4 * TOSC * (PR2 + 1) * (TMR2 Prescale Value)
• Pulse Width = TOSC * (CCPRxL:CCPxCON) * (TMR2 Prescale Value)
• Delay = 4 * TOSC * (ECCPxDEL)
Note 1: Dead-band delay is programmed using the ECCPxDEL register (Section 18.4.6 “Programmable Dead-Band
Delay Mode”).
DS30000575C-page 322
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 18-5:
EXAMPLE ENHANCED PWM OUTPUT RELATIONSHIPS (ACTIVE-LOW STATE)
PxM
Signal
PR2 + 1
Pulse
Width
0
Period
00
(Single Output)
PxA Modulated
PxA Modulated
10
(Half-Bridge)
Delay(1)
Delay(1)
PxB Modulated
PxA Active
01
(Full-Bridge,
Forward)
PxB Inactive
PxC Inactive
PxD Modulated
PxA Inactive
11
(Full-Bridge,
Reverse)
PxB Modulated
PxC Active
PxD Inactive
Relationships:
• Period = 4 * TOSC * (PR2 + 1) * (TMR2 Prescale Value)
• Pulse Width = TOSC * (CCPRxL:CCPxCON) * (TMR2 Prescale Value)
• Delay = 4 * TOSC * (ECCPxDEL)
Note 1: Dead-band delay is programmed using the ECCPxDEL register (Section 18.4.6 “Programmable Dead-Band
Delay Mode”).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 323
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4.1
HALF-BRIDGE MODE
Since the PxA and PxB outputs are multiplexed with the
PORT data latches, the associated TRIS bits must be
cleared to configure PxA and PxB as outputs.
In Half-Bridge mode, two pins are used as outputs to
drive push-pull loads. The PWM output signal is output
on the PxA pin, while the complementary PWM output
signal is output on the PxB pin (see Figure 18-6). This
mode can be used for half-bridge applications, as
shown in Figure 18-7, or for full-bridge applications,
where four power switches are being modulated with
two PWM signals.
FIGURE 18-6:
Period
Period
Pulse Width
PxA(2)
In Half-Bridge mode, the programmable dead-band delay
can be used to prevent shoot-through current in halfbridge power devices. The value of the PxDC bits of
the ECCPxDEL register sets the number of instruction
cycles before the output is driven active. If the value is
greater than the duty cycle, the corresponding output
remains inactive during the entire cycle. For more details
on the dead-band delay operations, see Section 18.4.6
“Programmable Dead-Band Delay Mode”.
td
td
PxB(2)
(1)
(1)
(1)
td = Dead-Band Delay
Note 1:
2:
FIGURE 18-7:
EXAMPLE OF HALFBRIDGE PWM OUTPUT
At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the
PR2 register.
Output signals are shown as active-high.
EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE APPLICATIONS
Standard Half-Bridge Circuit (“Push-Pull”)
FET
Driver
+
PxA
Load
FET
Driver
+
PxB
-
Half-Bridge Output Driving a Full-Bridge Circuit
V+
FET
Driver
FET
Driver
PxA
FET
Driver
Load
FET
Driver
PxB
DS30000575C-page 324
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4.2
FULL-BRIDGE MODE
In the Reverse mode, the PxC pin is driven to its active
state and the PxB pin is modulated, while the PxA and
PxD pins are driven to their inactive state, as provided in
Figure 18-9.
In Full-Bridge mode, all four pins are used as outputs.
An example of a full-bridge application is provided in
Figure 18-8.
The PxA, PxB, PxC and PxD outputs are multiplexed
with the port data latches. The associated TRIS bits
must be cleared to configure the PxA, PxB, PxC and
PxD pins as outputs.
In the Forward mode, the PxA pin is driven to its active
state and the PxD pin is modulated, while the PxB and
PxC pins are driven to their inactive state, as provided in
Figure 18-9.
FIGURE 18-8:
EXAMPLE OF FULL-BRIDGE APPLICATION
V+
FET
Driver
QC
QA
FET
Driver
PxA
Load
PxB
FET
Driver
PxC
FET
Driver
QD
QB
VPxD
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 325
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 18-9:
EXAMPLE OF FULL-BRIDGE PWM OUTPUT
Forward Mode
Period
PxA
(2)
Pulse Width
PxB(2)
PxC(2)
PxD(2)
(1)
(1)
Reverse Mode
Period
Pulse Width
PxA(2)
PxB(2)
PxC(2)
PxD(2)
(1)
Note 1:
2:
(1)
At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the PR2 register.
The output signal is shown as active-high.
DS30000575C-page 326
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4.2.1
Direction Change in Full-Bridge
Mode
In Full-Bridge mode, the PxM1 bit in the CCPxCON
register allows users to control the forward/reverse
direction. When the application firmware changes this
direction control bit, the module will change to the new
direction on the next PWM cycle.
A direction change is initiated in software by changing
the PxM1 bit of the CCPxCON register. The following
sequence occurs prior to the end of the current PWM
period:
• The modulated outputs (PxB and PxD) are placed
in their inactive state.
• The associated unmodulated outputs (PxA and
PxC) are switched to drive in the opposite
direction.
• PWM modulation resumes at the beginning of the
next period.
For an illustration of this sequence, see Figure 18-10.
The Full-Bridge mode does not provide a dead-band
delay. As one output is modulated at a time, a deadband delay is generally not required. There is a situation where a dead-band delay is required. This situation
occurs when both of the following conditions are true:
FIGURE 18-10:
• The direction of the PWM output changes when
the duty cycle of the output is at or near 100%.
• The turn-off time of the power switch, including
the power device and driver circuit, is greater than
the turn-on time.
Figure 18-11 shows an example of the PWM direction
changing from forward to reverse, at a near 100% duty
cycle. In this example, at time, t1, the PxA and PxD
outputs become inactive, while the PxC output
becomes active. Since the turn-off time of the power
devices is longer than the turn-on time, a shoot-through
current will flow through power devices, QC and QD
(see Figure 18-8), for the duration of ‘t’. The same
phenomenon will occur to power devices, QA and QB,
for PWM direction change from reverse to forward.
If changing PWM direction at high duty cycle is required
for an application, two possible solutions for eliminating
the shoot-through current are:
• Reduce PWM duty cycle for one PWM period
before changing directions.
• Use switch drivers that can drive the switches off
faster than they can drive them on.
Other options to prevent shoot-through current may
exist.
EXAMPLE OF PWM DIRECTION CHANGE
Period(1)
Signal
Period
PxA (Active-High)
PxB (Active-High)
Pulse Width
PxC (Active-High)
(2)
PxD (Active-High)
Pulse Width
Note 1:
2:
The direction bit, PxM1 of the CCPxCON register, is written any time during the PWM cycle.
When changing directions, the PxA and PxC signals switch before the end of the current PWM cycle. The
modulated PxB and PxD signals are inactive at this time. The length of this time is: (1/FOSC) • TMR2 Prescale Value.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 327
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 18-11:
EXAMPLE OF PWM DIRECTION CHANGE AT NEAR 100% DUTY CYCLE
Forward Period
t1
Reverse Period
PxA
PxB
PW
PxC
PxD
PW
TON
External Switch C
TOFF
External Switch D
Potential
Shoot-Through Current
Note 1:
18.4.3
All signals are shown as active-high.
2:
TON is the turn-on delay of power switch QC and its driver.
3:
TOFF is the turn-off delay of power switch QD and its driver.
START-UP CONSIDERATIONS
When any PWM mode is used, the application
hardware must use the proper external pull-up and/or
pull-down resistors on the PWM output pins.
Note:
T = TOFF – TON
When the microcontroller is released from
Reset, all of the I/O pins are in the highimpedance state. The external circuits
must keep the power switch devices in the
OFF state until the microcontroller drives
the I/O pins with the proper signal levels or
activates the PWM output(s).
The CCPxM bits of the CCPxCON register allow
the user to choose whether the PWM output signals are
active-high or active-low for each pair of PWM output
pins (PxA/PxC and PxB/PxD). The PWM output
polarities must be selected before the PWM pin output
drivers are enabled. Changing the polarity configuration while the PWM pin output drivers are enabled is
not recommended since it may result in damage to the
application circuits.
The PxA, PxB, PxC and PxD output latches may not be
in the proper states when the PWM module is
initialized. Enabling the PWM pin output drivers, at the
same time as the Enhanced PWM modes, may cause
damage to the application circuit. The Enhanced PWM
modes must be enabled in the proper Output mode and
complete a full PWM cycle before enabling the PWM
DS30000575C-page 328
pin output drivers. The completion of a full PWM cycle
is indicated by the TMR2IF or TMR4IF bit of the PIR1
or PIR5 register being set as the second PWM period
begins.
18.4.4
ENHANCED PWM AUTOSHUTDOWN MODE
The PWM mode supports an Auto-Shutdown mode that
will disable the PWM outputs when an external
shutdown event occurs. Auto-Shutdown mode places
the PWM output pins into a predetermined state. This
mode is used to help prevent the PWM from damaging
the application.
The auto-shutdown sources are selected using the
ECCPxAS bits (ECCPxAS). A shutdown
event may be generated by:
• A logic ‘0’ on the pin that is assigned the FLT0
input function
• Comparator C1
• Comparator C2
• Setting the ECCPxASE bit in firmware
A shutdown condition is indicated by the ECCPxASE
(Auto-Shutdown Event Status) bit (ECCPxAS). If
the bit is a ‘0’, the PWM pins are operating normally. If
the bit is a ‘1’, the PWM outputs are in the shutdown
state.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
When a shutdown event occurs, two things happen:
Each pin pair may be placed into one of three states:
• The ECCPxASE bit is set to ‘1’. The ECCPxASE
will remain set until cleared in firmware or an
auto-restart occurs. (See Section 18.4.5 “AutoRestart Mode”.)
• The enabled PWM pins are asynchronously
placed in their shutdown states. The PWM output
pins are grouped into pairs (PxA/PxC and PxB/
PxD). The state of each pin pair is
determined by the PSSxAC and PSSxBD bits
(ECCPxAS and , respectively).
• Drive logic ‘1’
• Drive logic ‘0’
• Tri-state (high-impedance)
REGISTER 18-3:
ECCPxAS: ECCPx AUTO-SHUTDOWN CONTROL REGISTER(1,2,3)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ECCPxASE
ECCPxAS2
ECCPxAS1
ECCPxAS0
PSSxAC1
PSSxAC0
PSSxBD1
PSSxBD0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ECCPxASE: ECCP Auto-Shutdown Event Status bit
1 = A shutdown event has occurred; ECCP outputs are in a shutdown state
0 = ECCP outputs are operating
bit 6-4
ECCPxAS: ECCP Auto-Shutdown Source Select bits
000 = Auto-shutdown is disabled
001 = Comparator C1OUT output is high
010 = Comparator C2OUT output is high
011 = Either Comparator C1OUT or C2OUT is high
100 = VIL on FLT0 pin
101 = VIL on FLT0 pin or Comparator C1OUT output is high
110 = VIL on FLT0 pin or Comparator C2OUT output is high
111 = VIL on FLT0 pin or Comparator C1OUT or Comparator C2OUT is high
bit 3-2
PSSxAC: PxA and PxC Pins Shutdown State Control bits
00 = Drive pins: PxA and PxC to ‘0’
01 = Drive pins: PxA and PxC to ‘1’
1x = PxA and PxC pins tri-state
bit 1-0
PSSxBD: Pins PxB and PxD Shutdown State Control bits
00 = Drive pins: PxB and PxD to ‘0’
01 = Drive pins: PxB and PxD to ‘1’
1x = PxB and PxD pins tri-state
Note 1:
2:
3:
The auto-shutdown condition is a level-based signal, not an edge-based signal. As long as the level is
present, the auto-shutdown will persist.
Writing to the ECCPxASE bit is disabled while an auto-shutdown condition persists.
Once the auto-shutdown condition has been removed and the PWM restarted (either through firmware or
auto-restart), the PWM signal will always restart at the beginning of the next PWM period.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 329
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 18-12:
PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN WITH FIRMWARE RESTART (PxRSEN = 0)
PWM Period
Shutdown Event
ECCPxASE bit
PWM Activity
Normal PWM
Start of
PWM Period
18.4.5
Shutdown
Event Occurs
AUTO-RESTART MODE
The Enhanced PWM can be configured to automatically
restart the PWM signal once the auto-shutdown condition has been removed. Auto-restart is enabled by
setting the PxRSEN bit (ECCPxDEL).
ECCPxASE
Cleared by
Shutdown
PWM
Firmware
Event Clears
Resumes
The module will wait until the next PWM period begins,
however, before re-enabling the output pin. This behavior allows the auto-shutdown with auto-restart features
to be used in applications based on current mode of
PWM control.
If auto-restart is enabled, the ECCPxASE bit will
remain set as long as the auto-shutdown condition is
active. When the auto-shutdown condition is removed,
the ECCPxASE bit will be cleared via hardware and
normal operation will resume.
FIGURE 18-13:
PWM AUTO-SHUTDOWN WITH AUTO-RESTART ENABLED (PxRSEN = 1)
PWM Period
Shutdown Event
ECCPxASE bit
PWM Activity
Normal PWM
Start of
PWM Period
DS30000575C-page 330
Shutdown
Event Occurs
Shutdown
Event Clears
PWM
Resumes
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4.6
PROGRAMMABLE DEAD-BAND
DELAY MODE
FIGURE 18-14:
In half-bridge applications, where all power switches are
modulated at the PWM frequency, the power switches
normally require more time to turn off than to turn on. If
both the upper and lower power switches are switched
at the same time (one turned on and the other turned
off), both switches may be on for a short period until one
switch completely turns off. During this brief interval, a
very high current (shoot-through current) will flow
through both power switches, shorting the bridge supply.
To avoid this potentially destructive shoot-through
current from flowing during switching, turning on either of
the power switches is normally delayed to allow the
other switch to completely turn off.
Period
Period
Pulse Width
PxA(2)
td
td
PxB(2)
(1)
(1)
(1)
td = Dead-Band Delay
Note 1:
In Half-Bridge mode, a digitally programmable deadband delay is available to avoid shoot-through current
from destroying the bridge power switches. The delay
occurs at the signal transition from the non-active state
to the active state. For an illustration, see Figure 18-14.
The lower seven bits of the associated ECCPxDEL
register (Register 18-4) set the delay period in terms of
microcontroller instruction cycles (TCY or 4 TOSC).
FIGURE 18-15:
EXAMPLE OF HALFBRIDGE PWM OUTPUT
2:
At this time, the TMR2 register is equal to the
PR2 register.
Output signals are shown as active-high.
EXAMPLE OF HALF-BRIDGE APPLICATIONS
V+
Standard Half-Bridge Circuit (“Push-Pull”)
FET
Driver
+
V
-
PxA
Load
FET
Driver
+
V
-
PxB
V-
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 331
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 18-4:
ECCPxDEL: ENHANCED PWM CONTROL REGISTER x
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PxRSEN
PxDC6
PxDC5
PxDC4
PxDC3
PxDC2
PxDC1
PxDC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
PxRSEN: PWM Restart Enable bit
1 = Upon auto-shutdown, the ECCPxASE bit clears automatically once the shutdown event goes
away; the PWM restarts automatically
0 = Upon auto-shutdown, ECCPxASE must be cleared by software to restart the PWM
bit 6-0
PxDC: PWM Delay Count bits
PxDCn=Number of FOSC/4 (4 * TOSC) cycles between the scheduled time when a PWM signal should
transition active and the actual time it does transition active.
18.4.7
PULSE STEERING MODE
In Single Output mode, pulse steering allows any of the
PWM pins to be the modulated signal. Additionally, the
same PWM signal can simultaneously be available on
multiple pins.
Once the Single Output mode is selected
(CCPxM = 11 and PxM = 00 of the
CCPxCON register), the user firmware can bring out
the same PWM signal to one, two, three or four output
pins by setting the appropriate STR bits
(PSTRxCON), as provided in Table 18-3.
Note:
While the PWM Steering mode is active, the
CCPxM bits (CCPxCON) select the PWM
output polarity for the Px pins.
The PWM auto-shutdown operation also applies to the
PWM Steering mode, as described in Section 18.4.4
“Enhanced PWM Auto-shutdown mode”. An autoshutdown event will only affect pins that have PWM
outputs enabled.
The associated TRIS bits must be set to
output (‘0’) to enable the pin output driver
in order to see the PWM signal on the pin.
DS30000575C-page 332
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 18-5:
R/W-0
CMPL1
PSTRxCON: PULSE STEERING CONTROL(1)
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
CMPL0
—
STRSYNC
STRD
STRC
STRB
STRA
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
CMPL: Complementary Mode Output Assignment Steering Sync bits
00 =See STR
01 =PA and PB are selected as the complementary output pair
10 =PA and PC are selected as the complementary output pair
11 =PA and PD are selected as the complementary output pair
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
STRSYNC: Steering Sync bit
1 = Output steering update occurs on the next PWM period
0 = Output steering update occurs at the beginning of the instruction cycle boundary
bit 3
STRD: Steering Enable bit D
1 = PxD pin has the PWM waveform with polarity control from CCPxM
0 = PxD pin is assigned to port pin
bit 2
STRC: Steering Enable bit C
1 = PxC pin has the PWM waveform with polarity control from CCPxM
0 = PxC pin is assigned to port pin
bit 1
STRB: Steering Enable bit B
1 = PxB pin has the PWM waveform with polarity control from CCPxM
0 = PxB pin is assigned to port pin
bit 0
STRA: Steering Enable bit A
1 = PxA pin has the PWM waveform with polarity control from CCPxM
0 = PxA pin is assigned to port pin
Note 1:
The PWM Steering mode is available only when the CCPxCON register bits, CCPxM = 11 and
PxM = 00.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 333
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 18-16:
SIMPLIFIED STEERING
BLOCK DIAGRAM
STRA(2)
PxA Signal
CCPxM1
1
PORT Data
0
Output Pin(1)
TRIS
STRB(2)
CCPxM0
1
PORT Data
0
STRC
Output Pin(1)
CCPxM1
1
PORT Data
0
Output Pin(1)
CCPxM0
1
PORT Data
0
2:
The STRSYNC bit of the PSTRxCON register gives the
user two choices for when the steering event will
happen. When the STRSYNC bit is ‘0’, the steering
event will happen at the end of the instruction that
writes to the PSTRxCON register. In this case, the output signal at the Px pins may be an incomplete
PWM waveform. This operation is useful when the user
firmware needs to immediately remove a PWM signal
from the pin.
Figures 18-17 and 18-18 illustrate the timing diagrams
of the PWM steering depending on the STRSYNC
setting.
TRIS
STRD(2)
Note 1:
Steering Synchronization
When the STRSYNC bit is ‘1’, the effective steering
update will happen at the beginning of the next PWM
period. In this case, steering on/off the PWM output will
always produce a complete PWM waveform.
TRIS
(2)
18.4.7.1
Output Pin(1)
TRIS
Port outputs are configured as displayed when
the CCPxCON register bits, PxM = 00
and CCPxM = 11.
Single PWM output requires setting at least
one of the STRx bits.
FIGURE 18-17:
EXAMPLE OF STEERING EVENT AT END OF INSTRUCTION (STRSYNC = 0)
PWM Period
PWM
STRn
P1
PORT Data
PORT Data
P1n = PWM
FIGURE 18-18:
EXAMPLE OF STEERING EVENT AT BEGINNING OF INSTRUCTION (STRSYNC = 1)
PWM
STRn
P1
PORT Data
PORT Data
P1n = PWM
DS30000575C-page 334
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
18.4.8
OPERATION IN POWER-MANAGED
MODES
18.4.8.1
Operation with Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor (FSCM)
In Sleep mode, all clock sources are disabled. Timer2/
4/6/8 will not increment and the state of the module will
not change. If the ECCPx pin is driving a value, it will
continue to drive that value. When the device wakes
up, it will continue from this state. If Two-Speed Startups are enabled, the initial start-up frequency from HFINTOSC and the postscaler may not be stable immediately.
If the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) is enabled, a clock
failure will force the device into the power-managed
RC_RUN mode and the OSCFIF bit of the PIR2 register
will be set. The ECCPx will then be clocked from the
internal oscillator clock source, which may have a
different clock frequency than the primary clock.
In PRI_IDLE mode, the primary clock will continue to
clock the ECCPx module without change.
Both Power-on Reset and subsequent Resets will force
all ports to Input mode and the ECCP registers to their
Reset states.
18.4.9
EFFECTS OF A RESET
This forces the ECCP module to reset to a state
compatible with previous, non-enhanced CCP modules
used on other PIC18 and PIC16 devices.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 335
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.0
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM
(CCP) MODULES
PIC18FXXJ94 devices have seven CCP (Capture/
Compare/PWM) modules, designated CCP4 through
CCP10. All the modules implement standard Capture,
Compare and Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) modes.
Note:
Each CCP module contains a 16-bit register that can
operate as a 16-bit Capture register, a 16-bit Compare
register or a PWM Master/Slave Duty Cycle register.
For the sake of clarity, all CCP module operation in the
following sections is described with respect to CCP4,
but is equally applicable to CCP5 through CCP10.
Throughout this section, generic references
are used for register and bit names that are
the same, except for an ‘x’ variable that indicates the item’s association with the specific
CCP module. For example, the control
register is named CCPxCON and refers to
CCP4CON through CCP10CON.
REGISTER 19-1:
U-0
CCPxCON: CCPx CONTROL REGISTER (CCP4-CCP10 MODULES)
U-0
—
—
R/W-0
DCxB1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
DCxB0
CCPxM3(1)
CCPxM2(1)
CCPxM1(1)
CCPxM0(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
DCxB: PWM Duty Cycle bit 1 and bit 0 for CCPx module bits
Capture mode:
Unused.
Compare mode:
Unused.
PWM mode:
These bits are the two Least Significant bits (bit 1 and bit 0) of the 10-bit PWM duty cycle. The eight
Most Significant bits (DCx) of the duty cycle are found in CCPRxL.
bit 3-0
CCPxM: CCPx Module Mode Select bits(1)
0000 =Capture/Compare/PWM is disabled (resets CCPx module)
0001 =Reserved
0010 =Compare mode, toggles output on match (CCPxIF bit is set)
0011 =Reserved
0100 =Capture mode: Every falling edge
0101 =Capture mode: Every rising edge
0110 =Capture mode: Every 4th rising edge
0111 =Capture mode: Every 16th rising edge
1000 =Compare mode: Initialize CCPx pin low; on compare match, force CCPx pin high (CCPxIF bit is set)
1001 =Compare mode: Initialize CCPx pin high; on compare match, force CCPx pin low (CCPxIF bit is set)
1010 =Compare mode: Generate software interrupt on compare match (CCPxIF bit is set, CCPx pin
reflects I/O state)
1011 =Compare mode: Special Event Trigger; reset timer on CCPx match (CCPxIF bit is set)
11xx =PWM mode
Note 1:
CCPxM = 1011 will only reset the timer and not start an A/D conversion on a CCPx match.
DS30000575C-page 336
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 19-2:
CCPTMRS1: CCP TIMER SELECT REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
C7TSEL1
C7TSEL0
—
C6TSEL0
—
C5TSEL0
C4TSEL1
C4TSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
C7TSEL: CCP7 Timer Selection bits
00 =CCP7 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
01 =CCP7 is based off of TMR5/TMR4
10 =CCP7 is based off of TMR5/TMR6
11 =CCP7 is based off of TMR5/TMR8
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
C6TSEL0: CCP6 Timer Selection bit
0 = CCP6 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
1 = CCP6 is based off of TMR5/TMR2
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
C5TSEL0: CCP5 Timer Selection bit
0 = CCP5 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
1 = CCP5 is based off of TMR5/TMR4
bit 1-0
C4TSEL: CCP4 Timer Selection bits
00 =CCP4 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
01 =CCP4 is based off of TMR3/TMR4
10 =CCP4 is based off of TMR3/TMR6
11 =Reserved; do not use
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 337
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 19-3:
CCPTMRS2: CCP TIMER SELECT REGISTER 2
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
C10TSEL0
—
C9TSEL0
C8TSEL1
C8TSEL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
C10TSEL0: CCP10 Timer Selection bit
0 = CCP10 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
1 = CCP10 is based off of TMR5/TMR2
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
C9TSEL0: CCP9 Timer Selection bit
0 = CCP9 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
1 = CCP9 is based off of TMR5/TMR4
bit 1-0
C8TSEL: CCP8 Timer Selection bits
00 =CCP8 is based off of TMR1/TMR2
01 =CCP8 is based off of TMR3/TMR4
10 =CCP8 is based off of TMR3/TMR6
11 =Reserved; do not use
DS30000575C-page 338
x = Bit is unknown
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 19-4:
CCPRxL: CCPx PERIOD LOW BYTE REGISTER
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
CCPRxL7
CCPRxL6
CCPRxL5
CCPRxL4
CCPRxL3
CCPRxL2
CCPRxL1
CCPRxL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
CCPRxL: CCPx Period Register Low Byte bits
Capture mode: Capture Register Low Byte
Compare mode: Compare Register Low Byte
PWM mode: Duty Cycle Register
REGISTER 19-5:
CCPRxH: CCPx PERIOD HIGH BYTE REGISTER
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
CCPRxH7
CCPRxH6
CCPRxH5
CCPRxH4
CCPRxH3
CCPRxH2
CCPRxH1
CCPRxH0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
CCPRxH: CCPx Period Register High Byte bits
Capture mode: Capture Register High Byte
Compare mode: Compare Register High Byte
PWM mode: Duty Cycle Buffer Register
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 339
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.1
CCP Module Configuration
TABLE 19-1:
Each Capture/Compare/PWM module is associated
with a control register (generically, CCPxCON) and a
data register (CCPRx). The data register, in turn, is
comprised of two 8-bit registers: CCPRxL (low byte)
and CCPRxH (high byte). All registers are both
readable and writable.
19.1.1
CCP MODULES AND TIMER
RESOURCES
The CCP modules utilize Timers, 1 through 8, that vary
with the selected mode. Various timers are available to
the CCP modules in Capture, Compare or PWM
modes, as shown in Table 19-1.
CCP MODE – TIMER
RESOURCE
CCP Mode
Timer Resource
Capture
Timer1, Timer3 or Timer 5
Compare
PWM
Timer2, Timer4, Timer 6 or Timer8
The assignment of a particular timer to a module is
determined by the timer to CCP enable bits in the
CCPTMRSx registers. (See Register 19-2 and
Register 19-3.) All of the modules may be active at
once and may share the same timer resource if they
are configured to operate in the same mode (Capture/
Compare or PWM) at the same time.
The CCPTMRS1 register selects the timers for CCP
modules, 7, 6, 5 and 4, and the CCPTMRS2 register
selects the timers for CCP modules, 10, 9 and 8. The
possible configurations are shown in Table 19-2 and
Table 19-3.
TABLE 19-2:
TIMER ASSIGNMENTS FOR CCP MODULES 4, 5, 6 AND 7
CCPTMRS1 Register
CCP4
CCP5
CCP6
CCP7
Capture/
Capture/
Capture/
PWM
PWM
C4TSEL
C6TSEL0 Compare
C5TSEL0 Compare
Compare
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Capture/
PWM
PWM C7TSEL
Compare
Mode
Mode
Mode
0 0
TMR1
TMR2
0
TMR1
TMR2
0
TMR1
TMR2
0 0
TMR1
TMR2
0 1
TMR3
TMR4
1
TMR5
TMR4
1
TMR5
TMR2
0 1
TMR5
TMR4
1 0
TMR3
TMR6
1 0
TMR5
TMR6
1 1
TMR5
TMR8
1 1
Note 1:
Reserved(1)
Do not use the reserved bits.
TABLE 19-3:
TIMER ASSIGNMENTS FOR CCP MODULES 8, 9 AND 10
CCPTMRS2 Register
CCP8
Devices with 32 Kbytes
CCP8
CCP9
CCP10
Capture/
Capture/
Capture/
Capture/
C8TSEL
PWM C8TSEL
PWM
PWM
PWM
Compare
Compare
C9TSEL0 Compare
C10TSEL0 Compare
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
Mode
0 0
TMR1
TMR2
0 0
TMR1
TMR2
0
TMR1
TMR2
0
TMR1
TMR2
0 1
TMR5
TMR4
0 1
TMR1
TMR4
1
TMR5
TMR4
1
TMR5
TMR2
1 0
TMR5
TMR6
1 0
TMR1
TMR6
1 1
Note 1:
Reserved(1)
1 1
Reserved(1)
Do not use the reserved bits.
DS30000575C-page 340
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.1.2
OPEN-DRAIN OUTPUT OPTION
When operating in Output mode (the Compare or PWM
modes), the drivers for the CCPx pins can be optionally
configured as open-drain outputs. This feature allows
the voltage level on the pin to be pulled to a higher level
through an external pull-up resistor and allows the
output to communicate with external circuits without the
need for additional level shifters.
The open-drain output option is controlled by the
CCPxOD bits (ODCON2). Setting the appropriate bit configures the pin for the corresponding module
for open-drain operation.
19.2
Capture Mode
In Capture mode, the CCPR4H:CCPR4L register pair
captures the 16-bit value of the Timer register selected
in the CCPTMRS1 when an event occurs on the CCP4
pin. An event is defined as one of the following:
•
•
•
•
Every falling edge
Every rising edge
Every 4th rising edge
Every 16th rising edge
The event is selected by the mode select bits,
CCP4M (CCP4CON). When a capture is
made, the interrupt request flag bit, CCP4IF (PIR4),
is set. (It must be cleared in software.) If another
capture occurs before the value in CCPR4 is read, the
old captured value is overwritten by the new captured
value.
Figure 19-1 shows the Capture mode block diagram.
19.2.1
CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
In Capture mode, the appropriate CCPx pin should be
configured as an input by setting the corresponding
TRIS direction bit.
Note:
19.2.2
If the CCPx pin is configured as an output,
a write to the port can cause a capture
condition.
TIMER1/3/5/7 MODE SELECTION
For the available timers (1/3/5) to be used for the capture
feature, the used timers must be running in Timer mode
or Synchronized Counter mode. In Asynchronous
Counter mode, the capture operation will not work.
The timer to be used with each CCP module is selected
in the CCPTMRSx registers. (See Section 19.1.1 “CCP
Modules and Timer Resources”.)
Details of the timer assignments for the CCP modules
are given in Table 19-2 and Table 19-3.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 341
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 19-1:
CAPTURE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR5H
Set CCP5IF
TMR5
Enable
C5TSEL0
CCP5 Pin
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
and
Edge Detect
CCPR5H
Q1:Q4
4
4
TMR1H
TMR1L
TMR3H
TMR3L
Set CCP4IF
4
CCP4CON
C4TSEL1
C4TSEL0
TMR3
Enable
CCP4 Pin
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
CCPR5L
TMR1
Enable
C5TSEL0
CCP5CON
TMR5L
and
Edge Detect
CCPR4H
CCPR4L
TMR1
Enable
C4TSEL0
C4TSEL1
Note:
19.2.3
TMR1L
This block diagram uses CCP4 and CCP5, and their appropriate timers as an example. For details on all of
the CCP modules and their timer assignments, see Table 19-2 and Table 19-3.
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture
interrupt may be generated. The user should keep the
CCP4IE bit (PIE4) clear to avoid false interrupts
and should clear the flag bit, CCP4IF, following any
such change in operating mode.
19.2.4
TMR1H
CCP PRESCALER
There are four prescaler settings in Capture mode.
They are specified as part of the operating mode
selected by the mode select bits (CCP4M).
Whenever the CCP module is turned off, or the CCP
module is not in Capture mode, the prescaler counter
is cleared. This means that any Reset will clear the
prescaler counter.
DS30000575C-page 342
Switching from one capture prescaler to another may
generate an interrupt. Doing that will also not clear the
prescaler counter – meaning the first capture may be
from a non-zero prescaler.
Example 19-1 shows the recommended method for
switching between capture prescalers. This example
also clears the prescaler counter and will not generate
the “false” interrupt.
EXAMPLE 19-1:
CHANGING BETWEEN
CAPTURE PRESCALERS
CLRF CCP4CON
; Turn CCP module off
MOVLW NEW_CAPT_PS ; Load WREG with the
; new prescaler mode
; value and CCP ON
MOVWF CCP4CON
; Load CCP4CON with
; this value
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.3
Compare Mode
19.3.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR4 register value is
constantly compared against the Timer register pair
value selected in the CCPTMR1 register. When a
match occurs, the CCP4 pin can be:
When the Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen
(CCP4M = 1010), the CCP4 pin is not affected.
Only a CCP interrupt is generated, if enabled, and the
CCP4IE bit is set.
•
•
•
•
19.3.4
Driven high
Driven low
Toggled (high-to-low or low-to-high)
Unchanged (that is, reflecting the state of the I/O
latch)
The action on the pin is based on the value of the mode
select bits (CCP4M). At the same time, the
interrupt flag bit, CCP4IF, is set.
Figure 19-2 gives the Compare mode block diagram
19.3.1
CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
The user must configure the CCPx pin as an output by
clearing the appropriate TRIS bit.
Note:
19.3.2
Clearing the CCPxCON register will force
the CCPx compare output latch (depending on device configuration) to the default
low level. This is not the PORTx I/O data
latch.
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
Both CCP modules are equipped with a Special Event
Trigger. This is an internal hardware signal, generated
in Compare mode, to trigger actions by other modules.
The Special Event Trigger is enabled by selecting
the Compare Special Event Trigger mode
(CCP4M = 1011).
For either CCP module, the Special Event Trigger resets
the Timer register pair for whichever timer resource is
currently assigned as the module’s time base. This
allows the CCPRx registers to serve as a Programmable
Period register for either timer.
The Special Event Trigger for CCP4 cannot start an A/
D conversion.
TIMER1/3/5 MODE SELECTION
If the CCP module is using the compare feature in
conjunction with any of the Timer1/3/5 timers, the
timers must be running in Timer mode or Synchronized
Counter mode. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the
compare operation will not work.
Note:
Details of the timer assignments for the
CCP modules are given in Table 19-2 and
Table 19-3.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 343
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 19-2:
COMPARE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
CCPR5H
Set CCP5IF
CCPR5L
Special Event Trigger
(Timer1/5 Reset)
CCP5 Pin
Compare
Match
Comparator
S
Output
Logic
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
4
CCP5CON
TMR1H
TMR1L
0
TMR5H
TMR5L
1
C5TSEL0
0
TMR1H
TMR1L
1
TMR3H
TMR3L
Special Event Trigger
(Timer1/Timer3 Reset)
C4TSEL1
C4TSEL0
Set CCP4IF
Comparator
CCPR4H
CCPR4L
Compare
Match
CCP4 Pin
Output
Logic
4
S
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
CCP4CON
Note:
This block diagram uses CCP4 and CCP5 and their appropriate timers as an example. For details on all of
the CCP modules and their timer assignments, see Table 19-2 and Table 19-3.
DS30000575C-page 344
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.4
PWM Mode
In Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP4 pin
produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output. Since
the CCP4 pin is multiplexed with a PORTC or PORTE
data latch, the appropriate TRIS bit must be cleared to
make the CCP4 pin an output.
Note:
A PWM output (Figure 19-4) has a time base (period)
and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). The
frequency of the PWM is the inverse of the period (1/
period).
FIGURE 19-4:
PWM OUTPUT
Period
Clearing the CCPxCON register will force
the CCPx compare output latch (depending on device configuration) to the default
low level. This is not the PORTx I/O data
latch.
Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2
Figure 19-3 shows a simplified block diagram of the
CCP4 module in PWM mode.
For a step-by-step procedure on how to set up the CCP
module for PWM operation, see Section 19.4.3
“Setup for PWM Operation”.
FIGURE 19-3:
SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK
DIAGRAM
Duty Cycle Registers
TMR2 = Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2
19.4.1
PWM PERIOD
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PR2
register. The PWM period can be calculated using the
following formula:
CCP4CON
EQUATION 19-1:
CCPR4L
PWM PERIOD
CALCULATION
PWM Period = [(PR2) + 1] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMR2 Prescale Value)
CCPR4H (Slave)
PWM frequency is defined as 1/[PWM period].
Comparator
R
Q
RC2/CCP4
TMR2
(Note 1)
S
Comparator
PR2
TRISC
Clear Timer,
CCP4 Pin and
Latch D.C.
Note 1: The 8-bit TMR2 value is concatenated with the 2-bit
internal Q clock, or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the
10-bit time base.
2:
CCP4 and its appropriate timers are used as an
example. For details on all of the CCP modules and
their timer assignments, see Table 19-2 and Table 19-3.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events
occur on the next increment cycle:
• TMR2 is cleared
• The CCP4 pin is set
(An exception: If PWM Duty Cycle = 0%, the
CCP4 pin will not be set)
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR4L into
CCPR4H
Note:
The
Timer2
postscalers
(see
Section 16.0 “Timer2/4/6/8 Modules”)
are not used in the determination of the
PWM frequency. The postscaler could be
used to have a servo update rate at a different frequency than the PWM output.
DS30000575C-page 345
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
19.4.2
PWM DUTY CYCLE
The PWM duty cycle is specified, to use CCP4 as an
example, by writing to the CCPR4L register and to the
CCP4CON bits. Up to 10-bit resolution is available. The CCPR4L contains the eight MSbs and the
CCP4CON contains the two LSbs. This 10-bit
value is represented by CCPR4L:CCP4CON.
The following equation is used to calculate the PWM
duty cycle in time:
EQUATION 19-2:
PWM DUTY CYCLE
(IN TIME)
The maximum PWM resolution (bits) for a given PWM
frequency is given by the equation:
PWM RESOLUTION
PWM Resolution (max)
CCPR4L and CCP4CON can be written to at any
time, but the duty cycle value is not latched into
CCPR4H until after a match between PR2 and TMR2
occurs (that is, the period is complete). In PWM mode,
CCPR4H is a read-only register.
Note:
F OSC
log ----------------
F PWM
= ------------------------------bits
log 2
If the PWM duty cycle value is longer than
the PWM period, the CCP4 pin will not be
cleared.
EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS AT 40 MHz
PWM Frequency
Timer Prescaler (1, 4, 16)
PR2 Value
Maximum Resolution (bits)
19.4.3
When the CCPR4H and two-bit latch match TMR2,
concatenated with an internal two-bit Q clock or two
bits of the TMR2 prescaler, the CCP4 pin is cleared.
EQUATION 19-3:
PWM Duty Cycle = (CCPR4L:CCP4CON) •
TOSC • (TMR2 Prescale Value)
TABLE 19-4:
The CCPR4H register and a two-bit internal latch are
used to double-buffer the PWM duty cycle. This
double-buffering is essential for glitchless PWM
operation.
2.44 kHz
9.77 kHz
39.06 kHz
156.25 kHz
312.50 kHz
416.67 kHz
16
4
1
1
1
1
FFh
FFh
FFh
3Fh
1Fh
17h
10
10
10
8
7
6.58
SETUP FOR PWM OPERATION
To configure the CCP module for PWM operation using
CCP4 as an example:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Set the PWM period by writing to the PR2
register.
Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the
CCPR4L register and CCP4CON bits.
Make the CCP4 pin an output by clearing the
appropriate TRIS bit.
Set the TMR2 prescale value, then enable Timer2 by writing to T2CON.
Configure the CCP4 module for PWM operation.
DS30000575C-page 346
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.0
20.1
MASTER SYNCHRONOUS
SERIAL PORT (MSSP)
MODULE
Master SSP (MSSP) Module
Overview
The Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) module is
a serial interface, useful for communicating with other
peripheral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral
devices may be serial EEPROMs, shift registers,
display drivers, A/D Converters, etc. The MSSP
module can operate in one of two modes:
• Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
• Inter-Integrated Circuit™ (I2C)
- Full Master mode
- Slave mode (with general address call)
20.2
Each MSSP module has four associated control registers. These include a STATUS register (SSPxSTAT)
and three control registers (SSPxCON1, SSPxCON2,
and SSPxCON3). The use of these registers and their
individual Configuration bits differ significantly depending on whether the MSSP module is operated in SPI or
I2C mode.
Additional details are provided under the individual
sections. On all PIC18F97J94 family devices, the SPI
DMA capability can only be used in conjunction with
MSSP1. The SPI DMA feature is described in
Section 20.4 “SPI DMA Module”.
Note:
In devices with more than one MSSP
module, it is very important to pay close
attention to SSPxCON register names.
SSP1CON1 and SSP1CON2 control
different operational aspects of the same
module, while SSP1CON1 and SSP2CON1
control the same features for two different
modules.
Note:
The SSPxBUF register cannot be used
with read-modify-write instructions, such
as BCF, COMF, etc.
The I2C interface supports the following modes in
hardware:
• Master mode
• Multi-Master mode
• Slave mode with 5-bit and 7-bit address masking
(with address masking for both 10-bit and 7-bit
addressing)
All members of the PIC18FXXJ94 have two MSSP
modules, designated as MSSP1 and MSSP2. Each
module operates independently of the other.
Note:
Throughout this section, generic references to an MSSP module in any of its
operating modes may be interpreted as
being equally applicable to MSSP1 or
MSSP2. Register names and module I/O
signals use the generic designator ‘x’ to
indicate the use of a numeral to distinguish a particular module when required.
Control bit names are not individuated.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Control Registers
To avoid lost data in Master mode, a
read of the SSPxBUF must be performed to clear the Buffer Full (BF)
detect bit (SSPSTAT) between each
transmission.
DS30000575C-page 347
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3
SPI Mode
FIGURE 20-1:
The SPI mode allows 8 bits of data to be synchronously
transmitted and received simultaneously. All four
modes of SPI are supported. To accomplish communication, three pins are typically used. These pins must
be assigned through the PPS-Lite Configuration
registers before use.
• Serial Data Out (SDOx) – Mapped to pin using
PPS-Lite Peripheral Output registers
• Serial Data In (SDIx) – Mapped to pin using
PPS-Lite Peripheral Input registers
• Serial Clock (SCKx) – Mapped to pin using
PPS-Lite Peripheral Input registers (for Slave
mode) or Peripheral Output registers (for Master
mode).
MSSPx BLOCK DIAGRAM
(SPI MODE)
Internal
Data Bus
Read
Write
SSPxBUF reg
SDIx
SSPxSR reg
Shift
Clock
SDOx
bit 0
SSx
SSx Control
Enable
Additionally, a fourth pin may be used when in a Slave
mode of operation:
Edge
Select
• Slave Select (SSx) – Mapped through PPS-Lite
Peripheral Input registers
2
Figure 20-1 shows the block diagram of the MSSPx
module when operating in SPI mode.
Clock Select
SCKx
SSPM
SMP:CKE 4
(TMR22Output)
2
Edge
Select
Prescaler TOSC
4, 16, 64
Data to TXx/RXx in SSPxSR
TRIS bit
Note:
DS30000575C-page 348
PPS-Lite signal names are used in this diagram for the sake of brevity. Refer to the text
for a full list of multiplexed functions.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.1
REGISTERS
Each MSSP module has four registers for SPI mode
operation. These are:
•
•
•
•
MSSPx Control Register 1 (SSPxCON1)
MSSPx STATUS Register (SSPxSTAT)
MSSPx Control Register 3 (SSPxCON3)
Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer Register
(SSPxBUF)
• MSSPx Shift Register (SSPxSR) – Not directly
accessible
SSPxSR is the shift register used for shifting data in or
out. SSPxBUF is the buffer register to which data bytes
are written to or read from.
In receive operations, SSPxSR and SSPxBUF
together, create a double-buffered receiver. When
SSPxSR receives a complete byte, it is transferred to
SSPxBUF and the SSPxIF interrupt is set.
During transmission, the SSPxBUF is not doublebuffered. A write to SSPxBUF will write to both
SSPxBUF and SSPxSR.
SSPxCON1, SSPxCON3 and SSPxSTAT are the control and STATUS registers in SPI mode operation. The
SSPxCON1 and SSPxCON3 registers are readable
and writable. The lower 6 bits of the SSPxSTAT are
read-only. The upper two bits of the SSPxSTAT are
read/write.
REGISTER 20-1:
R/W-0
SMP
SSPxSTAT: MSSPx STATUS REGISTER (SPI MODE)
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
(1)
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
CKE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
SMP: Sample bit
SPI Master mode:
1 = Input data is sampled at the end of data output time
0 = Input data is sampled at the middle of data output time
SPI Slave mode:
SMP must be cleared when SPI is used in Slave mode.
bit 6
CKE: SPI Clock Select bit(1)
1 = Transmit occurs on the transition from active to Idle clock state
0 = Transmit occurs on the transition from Idle to active clock state
bit 5
D/A: Data/Address bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 4
P: Stop bit
Used in I2C mode only. This bit is cleared when the MSSPx module is disabled; SSPEN is cleared.
bit 3
S: Start bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 2
R/W: Read/Write Information bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 1
UA: Update Address bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 0
BF: Buffer Full Status bit (Receive mode only)
1 = Receive is complete, SSPxBUF is full
0 = Receive is not complete, SSPxBUF is empty
Note 1:
Polarity of clock state is set by the CKP bit (SSPxCON1).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 349
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 20-2:
SSPxCON1: MSSPx CONTROL REGISTER 1 (SPI MODE)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
WCOL
SSPOV(1)
SSPEN(2)
CKP
SSPM3(4)
SSPM2(4)
SSPM1(4)
SSPM0(4)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit
1 = The SSPxBUF register is written while it is still transmitting the previous word (must be cleared in
software)
0 = No collision
bit 6
SSPOV: Receive Overflow Indicator bit(1)
SPI Slave mode:
1 = A new byte is received while the SSPxBUF register is still holding the previous data. In case of
overflow, the data in SSPxSR is lost. Overflow can only occur in Slave mode. The user must read
the SSPxBUF, even if only transmitting data, to avoid setting overflow (must be cleared in
software).
0 = No overflow
bit 5
SSPEN: Master Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit(2)
1 = Enables serial port and configures SCKx, SDOx, SDIx and SSx as serial port pins
0 = Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
bit 4
CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit
1 = Idle state for the clock is a high level
0 = Idle state for the clock is a low level
bit 3-0
SSPM: Master Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits(4)
1010 = SPI Master mode: Clock = FOSC/(4 * (SSPxADD + 1)(3)
0101 = SPI Slave mode: Clock = SCKx pin; SSx pin control is disabled; SSx can be used as I/O pin
0100 = SPI Slave mode: Clock = SCKx pin; SSx pin control is enabled
0011 = SPI Master mode: Clock = TMR2 output/2
0010 = SPI Master mode: Clock = FOSC/64
0001 = SPI Master mode: Clock = FOSC/16
0000 = SPI Master mode: Clock = FOSC/4
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
In Master mode, the overflow bit is not set since each new reception (and transmission) is initiated by
writing to the SSPxBUF register.
When enabled, these pins must be properly configured as inputs or outputs.
SSPxADD = 0 is not supported.
Bit combinations not specifically listed here are either reserved or implemented in I2C mode only.
DS30000575C-page 350
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 20-3:
SSPxCON3: MSSP CONTROL REGISTER 3 (SPI MODE)
R/HS/HC-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ACKTIM
PCIE
SCIE
BOEN
SDAHT
SBCDE
AHEN
DHEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ACKTIM: Acknowledge Time Status bit
Unused in SPI.
bit 6
PCIE: Stop Condition Interrupt Enable bit(1)
1 = Enable interrupt on detection of Stop condition
0 = Stop detection interrupts are disabled
bit 5
SCIE: Start Condition Interrupt Enable bit(1)
1 = Enable interrupt on detection of Start or Restart conditions
0 = Start detection interrupts are disabled
bit 4
BOEN: Buffer Overwrite Enable bit(2)
1 = SSPBUF updates every time a new data byte is shifted in, ignoring the BF bit
0 = If a new byte is received with BF bit already set, SSPOV is set, and the buffer is not updated
bit 3
SDAHT: SDA Hold Time Selection bit
Unused in SPI.
bit 2
SBCDE: Slave Mode Bus Collision Detect Enable bit
Unused in SPI.
bit 1
AHEN: Address Hold Enable bit
Unused in SPI.
bit 0
DHEN: Data Hold Enable bit
Unused in SPI.
Note 1:
2:
This bit has no effect in Slave modes that Start and Stop condition detection is explicitly listed as enabled.
For daisy-chained SPI operation; allows the user to ignore all but the last received byte. SSPOV is still set
when a new byte is received and BF = 1, but hardware continues to write the most recent byte to
SSPxBUF.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 351
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.2
OPERATION
When initializing the SPI, several options need to be
specified. This is done by programming the appropriate
control bits (SSPxCON1 and SSPxSTAT).
These control bits allow the following to be specified:
• I/O pins must be mapped to the SPI peripheral in
order to function. See Section 11.15 “PPS-Lite”
for an explanation of the PPS-Lite mapping
feature.
• Master mode (SCKx is the clock output)
• Slave mode (SCKx is the clock input)
• Clock Polarity (Idle state of SCKx)
• Data Input Sample Phase (middle or end of data
output time)
• Clock Edge (output data on rising/falling edge of
SCKx)
• Clock Rate (Master mode only)
• Slave Select mode (Slave mode only)
Each MSSPx module consists of a Transmit/Receive
Shift register (SSPxSR) and a Buffer register
(SSPxBUF). The SSPxSR shifts the data in and out of
the device, MSb first. The SSPxBUF holds the data that
was written to the SSPxSR until the received data is
ready. Once the 8 bits of data have been received, that
byte is moved to the SSPxBUF register. Then, the
Buffer Full detect bit, BF (SSPxSTAT), and the
interrupt flag bit, SSPxIF, are set. This double-buffering
of the received data (SSPxBUF) allows the next byte to
start reception before reading the data that was just
received. Any write to the SSPxBUF register during
transmission/reception of data will be ignored and the
Write Collision Detect bit, WCOL (SSPxCON1), will
be set. User software must clear the WCOL bit so that
it can be determined if the following write(s) to the
SSPxBUF register completed successfully.
EXAMPLE 20-1:
LOOP
When the application software is expecting to receive
valid data, the SSPxBUF should be read before the
next byte of data to transfer is written to the SSPxBUF.
The Buffer Full bit, BF (SSPxSTAT), indicates when
SSPxBUF has been loaded with the received data
(transmission is complete). When the SSPxBUF is
read, the BF bit is cleared. This data may be irrelevant
if the SPI is only a transmitter. Generally, the MSSPx
interrupt is used to determine when the transmission/
reception has completed. If the interrupt method is not
going to be used, then software polling can be done to
ensure that a write collision does not occur.
Example 20-1 shows the loading of the SSPxBUF
(SSPxSR) for data transmission.
The SSPxSR is not directly readable or writable and
can only be accessed by addressing the SSPxBUF
register. Additionally, the SSPxSTAT register indicates
the various status conditions.
20.3.3
OPEN-DRAIN OUTPUT OPTION
The drivers for the SDOx output and SCKx clock pins
can be optionally configured as open-drain outputs.
This feature allows the voltage level on the pin to be
pulled to a higher level through an external pull-up
resistor, and allows the output to communicate with
external circuits without the need for additional level
shifters. For more information, see Section 11.1.3
“Open-Drain Outputs”.
The open-drain output option is controlled by the
SSPxOD bits (ODCON1). Setting an SSPxOD bit
configures the SDOx and SCKx pins for the
corresponding module for open-drain operation.
Note:
To avoid lost data in Master mode, a
read of the SSPxBUF must be performed to clear the Buffer Full (BF)
detect bit (SSPxSTAT) between
each transmission.
LOADING THE SSP1BUF (SSP1SR) REGISTER
BTFSS
BRA
MOVF
SSP1STAT, BF
LOOP
SSP1BUF, W
MOVWF
RXDATA
;Save in user RAM, if data is meaningful
MOVF
MOVWF
TXDATA, W
SSP1BUF
;W reg = contents of TXDATA
;New data to xmit
DS30000575C-page 352
;Has data been received (transmit complete)?
;No
;WREG reg = contents of SSP1BUF
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.4
ENABLING SPI I/O
20.3.5
TYPICAL CONNECTION
To enable the serial port, the peripheral must first be
mapped to I/O pins using the PPS-Lite feature. To
enable the SPI peripheral, the MSSPx Enable bit,
SSPEN (SSPxCON1) must be set. To reset or
reconfigure SPI mode, clear the SSPEN bit, re-initialize
the SSPxCON registers and then set the SSPEN bit.
This configures the SDIx, SDOx, SCKx and SSx pins
as serial port pins. For the pins to behave as the serial
port function, some must have their data direction bits
(in the TRIS register) appropriately programmed as
follows:
Figure 20-2 shows a typical connection between two
microcontrollers. The master controller (Processor 1)
initiates the data transfer by sending the SCKx signal.
Data is shifted out of both shift registers on their programmed clock edge and latched on the opposite edge
of the clock. Both processors should be programmed to
the same Clock Polarity (CKP), then both controllers
would send and receive data at the same time.
Whether the data is meaningful (or dummy data)
depends on the application software. This leads to
three scenarios for data transmission:
• SDIx is automatically controlled by the SPI
module
• SDOx must have the TRIS bit cleared for the
corresponding RPn pin.
• SCKx (Master mode) must have the TRIS bit
cleared for the corresponding RPn pin
• SCKx (Slave mode) must have the TRIS bit set
for the corresponding RPn pin
• SSx must have the TRIS bit set for the
corresponding RPn pin.
• Master sends data–Slave sends dummy data
• Master sends data–Slave sends data
• Master sends dummy data–Slave sends data
Any serial port function that is not desired may be
overridden by programming the corresponding Data
Direction (TRIS) register to the opposite value.
FIGURE 20-2:
SPI MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master SSPM = 00xxb
SPI Slave SSPM = 010xb
SDOx
SDIx
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPxBUF)
SDIx
Shift Register
(SSPxSR)
MSb
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPxBUF)
SDOx
LSb
MSb
SCKx
PROCESSOR 1
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Shift Register
(SSPxSR)
Serial Clock
LSb
SCKx
PROCESSOR 2
DS30000575C-page 353
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.6
MASTER MODE
The master can initiate the data transfer at any time
because it controls the SCKx signal. The master determines when the slave (Processor 2, Figure 20-2) is to
broadcast data by the software protocol.
In Master mode, the data is transmitted/received as
soon as the SSPxBUF register is written to. If the SPI
is only going to receive, the SDOx output could be disabled (programmed as an input). The SSPxSR register
will continue to shift in the signal present on the SDIx
pin at the programmed clock rate. As each byte is
received, it will be loaded into the SSPxBUF register as
if a normal received byte (interrupts and Status bits
appropriately set). This could be useful in receiver
applications as a “Line Activity Monitor” mode.
The clock polarity is selected by appropriately programming the CKP bit (SSPxCON1). This, then, would
give waveforms for SPI communication, as shown in
Figure 20-3, Figure 20-5 and Figure 20-6, where the
FIGURE 20-3:
MSB is transmitted first. In Master mode, the SPI clock
rate (bit rate) is user-programmable to be one of the
following:
•
•
•
•
•
FOSC/4 (or TCY)
FOSC/(4 * (SSPxADD + 1)
FOSC/16 (or 4 • TCY)
FOSC/64 (or 16 • TCY)
Timer2 output/2
This allows a maximum data rate (at 64 MHz) of
16.00 Mbps.
Figure 20-3 shows the waveforms for Master mode.
When the CKE bit is set, the SDOx data is valid before
there is a clock edge on SCKx. The change of the input
sample is shown based on the state of the SMP bit. The
time when the SSPxBUF is loaded with the received
data is shown.
SPI MODE WAVEFORM (MASTER MODE)
Write to
SSPxBUF
SCKx
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCKx
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
4 Clock
Modes
SCKx
(CKP = 0
CKE = 1)
SCKx
(CKP = 1
CKE = 1)
SDOx
(CKE = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
SDOx
(CKE = 1)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
SDIx
(SMP = 0)
bit 0
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SDIx
(SMP = 1)
bit 7
bit 0
Input
Sample
(SMP = 1)
SSPxIF
SSPxSR to
SSPxBUF
DS30000575C-page 354
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.7
SLAVE MODE
In Slave mode, the data is transmitted and received as
the external clock pulses appear on SCKx. When the
last bit is latched, the SSPxIF interrupt flag bit is set.
transmitted byte and becomes a floating output.
External pull-up/pull-down resistors may be desirable
depending on the application.
While in Slave mode, the external clock is supplied by
the external clock source on the SCKx pin. This
external clock must meet the minimum high and low
times as specified in the electrical specifications.
When the SPI is in Slave mode with
pin
control
enabled
SSx
(SSPxCON1 = 0100), the SPI
module will reset if the SSx pin is set to
VDD.
While in Sleep mode, the slave can transmit/receive
data. When a byte is received, the device can be
configured to wake-up from Sleep.
If the SPI is used in Slave mode with CKE
set, then the SSx pin control must be
enabled.
20.3.8
When the SPI module resets, the bit counter is forced
to ‘0’. This can be done by either forcing the SSx pin to
a high level or clearing the SSPEN bit.
SLAVE SELECT
SYNCHRONIZATION
The SSx pin allows a Synchronous Slave mode. The
SPI must be in Slave mode with the SSx pin control
enabled (SSPxCON1 = 04h). When the SSx pin
is low, transmission and reception are enabled and the
SDOx pin is driven. When the SSx pin goes high, the
SDOx pin is no longer driven, even if in the middle of a
FIGURE 20-4:
Note:
To emulate two-wire communication, the SDOx pin can
be connected to the SDIx pin. When the SPI needs to
operate as a receiver, the SDOx pin can be configured
as an input. This disables transmissions from the
SDOx. The SDIx can always be left as an input (SDIx
function) since it cannot create a bus conflict.
SLAVE SYNCHRONIZATION WAVEFORM
SSx
SCKx
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCKx
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
Write to
SSPxBUF
SDOx
SDIx
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 7
bit 0
bit 0
bit 7
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPxIF
Interrupt
Flag
SSPxSR to
SSPxBUF
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2
DS30000575C-page 355
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 20-5:
SPI MODE WAVEFORM (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 0)
SSx
Optional
SCKx
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCKx
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
Write to
SSPxBUF
SDOx
SDIx
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
bit 0
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPxIF
Interrupt
Flag
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2
SSPxSR to
SSPxBUF
FIGURE 20-6:
SPI MODE WAVEFORM (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 1)
SSx
Not Optional
SCKx
(CKP = 0
CKE = 1)
SCKx
(CKP = 1
CKE = 1)
Write to
SSPxBUF
SDOx
SDIx
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
bit 0
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPxIF
Interrupt
Flag
SSPxSR to
SSPxBUF
DS30000575C-page 356
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.3.9
OPERATION IN POWER-MANAGED
MODES
In SPI Master mode, module clocks may be operating
at a different speed than when in full-power mode. In
the case of Sleep mode, all clocks are halted.
In Idle modes, a clock is provided to the peripherals.
That clock can be from the primary clock source, the
secondary clock (SOSC Oscillator) or the INTOSC
source.
20.3.11
Table 20-1 shows the compatibility between the
standard SPI modes and the states of the CKP and
CKE control bits.
TABLE 20-1:
If the Sleep mode is selected, all module clocks are
halted and the transmission/reception will remain in
that state until the device wakes. After the device
returns to Run mode, the module will resume
transmitting and receiving data.
In SPI Slave mode, the SPI Transmit/Receive Shift
register operates asynchronously to the device. This
allows the device to be placed in any power-managed
mode and data to be shifted into the SPI Transmit/
Receive Shift register. When all 8 bits have been
received, the MSSPx interrupt flag bit will be set, and if
enabled, will wake the device.
20.3.10
EFFECTS OF A RESET
SPI BUS MODES
Control Bits State
Standard SPI Mode
Terminology
CKP
CKE
0, 0
0
1
0, 1
0
0
1, 0
1
1
1, 1
1
0
In most cases, the speed that the master clocks SPI
data is not important; however, this should be
evaluated for each system.
If MSSPx interrupts are enabled, they can wake the
controller from Sleep mode, or one of the Idle modes,
when the master completes sending data. If an exit
from Sleep or Idle mode is not desired, MSSPx
interrupts should be disabled.
BUS MODE COMPATIBILITY
There is also an SMP bit which controls when the data
is sampled.
20.3.12
SPI CLOCK SPEED AND MODULE
INTERACTIONS
Because MSSP1 and MSSP2 are independent
modules, they can operate simultaneously at different
data rates. Setting the SSPM bits of the SSPxCON1 register determines the rate for the
corresponding module.
An exception is when both modules use Timer2 as a
time base in Master mode. In this instance, any
changes to the Timer2 module’s operation will affect
both MSSPx modules equally. If different bit rates are
required for each module, the user should select one of
the other three time base options for one of the
modules.
A Reset disables the MSSPx module and terminates
the current transfer.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 357
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.4
SPI DMA MODULE
The SPI DMA module contains control logic to allow the
MSSP1 module to perform SPI Direct Memory Access
transfers. This enables the module to quickly transmit
or receive large amounts of data with relatively little
CPU intervention. When the SPI DMA module is used,
MSSP1 can directly read and write to general purpose
SRAM. When the SPI DMA module is not enabled,
MSSP1 functions normally, but without DMA capability.
The SPI DMA module is composed of control logic, a
Destination Receive Address Pointer, a Transmit Source
Address Pointer, an interrupt manager and a Byte Count
register for setting the size of each DMA transfer. The
DMA module may be used with all SPI Master and Slave
modes, and supports both half-duplex and full-duplex
transfers.
20.4.1
I/O PIN CONSIDERATIONS
When enabled, the SPI DMA module uses the MSSP1
module. All SPI input and output signals, related to
MSSP1, are routed through the Peripheral Pin Select
(PPS) module. The appropriate initialization procedure,
as described in Section 20.4.6 “Using the SPI DMA
Module”, will need to be followed prior to using the SPI
DMA module. The output pins assigned to the SDO
and SCK functions can optionally be configured as
open-drain outputs, such as for level shifting operations
mentioned in the same section.
20.4.2
RAM TO RAM COPY OPERATIONS
Although the SPI DMA module is primarily intended to
be used for SPI communication purposes, the module
can also be used to perform RAM to RAM copy operations. To do this, configure the module for Full-Duplex
Master mode operation, but assign the SDO output and
SDI input functions onto the same RPn pin in the PPSLite module. Also assign SCK out and SCK in onto the
same RPn pin (a different pin than used for SDO and
SDI). This will allow the module to operate in Loopback
mode, providing RAM copy capability.
DS30000575C-page 358
20.4.3
IDLE AND SLEEP
CONSIDERATIONS
The SPI DMA module remains fully functional when the
microcontroller is in Idle mode.
During normal Sleep, the SPI DMA module is not functional and should not be used. To avoid corrupting a
transfer, user firmware should be careful to make
certain that pending DMA operations are complete by
polling the DMAEN bit in the DMACON1 register, prior
to putting the microcontroller into Sleep.
In SPI Slave modes, the MSSP1 module is capable of
transmitting and/or receiving one byte of data while in
Sleep mode. This allows the SSP1IF flag in the PIR1
register to be used as a wake-up source. When the
DMAEN bit is cleared, the SPI DMA module is
effectively disabled, and the MSSP1 module functions
normally, but without DMA capabilities. If the DMAEN
bit is clear prior to entering Sleep, it is still possible to
use the SSP1IF as a wake-up source without any data
loss.
Neither MSSP1 nor the SPI DMA module will provide
any functionality in Deep Sleep. Upon exiting from
Deep Sleep, all of the I/O pins, MSSP1 and SPI DMA
related registers will need to be fully re-initialized
before the SPI DMA module can be used again.
20.4.4
REGISTERS
The SPI DMA engine is enabled and controlled by the
following Special Function Registers:
• DMACON1
• DMACON2
• TXADDRH
• TXADDRL
• RXADDRH
• RXADDRL
• DMABCH
• DMABCL
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.4.4.1
DMACON1
The DMACON1 register is used to select the main
operating mode of the SPI DMA module. The SSCON1
and SSCON0 bits are used to control the slave select
pin.
When MSSP1 is used in SPI Master mode with the SPI
DMA module, SSDMA can be controlled by the DMA
module as an output pin. If MSSP1 will be used to communicate with an SPI slave device that needs the SSx
pin to be toggled periodically, the SPI DMA hardware
can automatically be used to de-assert SSx between
each byte, every two bytes or every four bytes.
Alternatively, user firmware can manually generate
slave select signals with normal general purpose I/O
pins, if required by the slave device(s).
When the TXINC bit is set, the TXADDR register will
automatically increment after each transmitted byte.
Automatic transmit address increment can be disabled
by clearing the TXINC bit. If the automatic transmit
address increment is disabled, each byte which is output on SDO will be the same (the contents of the SRAM
pointed to by the TXADDR register) for the entire DMA
transaction.
When the RXINC bit is set, the RXADDR register will
automatically increment after each received byte.
Automatic receive address increment can be disabled
by clearing the RXINC bit. If RXINC is disabled in FullDuplex or Half-Duplex Receive modes, all incoming
data bytes on SDI will overwrite the same memory
location pointed to by the RXADDR register. After the
SPI DMA transaction has completed, the last received
byte will reside in the memory location pointed to by the
RXADDR register.
The SPI DMA module can be used for either half-duplex
receive only communication, half-duplex transmit only
communication or full-duplex simultaneous transmit and
receive operations. All modes are available for both SPI
master and SPI slave configurations. The DUPLEX0
and DUPLEX1 bits can be used to select the desired
operating mode.
The behavior of the DLYINTEN bit varies greatly
depending on the SPI operating mode. For example
behavior for each of the modes, see Figure 20-3
through Figure 20-6.
SPI Slave mode, DLYINTEN = 1: In this mode, an
SSP1IF interrupt will be generated during a transfer if
the time between successful byte transmission events
is longer than the value set by the DLYCYC bits
in the DMACON2 register. This interrupt allows slave
firmware to know that the master device is taking an
unusually large amount of time between byte transmissions. For example, this information may be useful for
implementing application defined communication
protocols, involving time-outs if the bus remains Idle for
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
too long. When DLYINTEN = 1, the DLYLVL
interrupts occur normally according to the selected
setting.
SPI Slave mode, DLYINTEN = 0: In this mode, the
time-out based interrupt is disabled. No additional
SSP1IF interrupt events will be generated by the SPI
DMA module, other than those indicated by the
INTLVL bits in the DMACON2 register. In this
mode, always set DLYCYC = 0000.
SPI Master mode, DLYINTEN = 0: The DLYCYC
bits in the DMACON2 register determine the amount of
additional inter-byte delay, which is added by the SPI
DMA module during a transfer; the Master mode SS1
output feature may be used.
SPI Master mode, DLYINTEN = 1: The amount of
hardware overhead is slightly reduced in this mode,
and the minimum inter-byte delay is 8 TCY for FOSC/4,
9 TCY for FOSC/16 and 15 TCY for FOSC/64. This mode
can potentially be used to obtain slightly higher effective SPI bandwidth. In this mode, the SS1 control
feature cannot be used and should always be disabled
(DMACON1 = 00). Additionally, the interrupt
generating hardware (used in Slave mode) remains
active. To avoid extraneous SSP1IF interrupt events,
set the DMACON2 Delay bits, DLYCYC = 1111,
and ensure that the SPI serial clock rate is no slower
than FOSC/64.
In SPI Master modes, the DMAEN bit is used to enable
the SPI DMA module and to initiate an SPI DMA transaction. After user firmware sets the DMAEN bit, the
DMA hardware will begin transmitting and/or receiving
data bytes according to the configuration used. In SPI
Slave modes, setting the DMAEN bit will finish the
initialization steps needed to prepare the SPI DMA
module for communication (which must still be initiated
by the master device).
To avoid possible data corruption, once the DMAEN bit
is set, user firmware should not attempt to modify any
of the MSSP2 or SPI DMA related registers, with the
exception of the INTLVLx bits in the DMACON2
register.
If user firmware wants to halt an ongoing DMA transaction, the DMAEN bit can be manually cleared by the
firmware. Clearing the DMAEN bit while a byte is
currently being transmitted will not immediately halt the
byte in progress. Instead, any byte currently in
progress will be completed before the MSSP1 and SPI
DMA modules go back to their Idle conditions. If user
firmware clears the DMAEN bit, the TXADDR,
RXADDR and DMABC registers will no longer update,
and the DMA module will no longer make any
additional read or writes to SRAM; therefore, state
information can be lost.
DS30000575C-page 359
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 20-4:
DMACON1: DMA CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
SSCON1
SSCON0
TXINC
RXINC
DUPLEX1
DUPLEX0
DLYINTEN
DMAEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
SSCON: SSDMA Output Control bits (Master modes only)
11 = SSDMA is asserted for the duration of 4 bytes; DLYINTEN is always reset low
01 = SSDMA is asserted for the duration of 2 bytes; DLYINTEN is always reset low
10 = SSDMA is asserted for the duration of 1 byte; DLYINTEN is always reset low
00 = SSDMA is not controlled by the DMA module; DLYINTEN bit is software programmable
bit 5
TXINC: Transmit Address Increment Enable bit
Allows the transmit address to increment as the transfer progresses.
1 = The transmit address is to be incremented from the initial value of TXADDR
0 = The transmit address is always set to the initial value of TXADDR
bit 4
RXINC: Receive Address Increment Enable bit
Allows the receive address to increment as the transfer progresses.
1 = The received address is to be incremented from the initial value of RXADDR
0 = The received address is always set to the initial value of RXADDR
bit 3-2
DUPLEX: Transmit/Receive Operating Mode Select bits
10 = SPI DMA operates in Full-Duplex mode, data is simultaneously transmitted and received
01 = DMA operates in Half-Duplex mode, data is transmitted only
00 = DMA operates in Half-Duplex mode, data is received only
bit 1
DLYINTEN: Delay Interrupt Enable bit
Enables the interrupt to be invoked after the number of TCY cycles, specified in DLYCYC, has
elapsed from the latest completed transfer.
1 = The interrupt is enabled, SSCON must be set to ‘00’
0 = The interrupt is disabled
bit 0
DMAEN: DMA Operation Start/Stop bit
This bit is set by the users’ software to start the DMA operation. It is reset back to zero by the DMA
engine when the DMA operation is completed or aborted.
1 = DMA is in session
0 = DMA is not in session
DS30000575C-page 360
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.4.4.2
DMACON2
The DMACON2 register contains control bits for
controlling interrupt generation and inter-byte delay
behavior. The INTLVL bits are used to select
when an SSP1IF interrupt should be generated. The
function of the DLYCYC bits depends on the SPI
operating mode (Master/Slave), as well as the
DLYINTEN setting. In SPI Master mode, the
REGISTER 20-5:
DLYCYC bits can be used to control how much
time the module will Idle between bytes in a transfer. By
default, the hardware requires a minimum delay of
8 TCY for FOSC/4, 9 TCY for FOSC/16 and 15 TCY for
FOSC/64. An additional delay can be added with the
DLYCYCx bits. In SPI Slave modes, the DLYCYC
bits may optionally be used to trigger an additional
time-out based interrupt.
DMACON2: DMA CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
DLYCYC3
DLYCYC2
DLYCYC1
DLYCYC0
INTLVL3
INTLVL2
INTLVL1
INTLVL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-4
x = Bit is unknown
DLYCYC: Delay Cycle Selection bits
When DLYINTEN = 0, these bits specify the additional delay (above the base overhead of the hardware), in number of TCY cycles, before the SSP2BUF register is written again for the next transfer.
When DLYINTEN = 1, these bits specify the delay in number of TCY cycles from the latest completed
transfer before an interrupt to the CPU is invoked. In this case, the additional delay before the
SSP2BUF register is written again is 1 TCY + (base overhead of hardware).
1111 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 2,048 cycles
1110 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 1,024 cycles
1101 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 896 cycles
1100 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 768 cycles
1011 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 640 cycles
1010 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 512 cycles
1001 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 384 cycles
1000 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 256 cycles
0111 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 128 cycles
0110 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 64 cycles
0101 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 32 cycles
0100 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 16 cycles
0011 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 8 cycles
0010 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 4 cycles
0001 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 2 cycles
0000 = Delay time in number of instruction cycles is 1 cycle
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 361
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 20-5:
bit 3-0
DMACON2: DMA CONTROL REGISTER 2 (CONTINUED)
INTLVL: Watermark Interrupt Enable bits
These bits specify the amount of remaining data yet to be transferred (transmitted and/or received)
upon which an interrupt is generated.
1111 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 576 bytes
1110 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 512 bytes
1101 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 448 bytes
1100 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 384 bytes
1011 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 320 bytes
1010 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 256 bytes
1001 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 192 bytes
1000 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 128 bytes
0111 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 67 bytes
0110 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 32 bytes
0101 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 16 bytes
0100 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 8 bytes
0011 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 4 bytes
0010 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 2 bytes
0001 = Amount of remaining data to be transferred is 1 byte
0000 = Transfer complete
DS30000575C-page 362
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.4.4.3
DMABCH and DMABCL
The DMABCH and DMABCL register pair forms a
10-bit Byte Count register, which is used by the SPI
DMA module to send/receive up to 1,024 bytes for each
DMA transaction. When the DMA module is actively
running (DMAEN = 1), the DMA Byte Count register decrements after each byte is transmitted/received. The
DMA transaction will halt and the DMAEN bit will be
automatically cleared by hardware after the last byte has
completed. After a DMA transaction is complete, the
DMABC register will read 0x000.
Prior to initiating a DMA transaction by setting the
DMAEN bit, user firmware should load the appropriate
value into the DMABCH/DMABCL registers. The
DMABC is a “base zero” counter, so the actual number
of bytes which will be transmitted follows in
Equation 20-1.
DMA module cannot be used to read from the Special
Function Registers (SFRs) contained in Banks 14
and 15.
20.4.4.5
RXADDRH and RXADDRL
The RXADDRH and RXADDRL registers pair together
to form a 12-bit Receive Destination Address Pointer.
In modes that use RXADDR (Full-Duplex and HalfDuplex Receive), the RXADDR register will be
incremented after each byte is received. Received data
bytes will be stored at the memory location pointed to
by the RXADDR register.
For example, if user firmware wants to transmit 7 bytes
in one transaction, DMABC should be loaded with
006h. Similarly, if user firmware wishes to transmit
1,024 bytes, DMABC should be loaded with 3FFh.
EQUATION 20-1:
BYTES TRANSMITTED
FOR A GIVEN DMABC
Bytes XMIT ½ DMABC + 1
20.4.4.4
TXADDRH and TXADDRL
The TXADDRH and TXADDRL registers pair together
to form a 12-bit Transmit Source Address Pointer
register. In modes that use TXADDR (Full-Duplex and
Half-Duplex Transmit), the TXADDR will be incremented after each byte is transmitted. Transmitted data
bytes will be taken from the memory location pointed to
by the TXADDR register. The contents of the memory
locations pointed to by TXADDR will not be modified by
the DMA module during a transmission.
The SPI DMA module can read from, and transmit data
from, all general purpose memory on the device, including memory used for USB endpoint buffers. The SPI
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 363
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
The SPI DMA module can write received data to all
general purpose memory on the device, including
memory used for USB endpoint buffers. The SPI DMA
module cannot be used to modify the Special Function
Registers contained in Banks 14 and 15.
20.4.5
INTERRUPTS
The SPI DMA module alters the behavior of the
SSP1IF interrupt flag. In normal non-DMA modes, the
SSP1IF is set once after every single byte is transmitted/received through the MSSP1 module. When
MSSP1 is used with the SPI DMA module, the SSP1IF
interrupt flag will be set according to the user-selected
INTLVL value specified in the DMACON2
register. The SSP1IF interrupt condition will also be
generated once the SPI DMA transaction has fully
completed and the DMAEN bit has been cleared by
hardware.
The SSP1IF flag becomes set once the DMA byte count
value indicates that the specified INTLVLx has been
reached. For example, if DMACON2 = 0101
(16 bytes remaining), the SSP1IF interrupt flag will
become set once DMABC reaches 00Fh. If user
firmware then clears the SSP1IF interrupt flag, the flag
will not be set again by the hardware until after all bytes
have been fully transmitted and the DMA transaction is
complete.
Note:
User firmware may modify the INTLVLx
bits while a DMA transaction is in progress
(DMAEN = 1). If an INTLVLx value is
selected which is higher than the actual
remaining number of bytes (indicated by
DMABC + 1), the SSP1IF interrupt flag
will immediately become set.
For example, if DMABC = 00Fh (implying 16 bytes are
remaining) and user firmware writes ‘1111’ to
INTLVL (interrupt when 576 bytes are remaining),
the SSP1IF interrupt flag will immediately become set.
If user firmware clears this interrupt flag, a new interrupt condition will not be generated until either: user
firmware again writes INTLVLx with an interrupt level
higher than the actual remaining level, or the DMA
transaction completes and the DMAEN bit is cleared.
Note:
If the INTLVLx bits are modified while a
DMA transaction is in progress, care
should be taken to avoid inadvertently
changing the DLYCYC value.
DS30000575C-page 364
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
20.4.6
USING THE SPI DMA MODULE
The following steps would typically be taken to enable
and use the SPI DMA module:
1.
2.
3.
Configure the I/O pins, which will be used by
MSSP2:
a) Assign SCK1, SDO1, SDI1 and SS1 to the
RPn pins, as appropriate for the SPI mode
which will be used. Only functions which will
be used need to be assigned to a pin.
b) Initialize the associated LATx registers for
the desired Idle SPI bus state.
c) If Open-Drain Output mode on SDO1 and
SCK1 (Master mode) is desired, set
ODCON1.
d) Configure the corresponding TRISx bits for
each I/O pin used.
Configure and enable MSSP1 for the desired
SPI operating mode:
a) Select the desired operating mode (Master
or Slave, SPI Mode 0, 1, 2 and 3) and configure the module by writing to the
SSP1STAT and SSP1CON1 registers.
b) Enable MSSP1 by setting
SSP1CON1 = 1.
Configure the SPI DMA engine:
a) Select the desired operating mode by
writing the appropriate values to DMACON2 and DMACON1.
b) Initialize the TXADDRH/TXADDRL Pointer
(Full-Duplex or Half-Duplex Transmit Only
mode).
c) Initialize the RXADDRH/RXADDRL Pointer
(Full-Duplex or Half-Duplex Receive Only
mode).
d) Initialize the DMABCH/DMABCL Byte
Count register with the number of bytes to
be transferred in the next SPI DMA
operation.
e) Set the DMAEN bit (DMACON1).
indicating the transaction is still in progress.
User firmware would typically use this interrupt condition to begin preparing new data
for the next DMA transaction. Firmware
should not repeat Steps 3.b. through 3.e.
until the DMAEN bit is cleared by the
hardware, indicating the transaction is
complete.
Example 20-3 provides example code, demonstrating
the initialization process and the steps needed to use
the SPI DMA module to perform a 512-byte Full-Duplex
Master mode transfer.
In SPI Master modes, this will initiate a DMA
transaction. In SPI Slave modes, this will complete the initialization process, and the module
will now be ready to begin receiving and/or
transmitting data to the master device once the
master starts the transaction.
4.
Detect the SSP1IF interrupt condition (PIR1 Converted Value > Threshold 1
In this case, both of the following occur:
• The Compare Hit bit (CHHn) for the corresponding channel is set; the Compare Hit bit for the
mirrored channel remains cleared.
• If the Write Mode bits, WM
(ADCON5L), are programmed to '01', the
converted value is written to the buffer, replacing
the lower threshold value. If WM = 10, the
converted value is discarded.
The changes to the result buffer and the Compare Hit
register are shown in Figure 22-14.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 467
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 22-13:
INSIDE WINDOW COMPARISON OPERATION
Before Conversion and Comparison
ADC1BUF15
—
ADC1BUF14
—
ADC1BUF13
—
ADC1BUF12
—
ADC1BUF11
After Conversion and Comparison
Compare Only
(‘10’)
Compare and
Store (‘01’)
ADC1BUF15
—
—
ADC1BUF14
—
—
—
ADC1BUF13
—
—
ADC1BUF10
Threshold 2
ADC1BUF12
—
—
ADC1BUF9
—
ADC1BUF11
—
—
ADC1BUF8
—
ADC1BUF10
Threshold 2
Threshold 2
ADC1BUF7
—
ADC1BUF9
—
—
ADC1BUF6
—
ADC1BUF8
—
—
ADC1BUF5
—
ADC1BUF7
—
—
ADC1BUF4
—
ADC1BUF6
—
—
ADC1BUF3
—
ADC1BUF5
—
—
ADC1BUF2
Threshold 1
ADC1BUF4
—
—
ADC1BUF1
—
ADC1BUF3
—
—
ADC1BUF0
—
ADC1BUF2
Threshold 1
Conversion Value
ADC1BUF1
—
—
ADC1BUF0
—
—
AD1CHITL
AD1CHITL
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
22.7.5.3
Outside Window Comparison
When the Compare Mode bits CM are
programmed as '11', the converter compares the
sampled value to see if it falls outside of the threshold
values in the buffer and mirrored channel location.
Again, since the value in the mirrored channel location
is always the greater value of the two thresholds, the
condition is met when either:
Converted Value >Threshold 2
or
Threshold 1 > Converted Value
In these cases, the following occurs:
• The Compare Hit bit (CHHn) for the corresponding channel is set.
• If the converted value is greater than Threshold
2, the CHHn bit for the mirrored channel is also
set. If it is less than Threshold 1, the mirrored
channel bit remains '0'.
DS30000575C-page 468
• If the Write Mode bits, WM
(ADCON5L), are programmed to '01':
- If the converted value is above Threshold 2,
the converted value is written to the mirrored
channel address, replacing the upper threshold value.
- If the converted value is below Threshold 1,
the converted value is written to the channel
address, replacing the lower threshold value.
• If WM = 10, the converted value is
discarded.
The changes to the result buffer and the Compare Hit
register are shown in Figure 22-15 (over the upper
threshold) and Figure 22-16 (under the lower threshold).
Note that when a Windowed Comparison mode is
selected and channel mirroring is enabled, nothing prevents a conversion from another operation from being
stored in the mirrored channel location. In the previous
examples of windowed operation, if AN10 is included in
a Threshold Detect operation, a conversion on AN10
might be tested against the upper threshold for AN2,
stored in that location. This could result in the threshold
value being overwritten and/or the CHH10 bit being set.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
For this reason, users must always carefully consider
the allocation and use of the upper analog channels
(both external and internal) when using Windowed
Compare modes. Wherever possible, exclude the
upper analog channels for Threshold Detect
operations, and convert and test those channels in a
separate routine.
FIGURE 22-14:
OUTSIDE WINDOW COMPARISON OPERATION (OVER THRESHOLD 2)
Before Conversion and Comparison
ADC1BUF15
—
ADC1BUF14
—
ADC1BUF13
—
After Conversion and Comparison
Compare Only
(‘10’)
Compare and
Store (‘01’)
ADC1BUF15
—
—
—
ADC1BUF14
—
—
—
ADC1BUF13
—
—
Threshold 2
ADC1BUF12
—
—
—
ADC1BUF11
—
—
ADC1BUF8
—
ADC1BUF10
Threshold 2
Conversion Value
ADC1BUF7
—
ADC1BUF9
—
—
—
ADC1BUF8
—
—
—
ADC1BUF7
—
—
—
ADC1BUF6
—
—
—
ADC1BUF5
—
—
Threshold 1
ADC1BUF4
—
—
—
ADC1BUF3
—
—
—
ADC1BUF2
Threshold 1
Threshold 1
ADC1BUF1
—
—
ADC1BUF0
—
—
ADC1BUF12
ADC1BUF11
ADC1BUF10
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF0
AD1CHITL
AD1CHITL
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 469
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 22-15:
OUTSIDE WINDOW COMPARISON OPERATION (UNDER THRESHOLD 1)
Before Conversion and Comparison
ADC1BUF15
—
ADC1BUF14
—
ADC1BUF13
—
ADC1BUF12
—
ADC1BUF11
After Conversion and Comparison
Compare Only
(‘10’)
Compare and
Store (‘01’)
ADC1BUF15
—
—
ADC1BUF14
—
—
—
ADC1BUF13
—
—
ADC1BUF10
Threshold 2
ADC1BUF12
—
—
ADC1BUF9
—
ADC1BUF11
—
—
ADC1BUF8
—
ADC1BUF10
Threshold 2
Threshold 2
ADC1BUF7
—
ADC1BUF9
—
—
ADC1BUF6
—
ADC1BUF8
—
—
ADC1BUF5
—
ADC1BUF7
—
—
ADC1BUF4
—
ADC1BUF6
—
—
ADC1BUF3
—
ADC1BUF5
—
—
ADC1BUF2
Threshold 1
ADC1BUF4
—
—
ADC1BUF1
—
ADC1BUF3
—
—
ADC1BUF0
—
ADC1BUF2
Threshold 1
Conversion Value
ADC1BUF1
—
—
ADC1BUF0
—
—
AD1CHITL
22.8
22.8.1
AD1CHITL
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Examples
INITIALIZATION
Example 22-1 shows a simple initialization code
example for the A/D module. Operation in Idle mode is
disabled, output data is in unsigned fractional format,
and AVDD and AVSS are used for VR+ and VR-. The
start of sampling, as well as the start of conversion
(conversion trigger), are performed directly in software.
Scanning of inputs is disabled and an interrupt occurs
after every sample/convert sequence (one conversion
result) with only one channel (AN0) being converted.
The A/D conversion clock is TCY/2.
DS30000575C-page 470
In this particular configuration, all 16 analog input pins
are set up as analog inputs. It is important to note that
with this A/D module, I/O pins are configured for analog
or digital operation at the I/O port with the ANSn Analog
Select registers. The use of these registers is
described in detail in the I/O Port chapter of the specific
device data sheet.
This example shows one method of controlling a
sample/convert sequence by manually setting and
clearing the SAMP bit (ADCON1L). This method,
among others, is more fully discussed in Section 22.4
“Controlling the Sampling Process” and Section
22.5 “Controlling the Conversion Process”.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 22-3:
A/D INITIALIZATION CODE EXAMPLE
ADCON1H = 0x22;
// Configure sample clock source
ADCON1L = 0x00;
// and conversion trigger mode.
// Unsigned Fraction format (FORM=10),
// Manual conversion trigger (SSRC=0000),
// Manual start of sampling (ASAM=0),
// S/H in Sample (SAMP = 1)
ADCON2H = 0;
// Configure A/D voltage reference
ADCON2L = 0;
// and buffer fill modes.
// Vr+ and Vr- from AVdd and AVss(PVCFG=00, NVCFG=0),
// Inputs are not scanned,
// Interrupt after every sample
ADCON3H = 0;
// Configure sample time = 1Tad,
ADCON3L = 0;
// A/D conversion clock as Tcy
ADCHS0H = 0;
// Configure input channels,
ADCHS0L = 0;
// S/H+ input is AN0,
// S/H- input is Vr- (AVss).
ADCSS0L = 0;
// No inputs are scanned.
ADCSS0H = 0;
// No inputs are scanned.
PIR1bits.ADIF = 0;
// Clear A/D conversion interrupt.
// Configure A/D interrupt priority bits (ADIP) here, if
// required. Default priority level is high.
PIE1bits.ADIE = 1;
// Enable A/D conversion interrupt
ADCON1Hbits.ADON = 1;
// Turn on A/D
ADCON1Lbits.SAMP = 1;
// Start sampling the input
Delay();
// Ensure the correct sampling time has elapsed
// before starting conversion.
ADCON1Lbits.SAMP = 0;
// End A/D sampling and start conversion
// Example code for A/D ISR:
#pragma interrupt _ADC1Interrupt
void _ADC1Interrupt(void)
{
PIR1bits.ADIF = 0;
}
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 471
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
22.8.2
CONVERSION SEQUENCE
EXAMPLES
22.8.2.1
The following configuration examples show the A/D
operation in different sampling and buffering configurations. In each example, setting the ASAM bit starts
automatic sampling. A conversion trigger ends
sampling and starts conversion.
Sampling and Converting a Single
Channel Multiple Times
In this case Figure 22-16, one A/D input, AN0, will be
sampled and converted. The results are stored in the
ADCBUFn buffer. This process repeats 16 times until
the buffer is full and then the module generates an
interrupt. The entire process will then repeat.
With the ALTS bit clear, only the MUX A inputs are
active. The CH0SAx and CH0NAx bits are specified
(AN0 - VR-) as the inputs to the Sample-and-Hold
channel. All other input selection bits are unused.
FIGURE 22-16:
CONVERTING ONE CHANNEL 16 TIMES PER INTERRUPT
Conversion
Trigger
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
A/D CLK
TCONV
Analog Input
AN0
TCONV
AN0
TCONV
AN0
TCONV
AN0
ASAM
SAMP
DONE
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUFE
ADC1BUFF
AD1IF
BSF AD1CON1, ASAM
DS30000575C-page 472
Instruction Execution
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 22-4:
CONVERTING A SINGLE CHANNEL 16 TIMES PER INTERRUPT
A/D Configuration:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Select AN0 for S/H+ Input (CH0SA = 00000)
Select VR- for S/H- Input (CH0NA = 000)
Configure for No Input Scan (CSCNA = 0)
Use Only MUX A for Sampling (ALTS = 0)
Set AD1IF on Every 16th Sample (SMPI = 01111)
Configure Buffers for Single, 16-Word Results (BUFM = 0)
Operational Sequence:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 0h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 1h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 2h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 3h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 4h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 5h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 6h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 7h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 8h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 9h.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Ah.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Bh.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Ch.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Dh.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Eh.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer Fh.
Set AD1IF Flag (and generate interrupt, if enabled).
Repeat (1-16) After Return from Interrupt.
Results Stored in Buffer (after 2 cycles):
Buffer
Address
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF7
ADC1BUF8
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUFA
ADC1BUFB
ADC1BUFC
ADC1BUFD
ADC1BUFE
ADC1BUFF
Buffer Contents
at 1st AD1IF Event
AN0, Sample 1
AN0, Sample 2
AN0, Sample 3
AN0, Sample 4
AN0, Sample 5
AN0, Sample 6
AN0, Sample 7
AN0, Sample 8
AN0, Sample 9
AN0, Sample 10
AN0, Sample 11
AN0, Sample 12
AN0, Sample 13
AN0, Sample 14
AN0, Sample 15
AN0, Sample 16
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Buffer Contents
at 2nd AD1IF Event
AN0, Sample 17
AN0, Sample 18
AN0, Sample 19
AN0, Sample 20
AN0, Sample 21
AN0, Sample 22
AN0, Sample 23
AN0, Sample 24
AN0, Sample 25
AN0, Sample 26
AN0, Sample 27
AN0, Sample 28
AN0, Sample 29
AN0, Sample 30
AN0, Sample 31
AN0, Sample 32
DS30000575C-page 473
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
22.8.2.2
A/D Conversions While Scanning
Through All Analog Inputs
Other conditions are similar to those located in Section
Section 22.8.2.1 “Sampling and Converting a
Single Channel Multiple Times”.
Figure 22-17 and Example 22-5 illustrate a typical
setup, where all available analog input channels are
sampled and converted. In this instance, 16 analog
inputs are assumed. The set CSCNA bit specifies
scanning of the A/D inputs to the S/H positive input.
FIGURE 22-17:
Initially, the AN0 input is sampled and converted. The
result is stored in the ADCBUFn buffer. Then, the AN1
input is sampled and converted. This process of scanning the inputs repeats 16 times, until the buffer is full,
and then the module generates an interrupt. The entire
process will then repeat.
SCANNING ALL 16 INPUTS PER SINGLE INTERRUPT
Conversion
Trigger
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
A/D CLK
TCONV
Analog Input
AN0
TCONV
AN1
TCONV
AN14
TCONV
AN15
ASAM
SAMP
DONE
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUFE
ADC1BUFF
AD1IF
BSET AD1CON1, #ASAM
DS30000575C-page 474
Instruction Execution
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 22-5:
SCANNING AND CONVERTING ALL 16 CHANNELS PER SINGLE INTERRUPT
A/D Configuration:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Select Any Channel for S/H+ Input (CH0SA = xxxxx)
Select VR- for S/H- Input (CH0NA = 000)
Use Only MUX A for Sampling (ALTS = 0)
Configure MUX A for Input Scan (CSCNA = 1)
Include All Analog Channels in Scanning (AD1CSSL = 1111 1111 1111 1111)
Set AD1IF on Every 16th Sample (SMPI = 01111)
Configure Buffers for Single, 16-Word Results (BUFM = 0)
Operational Sequence:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
Sample MUX A Input AN0; Convert and Write to Buffer 0h.
Sample MUX A Input AN1; Convert and Write to Buffer 1h.
Sample MUX A Input AN2; Convert and Write to Buffer 2h.
Sample MUX A Input AN3; Convert and Write to Buffer 3h.
Sample MUX A Input AN4; Convert and Write to Buffer 4h.
Sample MUX A Input AN5; Convert and Write to Buffer 5h.
Sample MUX A Input AN6; Convert and Write to Buffer 6h.
Sample MUX A Input AN7; Convert and Write to Buffer 7h.
Sample MUX A Input AN8; Convert and Write to Buffer 8h.
Sample MUX A Input AN9; Convert and Write to Buffer 9h.
Sample MUX A Input AN10; Convert and Write to Buffer Ah.
Sample MUX A Input AN11; Convert and Write to Buffer Bh.
Sample MUX A Input AN12; Convert and Write to Buffer Ch.
Sample MUX A Input AN13; Convert and Write to Buffer Dh.
Sample MUX A Input AN14; Convert and Write to Buffer Eh.
Sample MUX A Input AN15; Convert and Write to Buffer Fh.
Set AD1IF Flag (and generate interrupt, if enabled).
Repeat (1-16) after Return from Interrupt.
Results Stored in Buffer (after 2 cycles):
Buffer
Address
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF7
ADC1BUF8
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUF10
ADC1BUF11
ADC1BUF12
ADC1BUF13
ADC1BUF14
ADC1BUF15
Buffer Contents
at 1st AD1IF Event
Sample 1 (AN0, Sample 1)
Sample 2 (AN1, Sample 1)
Sample 3 (AN2, Sample 1)
Sample 4 (AN3, Sample 1)
Sample 5 (AN4, Sample 1)
Sample 6 (AN5, Sample 1)
Sample 7 (AN6, Sample 1)
Sample 8 (AN7, Sample 1)
Sample 9 (AN8, Sample 1)
Sample 10 (AN9, Sample 1)
Sample 11 (AN10, Sample 1)
Sample 12 (AN11, Sample 1)
Sample 13 (AN12, Sample 1)
Sample 14 (AN13, Sample 1)
Sample 15 (AN14, Sample 1)
Sample 16 (AN15, Sample 1)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Buffer Contents
at 2nd AD1IF Event
Sample 17 (AN0, Sample 2)
Sample 18 (AN1, Sample 2)
Sample 19 (AN2, Sample 2)
Sample 20 (AN3, Sample 2)
Sample 21 (AN4, Sample 2)
Sample 22 (AN5, Sample 2)
Sample 23 (AN6, Sample 2)
Sample 24 (AN7, Sample 2)
Sample 25 (AN8, Sample 2)
Sample 26 (AN9, Sample 2)
Sample 27 (AN10, Sample 2)
Sample 28 (AN11, Sample 2)
Sample 29 (AN12, Sample 2)
Sample 30 (AN13, Sample 2)
Sample 31 (AN14, Sample 2)
Sample 32 (AN15, Sample 2)
DS30000575C-page 475
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
22.8.3
USING DUAL BUFFERS
Figure 22-18 and Example 22-6 demonstrate using
dual buffers and alternating the buffer fill.
Setting the BUFM bit enables dual buffers. In this
example, an interrupt is generated after each sample.
The BUFM setting does not affect other operational
parameters. First, the conversion sequence starts
filling the buffer at ADCBUF0. After the first interrupt
occurs, the buffer begins to fill at ADCBUF8. The BUFS
Status bit is toggled after each interrupt.
FIGURE 22-18:
CONVERTING A SINGLE CHANNEL, ONCE PER INTERRUPT, USING DUAL,
8-WORD BUFFERS
Conversion
Trigger
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
A/D CLK
TCONVTCONVTCONVTCONV
Analog Input
AN3
TCONVTCONVTCONVTCONV
TCONVTCONVTCONVTCONV
AN3
AN3
BCLR IFS0, #AD1IF
BCLR IFS0, #AD1IF
SAMP
BUFS
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF8
AD1IF
BSET AD1CON1, #ASAM
DS30000575C-page 476
Instruction Execution
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 22-6:
CONVERTING A SINGLE CHANNEL, ONCE PER INTERRUPT, DUAL BUFFER
MODE
A/D Configuration:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Select AN3 for S/H+ Input (CH0SA = 00011)
Select VR- for S/H- Input (CH0NA = 000)
Configure for No Input Scan (CSCNA = 0)
Use Only MUX A for Sampling (ALTS = 0)
Set AD1IF on Every Sample (SMPI = 00000)
Configure Buffer as Dual, 8-Word Segments (BUFM = 1)
Operational Sequence:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Sample MUX A Input, AN3; Convert and Write to Buffer 0h.
Set AD1IF Flag (and generate interrupt, if enabled); Write Access Automatically
Switches to Alternate Buffer.
Sample MUX A Input, AN3; Convert and Write to Buffer 8h.
Set AD1IF Flag (and generate interrupt, if enabled); Write Access Automatically
Switches to Alternate Buffer.
Repeat (1-4).
Results Stored in Buffer (after 2 cycles):
Buffer
Address
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF7
ADC1BUF8
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUFA
ADC1BUFB
ADC1BUFC
ADC1BUFD
ADC1BUFE
ADC1BUFF
22.8.3.1
Buffer Contents
at 1st AD1IF Event
Sample 1 (AN3, Sample 1)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
Buffer Contents
at 2nd AD1IF Event
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
Sample 2 (AN3, Sample 2)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
Using Alternating MUX A and MUX
B Input Selections
Figure 22-19 and Example 22-7 demonstrate alternate
sampling of the inputs assigned to MUX A and MUX B.
Setting the ALTS bit enables alternating input selections. The first sample uses the MUX A inputs specified
by the CH0SAx and CH0NAx bits. The next sample
uses the MUX B inputs, specified by the CH0SBx and
CH0NBx bits.
This example also demonstrates use of the dual,
8-word buffers. An interrupt occurs after every 8th
sample, resulting in filling eight words into the buffer on
each interrupt.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 477
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 22-19:
Conversion
Trigger
CONVERTING TWO INPUTS USING ALTERNATING INPUT SELECTIONS
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
TSAMP
A/D CLK
TCONVTCONV
Analog
Input
AN1
TCONVTCONV
AN15
TCONVTCONV
AN15
TCONVTCONV
AN1
TCONVTCONV
AN15
ASAM
SAMP
Cleared
in Software
DONE
BUFS
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF7
ADC1BUF8
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUFA
ADC1BUFB
AD1IF
Cleared by Software
DS30000575C-page 478
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 22-7:
CONVERTING TWO INPUTS BY ALTERNATING MUX A AND MUX B
A/D Configuration:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Select AN1 for MUX A S/H+ Input (CH0SA = 00001)
Select VR- for MUX A S/H- Input (CH0NA = 000)
Configure for No Input Scan (CSCNA = 0)
Select AN15 for MUX B S/H+ Input (CH0SB = 11111)
Select VR- for MUX B S/H- Input (CH0NB = 000)
Alternate MUX A and MUX B for Sampling (ALTS = 1)
Set AD1IF on Every 8th Sample (SMPI = 00111)
Configure Buffer as Two, 8-Word Segments (BUFM = 1)
Operational Sequence:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Sample MUX A Input AN1; Convert and Write to Buffer 0h.
Sample MUX B Input AN15; Convert and Write to Buffer 1h.
Sample MUX A Input AN1; Convert and Write to Buffer 2h.
Sample MUX B Input AN15; Convert and Write to Buffer 3h.
Sample MUX A Input AN1; Convert and Write to Buffer 4h.
Sample MUX B Input AN15; Convert and Write to Buffer 5h.
Sample MUX A Input AN1; Convert and Write to Buffer 6h.
Sample MUX B Input AN15; Convert and Write to Buffer 7h.
Set AD1IF Flag (and generate interrupt, if enabled); Write Access Automatically
Switches to Alternate Buffer.
10. Repeat (1-9); Resume Writing to Buffer with Buffer 8h (first address of alternate buffer).
Results Stored in Buffer (after 2 cycles):
Buffer
Address
ADC1BUF0
ADC1BUF1
ADC1BUF2
ADC1BUF3
ADC1BUF4
ADC1BUF5
ADC1BUF6
ADC1BUF7
ADC1BUF8
ADC1BUF9
ADC1BUFA
ADC1BUFB
ADC1BUFC
ADC1BUFD
ADC1BUFE
ADC1BUFF
Buffer Contents
at 1st AD1IF Event
Sample 1 (AN1, Sample 1)
Sample 2 (AN15, Sample 1)
Sample 3 (AN1, Sample 2)
Sample 4 (AN15, Sample 2)
Sample 5 (AN1, Sample 3)
Sample 6 (AN15, Sample 3)
Sample 7 (AN1, Sample 4)
Sample 8 (AN15, Sample 4)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Buffer Contents
at 2nd AD1IF Event
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
(undefined)
Sample 9 (AN1, Sample 5)
Sample 10 (AN15, Sample 5)
Sample 11 (AN1, Sample 6)
Sample 12 (AN15, Sample 6)
Sample 13 (AN1, Sample 7)
Sample 14 (AN15, Sample 7)
Sample 15 (AN1, Sample 8)
Sample 16 (AN15, Sample 8)
DS30000575C-page 479
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
22.9
A/D Sampling Requirements
The Analog Input model of the 12-bit A/D Converter is
shown in Figure 22-20. The total sampling time for the
A/D is a function of the holding capacitor charge time.
For the A/D Converter to meet its specified accuracy,
the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed
to fully charge to the voltage level on the analog input
pin. The source impedance (RS), the interconnect
impedance (RIC) and the internal sampling switch
(RSS) impedance combine to directly affect the time
required to charge CHOLD. The combined impedance
of the analog sources must, therefore, be small enough
FIGURE 22-20:
to fully charge the holding capacitor within the chosen
sample time. To minimize the effects of pin leakage
currents on the accuracy of the A/D Converter, the
maximum recommended source impedance, RS, is
2.5 k. After the analog input channel is selected
(changed), this sampling function must be completed
prior to starting the conversion. The internal holding
capacitor will be in a discharged state prior to each
sample operation.
At least 1 TAD time period should be allowed between
conversions for the sample time. For more details, see
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”.
12-BIT A/D CONVERTER ANALOG INPUT MODEL
RIC 250
Rs
VA
ANx
Sampling
Switch
RSS
CPIN
RSS 3 k
CHOLD
= 4.4 pF
ILEAKAGE
500 nA
VSS
Legend: CPIN
= Input Capacitance
= Threshold Voltage
VT
ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the Pin due to
Various Junctions
RIC
= Interconnect Resistance
RSS
= Sampling Switch Resistance
CHOLD
= Sample/Hold Capacitance (from DAC)
Note: CPIN value depends on device package and is not tested. The effect of the CPIN is negligible if Rs 5 k.
22.10 Transfer Functions
For the 12-bit transfer function:
The transfer functions of the A/D Converter, in 12-bit
and 10-bit resolution, are shown in Figure 22-21 and
Figure 22-22, respectively. In both cases, the difference of the input voltages, (VINH - VINL), is compared
to the reference, ((VR+) - (VR-)).
• The first code transition occurs when the input
voltage is ((VR+) - (VR-))/4096 or 1.0 LSb.
• The '0000 0000 0001' code is centered at VR+ (1.5 * ((VR+) - (VR-)) / 4096).
• The '0010 0000 0000' code is centered at
VREFL + (2048.5 * ((VR+) - (VR-)) /4096).
• An input voltage less than VR- + (((VR-) - (VR-)) /
4096) converts as '0000 0000 0000'.
• An input voltage greater than (VR-) + (4096
((VR+) - (VR-))/4096) converts as '1111 1111
1111'.
DS30000575C-page 480
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 22-21:
12-BIT A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
Output Code
(Binary (Decimal))
1111 1111 1111 (4095)
1111 1111 1110 (4094)
0010 0000 0011 (2051)
0010 0000 0010 (2050)
0010 0000 0001 (2049)
0010 0000 0000 (2048)
0001 1111 1111 (2047)
0001 1111 1110 (2046)
0001 1111 1101 (2045)
0000 0000 0001 (1)
(VINH – VINL)
VR+
4096
4095 * (VR + – VR-)
VR- +
4096
VR- +
2048 * (VR+ – VR-)
4096
VR- +
Voltage Level
VR+ – VR-
0
VR-
0000 0000 0000 (0)
For the 10-bit transfer function (when 10-bit resolution
is available):
• The first code transition occurs when the input
voltage is ((VR+) - (VR-))/1024 or 1.0 LSb.
• The '00 0000 0001' code is centered at VR- +
(1.5 * (((VR+) - (VR-)) / 1024).
• The '10 0000 0000' code is centered at VREFL
+ (512.5 * (((VR+) - (VR-)) /1024).
• An input voltage less than VR- + (((VR-) - (VR-)) /
1024) converts as '00 0000 0000'.
• An input voltage greater than (VR-) + ((1023
(VR+)) - (VR-))/1024) converts as '11 1111
1111'.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 481
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 22-22:
10-BIT A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
Output Code
(Binary (Decimal))
11 1111 1111 (1023)
11 1111 1110 (1022)
10 0000 0011 (515)
10 0000 0010 (514)
10 0000 0001 (513)
10 0000 0000 (512)
01 1111 1111 (511)
01 1111 1110 (510)
01 1111 1101 (509)
00 0000 0001 (1)
(VINH – VINL)
VR+
1024
1023 * (VR+ – VR-)
VR- +
1024
VR- +
512 * (VR+ – VR-)
1024
VR- +
Voltage Level
VR+ – VR-
0
VR-
00 0000 0000 (0)
22.11 Operation During Sleep and Idle
Modes
22.11.2
Sleep and Idle modes are useful for minimizing conversion noise because the digital activity of the CPU,
buses and other peripherals is minimized.
The A/D module can operate during Sleep mode if the
A/D clock source is set to the internal A/D RC oscillator
(ADRC = 1). This eliminates digital switching noise
from the conversion. When the conversion is
completed, the DONE bit will be set and the result is
loaded into the A/D Result Buffer n, ADCBUFn.
22.11.1
CPU SLEEP MODE WITHOUT RC A/
D CLOCK
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic '0'.
If Sleep occurs in the middle of a conversion, the
conversion is aborted unless the A/D is clocked from its
internal RC clock generator. The converter will not
resume a partially completed conversion on exiting
from Sleep mode.
Register contents are not affected by the device
entering or leaving Sleep mode.
DS30000575C-page 482
CPU SLEEP MODE WITH RC A/D
CLOCK
If the A/D interrupt is enabled (ADIE = 1), the device will
wake-up from Sleep when the A/D interrupt occurs.
Program execution will resume at the A/D Interrupt
Service Routine (ISR). After the ISR completes execution will continue from the instruction after the SLEEP
instruction that placed the device in Sleep mode.
If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the A/D module will
then be turned off, although the ADON bit will remain
set.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
To minimize the effects of digital noise on the A/D
module operation, the user should select a conversion
trigger source that ensures the A/D conversion will take
place in Sleep mode. The automatic conversion trigger
option can be used for sampling and conversion in
Sleep (SSRC = 0111). To use the automatic
conversion option, the ADON bit should be set in the
instruction prior to the SLEEP instruction.
Note:
For the A/D module to operate in Sleep,
the A/D clock source must be set to RC
(ADRC = 1).
22.11.3
A/D OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
The module will continue normal operation when the
device enters Idle mode. If the A/D interrupt is enabled
(ADIE = 1), the device will wake-up from Idle mode
when the A/D interrupt occurs. If the respective global
interrupt enable bit(s) are also set, program execution
will resume at the A/D Interrupt Service Routine (ISR).
After the ISR completes, execution will continue from
the instruction after the SLEEP instruction that placed
the device in Idle mode.
22.11.4
PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE
(PMD) REGISTER
The Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) registers
provide a method to disable the A/D module by stopping all clock sources supplied to that module. When a
peripheral is disabled via the appropriate PMDx control
bit, the peripheral is in a minimum power consumption
state. The control and STATUS registers associated
with the peripheral will also be disabled, so writes to
those registers will have no effect and read values will
be invalid. The A/D module is enabled only when the
ADCMD bit in the PMD3 register is cleared.
2.
3.
is complete. These timing specifications are
provided in the “Electrical Characteristics”
section of the device data sheets.
Often, the source impedance of the analog
signal is high (greater than 2.5 k), so the
current drawn from the source by leakage, and
to charge the sample capacitor, can affect
accuracy. If the input signal does not change too
quickly, try putting a 0.1 uF capacitor on the
analog input. This capacitor will charge to the
analog voltage being sampled and supply the
instantaneous current needed to charge the
internal holding capacitor.
Put the device into Sleep mode before the start
of the A/D conversion. The RC clock source
selection is required for conversions in Sleep
mode. This technique increases accuracy,
because digital noise from the CPU and other
peripherals is minimized.
Question 2: Do you know of a good reference on A/
D Converters?
Answer: A good reference for understanding A/D
conversions is the “Analog-Digital Conversion
Handbook third edition, published by Prentice Hall
(ISBN 0-13-03-2848-0).
Question 3: My combination of channels/samples
and samples/interrupt is greater than the size of the
buffer. What will happen to the buffer?
Answer: This configuration is not recommended. The
buffer will contain unknown results.
22.13 Related Application Notes
Question 1: How can I optimize the system performance of the A/D Converter?
This section lists application notes that are related to
this section of the data sheet. These application notes
may not be written specifically for the PIC18F device
family, but the concepts are pertinent and could be
used with modification and possible limitations. The
current application notes related to the 12-Bit A/D
Converter with Threshold Detect module are:
Answer: There are three main things to consider in
optimizing A/D performance:
AN546, Using the Analog-to-Digital (A/D) Converter
(DS00546)
1.
AN557, Four-Channel Digital Voltmeter with Display
and Keyboard (DS00557)
22.12 Design Tips
Make sure you are meeting all of the timing
specifications. If you are turning the module off
and on, there is a minimum delay you must wait
before taking a sample. If you are changing
input channels, there is a minimum delay you
must wait for this as well, and finally, there is
TAD, which is the time selected for each bit
conversion. This is selected in AD1CON3 and
should be within a certain range, as specified in
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”. If
TAD is too short, the result may not be fully converted before the con- version is terminated, and
if TAD is made too long, the voltage on the sampling capacitor can decay before the conversion
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
AN693, Understanding A/D Converter Performance
Specifications (DS00693)
Note:
Visit the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com) for additional application notes
and code examples for the PIC18F family
of devices.
DS30000575C-page 483
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
23.0
COMPARATOR MODULE
23.1
The analog comparator module contains three comparators that can be independently configured in a variety
of ways. The inputs can be selected from the analog
inputs and two internal voltage references. The digital
outputs are available at the pin level, via PPS-Lite, and
can also be read through the control register. Multiple
output and interrupt event generations are also available. A generic single comparator from the module is
shown in Figure 23-1.
Registers
The CMxCON registers (CM1CON, CM2CON and
CM3CON) select the input and output configuration for
each comparator, as well as the settings for interrupt
generation (see Register 23-1).
The CMSTAT register (Register 23-2) provides the output results of the comparators. The bits in this register
are read-only.
Key features of the module includes:
•
•
•
•
•
Independent comparator control
Programmable input configuration
Output to both pin and register levels
Programmable output polarity
Independent interrupt generation for each
comparator with configurable interrupt-on-change
FIGURE 23-1:
COMPARATOR SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM
CxOUT
(CMSTAT)
CCH
CxINB
0
CxINC
1
C2INB/C2IND(1)
2
VBG
3
Interrupt
Logic
CMPxIF
EVPOL
CREF
COE
VIN-
Note 1:
CxINA
0
CVREF
1
VIN+
Cx
Polarity
Logic
CON
CPOL
CxOUT
Comparator 1 and Comparator 3 use C2INB as an input to the inverted terminal. Comparator 2 uses C2IND as an
input to the inverted terminal.
DS30000575C-page 484
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 23-1:
CMxCON: COMPARATOR CONTROL x REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
CON
COE
CPOL
EVPOL1
EVPOL0
CREF
CCH1
CCH0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CON: Comparator Enable bit
1 = Comparator is enabled
0 = Comparator is disabled
bit 6
COE: Comparator Output Enable bit
1 = Comparator output is present on the CxOUT pin
0 = Comparator output is internal only
bit 5
CPOL: Comparator Output Polarity Select bit
1 = Comparator output is inverted
0 = Comparator output is not inverted
bit 4-3
EVPOL: Interrupt Polarity Select bits
11 = Interrupt generation on any change of the output(1)
10 = Interrupt generation only on high-to-low transition of the output
01 = Interrupt generation only on low-to-high transition of the output
00 = Interrupt generation is disabled
bit 2
CREF: Comparator Reference Select bit (non-inverting input)
1 = Non-inverting input connects to internal CVREF voltage
0 = Non-inverting input connects to CxINA pin
bit 1-0
CCH: Comparator Channel Select bits
11 = Inverting input of comparator connects to VBG
10 = Inverting input of comparator connects to C2INB pin
01 = Inverting input of comparator connects to CxINC pin
00 = Inverting input of comparator connects to CxINx pin(2)
Note 1:
2:
x = Bit is unknown
The CMPxIF is automatically set any time this mode is selected and must be cleared by the application
after the initial configuration.
Comparator 1 and Comparator 3 use C2INB as an input to the inverting terminal. Comparator 2 uses
C2IND as an input to the inverting terminal.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 485
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 23-2:
CMSTAT: COMPARATOR STATUS REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R-x
R-x
R-x
—
—
—
—
—
C3OUT
C2OUT
C1OUT
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
C3OUT:C1OUT: Comparator x Status bits
If CPOL (CMxCON)= 0 (non-inverted polarity):
1 = Comparator x’s VIN+ > VIN0 = Comparator x’s VIN+ < VINCPOL = 1 (inverted polarity):
1 = Comparator x’s VIN+ < VIN0 = Comparator x’s VIN+ > VIN-
23.2
Comparator Operation
A single comparator is shown in Figure 23-2, along with
the relationship between the analog input levels and
the digital output. When the analog input at VIN+ is less
than the analog input, VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital low level. When the analog input at VIN+
is greater than the analog input, VIN-, the output of the
comparator is a digital high level. The shaded areas of
the output of the comparator in Figure 23-2 represent
the uncertainty due to input offsets and response time.
FIGURE 23-2:
VIN-
SINGLE COMPARATOR
–
Output
VIN+
+
x = Bit is unknown
comparator input change. Otherwise, the maximum
delay of the comparators should be used (see
Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”).
23.4
Analog Input Connection
Considerations
A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in
Figure 23-3. Since the analog pins are connected to a
digital output, they have reverse biased diodes to VDD
and VSS. The analog input, therefore, must be between
VSS and VDD. If the input voltage deviates from this
range by more than 0.6V in either direction, one of the
diodes is forward biased and a latch-up condition may
occur.
A maximum source impedance of 10 k is
recommended for the analog sources. Any external
component connected to an analog input pin, such as
a capacitor or a Zener diode, should have very little
leakage current.
VINVIN+
Output
23.3
Comparator Response Time
Response time is the minimum time, after selecting a
new reference voltage or input source, before the comparator output has a valid level. The response time of
the comparator differs from the settling time of the voltage reference. Therefore, both of these times must be
considered when determining the total response to a
DS30000575C-page 486
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 23-3:
COMPARATOR ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
RIC
RS
CxINA Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 0, CCH = 00
CxOUT
Pin
Comparator CxINC > CxINA Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 0, CCH = 01
COE
CxINB
CxINA
COE
VINVIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
Comparator C2IND/C2INB > CxINA Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 0, CCH = 10
CxINC
VIN-
CxINA
VIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
Comparator VBG > CxINA Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 0, CCH = 11
COE
C2IND/
C2INB
CxINA
COE
VINVIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
Comparator CxINB > CVREF Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 1, CCH = 00
VBG
VIN-
CxINA
VIN+
Cx
Comparator CxINC > CVREF Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 1, CCH = 01
COE
CxINB
CVREF
COE
VINVIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
CxINC
VIN-
CVREF
VIN+
Cx
COE
CVREF
Note 1:
COE
VINVIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
Comparator VBG > CVREF Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 1, CCH = 11
Comparator C2IND/C2INB > CVREF Compare
CON = 1, CREF = 1, CCH = 10
C2IND/
C2INB
CxOUT
Pin
CxOUT
Pin
VBG
VIN-
CVREF
VIN+
Cx
CxOUT
Pin
VBG is the Internal Reference Voltage (see Table 30-14).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 489
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
23.6
Comparator Interrupts
The comparator interrupt flag is set whenever any of
the following occurs:
• Low-to-high transition of the comparator output
• High-to-low transition of the comparator output
• Any change in the comparator output
The comparator interrupt selection is done by the
EVPOL bits in the CMxCON register
(CMxCON).
In order to provide maximum flexibility, the output of the
comparator may be inverted using the CPOL bit in the
CMxCON register (CMxCON). This is functionally
identical to reversing the inverting and non-inverting
inputs of the comparator for a particular mode.
An interrupt is generated on the low-to-high or high-tolow transition of the comparator output. This mode of
interrupt generation is dependent on EVPOL in
the CMxCON register. When EVPOL = 01 or 10,
the interrupt is generated on a low-to-high or high-tolow transition of the comparator output. Once the
interrupt is generated, it is required to clear the interrupt
flag by software.
TABLE 23-2:
When EVPOL = 11, the comparator interrupt flag
is set whenever there is a change in the output value of
either comparator. Software will need to maintain
information about the status of the output bits, as read
from CMSTAT, to determine the actual change
that occurred.
The CMPxIF (PIR6) bits are the Comparator Interrupt Flags. The CMPxIF bits must be reset by
clearing them. Since it is also possible to write a ‘1’ to
this register, a simulated interrupt may be initiated.
Table 23-2 shows the interrupt generation with respect
to comparator input voltages and EVPOL bit settings.
Both the CMPxIE bits (PIE6) and the PEIE bit
(INTCON) must be set to enable the interrupt. In
addition, the GIE bit (INTCON) must also be set. If
any of these bits are clear, the interrupt is not enabled,
though the CMPxIF bits will still be set if an interrupt
condition occurs.
A simplified diagram of the interrupt section is shown in
Figure 23-3.
Note:
CMPxIF will not
EVPOL = 00.
be
set
when
COMPARATOR INTERRUPT GENERATION
CPOL
EVPOL
00
01
0
10
11
00
01
1
10
11
DS30000575C-page 490
Comparator
Input Change
CxOUT Transition
Interrupt
Generated
VIN+ > VIN-
Low-to-High
No
VIN+ < VIN-
High-to-Low
No
VIN+ > VIN-
Low-to-High
Yes
VIN+ < VIN-
High-to-Low
No
VIN+ > VIN-
Low-to-High
No
VIN+ < VIN-
High-to-Low
Yes
VIN+ > VIN-
Low-to-High
Yes
VIN+ < VIN-
High-to-Low
Yes
VIN+ > VIN-
High-to-Low
No
VIN+ < VIN-
Low-to-High
No
VIN+ > VIN-
High-to-Low
No
VIN+ < VIN-
Low-to-High
Yes
VIN+ > VIN-
High-to-Low
Yes
VIN+ < VIN-
Low-to-High
No
VIN+ > VIN-
High-to-Low
Yes
VIN+ < VIN-
Low-to-High
Yes
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
23.7
Comparator Operation
During Sleep
When a comparator is active and the device is placed
in Sleep mode, the comparator remains active and the
interrupt is functional, if enabled. This interrupt will
wake-up the device from Sleep mode when enabled.
Each operational comparator will consume additional
current.
23.8
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces the CMxCON registers to their
Reset state. This forces both comparators and the
voltage reference to the OFF state.
To minimize power consumption while in Sleep mode,
turn off the comparators (CON = 0) before entering
Sleep. If the device wakes up from Sleep, the contents
of the CMxCON register are not affected.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 491
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
24.0
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE
REFERENCE MODULE
EQUATION 24-1:
If CVRSS = 1:
The comparator voltage reference is a 32-tap resistor
ladder network that provides a selectable reference
voltage. Although its primary purpose is to provide a
reference for the analog comparators, it may also be
used independently of them.
A block diagram of the module is shown in Figure 24-1.
The resistor ladder is segmented to provide a range of
CVREF values and has a power-down function to
conserve power when the reference is not being used.
The module’s supply reference can be provided from
either device VDD/VSS or an external voltage reference.
24.1
Configuring the Comparator
Voltage Reference
The comparator voltage reference module is controlled
through the CVRCONH register (Register 24-1). The
comparator voltage reference provides a range of
output voltage with 32 levels.
CVR
CVREF =( VREF- +
) • (VREF+ – VREF-)
32
If CVRSS = 0:
CVR
CVREF =( AVSS +
) • (AVDD – AVSS)
32
The comparator voltage reference supply can come
from either VDD and VSS, or the external VREF+ and
VREF- that are multiplexed with RA3 and RA2. The
voltage source is selected by the CVRPSS bits
(CVRCONL).
The settling time of the comparator voltage reference
must be considered when changing the CVREF output (see Table 30-13 in Section 30.0 “Electrical
Specifications”).
The CVR selection bits (CVRCONH) offer a
range of output voltages. Equation 24-1 shows how the
comparator voltage reference is computed.
REGISTER 24-1:
CVRCONH: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER HIGH
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
CVR4
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
CVR: Comparator VREF Value Selection 0 CVR 31 bits
CVREF = VNEGSRC + (CVR/32) • (VPOSSRC – VNEGSRC)
DS30000575C-page 492
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 24-2:
CVRCONL: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER LOW
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
CVREN
CVROE
CVRPSS1
CVRPSS0
—
—
—
CVRNSS
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CVREN: Comparator Voltage Reference Enable bit
1 = CVREF circuit is powered on
0 = CVREF circuit is powered down
bit 6
CVROE: Comparator VREF Output Enable bit
1 = CVREF voltage level is output on CVREF pin
0 = CVREF voltage level is disconnected from CVREF pin
bit 5-4
CVRPSS: Comparator VREF Positive Source (VPOSSRC) Selection bits
11 = Reserved, do not use. Positive source is floating
10 = VBG (Band gap)
01 = VREF+
00 = AVDD
bit 3-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CVRNSS: Comparator VREF Negative Source (VNEGSRC) Selection bit
01 = VREF00 = AVSS
FIGURE 24-1:
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM
VREF+
AVDD
CVRSS = 1
8R
CVRSS = 0
CVR
R
CVREN
R
R
32 Steps
R
32-to-1 MUX
R
CVREF
R
R
VREF-
CVRSS = 1
CVRSS = 0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 493
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
24.2
Voltage Reference Accuracy/Error
The full range of voltage reference cannot be realized
due to the construction of the module. The transistors
on the top and bottom of the resistor ladder network
(Figure 24-1) keep CVREF from approaching the reference source rails. The voltage reference is derived
from the reference source; therefore, the CVREF output
changes with fluctuations in that source. The tested
absolute accuracy of the voltage reference can be
found in Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”.
24.3
Operation During Sleep
When the device wakes up from Sleep through an
interrupt or a Watchdog Timer time-out, the contents of
the CVRCON register are not affected. To minimize
current consumption in Sleep mode, the voltage
reference should be disabled.
FIGURE 24-2:
24.4
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset disables the voltage reference by
clearing bit, CVREN (CVRCONL). This Reset also
disconnects the reference from the RF5 pin by clearing
bit, CVROE (CVRCONL).
24.5
Connection Considerations
The voltage reference module operates independently
of the comparator module. The output of the reference
generator may be connected to the RA0 pin if the
CVROE bit is set. Enabling the voltage reference output onto RA0, when it is configured as a digital input,
will increase current consumption. Connecting RA0 as
a digital output with CVRSS enabled will also increase
current consumption.
The RA0 pin can be used as a simple D/A output with
limited drive capability. Due to the limited current drive
capability, a buffer must be used on the voltage
reference output for external connections to VREF.
Figure 24-2 shows an example buffering technique.
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE OUTPUT BUFFER EXAMPLE
PIC18F97J94
CVREF
Module
R(1)
Voltage
Reference
Output
Impedance
Note 1:
RF5
+
–
CVREF Output
R is dependent upon the Comparator Voltage Reference bits, CVRCONH, CVRCONL and
CVRCONL.
DS30000575C-page 494
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
25.0
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT
(HLVD)
The PIC18FXXJ94 of devices has a High/Low-Voltage
Detect module (HLVD). This is a programmable circuit
that sets both a device voltage trip point and the direction
of change from that point. If the device experiences an
excursion past the trip point in that direction, an interrupt
flag is set. If the interrupt is enabled, the program execution branches to the interrupt vector address and the
software responds to the interrupt.
The High/Low-Voltage Detect Control register
(Register 25-1) completely controls the operation of the
HLVD module. This allows the circuitry to be “turned
off” by the user under software control, which
minimizes the current consumption for the device.
The module’s block diagram is shown in Figure 25-1.
REGISTER 25-1:
HLVDCON: HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
VDIRMAG
BGVST
IRVST
HLVDEN
HLVDL3(1)
HLVDL2(1)
HLVDL1(1)
HLVDL0(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
VDIRMAG: Voltage Direction Magnitude Select bit
1 = Event occurs when voltage equals or exceeds trip point (HLVDL)
0 = Event occurs when voltage equals or falls below trip point (HLVDL)
bit 6
BGVST: Band Gap Reference Voltages Stable Status Flag bit
1 = Internal band gap voltage references are stable
0 = Internal band gap voltage references are not stable
bit 5
IRVST: Internal Reference Voltage Stable Flag bit
1 = Indicates that the voltage detect logic will generate the interrupt flag at the specified voltage range
0 = Indicates that the voltage detect logic will not generate the interrupt flag at the specified voltage
range and the HLVD interrupt should not be enabled
bit 4
HLVDEN: High/Low-Voltage Detect Power Enable bit
1 = HLVD is enabled
0 = HLVD is disabled
bit 3-0
HLVDL: Voltage Detection Limit bits(1)
1111 = External analog input is used (input comes from the HLVDIN pin)
1110 = Maximum setting
.
.
.
0100 = Minimum setting
Note 1:
For the electrical specifications, see Parameter D420.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 495
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
The module is enabled by setting the HLVDEN bit
(HLVDCON). Each time the HLVD module is
enabled, the circuitry requires some time to stabilize.
The IRVST bit (HLVDCON) is a read-only bit used
to indicate when the circuit is stable. The module can
only generate an interrupt after the circuit is stable and
IRVST is set.
trip point voltage. The “trip point” voltage is the voltage
level at which the device detects a high or low-voltage
event, depending on the configuration of the module.
When the supply voltage is equal to the trip point, the
voltage tapped off of the resistor array is equal to the
internal reference voltage generated by the voltage
reference module. The comparator then generates an
interrupt signal by setting the HLVDIF bit.
The VDIRMAG bit (HLVDCON) determines the
overall operation of the module. When VDIRMAG is
cleared, the module monitors for drops in VDD below a
predetermined set point. When the bit is set, the
module monitors for rises in VDD above the set point.
25.1
The trip point voltage is software programmable to any of
16 values. The trip point is selected by programming the
HLVDL bits (HLVDCON).
The HLVD module has an additional feature that allows
the user to supply the trip voltage to the module from an
external source. This mode is enabled when bits,
HLVDL, are set to ‘1111’. In this state, the
comparator input is multiplexed from the external input
pin, HLVDIN. This gives users the flexibility of configuring the High/Low-Voltage Detect interrupt to occur at
any voltage in the valid operating range.
Operation
When the HLVD module is enabled, a comparator uses
an internally generated reference voltage as the set
point. The set point is compared with the trip point,
where each node in the resistor divider represents a
FIGURE 25-1:
VDD
HLVD MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM (WITH EXTERNAL INPUT)
Externally Generated
Trip Point
VDD
HLVDL
HLVDCON
Register
HLVDEN
VDIRMAG
Set
HLVDIF
16-to-1 MUX
HLVDIN
HLVDEN
BOREN
DS30000575C-page 496
Internal Voltage
Reference
1.2V Typical
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
25.2
HLVD Setup
To set up the HLVD module:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Select the desired HLVD trip point by writing the
value to the HLVDL bits.
Set the VDIRMAG bit to detect high voltage
(VDIRMAG = 1) or low voltage (VDIRMAG = 0).
Enable the HLVD module by setting the
HLVDEN bit.
Clear the HLVD interrupt flag (PIR2), which
may have been set from a previous interrupt.
If interrupts are desired, enable the HLVD interrupt by setting the HLVDIE and GIE bits
(PIE2 and INTCON, respectively).
An interrupt will not be generated until the IRVST bit is
set.
Note:
Before changing any module settings
(VDIRMAG, HLVDL), first disable the
module (HLVDEN = 0), make the changes
and re-enable the module. This prevents
the generation of false HLVD events.
25.3
Current Consumption
When the module is enabled, the HLVD comparator
and voltage divider are enabled and consume static
current.
Depending on the application, the HLVD module does
not need to operate constantly. To reduce current
requirements, the HLVD circuitry may only need to be
enabled for short periods where the voltage is checked.
After such a check, the module could be disabled.
25.4
HLVD Start-up Time
The internal reference voltage of the HLVD module,
specified in electrical specification, Parameter 37
(Section 30.0 “Electrical Specifications”), may be
used by other internal circuitry, such as the
programmable Brown-out Reset. If the HLVD or other
circuits using the voltage reference are disabled to
lower the device’s current consumption, the reference
voltage circuit will require time to become stable before
a low or high-voltage condition can be reliably
detected. This start-up time, TIRVST, is an interval that
is independent of device clock speed. It is specified in
electrical specification, Parameter 37 (Table 30-26).
The HLVD interrupt flag is not enabled until TIRVST has
expired and a stable reference voltage is reached. For
this reason, brief excursions beyond the set point may
not be detected during this interval (see Figure 25-2 or
Figure 25-3).
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 497
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
FIGURE 25-2:
LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT OPERATION (VDIRMAG = 0)
CASE 1:
HLVDIF will Not be Set
VDD
VHLVD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIRVST
IRVST
HLVDIF Cleared in Software
Internal Reference is Stable
CASE 2:
VDD
VHLVD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIRVST
IRVST
HLVDIF Cleared in Software
Internal Reference is Stable
HLVDIF Cleared in Software,
HLVDIF Remains Set Since HLVD Condition still Exists
FIGURE 25-3:
HIGH-VOLTAGE DETECT OPERATION (VDIRMAG = 1)
CASE 1:
HLVDIF will not be Set
VHLVD
VDD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIRVST
IRVST
HLVDIF Cleared in Software
Internal Reference is Stable
CASE 2:
VHLVD
VDD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIRVST
IRVST
Internal Reference is Stable
DS30000575C-page 498
HLVDIF Cleared in Software
HLVDIF Cleared in Software,
HLVDIF Remains Set since HLVD Condition still Exists
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
25.5
Applications
25.6
In many applications, it is desirable to detect a drop
below, or rise above, a particular voltage threshold. For
example, the HLVD module could be periodically
enabled to detect Universal Serial Bus (USB) attach or
detach. This assumes the device is powered by a lower
voltage source than the USB when detached. An attach
would indicate a high-voltage detect from, for example,
3.3V to 5V (the voltage on USB) and vice versa for a
detach. This feature could save a design a few extra
components and an attach signal (input pin).
For general battery applications, Figure 25-4 shows a
possible voltage curve. Over time, the device voltage
decreases. When the device voltage reaches voltage,
VA, the HLVD logic generates an interrupt at time, TA.
The interrupt could cause the execution of an ISR, which
would allow the application to perform “housekeeping
tasks” and a controlled shutdown, before the device
voltage exits the valid operating range at TB. This would
give the application a time window, represented by the
difference between TA and TB, to safely exit.
FIGURE 25-4:
Operation During Sleep
When enabled, the HLVD circuitry continues to operate
during Sleep. If the device voltage crosses the trip
point, the HLVDIF bit will be set and the device will
wake-up from Sleep. Device execution will continue
from the interrupt vector address if interrupts have
been globally enabled.
25.7
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the HLVD module to be turned off.
TYPICAL LOW-VOLTAGE
DETECT APPLICATION
Voltage
VA
VB
TA
Time
TB
Legend: VA = HLVD trip point
VB = Minimum valid device
operating voltage
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 499
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
26.0
CHARGE TIME
MEASUREMENT UNIT (CTMU)
•
•
•
•
•
Control of edge sequence
Control of response to edges
Time measurement resolution of 1 nanosecond
High-precision time measurement
Time delay of external or internal signal
asynchronous to system clock
• Accurate current source suitable for capacitive
measurement
The Charge Time Measurement Unit (CTMU) is a
flexible analog module that provides accurate differential time measurement between pulse sources, as well
as asynchronous pulse generation. By working with
other on-chip analog modules, the CTMU can precisely
measure time, capacitance and relative changes in
capacitance or generate output pulses with a specific
time delay. The CTMU is ideal for interfacing with
capacitive-based sensors.
The CTMU works in conjunction with the A/D Converter
to provide up to 24 channels for time or charge
measurement, depending on the specific device and
the number of A/D channels available. When configured for time delay, the CTMU is connected to one of
the analog comparators. The level-sensitive input edge
sources can be selected from four sources: two
external inputs or the CCP1/CCP2 Special Event
Triggers.
The module includes these key features:
• Up to 24 channels available for capacitive or time
measurement input
• Low-cost temperature measurement using on-chip
diode channel
• On-chip precision current source
• Sixteen-edge input trigger sources
• Polarity control for each edge source
• Provides a trigger for the A/D Converter
FIGURE 26-1:
The CTMU special event can trigger the Analog-to-Digital
Converter module.
Figure 26-1 provides a block diagram of the CTMU.
CTMU BLOCK DIAGRAM
CTMUCONH:CTMUCONL
EDGEN
EDGSEQEN
EDG1SEL
EDG1POL
EDG2SEL
EDG2POL
CTED1
CTED2
CTMUCON1
ITRIM
IRNG
EDG1STAT
EDG2STAT
Edge
Control
Logic
Current Source
Current
Control
CCP2
TGEN
IDISSEN
CTTRIG
CTMU
Control
Logic
Pulse
Generator
CCP1
A/D Converter
A/D Trigger
CTPLS
Comparator 2
Input
Comparator 2 Output
DS30000575C-page 500
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
26.1
CTMU Registers
The CTMUCON1 and CTMUCON3 registers
(Register 26-1 and Register 26-3) contain control bits
for configuring the CTMU module edge source selection, edge source polarity selection, edge sequencing,
A/D trigger, analog circuit capacitor discharge and
enables. The CTMUCON2 register (Register 26-2) has
bits for selecting the current source range and current
source trim.
The control registers for the CTMU are:
•
•
•
•
CTMUCON1
CTMUCON2
CTMUCON3
CTMUCON4
REGISTER 26-1:
CTMUCON1: CTMU CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CTMUEN
—
CTMUSIDL
TGEN
EDGEN
EDGSEQEN
IDISSEN
CTTRIG
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
CTMUEN: CTMU Enable bit
1 = Module is enabled
0 = Module is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
CTMUSIDL: Stop in Idle Mode bit
1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode
0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode
bit 4
TGEN: Time Generation Enable bit
1 = Enables edge delay generation
0 = Disables edge delay generation
bit 3
EDGEN: Edge Enable bit
1 = Edges are not blocked
0 = Edges are blocked
bit 2
ESGSEQEN: Edge Sequence Enable bit
1 = Edge 1 event must occur before Edge 2 event can occur
0 = No edge sequence is needed
bit 1
IDISSEN: Analog Current Source Control bit
1 = Analog current source output is grounded
0 = Analog current source output is not grounded
bit 0
CTTRIG: CTMU Special Event Trigger bit
1 = CTMU Special Event Trigger is enabled
0 = CTMU Special Event Trigger is disabled
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 501
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 26-2:
CTMUCON2: CTMU CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ITRIM5
ITRIM4
ITRIM3
ITRIM2
ITRIM1
ITRIM0
IRNG1
IRNG0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-2
ITRIM: Current Source Trim bits
011111 = Maximum positive change (+62% typ.) from nominal current
011110
.
.
.
000001 = Minimum positive change (+2% typ.) from nominal current
000000 = Nominal current output specified by IRNG
111111 = Minimum negative change (-2% typ.) from nominal current
.
.
.
100010
100001 = Maximum negative change (-62% typ.) from nominal current
bit 1-0
IRNG: Current Source Range Select bits
11 = 100 x Base Current
10 = 10 x Base Current
01 = Base Current Level (0.55 A nominal)
00 = 1000 x Base Current
DS30000575C-page 502
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 26-3:
R/W-0
EDG2EN
CTMUCON3: CTMU CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER 3
R/W-0
EDG2POL
R/W-0
EDG2SEL3
R/W-0
EDG2SEL2
R/W-0
EDG2SEL1
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
EDG2SEL0
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
EDG2EN: Edge 2 Edge-Sensitive Select bit
1 = Input is edge-sensitive
0 = Input is level-sensitive
bit 6
EDG2POL: Edge 2 Polarity Select bit
1 = Edge 2 is programmed for a positive edge response
0 = Edge 2 is programmed for a negative edge response
bit 5-2
EDG2SEL: Edge 2 Source Select bits
1111 = CMP3 selected
1110 = CMP2 selected
1101 = CMP1 selected
1100 = Reserved
1011 = CCP3 trigger selected
1010 = CCP2 trigger selected
1001 = CCP1 trigger selected
1000 = CTED13 selected
0111 = CTED12 selected
0110 = CTED11 selected
0101 = CTED10 selected
0100 = CTED9 selected
0011 = CTED1 selected
0010 = CTED2 selected
0001 = CCP1 interrupt selected
0000 = TMR1 interrupt selected
bit 1-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS30000575C-page 503
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
REGISTER 26-4:
CTMUCON4: CTMU CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER 4
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
EDG1EN
EDG1POL
EDG1SEL3
EDG1SEL2
EDG1SEL1
EDG1SEL0
EDG2STAT
EDG1STAT
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
EDG1EN: Edge 1 Edge-Sensitive Select bit
1 = Input is edge-sensitive
0 = Input is level-sensitive
bit 6
EDG1POL: Edge 1 Polarity Select bit
1 = Edge 1 is programmed for a positive edge response
0 = Edge 1 is programmed for a negative edge response
bit 5-2
EDG1SEL: Edge 1 Source Select bits
1111 = CMP3 selected
1110 = CMP2 selected
1101 = CMP1 selected
1100 = CCP3 trigger selected
1011 = CCP2 trigger selected
1010 = CCP1 trigger selected
1001 = CTED8 selected
1000 = CTED7 selected
0111 = CTED6 selected
0110 = CTED5 selected
0101 = CTED4 selected
0100 = CTED3 selected
0011 = CTED1 selected
0010 = CTED2 selected
0001 = CCP1 interrupt selected
0000 = TMR1 interrupt selected
bit 1-0
EDG2STAT: Edge 2 Status bit
Indicates the status of Edge 2 and can be written to control edge source.
1 = Edge2 has occurred
0 = Edge2 has not occurred
bit 1-0
EDG1STAT: Edge 1 Status bit
1 = Edge 1 has occurred
0 = Edge 1 has not occurred
DS30000575C-page 504
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
26.2
CTMU Operation
The CTMU works by using a fixed current source to
charge a circuit. The type of circuit depends on the type
of measurement being made.
In the case of charge measurement, the current is fixed
and the amount of time the current is applied to the circuit is fixed. The amount of voltage read by the A/D
becomes a measurement of the circuit’s capacitance.
In the case of time measurement, the current, as well
as the capacitance of the circuit, is fixed. In this case,
the voltage read by the A/D is representative of the
amount of time elapsed from the time the current
source starts and stops charging the circuit.
If the CTMU is being used as a time delay, both capacitance and current source are fixed, as well as the voltage
supplied to the comparator circuit. The delay of a signal
is determined by the amount of time it takes the voltage
to charge to the comparator threshold voltage.
26.2.1
THEORY OF OPERATION
The operation of the CTMU is based on the equation
for charge:
I=C•
dV
dT
More simply, the amount of charge measured in
coulombs in a circuit is defined as current in amperes
(I), multiplied by the amount of time in seconds that the
current flows (t). Charge is also defined as the capacitance in farads (C), multiplied by the voltage of the
circuit (V). It follows that:
I•t=C•V
The CTMU module provides a constant, known current
source. The A/D Converter is used to measure (V) in
the equation, leaving two unknowns: capacitance (C)
and time (t). The above equation can be used to calculate capacitance or time, by either the relationship
using the known fixed capacitance of the circuit:
t = (C • V)/I
or by:
C = (I • t)/V
using a fixed time that the current source is applied to
the circuit.
26.2.2
CURRENT SOURCE
At the heart of the CTMU is a precision current source,
designed to provide a constant reference for measurements. The level of current is user-selectable across
three ranges, or a total of two orders of magnitude, with
the ability to trim the output in ±2% increments
(nominal). The current range is selected by the
IRNG bits (CTMUCON1), with a value of
‘01’ representing the lowest range.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Current trim is provided by the ITRIM bits
(CTMUCON1). These six bits allow trimming of
the current source, in steps of approximately 2% per
step. Half of the range adjusts the current source positively and the other half reduces the current source. A
value of ‘000000’ is the neutral position (no change). A
value of ‘100001’ is the maximum negative adjustment
(approximately -62%) and ‘011111’ is the maximum
positive adjustment (approximately +62%).
26.2.3
EDGE SELECTION AND CONTROL
CTMU measurements are controlled by edge events
occurring on the module’s two input channels. Each channel, referred to as Edge 1 and Edge 2, can be configured
to receive input pulses from one of the edge input pins
(CTED1 and CTED2) or CCPx Special Event Triggers
(CCP1 and CCP2). The input channels are level-sensitive,
responding to the instantaneous level on the channel
rather than a transition between levels. The inputs are
selected using the EDG1SELx (CTMUCON2) and
EDG2SELx (CTMUCON3) bit pairs.
In addition to source, each channel can be configured for event polarity using the EDGE2POL (CTMUCON2) and EDGE1POL (CTMUCON3 bits.
The input channels can also be filtered for an edge
event sequence (Edge 1 occurring before Edge 2) by
setting the EDGSEQEN bit (CTMUCON).
26.2.4
EDGE STATUS
The CTMUCON3 register also contains two Edge
Status
bits:
EDG2STAT
and
EDG1STAT
(CTMUCON3). Their primary function is to show
if an edge response has occurred on the corresponding
channel. The CTMU automatically sets a particular bit
when an edge response is detected on its channel. The
level-sensitive nature of the input channels also means
that the Status bits become set immediately if the
channel’s configuration is changed and matches the
channel’s current state.
The module uses the Edge Status bits to control the
current source output to external analog modules (such
as the A/D Converter). Current is only supplied to external modules when only one (not both) of the Status bits
is set. Current is shut off when both bits are either set
or cleared. This allows the CTMU to measure current
only during the interval between edges. After both
Status bits are set, it is necessary to clear them before
another measurement is taken. Both bits should be
cleared simultaneously, if possible, to avoid re-enabling
the CTMU current source.
In addition to being set by the CTMU hardware, the
Edge Status bits can also be set by software. This permits a user application to manually enable or disable
the current source. Setting either (but not both) of the
bits enables the current source. Setting or clearing both
bits at once disables the source.
DS30000575C-page 505
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
26.2.5
INTERRUPTS
The CTMU sets its interrupt flag (PIR3) whenever
the current source is enabled, then disabled. An interrupt is generated only if the corresponding interrupt
enable bit (PIE3) is also set. If edge sequencing is
not enabled (i.e., Edge 1 must occur before Edge 2), it
is necessary to monitor the Edge Status bits, and
determine which edge occurred last and caused the
interrupt.
26.3
CTMU Module Initialization
The following sequence is a general guideline used to
initialize the CTMU module:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Select the current source range using the
IRNGx bits (CTMUCON1).
Adjust the current source trim using the ITRIMx
bits (CTMUCON1).
Configure the edge input sources for Edge 1
and Edge 2 by setting the EDG1SELx and
EDG2SELx bits (CTMUCON3 and CTMUCON2, respectively).
Configure the input polarities for the edge inputs
using the EDG1POL and EDG2POL bits
(CTMUCON3 and CTMUCON2).
The default configuration is for negative edge
polarity (high-to-low transitions).
5.
Enable edge sequencing using the EDGSEQEN
bit (CTMUCON).
By default, edge sequencing is disabled.
6.
Select the operating mode (Measurement or
Time
Delay)
with
the
TGEN
bit
(CTMUCON).
The default mode is Time/Capacitance
Measurement mode.
7.
Configure the module to automatically trigger
an A/D conversion when the second edge
event has occurred using the CTTRIG bit
(CTMUCON).
The conversion trigger is disabled by default.
8.
Discharge the connected circuit by setting the
IDISSEN bit (CTMUCON).
9. After waiting a sufficient time for the circuit to
discharge, clear the IDISSEN bit.
10. Disable the module by clearing the CTMUEN bit
(CTMUCON).
11. Clear the Edge Status bits, EDG2STAT and
EDG1STAT (CTMUCON3).
Both bits should be cleared simultaneously, if
possible, to avoid re-enabling the CTMU current
source.
12. Enable both edge inputs by setting the EDGEN
bit (CTMUCON).
13. Enable the module by setting the CTMUEN bit.
DS30000575C-page 506
Depending on the type of measurement or pulse
generation being performed, one or more additional
modules may also need to be initialized and configured
with the CTMU module:
• Edge Source Generation: In addition to the
external edge input pins, CCP1/CCP2 Special
Event Triggers can be used as edge sources for
the CTMU.
• Capacitance or Time Measurement: The CTMU
module uses the A/D Converter to measure the
voltage across a capacitor that is connected to one
of the analog input channels.
• Pulse Generation: When generating system clock
independent, output pulses, the CTMU module
uses Comparator 2 and the associated
comparator voltage reference.
26.4
Calibrating the CTMU Module
The CTMU requires calibration for precise measurements of capacitance and time, as well as for accurate
time delay. If the application only requires measurement
of a relative change in capacitance or time, calibration is
usually not necessary. An example of a less precise
application is a capacitive touch switch, in which the
touch circuit has a baseline capacitance and the added
capacitance of the human body changes the overall
capacitance of a circuit.
If actual capacitance or time measurement is required,
two hardware calibrations must take place:
• The current source needs calibration to set it to a
precise current.
• The circuit being measured needs calibration to
measure or nullify any capacitance other than that
to be measured.
26.4.1
CURRENT SOURCE CALIBRATION
The current source on board the CTMU module has a
range of ±62% nominal for each of three current
ranges. For precise measurements, it is possible to
measure and adjust this current source by placing a
high-precision resistor, RCAL, onto an unused analog
channel. An example circuit is shown in Figure 26-2.
To measure the current source:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Initialize the A/D Converter.
Initialize the CTMU.
Enable the current source by setting EDG1STAT
(CTMUCON3).
Issue time delay for voltage across RCAL to
stabilize and the A/D Sample-and-Hold (S/H)
capacitor to charge.
Perform the A/D conversion.
Calculate the current source current using
I = V / RCAL, where RCAL is a high-precision
resistance and V is measured by performing an
A/D conversion.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
The CTMU current source may be trimmed with the
ITRIMx bits in CTMUCON1, using an iterative process
to get the exact current desired. Alternatively, the nominal value without adjustment may be used. That value
may be stored by software for use in all subsequent
capacitive or time measurements.
To calculate the optimal value for RCAL, the nominal
current must be chosen.
For example, if the A/D Converter reference voltage is
3.3V, use 70% of full scale (or 2.31V) as the desired
approximate voltage to be read by the A/D Converter. If
the range of the CTMU current source is selected to be
0.55 A, the resistor value needed is calculated as
RCAL = 2.31V/0.55 A, for a value of 4.2 MΩ. Similarly,
if the current source is chosen to be 5.5 A, RCAL would
be 420,000Ω, and 42,000Ω if the current source is set
to 55 A.
FIGURE 26-2:
CTMU CURRENT SOURCE
CALIBRATION CIRCUIT
PIC18F97J94
Current Source
A value of 70% of full-scale voltage is chosen to make
sure that the A/D Converter is in a range that is well
above the noise floor. If an exact current is chosen to
incorporate the trimming bits from CTMUCON1, the
resistor value of RCAL may need to be adjusted accordingly. RCAL also may be adjusted to allow for available
resistor values. RCAL should be of the highest precision
available in light of the precision needed for the circuit
that the CTMU will be measuring. A recommended
minimum would be 0.1% tolerance.
The following examples show a typical method for
performing a CTMU current calibration.
• Example 26-1 demonstrates how to initialize the
A/D Converter and the CTMU.
This routine is typical for applications using both
modules.
• Example 26-2 demonstrates one method for the
actual calibration routine.
This method manually triggers the A/D Converter to
demonstrate the entire step-wise process. It is also
possible to automatically trigger the conversion by
setting the CTMU’s CTTRIG bit (CTMUCON).
CTMU
A/D
Trigger
A/D Converter
ANx
RCAL
A/D
MUX
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 507
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 26-1:
SETUP FOR CTMU CALIBRATION ROUTINES
#include "p18cxxx.h"
/**************************************************************************/
/*Setup CTMU *****************************************************************/
/**************************************************************************/
void setup(void)
{ //CTMUCON - CTMU Control register
CTMUCON = 0x00;
//make sure CTMU is disabled
CTMUCON3 = 0x90;
//CTMU continues to run when emulator is stopped,CTMU continues
//to run in idle mode,Time Generation mode disabled, Edges are blocked
//No edge sequence order, Analog current source not grounded, trigger
//output disabled, Edge2 polarity = positive level, Edge2 source =
//source 0, Edge1 polarity = positive level, Edge1 source = source 0,
// Set Edge status bits to zero
//CTMUCON1 - CTMU Current Control Register
CTMUCON1 = 0x01;
//0.55uA, Nominal - No Adjustment
/**************************************************************************/
//Setup AD converter;
/**************************************************************************/
TRISBbits.TRISB0=0;
TRISAbits.TRISA2=1;
ANCON1bits.ANSEL2=1;
ADCON1Hbits.FORM=0b00;
ADCON1Lbits.SSRC=0b0111;
ADCON3Hbits.SAMC=0b00111;
ADCON3Lbits.ADCS=0x3F;
ADCON2Hbits.PVCFG=0b00;
ADCON2Hbits.NVCFG0=0;
ADCHS0Lbits.CHONA=0b000;
ADCHS0Lbits.CHOSA=0b00010;
ADCON1Hbits.ADON=1; // Turn on ADC
//set channel 2 as an input
// Configured AN2 as an analog channel
// Result format 1= Right justified
//
//
//
//
//
Acquisition time 7 = 20TAD 2 = 4TAD 1=2TAD
Clock conversion bits 6= FOSC/64 2=FOSC/32
ADCON1
Vref+ = AVdd
Vref- = AVss
// Select ADC channel
}
DS30000575C-page 508
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
EXAMPLE 26-2:
CTMU CURRENT CALIBRATION ROUTINE
#include "p18cxxx.h"
#define COUNT 500
#define DELAY for(i=0;i 9] or [DC = 1], then
(W) + 6 W;
else
(W) W
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – 1 dest
Status Affected:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
Encoding:
If [W > 9] or [C = 1], then
(W) + 6 W;
C =1;
else
(W) W
Status Affected:
Description:
0000
0000
0000
0111
Description:
DAW adjusts the 8-bit value in W,
resulting from the earlier addition of two
variables (each in packed BCD format)
and produces a correct packed BCD
result.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register W
Process
Data
Write
W
A5h
0
0
05h
1
0
ffff
ffff
Decrement register, ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
DAW
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
01da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
C
Encoding:
Example 1:
0000
Example:
DECF
Before Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
CNT,
1, 0
01h
0
00h
1
Example 2:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
DS30000575C-page 584
CEh
0
0
34h
1
0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
DECFSZ
Decrement f, Skip if 0
DCFSNZ
Decrement f, Skip if Not 0
Syntax:
DECFSZ f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
DCFSNZ
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – 1 dest,
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) – 1 dest,
skip if result 0
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0010
Description:
11da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
Encoding:
0100
Description:
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction
which is already fetched is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
it a 2-cycle instruction.
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
DECFSZ
GOTO
CNT, 1, 1
LOOP
Example:
HERE
CONTINUE
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
If CNT
=
PC =
If CNT
PC =
Address (HERE)
CNT – 1
0;
Address (CONTINUE)
0;
Address (HERE + 2)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
If skip:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
1
11da
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
instruction which is already fetched is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making it a 2-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Words:
f {,d {,a}}
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
Before Instruction
TEMP
After Instruction
TEMP
If TEMP
PC
If TEMP
PC
DCFSNZ
:
:
TEMP, 1, 0
=
?
=
=
=
=
TEMP – 1,
0;
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (NZERO)
DS30000575C-page 585
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
INCF
Increment f
Syntax:
GOTO k
Syntax:
INCF
Operands:
0 k 1048575
Operands:
Operation:
k PC
Status Affected:
None
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 dest
Status Affected:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
Encoding:
1st word (k)
2nd word(k)
1110
1111
1111
k19kkk
k7kkk
kkkk
kkkk0
kkkk8
Description:
GOTO allows an unconditional branch
anywhere within entire 2-Mbyte memory
range. The 20-bit value ‘k’ is loaded into
PC. GOTO is always a 2-cycle
instruction.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
0010
Description:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘k’,
No
operation
Read literal
‘k’,
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
GOTO THERE
After Instruction
PC =
Address (THERE)
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
INCF
Before Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
C
=
DC
=
DS30000575C-page 586
10da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
CNT, 1, 0
FFh
0
?
?
00h
1
1
1
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
INCFSZ
Increment f, Skip if 0
INFSNZ
Syntax:
INCFSZ
Syntax:
INFSNZ
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
f {,d {,a}}
Increment f, Skip if Not 0
f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
(f) + 1 dest,
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) + 1 dest,
skip if result 0
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0011
Description:
11da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
Encoding:
0100
Description:
10da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction
which is already fetched is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
it a 2-cycle instruction.
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
instruction which is already fetched is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making it a 2-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note:
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip:
If skip:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
If CNT
=
PC
=
If CNT
PC
=
INCFSZ
:
:
Address (HERE)
CNT + 1
0;
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (NZERO)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
CNT, 1, 0
Example:
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
REG
=
If REG
PC
=
If REG
=
PC
=
INFSNZ
REG, 1, 0
Address (HERE)
REG + 1
0;
Address (NZERO)
0;
Address (ZERO)
DS30000575C-page 587
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
IORLW
Inclusive OR Literal with W
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
IORLW k
Syntax:
IORWF
Operands:
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
(W) .OR. k W
Status Affected:
N, Z
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0000
1001
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are ORed with the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed
in W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
0001
Description:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
W
Example:
IORLW
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
=
ffff
ffff
Inclusive OR W with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’,
the result is placed back in register ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
35h
9Ah
BFh
00da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
IORWF
Before Instruction
RESULT =
W
=
After Instruction
RESULT =
W
=
DS30000575C-page 588
RESULT, 0, 1
13h
91h
13h
93h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
LFSR
Load FSR
MOVF
Move f
Syntax:
LFSR f, k
Syntax:
MOVF
Operands:
0f2
0 k 4095
Operands:
Operation:
k FSRf
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Status Affected:
None
Operation:
f dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
1110
1111
1110
0000
00ff
k7kkk
k11kkk
kkkk
Description:
The 12-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
file select register pointed to by ‘f’.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
0101
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’ MSB
Process
Data
Write
literal ‘k’
MSB to
FSRfH
Decode
Read literal
‘k’ LSB
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to FSRfL
Example:
After Instruction
FSR2H
FSR2L
03h
ABh
00da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are moved to
a destination dependent upon the
status of ‘d’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’. Location ‘f’
can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
LFSR 2, 3ABh
=
=
f {,d {,a}}
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
W
Example:
MOVF
Before Instruction
REG
W
After Instruction
REG
W
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
REG, 0, 0
=
=
22h
FFh
=
=
22h
22h
DS30000575C-page 589
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
MOVFF
Move f to f
MOVLB
Move Literal to Low Nibble in BSR
Syntax:
MOVFF fs,fd
Syntax:
MOVLB k
Operands:
0 fs 4095
0 fd 4095
Operands:
0 k 255
Operation:
k BSR
Status Affected:
None
Operation:
(fs) fd
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
Description:
Encoding:
1100
1111
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffffs
ffffd
The contents of source register, ‘fs’, are
moved to destination register ‘fd’.
Location of source ‘fs’ can be anywhere
in the 4096-byte data space (000h to
FFFh) and location of destination ‘fd’
can also be anywhere from 000h to
FFFh.
Either source or destination can be W
(a useful special situation).
MOVFF is particularly useful for
transferring a data memory location to a
peripheral register (such as the transmit
buffer or an I/O port).
The MOVFF instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
0000
0001
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
Bank Select Register (BSR). The value
of BSR always remains ‘0’
regardless of the value of k7:k4.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to BSR
MOVLB
5
Example:
Before Instruction
BSR Register =
After Instruction
BSR Register =
02h
05h
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
(src)
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
No dummy
read
Example:
MOVFF
Before Instruction
REG1
REG2
After Instruction
REG1
REG2
DS30000575C-page 590
REG1, REG2
=
=
33h
11h
=
=
33h
33h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
MOVLW
Move Literal to W
MOVWF
Move W to f
Syntax:
MOVLW k
Syntax:
MOVWF
Operands:
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
kW
0 f 255
a [0,1]
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description:
1110
kkkk
kkkk
The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Operation:
(W) f
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0110
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
W
Example:
After Instruction
W
=
MOVLW
f {,a}
111a
ffff
ffff
Move data from W to register ‘f’.
Location ‘f’ can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
5Ah
5Ah
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
MOVWF
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
=
REG
=
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
REG, 0
4Fh
FFh
4Fh
4Fh
DS30000575C-page 591
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
MULLW
Multiply Literal with W
MULWF
Multiply W with f
Syntax:
MULLW
Syntax:
MULWF
Operands:
0 f 255
a [0,1]
Operation:
(W) x (f) PRODH:PRODL
Status Affected:
None
k
Operands:
0 k 255
Operation:
(W) x k PRODH:PRODL
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description:
1101
kkkk
kkkk
An unsigned multiplication is carried
out between the contents of W and the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The 16-bit result is
placed in the PRODH:PRODL register
pair. PRODH contains the high byte.
Encoding:
0000
Description:
W is unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
1
Cycles:
1
ffff
ffff
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero result is
possible but not detected.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
Example:
001a
An unsigned multiplication is carried out
between the contents of W and the
register file location ‘f’. The 16-bit result is
stored in the PRODH:PRODL register
pair. PRODH contains the high byte. Both
W and ‘f’ are unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero result
is possible but not detected.
Words:
f {,a}
MULLW
Before Instruction
W
PRODH
PRODL
After Instruction
W
PRODH
PRODL
=
=
=
=
=
=
0C4h
E2h
?
?
E2h
ADh
08h
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction set
is enabled, this instruction operates in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and BitOriented Instructions in Indexed Literal
Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
Example:
MULWF
Before Instruction
W
REG
PRODH
PRODL
After Instruction
W
REG
PRODH
PRODL
DS30000575C-page 592
REG, 1
=
=
=
=
C4h
B5h
?
?
=
=
=
=
C4h
B5h
8Ah
94h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
NEGF
Negate f
Syntax:
NEGF
Operands:
0 f 255
a [0,1]
f {,a}
Operation:
(f) + 1 f
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Encoding:
0110
Description:
110a
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
1
1
Syntax:
NOP
Operands:
None
Operation:
No operation
Status Affected:
None
0000
1111
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Cycles:
No Operation
Encoding:
Location ‘f’ is negated using two’s
complement. The result is placed in the
data memory location ‘f’.
Words:
NOP
0000
xxxx
Description:
No operation.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
0000
xxxx
0000
xxxx
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
None.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
NEGF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
REG, 1
0011 1010 [3Ah]
1100 0110 [C6h]
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 593
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
POP
Pop Top of Return Stack
PUSH
Push Top of Return Stack
Syntax:
POP
Syntax:
PUSH
Operands:
None
Operands:
None
Operation:
(TOS) bit bucket
Operation:
(PC + 2) TOS
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
0110
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
0101
Description:
The TOS value is pulled off the return
stack and is discarded. The TOS value
then becomes the previous value that
was pushed onto the return stack.
This instruction is provided to enable
the user to properly manage the return
stack to incorporate a software stack.
Description:
The PC + 2 is pushed onto the top of
the return stack. The previous TOS
value is pushed down on the stack.
This instruction allows implementing a
software stack by modifying TOS and
then pushing it onto the return stack.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
POP TOS
value
No
operation
POP
GOTO
NEW
Example:
Q2
Q3
Q4
PUSH
PC + 2 onto
return stack
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
Before Instruction
TOS
Stack (1 level down)
=
=
0031A2h
014332h
After Instruction
TOS
PC
=
=
014332h
NEW
DS30000575C-page 594
Q1
Decode
PUSH
Before Instruction
TOS
PC
=
=
345Ah
0124h
After Instruction
PC
TOS
Stack (1 level down)
=
=
=
0126h
0126h
345Ah
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
RCALL
Relative Call
RESET
Reset
Syntax:
RCALL
Syntax:
RESET
n
Operands:
-1024 n 1023
Operands:
None
Operation:
(PC) + 2 TOS,
(PC) + 2 + 2n PC
Operation:
Reset all registers and flags that are
affected by a MCLR Reset.
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
All
Encoding:
1101
Description:
1nnn
nnnn
nnnn
Subroutine call with a jump up to 1K
from the current location. First, return
address (PC + 2) is pushed onto the
stack. Then, add the 2’s complement
number ‘2n’ to the PC. Since the PC will
have incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is a
2-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
0000
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
1111
1111
This instruction provides a way to
execute a MCLR Reset in software.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Start
reset
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
Q Cycle Activity:
0000
Description:
After Instruction
Registers =
Flags*
=
RESET
Reset Value
Reset Value
PUSH PC
to stack
No
operation
Example:
No
operation
HERE
RCALL Jump
Before Instruction
PC =
Address (HERE)
After Instruction
PC =
Address (Jump)
TOS =
Address (HERE + 2)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 595
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
RETLW
Return Literal to W
Syntax:
RETFIE {s}
Syntax:
RETLW k
Operands:
s [0,1]
Operands:
0 k 255
Operation:
(TOS) PC,
1 GIE/GIEH or PEIE/GIEL;
if s = 1,
(WS) W,
(STATUSS) STATUS,
(BSRS) BSR,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
Operation:
k W,
(TOS) PC,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
0000
0000
0001
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
kkkk
kkkk
W is loaded with the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The
Program Counter is loaded from the top
of the stack (the return address). The
high address latch (PCLATH) remains
unchanged.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
POP PC
from stack,
write to W
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
POP PC
from stack
Set GIEH or
GIEL
Example:
1100
Description:
000s
Return from interrupt. Stack is popped
and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is loaded into
the PC. Interrupts are enabled by
setting either the high or low-priority
Global Interrupt Enable bit. If ‘s’ = 1, the
contents of the shadow registers WS,
STATUSS and BSRS are loaded into
their corresponding registers W,
STATUS and BSR. If ‘s’ = 0, no update
of these registers occurs.
Words:
No
operation
0000
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL.
Encoding:
Description:
Encoding:
No
operation
RETFIE
After Interrupt
PC
W
BSR
STATUS
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL
DS30000575C-page 596
No
operation
No
operation
1
=
=
=
=
=
TOS
WS
BSRS
STATUSS
1
CALL TABLE ;
;
;
;
:
TABLE
ADDWF PCL ;
RETLW k0
;
RETLW k1
;
:
:
RETLW kn
;
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
=
W contains table
offset value
W now has
table value
W = offset
Begin table
End of table
07h
value of kn
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
RLCF
Rotate Left f through Carry
Syntax:
RETURN {s}
Syntax:
RLCF
Operands:
s [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
(TOS) PC;
if s = 1,
(WS) W,
(STATUSS) STATUS,
(BSRS) BSR,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) dest,
(f) C,
(C) dest
Status Affected:
C, N, Z
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description:
Encoding:
0000
0001
001s
0011
Description:
Return from subroutine. The stack is
popped and the top of the stack (TOS)
is loaded into the Program Counter. If
‘s’= 1, the contents of the shadow
registers WS, STATUSS and BSRS are
loaded into their corresponding
registers W, STATUS and BSR. If
‘s’ = 0, no update of these registers
occurs.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
Process
Data
POP PC
from stack
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
01da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left through the Carry flag.
If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in W. If ‘d’
is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register
‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and BitOriented Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
register f
C
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
RETURN
After Instruction:
PC = TOS
Example:
Before Instruction
REG
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
RLCF
REG, 0, 0
1110 0110
0
1110 0110
1100 1100
1
DS30000575C-page 597
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
RLNCF
Rotate Left f (No Carry)
RRCF
Rotate Right f through Carry
Syntax:
RLNCF
Syntax:
RRCF
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) dest,
(f) dest
Operation:
Status Affected:
N, Z
(f) dest,
(f) C,
(C) dest
Status Affected:
C, N, Z
Encoding:
0100
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
01da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
Encoding:
0011
Description:
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
Cycles:
1
Q1
Decode
Q2
Read
register ‘f’
Example:
RLNCF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
DS30000575C-page 598
Q3
Process
Data
Q4
Write to
destination
Words:
1
Cycles:
register f
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
REG, 1, 0
1010 1011
0101 0111
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right through the Carry
flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in W.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
C
Q Cycle Activity:
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
register f
1
00da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
f {,d {,a}}
Example:
RRCF
Before Instruction
REG
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
REG, 0, 0
1110 0110
0
1110 0110
0111 0011
0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
RRNCF
Rotate Right f (No Carry)
SETF
Set f
Syntax:
RRNCF
Syntax:
SETF
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 255
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) dest,
(f) dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0100
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
00da
Operation:
FFh f
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
ffff
ffff
0110
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’.
register f
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
RRNCF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
Example 2:
ffff
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
SETF
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
REG
REG,1
=
5Ah
=
FFh
REG, 1, 0
1101 0111
1110 1011
RRNCF
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
=
REG
=
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Example:
Q Cycle Activity:
100a
The contents of the specified register
are set to FFh.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank will be
selected, overriding the BSR value. If ‘a’
is ‘1’, then the bank will be selected as
per the BSR value.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
f {,a}
REG, 0, 0
?
1101 0111
1110 1011
1101 0111
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 599
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
SLEEP
Enter Sleep Mode
SUBFWB
Subtract f from W with Borrow
Syntax:
SLEEP
Syntax:
SUBFWB
Operands:
None
Operands:
Operation:
00h WDT,
0 WDT postscaler,
1 TO,
0 PD
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(W) – (f) – (C) dest
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
TO, PD
Encoding:
0000
Encoding:
0000
0000
0011
0101
Description:
The Power-Down Status bit (PD) is
cleared. The Time-out Status bit (TO)
is set. The Watchdog Timer and its
postscaler are cleared.
Description:
1
Cycles:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
Process
Data
Go to
Sleep
Example:
SLEEP
Before Instruction
TO =
?
?
PD =
After Instruction
1†
TO =
0
PD =
† If WDT causes wake-up, this bit is cleared.
DS30000575C-page 600
ffff
ffff
Subtract register ‘f’ and Carry flag
(borrow) from W (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in
W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored in
register ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and BitOriented Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
01da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
The processor is put into Sleep mode
with the oscillator stopped.
Words:
f {,d {,a}}
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
=
3
W
=
2
C
=
1
After Instruction
REG
=
FF
W
=
2
C
=
0
Z
=
0
N
=
1
; result is negative
Example 2:
SUBFWB
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
=
2
W
=
5
C
=
1
After Instruction
REG
=
2
W
=
3
C
=
1
Z
=
0
N
=
0
; result is positive
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Example 3:
Before Instruction
REG
=
1
W
=
2
C
=
0
After Instruction
REG
=
0
W
=
2
C
=
1
Z
=
1
; result is zero
N
=
0
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
SUBLW
Subtract W from Literal
SUBWF
Subtract W from f
Syntax:
SUBLW k
Syntax:
SUBWF
Operands:
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
k – (W) W
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W) dest
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Encoding:
0000
1000
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
W is subtracted from the 8-bit
literal ‘k’. The result is placed in W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
0101
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
W
Example 1:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 2:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 3:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
SUBLW
SUBLW
; result is positive
02h
?
00h
1
1
0
SUBLW
; result is zero
02h
03h
?
FFh
0
0
1
; (2’s complement)
; result is negative
ffff
Subtract W from register ‘f’ (2’s
complement method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result
is stored back in register ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
SUBWF
REG, 1, 0
Example 1:
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 2:
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 3:
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and BitOriented Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset Mode” for details.
02h
02h
11da
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
01h
?
01h
1
0
0
f {,d {,a}}
3
2
?
1
2
1
0
0
; result is positive
SUBWF
REG, 0, 0
2
2
?
2
0
1
1
0
SUBWF
; result is zero
REG, 1, 0
1
2
?
FFh ;(2’s complement)
2
0
; result is negative
0
1
DS30000575C-page 601
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
SUBWFB
Subtract W from f with Borrow
SWAPF
Swap f
Syntax:
SUBWFB
Syntax:
SWAPF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W) – (C) dest
Operation:
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
(f) dest,
(f) dest
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0101
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
10da
ffff
ffff
Subtract W and the Carry flag (borrow)
from register ‘f’ (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’.
Encoding:
0011
Description:
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Q2
Read
register ‘f’
Example 1:
SUBWFB
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 2:
Q4
Write to
destination
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
REG, 1, 0
19h
0Dh
1
(0001 1001)
(0000 1101)
0Ch
0Dh
1
0
0
(0000 1011)
(0000 1101)
ffff
Example:
SWAPF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
REG, 1, 0
53h
35h
; result is positive
SUBWFB REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 3:
1Bh
1Ah
0
(0001 1011)
(0001 1010)
1Bh
00h
1
1
0
(0001 1011)
SUBWFB
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
C
Z
N
Q3
Process
Data
ffff
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
10da
The upper and lower nibbles of register
‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in register ‘f’.
=
=
=
=
DS30000575C-page 602
; result is zero
REG, 1, 0
03h
0Eh
1
(0000 0011)
(0000 1101)
F5h
(1111 0100)
; [2’s comp]
(0000 1101)
0Eh
0
0
1
; result is negative
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TBLRD
Table Read
TBLRD
Table Read (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLRD ( *; *+; *-; +*)
Example 1:
TBLRD
Operands:
None
Operation:
if TBLRD *,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) TABLAT;
TBLPTR – No Change
if TBLRD *+,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) + 1 TBLPTR
if TBLRD *-,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) – 1 TBLPTR
if TBLRD +*,
(TBLPTR) + 1 TBLPTR;
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) TABLAT
Status Affected: None
Encoding:
Description:
0000
0000
0000
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY(00A356h)
After Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
Example 2:
TBLRD
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY(01A357h)
MEMORY(01A358h)
After Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
*+ ;
=
=
=
55h
00A356h
34h
=
=
34h
00A357h
+* ;
=
=
=
=
AAh
01A357h
12h
34h
=
=
34h
01A358h
10nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *=3 +*
This instruction is used to read the contents
of Program Memory (P.M.). To address the
program memory, a pointer called Table
Pointer (TBLPTR) is used.
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory. TBLPTR
has a 2-Mbyte address range.
TBLPTR = 0:Least Significant Byte of
Program Memory Word
TBLPTR = 1:Most Significant Byte of
Program Memory Word
The TBLRD instruction can modify the value
of TBLPTR as follows:
• no change
• post-increment
• post-decrement
• pre-increment
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No operation
(Read Program
Memory)
No
operation
No operation
(Write
TABLAT)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 603
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TBLWT
Table Write
TBLWT
Table Write (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLWT ( *; *+; *-; +*)
Example 1:
TBLWT *+;
Operands:
None
Operation:
if TBLWT*,
(TABLAT) Holding Register;
TBLPTR – No Change
if TBLWT*+,
(TABLAT) Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) + 1 TBLPTR
if TBLWT*-,
(TABLAT) Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) – 1 TBLPTR
if TBLWT+*,
(TBLPTR) + 1 TBLPTR;
(TABLAT) Holding Register
Status Affected:
Example 2:
None
Encoding:
Description:
Before Instruction
TABLAT
=
55h
TBLPTR
=
00A356h
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
FFh
After Instructions (table write completion)
TABLAT
=
55h
TBLPTR
=
00A357h
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
55h
0000
0000
0000
11nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *=3 +*
This instruction uses the 3 LSBs of
TBLPTR to determine which of the
8 holding registers the TABLAT is written
to. The holding registers are used to
program the contents of Program Memory
(P.M.). (Refer to Section 6.0 “Memory
Organization” for additional details on
programming Flash memory.)
TBLWT +*;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
=
34h
TBLPTR
=
01389Ah
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
=
FFh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
=
FFh
After Instruction (table write completion)
TABLAT
=
34h
TBLPTR
=
01389Bh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
=
FFh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
=
34h
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory.
TBLPTR has a 2-Mbyte address range.
The LSb of the TBLPTR selects which
byte of the program memory location to
access.
TBLPTR[0] = 0:Least Significant Byte
of Program Memory
Word
TBLPTR[0] = 1:Most Significant Byte of
Program Memory
Word
The TBLWT instruction can modify the
value of TBLPTR as follows:
•
•
•
•
no change
post-increment
post-decrement
pre-increment
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
operation operation operation
No
No
No
No
operation operation operation operation
(Write to
(Read
Holding
TABLAT)
Register)
DS30000575C-page 604
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TSTFSZ
Test f, Skip if 0
XORLW
Exclusive OR Literal with W
Syntax:
TSTFSZ f {,a}
Syntax:
XORLW k
Operands:
0 f 255
a [0,1]
Operands:
0 k 255
Operation:
(W) .XOR. k W
Status Affected:
N, Z
Operation:
skip if f = 0
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
Encoding:
0110
Description:
011a
ffff
ffff
If ‘f’ = 0, the next instruction fetched
during the current instruction execution
is discarded and a NOP is executed,
making this a 2-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
0000
1010
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are XORed with
the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed
in W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
W
Example:
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
=
XORLW
0AFh
B5h
1Ah
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If CNT
PC
If CNT
PC
TSTFSZ
:
:
CNT, 1
=
Address (HERE)
=
=
=
00h,
Address (ZERO)
00h,
Address (NZERO)
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 605
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
XORWF
Exclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
XORWF
Operands:
0 f 255
d [0,1]
a [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0001
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
10da
ffff
ffff
Exclusive OR the contents of W with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in the register ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f 95 (5Fh). See
Section 29.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
XORWF
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
DS30000575C-page 606
REG, 1, 0
AFh
B5h
1Ah
B5h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
29.2
Extended Instruction Set
A summary of the instructions in the extended instruction set is provided in Table 29-3. Detailed descriptions
are provided in Section 29.2.2 “Extended Instruction
Set”. The opcode field descriptions in Table 29-1
(page 566) apply to both the standard and extended
PIC18 instruction sets.
In addition to the standard 75 instructions of the PIC18
instruction set, the PIC18FXXJ94 of devices also provides an optional extension to the core CPU functionality. The added features include eight additional
instructions that augment Indirect and Indexed
Addressing operations and the implementation of
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing for many of the
standard PIC18 instructions.
Note:
The additional features of the extended instruction set
are enabled by default on unprogrammed devices.
Users must properly set or clear the XINST Configuration bit during programming to enable or disable these
features.
The instructions in the extended set can all be
classified as literal operations, which either manipulate
the File Select Registers, or use them for Indexed
Addressing. Two of the instructions, ADDFSR and
SUBFSR, each have an additional special instantiation
for using FSR2. These versions (ADDULNK and
SUBULNK) allow for automatic return after execution.
29.2.1
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SYNTAX
Most of the extended instructions use indexed arguments, using one of the File Select Registers and some
offset to specify a source or destination register. When
an argument for an instruction serves as part of
Indexed Addressing, it is enclosed in square brackets
(“[ ]”). This is done to indicate that the argument is used
as an index or offset. The MPASM™ Assembler will
flag an error if it determines that an index or offset value
is not bracketed.
The extended instructions are specifically implemented
to optimize re-entrant program code (that is, code that
is recursive or that uses a software stack) written in
high-level languages, particularly C. Among other
things, they allow users working in high-level
languages to perform certain operations on data
structures more efficiently. These include:
When the extended instruction set is enabled, brackets
are also used to indicate index arguments in byteoriented and bit-oriented instructions. This is in addition
to other changes in their syntax. For more details, see
Section 29.2.3.1 “Extended Instruction Syntax with
Standard PIC18 Commands”.
• Dynamic allocation and deallocation of software
stack space when entering and leaving
subroutines
• Function Pointer invocation
• Software Stack Pointer manipulation
• Manipulation of variables located in a software
stack
TABLE 29-3:
The instruction set extension and the
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
were designed for optimizing applications
written in C; the user may likely never use
these instructions directly in assembler.
The syntax for these commands is
provided as a reference for users who
may be reviewing code that has been
generated by a compiler.
Note:
In the past, square brackets have been
used to denote optional arguments in the
PIC18 and earlier instruction sets. In this
text and going forward, optional
arguments are denoted by braces (“{ }”).
EXTENSIONS TO THE PIC18 INSTRUCTION SET
Mnemonic,
Operands
ADDFSR
ADDULNK
CALLW
MOVSF
f, k
k
MOVSS
zs, zd
PUSHL
k
SUBFSR
SUBULNK
f, k
k
zs, fd
Description
Add Literal to FSR
Add Literal to FSR2 and Return
Call Subroutine using WREG
Move zs (source) to 1st word
fd (destination) 2nd word
Move zs (source) to 1st word
zd (destination) 2nd word
Store Literal at FSR2,
Decrement FSR2
Subtract Literal from FSR
Subtract Literal from FSR2 and
return
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Cycles
1
2
2
2
16-Bit Instruction Word
MSb
LSb
Status
Affected
1000
1000
0000
1011
ffff
1011
xxxx
1010
ffkk
11kk
0001
0zzz
ffff
1zzz
xzzz
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
0100
zzzz
ffff
zzzz
zzzz
kkkk
None
None
None
None
1
1110
1110
0000
1110
1111
1110
1111
1110
1
2
1110
1110
1001
1001
ffkk
11kk
kkkk
kkkk
None
None
2
None
None
DS30000575C-page 607
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
29.2.2
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET
ADDFSR
Add Literal to FSR
ADDULNK
Syntax:
ADDFSR f, k
Syntax:
ADDULNK k
Operands:
0 k 63
f [ 0, 1, 2 ]
Operands:
0 k 63
Operation:
Operation:
FSR(f) + k FSR(f)
FSR2 + k FSR2,
(TOS) PC
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
1000
ffkk
kkkk
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of the FSR specified by ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Add Literal to FSR2 and Return
Encoding:
1110
Description:
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
Example:
After Instruction
FSR2
=
03FFh
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
0422h
Example:
Note:
kkkk
This may be thought of as a special
case of the ADDFSR instruction,
where f = 3 (binary ‘11’); it operates
only on FSR2.
ADDFSR 2, 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
11kk
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOP is performed during
the second cycle.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
1000
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of FSR2. A RETURN is then
executed by loading the PC with the
TOS.
ADDULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
0422h
(TOS)
All PIC18 instructions may take an optional label argument preceding the instruction mnemonic for use in
symbolic addressing. If a label is used, the instruction format then becomes: {label} instruction argument(s).
DS30000575C-page 608
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
CALLW
Subroutine Call Using WREG
MOVSF
Move Indexed to f
Syntax:
CALLW
Syntax:
MOVSF [zs], fd
Operands:
None
Operands:
Operation:
(PC + 2) TOS,
(W) PCL,
(PCLATH) PCH,
(PCLATU) PCU
0 zs 127
0 fd 4095
Operation:
((FSR2) + zs) fd
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description
0000
0001
0100
First, the return address (PC + 2) is
pushed onto the return stack. Next, the
contents of W are written to PCL; the
existing value is discarded. Then, the
contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are
latched into PCH and PCU,
respectively. The second cycle is
executed as a NOP instruction while the
new next instruction is fetched.
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
Description:
Unlike CALL, there is no option to
update W, STATUS or BSR.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
WREG
Push PC to
stack
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Before Instruction
PC
=
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
W
=
After Instruction
PC
=
TOS
=
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
W
=
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
CALLW
Decode
address (HERE)
10h
00h
06h
001006h
address (HERE + 2)
10h
00h
06h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
zzzzs
ffffd
If the resultant source address points to
an Indirect Addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h.
Decode
HERE
0zzz
ffff
The contents of the source register are
moved to destination register ‘fd’. The
actual address of the source register is
determined by adding the 7-bit literal
offset ‘zs’, in the first word, to the value
of FSR2. The address of the destination
register is specified by the 12-bit literal
‘fd’ in the second word. Both addresses
can be anywhere in the 4096-byte data
space (000h to FFFh).
Q1
Example:
1011
ffff
The MOVSF instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
1110
1111
Q2
Q3
Determine
Determine
source addr source addr
No
operation
No
operation
No dummy
read
Example:
MOVSF
Before Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
REG2
After Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
REG2
Q4
Read
source reg
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
[05h], REG2
=
80h
=
=
33h
11h
=
80h
=
=
33h
33h
DS30000575C-page 609
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
MOVSS
Move Indexed to Indexed
PUSHL
Store Literal at FSR2, Decrement FSR2
Syntax:
MOVSS [zs], [zd]
Syntax:
PUSHL k
Operands:
0 zs 127
0 zd 127
Operands:
0k 255
Operation:
k (FSR2),
FSR2 – 1 FSR2
Status Affected:
None
Operation:
((FSR2) + zs) ((FSR2) + zd)
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (dest.)
Description
1110
1111
1011
xxxx
1zzz
xzzz
zzzzs
zzzzd
The contents of the source register are
moved to the destination register. The
addresses of the source and destination
registers are determined by adding the
7-bit literal offsets, ‘zs’ or ‘zd’,
respectively, to the value of FSR2. Both
registers can be located anywhere in
the 4096-byte data memory space
(000h to FFFh).
The MOVSS instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
If the resultant source address points to
an Indirect Addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h. If the
resultant destination address points to
an Indirect Addressing register, the
instruction will execute as a NOP.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Decode
Example:
Q2
Q3
Determine
Determine
source addr source addr
Determine
dest addr
Determine
dest addr
Encoding:
1111
Description:
1010
kkkk
kkkk
The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is written to the data
memory address specified by FSR2.
FSR2 is decremented by 1 after the
operation.
This instruction allows users to push
values onto a software stack.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
data
Write to
destination
Example:
PUSHL 08h
Before Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01ECh
00h
After Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01EBh
08h
Q4
Read
source reg
Write
to dest reg
MOVSS [05h], [06h]
Before Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
After Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
DS30000575C-page 610
=
80h
=
33h
=
11h
=
80h
=
33h
=
33h
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
SUBFSR
Subtract Literal from FSR
SUBULNK
Syntax:
SUBFSR f, k
Syntax:
SUBULNK k
Operands:
0 k 63
Operands:
0 k 63
f [ 0, 1, 2 ]
Operation:
Operation:
FSRf – k FSRf
FSR2 – k FSR2,
(TOS) PC
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
1001
ffkk
kkkk
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from
the contents of the FSR specified
by ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
1110
Description:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
After Instruction
FSR2
=
SUBFSR 2, 23h
1001
11kk
kkkk
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from the
contents of the FSR2. A RETURN is then
executed by loading the PC with the
TOS.
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOP is performed during the
second cycle.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
Subtract Literal from FSR2 and Return
This may be thought of as a special case
of the SUBFSR instruction, where f = 3
(binary ‘11’); it operates only on FSR2.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
03FFh
03DCh
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
Example:
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
SUBULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03DCh
(TOS)
DS30000575C-page 611
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
29.2.3
Note:
BYTE-ORIENTED AND BITORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
Enabling the PIC18 instruction set extension may cause legacy applications to
behave erratically or fail entirely.
In addition to eight new commands in the extended set,
enabling the extended instruction set also enables
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing (Section 6.6.1
“Indexed Addressing with Literal Offset”). This has
a significant impact on the way that many commands of
the standard PIC18 instruction set are interpreted.
When the extended set is disabled, addresses embedded in opcodes are treated as literal memory locations:
either as a location in the Access Bank (a = 0) or in a
GPR bank designated by the BSR (a = 1). When the
extended instruction set is enabled and a = 0, however,
a file register argument of 5Fh or less is interpreted as
an offset from the pointer value in FSR2 and not as a
literal address. For practical purposes, this means that
all instructions that use the Access RAM bit as an
argument – that is, all byte-oriented and bit-oriented
instructions, or almost half of the core PIC18 instructions – may behave differently when the extended
instruction set is enabled.
When the content of FSR2 is 00h, the boundaries of the
Access RAM are essentially remapped to their original
values. This may be useful in creating backward
compatible code. If this technique is used, it may be
necessary to save the value of FSR2 and restore it
when moving back and forth between C and assembly
routines in order to preserve the Stack Pointer. Users
must also keep in mind the syntax requirements of the
extended instruction set (see Section 29.2.3.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax with Standard PIC18
Commands”).
Although the Indexed Literal Offset mode can be very
useful for dynamic stack and pointer manipulation, it
can also be very annoying if a simple arithmetic operation is carried out on the wrong register. Users who are
accustomed to the PIC18 programming must keep in
mind, that when the extended instruction set is
enabled, register addresses of 5Fh or less are used for
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing.
Representative examples of typical byte-oriented and
bit-oriented instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset
mode are provided on the following page to show how
execution is affected. The operand conditions shown in
the examples are applicable to all instructions of these
types.
DS30000575C-page 612
29.2.3.1
Extended Instruction Syntax with
Standard PIC18 Commands
When the extended instruction set is enabled, the file
register argument ‘f’ in the standard byte-oriented and
bit-oriented commands is replaced with the literal offset
value ‘k’. As already noted, this occurs only when ‘f’ is
less than or equal to 5Fh. When an offset value is used,
it must be indicated by square brackets (“[ ]”). As with
the extended instructions, the use of brackets indicates
to the compiler that the value is to be interpreted as an
index or an offset. Omitting the brackets, or using a
value greater than 5Fh within the brackets, will
generate an error in the MPASM™ Assembler.
If the index argument is properly bracketed for Indexed
Literal Offset Addressing, the Access RAM argument is
never specified; it will automatically be assumed to be
‘0’. This is in contrast to standard operation (extended
instruction set disabled), when ‘a’ is set on the basis of
the target address. Declaring the Access RAM bit in
this mode will also generate an error in the MPASM
Assembler.
The destination argument, ‘d’, functions as before.
In the latest versions of the MPASM Assembler,
language support for the extended instruction set must
be explicitly invoked. This is done with either the
command-line option, /y, or the PE directive in the
source listing.
29.2.4
CONSIDERATIONS WHEN
ENABLING THE EXTENDED
INSTRUCTION SET
It is important to note that the extensions to the instruction set may not be beneficial to all users. In particular,
users who are not writing code that uses a software
stack may not benefit from using the extensions to the
instruction set.
Additionally, the Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode may create issues with legacy applications
written to the PIC18 assembler. This is because
instructions in the legacy code may attempt to address
registers in the Access Bank below 5Fh. Since these
addresses are interpreted as literal offsets to FSR2
when the instruction set extension is enabled, the
application may read or write to the wrong data
addresses.
When porting an application to the PIC18FXXJ94, it is
very important to consider the type of code. A large, reentrant application that is written in C and would benefit
from efficient compilation will do well when using the
instruction set extensions. Legacy applications that
heavily use the Access Bank will most likely not benefit
from using the extended instruction set.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
ADD W to Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
BSF
Bit Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
Syntax:
ADDWF
Syntax:
BSF [k], b
Operands:
0 k 95
d [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 95
0b7
Operation:
(W) + ((FSR2) + k) dest
Operation:
1 ((FSR2) + k)
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
None
ADDWF
Encoding:
[k] {,d}
0010
Description:
01d0
kkkk
kkkk
The contents of W are added to the
contents of the register indicated by
FSR2, offset by the value ‘k’.
If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in W. If ‘d’
is ‘1’, the result is stored back in
register ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
1000
bbb0
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
Bit ‘b’ of the register indicated by FSR2,
offset by the value ‘k’, is set.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWF
Before Instruction
W
OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A2Ch
After Instruction
W
Contents
of 0A2Ch
[OFST] ,0
=
=
=
17h
2Ch
0A00h
=
20h
=
37h
=
20h
Example:
BSF
Before Instruction
FLAG_OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A0Ah
After Instruction
Contents
of 0A0Ah
[FLAG_OFST], 7
=
=
0Ah
0A00h
=
55h
=
D5h
SETF
Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
Syntax:
SETF [k]
Operands:
0 k 95
Operation:
FFh ((FSR2) + k)
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0110
1000
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of the register indicated by
FSR2, offset by ‘k’, are set to FFh.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
register
Example:
SETF
Before Instruction
OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A2Ch
After Instruction
Contents
of 0A2Ch
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
[OFST]
=
=
2Ch
0A00h
=
00h
=
FFh
DS30000575C-page 613
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
29.2.5
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS WITH
MICROCHIP MPLAB® IDE TOOLS
The latest versions of Microchip’s software tools have
been designed to fully support the extended instruction
set for the PIC18F97J94 Family. This includes the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler, MPASM assembly language
and MPLAB Integrated Development Environment
(IDE).
When selecting a target device for software
development, MPLAB IDE will automatically set default
Configuration bits for that device. The default setting for
the XINST Configuration bit is ‘1’, enabling the
extended instruction set and Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing. For proper execution of applications
developed to take advantage of the extended
instruction set, XINST must be set during
programming.
To develop software for the extended instruction set,
the user must enable support for the instructions and
the Indexed Addressing mode in their language tool(s).
Depending on the environment being used, this may be
done in several ways:
• A menu option or dialog box within the
environment that allows the user to configure the
language tool and its settings for the project
• A command-line option
• A directive in the source code
These options vary between different compilers,
assemblers and development environments. Users are
encouraged to review the documentation accompanying their development systems for the appropriate
information.
DS30000575C-page 614
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
30.0
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Absolute Maximum Ratings(†)
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +100°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS.......................................................................................................... -0.3V to 5.5V
Voltage on any digital only I/O pin with respect to VSS (except VDD)........................................................... -0.3V to 5.5V
Voltage on any combined digital and analog pin with respect to VSS (except VDD and MCLR)...... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VBAT with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to 3.66V
Voltage on VUSB3V3 with respect to VSS ........................................................................................ (VDD – 0.3V) to +4.0V
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS .......................................................................................................... -0.3V to 3.66V
Voltage on D+ or D- with respect to VSS – 0W source impedance (Note 2)............................ -0.5V to (VUSB3V3 + 0.5V)
Source impedance 28W, VUSB3V3 3.0V) .............................................................................................. -1.0V to +4.6V
Total power dissipation (Note 1) ..................................................................................................................................1W
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin ..............................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD) .......................................................................................................... ±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) .................................................................................................. ±20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pins........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pins...................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk byall ports combined.......................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports combined..................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows:
Pdis = VDD x {IDD – IOH} + {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + (VOL x IOL)
2: The original “USB 2.0 Specification” indicated that USB devices should withstand 24-hour short circuits of
D+ or D- to VBUS voltages. This requirement was later removed in an engineering change notice (ECN) supplement to the USB specifications, which supersedes the original specifications. PIC18FXXJ94 family
devices will typically be able to survive this short circuit test, but it is recommended to adhere to the absolute
maximum specified here to avoid damaging the device.
†
NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above
those indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions
for extended periods may affect device reliability.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 615
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH, REGULATOR DISABLED (INDUSTRIAL)(1,2)
FIGURE 30-1:
4V
3.75V
3.6V
Voltage (VDD)
3.25V
PIC18F97J94 Family
2V
4 MHz
Note 1:
2:
3V
2.5V
Frequency
64 MHz
When the USB module is enabled, VUSB3V3 and VDD should be connected together and provided
3.0V-3.6V. When the USB module is not enabled, VUSB3V3 and VDD should still be connected
together.
VCAP (nominal on-chip regulator output voltage) = 1.8V.
DS30000575C-page 616
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-1:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: SUPPLY VOLTAGE PIC18FXXJ94 (INDUSTRIAL)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2V to 3.6V (unless otherwise
stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C TA +85°C
PIC18FXXJ94
(Industrial)
Param
No.
D001
Symbol
VDD
Characteristic
Supply Voltage
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
2.0
—
3.6
V
D001C AVDD
Analog Supply Voltage
VDD –
0.3
—
VDD +
0.3
V
D001D AVSS
Analog Ground Potential
VSS – 0.3
—
VSS + 0.3
V
D001E VUSB3V3
USB Supply Voltage
3
3.3
3.6
V
D002
VDR
RAM Data Retention
Voltage(1)
1.2
—
—
V
D003
VPOR
VDD/VBAT Start Voltage
to Ensure Internal
Power-on Reset Signal
—
—
0.7
V
D004
SVDD
VDD/VBAT Rise Rate
to Ensure Internal
Power-on Reset Signal
0.05
—
—
D005
BVDD
Brown-out Reset
Voltage
BORV = 1(2)
BORV = 0
1.8
2.0
1.88
2.05
1.95
2.20
V
V
USB module enabled(3)
See Section 5.2 “Power-on
Reset (POR)” for details
V/ms See Section 5.2 “Power-on
Reset (POR)” for details
D006
VVDDBOR
1.4V
2.0
V
D007
VVBATBOR
1.4V
1.95
V
D008
VDSBOR
Note 1:
2:
3:
Conditions
1.8
This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode, or during a device Reset, without losing RAM data.
The device will operate normally until Brown-out Reset occurs, even though VDD may be below VDDMIN.
VUSB3V3 should be connected to VDD.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 617
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-2:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT PIC18FXXJ94
(INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18FXXJ94 Family
(Industrial)
Param
No.
Typ.(1)
Max.
Units
3.7
7.0
µA
-40°C
3.7
7.0
µA
+25°C
5.0
9.0
µA
+60°C
DC60
DC61
DC70
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Conditions
9.0
18
µA
+85°C
3.7
8.0
µA
-40°C
3.7
8.0
µA
+25°C
5.0
11.0
µA
+60°C
10
20
µA
+85°C
0.07
0.55
µA
-40°C
0.09
0.55
µA
+25°C
2.0
3.2
µA
+60°C
7.0
8.5
µA
+85°C
0.10
0.65
µA
-40°C
0.15
0.65
µA
+25°C
2.0
3.5
µA
+60°C
7.2
9.0
µA
+85°C
0.06
0.5
µA
-40°C
0.08
0.5
µA
+25°C
0.21
0.8
µA
+60°C
0.41
1.5
µA
+85°C
0.09
0.6
µA
-40°C
0.11
0.6
µA
+25°C
0.42
1.2
µA
+60°C
0.8
4.8
µA
+85°C
0.4
3.0
µA
-40°C TO +85°C
2.0V
Sleep(2)
3.3V
2.0V
Retention Sleep or
Retention Deep Sleep(3)
3.3V
2.0V
Deep Sleep
3.3V
0
RTCC with VBAT mode (LPRC or
SOSC)(4)
Data in the Typical column is at 3.3V, 25°C; typical parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.
Retention regulator is disabled; SRETEN (RCON4= 0), RETEN (CONFIG7L= 1).
Retention regulator is enabled; SRETEN (RCON4 = 1), RETEN (CONFIG7L = 0).
VBAT pin is connected to the battery and RTCC is running with VDD = 0.
TABLE 30-3:
Param
No.
Standard Operating Conditions: 2V to 3.6V (unless otherwise
stated)
Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Device
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Supply Current (IDD)
All Devices
DS30000575C-page 618
22
55
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
23
56
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
21
54
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
22
55
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
FOSC = 31 kHz, RC_RUN
FOSC = 31 kHz, RC_IDLE
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-4:
Param
No.
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Device
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
22
55
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
23
56
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
21
54
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD =2.0V
22
55
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
Supply Current (IDD)
All Devices
TABLE 30-5:
Param
No.
FOSC = 32 kHz, SEC_RUN
FOSC = 32 kHz, SEC_IDLE
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Device
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
325
430
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
325
430
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
540
700
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
540
700
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
820
1000
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
825
1000
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
275
370
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
275
370
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
Supply Current (IDD)
All Devices
345
440
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
345
440
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
435
620
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
435
620
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
FOSC = 1 MHz, RC_RUN
FOSC = 4 MHz, RC_RUN
FOSC = 8 MHz, RC_RUN
FOSC = 1 MHz, RC_IDLE
FOSC = 4 MHz, RC_IDLE
FOSC = 8 MHz, RC_IDLE
DS30000575C-page 619
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-6:
Param
No.
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Device
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
100
150
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
105
155
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
330
390
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
340
405
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
5.0
5.5
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
5.0
5.5
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
5.7
6.5
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
5.7
7.0
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
52
90
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
Supply Current (IDD)
All Devices
DS30000575C-page 620
66
95
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
135
185
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
145
195
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
1.8
2.6
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
= 3.3V
2.0
2.8
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD
2.3
2.9
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
2.4
3.0
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
FOSC = 1 MHz, PRI_RUN mode,
EC Oscillator
FOSC = 4 MHz, PRI_RUN mode,
EC Oscillator
FOSC = 64 MHz, PRI_RUN
mode, EC Oscillator
FOSC = 64 MHz, PRI_RUN
mode, 8 MHz EC Oscillator with
96 MHz or 8X PLL
FOSC = 1 MHz, PRI_IDLE mode,
EC Oscillator
FOSC = 4 MHz, PRI_IDLE mode,
EC Oscillator
FOSC = 64 MHz, PRI_IDLE
mode, EC Oscillator
FOSC = 64 MHz, PRI_IDLE
mode, 8 MHz EC Oscillator with
96 MHz or 8X PLL
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-7:
Param
No.
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Device
Typ.(1) Max.
Units
Conditions
Module Differential Currents (∆IWDT, ∆IBOR, ∆IHLVD, ∆IDSBOR, ∆IDSWDT, ∆IOSCB, ∆IADRC, ∆ILCD, ∆IUSB)
D020 (∆IWDT)
D021 (∆IBOR)
D022 (∆IHLVD)
Watchdog Timer
0.4
1
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
0.4
1
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
Brown-out Reset
8
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
9
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
High-Power BOR
4
8
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
5
9
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
D023 (∆IDSBOR) Deep Sleep BOR
135
480
nA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
to 3.3V
∆Deep Sleep BOR(2)
D024 (∆IDSWDT) Deep Sleep
Watchdog Timer
290
480
nA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
to 3.3V
∆Deep Sleep WDT(2)
D025 (∆IOSCB)
D027 (∆ILCD)
D028 (∆IADRC)
D028 (∆IUSB)
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
High/Low-Voltage
Detect
4
5
Real-Time Clock/
Calendar with Timer1 Oscillator
0.38
1
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
0.55
1
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
LCD Module
0.6
4
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
∆LCD External/Internal,
1/8 MUX, 1/3 Bias(2,3)
6
30
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
7
40
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
∆LCD Charge Pump,
1/8 MUX, 1/3 Bias(2,4)
A/D with RC
330
500
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
385
500
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.3V
1
2
mA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD and
VUSB3V3 = 3.3V
USB Module
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Sym.
VBT
Characteristic
Operating Voltage
VBTADC VBAT A/D Monitoring
Voltage Specification(1)
Note 1:
USB enabled, no cable connected; traffic makes a large difference(5)
Data in the Typical column is at 3.3V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
Incremental current while the module is enabled and running.
LCD is enabled and running, no glass is connected; the resistor ladder current is not included.
LCD is enabled and running, no glass is connected.
This is the module differential current when the USB module is enabled and clocked at 48 MHz, but with no USB cable
attached. When the USB cable is attached, or data is being transmitted, the current consumption may be much higher (see
Section 27.6.4 “USB Transceiver Current Consumption”). During USB Suspend mode (USBEN = 1, SUSPND = 1, bus in
Idle state), the USB module current will be dominated by the D+ or D- pull-up resistor. The integrated pull-up resistors use
“resistor switching” according to the resistor_ecn supplement to the “USB 2.0 Specification” and therefore, may be as low as
900Ω during Idle conditions.
TABLE 30-8:
Param
No.
Sleep mode 32.768 kHz,
T1OSCEN = 1, LPT1OSC = 0
Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V < VDD < 3.6V
-40°C TA +85°C for Industrial (unless otherwise stated)
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
2.0
—
3.6
V
Battery connected to VBAT pin
1.6
—
3.6
V
A/D monitoring the VBAT pin using
the internal A/D channel
Measure A/D value using the A/D represented by the equation (Measured Voltage = ((VBAT/2)/VDD) * 1024) for
10-bit A/D; Measured Voltage = ((VBAT/2)/VDD) * 4096) for 12-bit A/D.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 621
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-9:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN AND SUPPLY CURRENT
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY (INDUSTRIAL)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Sym.
VIL
D031
D031A
D031B
D032
D033
D033A
D034
Characteristic
Input Low Voltage
All I/O Ports:
Schmitt Trigger Buffer
RC3 and RC4
MCLR
OSC1
OSC1
SOSCI
VIH
D041
D041A
D041B
D042
D043
D043A
D044
Input High Voltage
All I/O Ports:
Schmitt Trigger Buffer
RC3 and RC4
MCLR
OSC1
OSC1
SOSCI
Min.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Vss
Vss
Vss
Vss
Vss
Vss
Vss
0.2 VDD
0.3 VDD
0.8
0.2 VDD
0.2 VDD
0.2 VDD
0.3 VDD
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
2V VDD 3.6V
I2C enabled
SMBus enabled
0.8 VDD
0.7 VDD
2.1
0.8 VDD
0.9 VDD
0.7 VDD
0.7 VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
2V VDD 3.6V
I2C enabled
SMBus enabled
±50
±500
nA
LP, MS, HS modes
EC modes
RC mode
HS mode
D060
Input Leakage Current(1)
I/O Ports
D061
D063
MCLR
OSC1
—
—
±500
1
nA
µA
Vss VPIN VDD
Pin at high-impedance
Vss VPIN VDD
Vss VPIN VDD
IPU
Weak Pull-up Current
Weak Pull-up Current
50
400
µA
VDD = 3.6V, VPIN = Vss
VOL
Output Low Voltage
I/O Ports:
All Ports
OSC2/CLKO
(EC modes)
—
—
—
—
0.4
0.4
0.4
0.4
V
V
V
V
IOL = 6.6 mA, VDD = 3.6V
IOL = 5.0 mA, VDD = 2V
IOL = 6.6 mA, VDD = 3.6V
IOL = 5.0 mA, VDD = 2V
3.0
2.4
1.6
1.4
—
—
—
—
V
V
V
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 3.6V
IOH = -6.0 mA, VDD = 3.6V
IOH = -1.0 mA, VDD = 2V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 2V
2.4
1.4
—
—
V
V
IOH = -6.0 mA, VDD = 3.6V
IOH = -1.0 mA, VDD = 2V
—
20
pF
—
—
50
400
pF
pF
In HS mode when external clock is
used to drive OSC1
To meet the AC Timing Specifications
I2C Specification
IIL
D070
D080
D083
VOH
D090
Output High Voltage(1)
I/O Ports:
All Ports
OSC2/CLKO
(INTOSC, EC modes)
D092
D100
COSC2
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins
OSC2 Pin
D101
D102
CIO
CB
All I/O Pins and OSC2
SCLx, SDAx
Note 1:
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
DS30000575C-page 622
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-10: DC CHARACTERISTICS: CTMU CURRENT SOURCE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2V to 3.6V
Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for Industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Sym.
No.
Note 1:
Min.
Typ.(1)
Max.
Units
IOUT1 CTMU Current Source,
Base Range
—
550
—
nA
CTMUCON1 = 01
IOUT2 CTMU Current Source,
10x Range
—
5.5
—
A
CTMUCON1 = 10
IOUT3 CTMU Current Source,
100x Range
—
55
—
A
CTMUCON1 = 11
Characteristic
Conditions
Nominal value at center point of current trim range (CTMUCON1 = 000000).
TABLE 30-11: MEMORY PROGRAMMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions
Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for Industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Sym.
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ†
Max.
Units
Conditions
Internal Program Memory
Programming Specifications(1)
D110
VPP
Voltage on MCLR/VPP Pin
D113
IDDP
Supply Current During
Programming
D130
EP
Cell Endurance
D131
VPR
VDD for Read
VDD + 1.5
—
10
V
—
—
10
mA
1K
20K
—
E/W
2
—
3.6
V
—
3.6
V
(Note 2, Note 3)
Program Flash Memory
D132B VPEW
Voltage for Self-Timed Erase or
Write Operations VDD
2
D133A TIW
Self-Timed Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
ms
D133B TIE
Self-Timed Block Erased Cycle
Time
—
33
—
ms
10
—
—
Year
mA
D134
TRETD Characteristic Retention
D135
IDDP
Supply Current during
Programming
—
—
10
D140
TWE
Writes per Erase Cycle
—
—
1
-40C to +85C
PIC18FXXKXX devices
Provided no other
specifications are violated
For each physical address
† Data in “Typ” column is at 3.3V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: These specifications are for programming the on-chip program memory through the use of table write
instructions.
2: Required only if single-supply programming is disabled.
3: The MPLAB® ICD 2 does not support variable VPP output. Circuitry to limit the MPLAB ICD 2 VPP voltage
must be placed between the MPLAB ICD 2 and the target system when programming or debugging with
the MPLAB ICD 2.
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS30000575C-page 623
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-12: COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 2.0V VDD 3.6V, -40°C TA +85°C
Param
No.
D300
Sym.
Characteristics
Input Offset Voltage
VIOFF
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
—
±5.0
40
mV
D301
VICM
Input Common-Mode Voltage
0
—
AVDD
V
D302
CMRR
Common-Mode Rejection Ratio
55
—
—
dB
D303
TRESP
Response Time(1)
—
150
400
ns
D304
TMC2OV
Comparator Mode Change to
Output Valid*
—
—
10
s
Note 1:
Comments
Response time is measured with one comparator input at (AVDD – 1.5)/2, while the other input transitions
from VSS to VDD.
TABLE 30-13: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 2.0V VDD 3.6V, -40°C TA +85°C
Param
No.
Sym.
Characteristics
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
D310
VRES
Resolution
VDD/32
—
VDD/32
LSb
D311
VRAA
Absolute Accuracy
—
—
3/4
LSb
D312
VRUR
Unit Resistor Value (R)
—
2k
—
TSET
Time(1)
—
—
10
s
D313
Note 1:
Settling
Comments
Settling time measured while CVRR = 1 and CVR transitions from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’.
TABLE 30-14: INTERNAL VOLTAGE REGULATOR SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: -40°C TA +85°C
Param
No.
Sym.
Characteristics
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
VRGOUT Regulator Output Voltage
—
1.8
—
V
CEFC
4.7
10
—
F
External Filter Capacitor Value
Comments
Capacitor must be
low-ESR, a low series
resistance (< 5)
TABLE 30-15: RC OSCILLATOR START-UP TIME
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristics
Standard Operating Conditions: 2V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for Industrial
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
TFRC
—
15
—
µs
TLPRC
—
10
—
µs
DS30000575C-page 624
Comments
2012-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F97J94 FAMILY
TABLE 30-16: USB MODULE SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: -40°C